RENESAS R5F212K2SNFP

REJ09B0406-0110
16
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Hardware Manual
RENESAS MCU
R8C FAMILY / R8C/2x SERIES
All information contained in these materials, including products and product specifications,
represents information on the product at the time of publication and is subject to change by
Renesas Technology Corp. without notice. Please review the latest information published
by Renesas Technology Corp. through various means, including the Renesas Technology
Corp. website (http://www.renesas.com).
Rev.1.10
Revision Date: Dec 21, 2007
www.renesas.com
Notes regarding these materials
1. This document is provided for reference purposes only so that Renesas customers may select the appropriate
Renesas products for their use. Renesas neither makes warranties or representations with respect to the
accuracy or completeness of the information contained in this document nor grants any license to any
intellectual property rights or any other rights of Renesas or any third party with respect to the information in
this document.
2. Renesas shall have no liability for damages or infringement of any intellectual property or other rights arising
out of the use of any information in this document, including, but not limited to, product data, diagrams, charts,
programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples.
3. You should not use the products or the technology described in this document for the purpose of military
applications such as the development of weapons of mass destruction or for the purpose of any other military
use. When exporting the products or technology described herein, you should follow the applicable export
control laws and regulations, and procedures required by such laws and regulations.
4. All information included in this document such as product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and
application circuit examples, is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is
subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas products listed in this
document, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas sales office. Also, please pay regular
and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas such as that disclosed
through our website. (http://www.renesas.com )
5. Renesas has used reasonable care in compiling the information included in this document, but Renesas
assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred as a result of errors or omissions in the information
included in this document.
6. When using or otherwise relying on the information in this document, you should evaluate the information in
light of the total system before deciding about the applicability of such information to the intended application.
Renesas makes no representations, warranties or guaranties regarding the suitability of its products for any
particular application and specifically disclaims any liability arising out of the application and use of the
information in this document or Renesas products.
7. With the exception of products specified by Renesas as suitable for automobile applications, Renesas
products are not designed, manufactured or tested for applications or otherwise in systems the failure or
malfunction of which may cause a direct threat to human life or create a risk of human injury or which require
especially high quality and reliability such as safety systems, or equipment or systems for transportation and
traffic, healthcare, combustion control, aerospace and aeronautics, nuclear power, or undersea communication
transmission. If you are considering the use of our products for such purposes, please contact a Renesas
sales office beforehand. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth above.
8. Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, you should not use Renesas products for the purposes listed below:
(1) artificial life support devices or systems
(2) surgical implantations
(3) healthcare intervention (e.g., excision, administration of medication, etc.)
(4) any other purposes that pose a direct threat to human life
Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth in the above and purchasers who
elect to use Renesas products in any of the foregoing applications shall indemnify and hold harmless Renesas
Technology Corp., its affiliated companies and their officers, directors, and employees against any and all
damages arising out of such applications.
9. You should use the products described herein within the range specified by Renesas, especially with respect
to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation
characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas shall have no liability for malfunctions or
damages arising out of the use of Renesas products beyond such specified ranges.
10. Although Renesas endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, IC products have specific
characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use
conditions. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard against the possibility of physical injury, and
injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas product, such as safety design for
hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention,
appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other applicable measures. Among others, since the
evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or
system manufactured by you.
11. In case Renesas products listed in this document are detached from the products to which the Renesas
products are attached or affixed, the risk of accident such as swallowing by infants and small children is very
high. You should implement safety measures so that Renesas products may not be easily detached from your
products. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of such detachment.
12. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written
approval from Renesas.
13. Please contact a Renesas sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this
document, Renesas semiconductor products, or if you have any other inquiries.
General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products
The following usage notes are applicable to all MPU/MCU products from Renesas. For detailed usage notes
on the products covered by this manual, refer to the relevant sections of the manual. If the descriptions under
General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products and in the body of the manual differ from each
other, the description in the body of the manual takes precedence.
1. Handling of Unused Pins
Handle unused pins in accord with the directions given under Handling of Unused Pins in the
manual.
 The input pins of CMOS products are generally in the high-impedance state. In operation
with an unused pin in the open-circuit state, extra electromagnetic noise is induced in the
vicinity of LSI, an associated shoot-through current flows internally, and malfunctions occur
due to the false recognition of the pin state as an input signal become possible. Unused
pins should be handled as described under Handling of Unused Pins in the manual.
2. Processing at Power-on
The state of the product is undefined at the moment when power is supplied.
 The states of internal circuits in the LSI are indeterminate and the states of register
settings and pins are undefined at the moment when power is supplied.
In a finished product where the reset signal is applied to the external reset pin, the states
of pins are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the reset
process is completed.
In a similar way, the states of pins in a product that is reset by an on-chip power-on reset
function are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the power
reaches the level at which resetting has been specified.
3. Prohibition of Access to Reserved Addresses
Access to reserved addresses is prohibited.
 The reserved addresses are provided for the possible future expansion of functions. Do
not access these addresses; the correct operation of LSI is not guaranteed if they are
accessed.
4. Clock Signals
After applying a reset, only release the reset line after the operating clock signal has become
stable. When switching the clock signal during program execution, wait until the target clock
signal has stabilized.
 When the clock signal is generated with an external resonator (or from an external
oscillator) during a reset, ensure that the reset line is only released after full stabilization of
the clock signal. Moreover, when switching to a clock signal produced with an external
resonator (or by an external oscillator) while program execution is in progress, wait until
the target clock signal is stable.
5. Differences between Products
Before changing from one product to another, i.e. to one with a different part number, confirm
that the change will not lead to problems.
 The characteristics of MPU/MCU in the same group but having different part numbers may
differ because of the differences in internal memory capacity and layout pattern. When
changing to products of different part numbers, implement a system-evaluation test for
each of the products.
How to Use This Manual
1.
Purpose and Target Readers
This manual is designed to provide the user with an understanding of the hardware functions and electrical
characteristics of the MCU. It is intended for users designing application systems incorporating the MCU. A basic
knowledge of electric circuits, logical circuits, and MCUs is necessary in order to use this manual.
The manual comprises an overview of the product; descriptions of the CPU, system control functions, peripheral
functions, and electrical characteristics; and usage notes.
Particular attention should be paid to the precautionary notes when using the manual. These notes occur
within the body of the text, at the end of each section, and in the Usage Notes section.
The revision history summarizes the locations of revisions and additions. It does not list all revisions. Refer
to the text of the manual for details.
The following documents apply to the R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group. Make sure to refer to the latest versions of
these documents. The newest versions of the documents listed may be obtained from the Renesas Technology Web
site.
Document Type
Datasheet
Description
Document Title
Document No.
REJ03B0219
Hardware overview and electrical characteristics R8C/2K Group,
R8C/2L Group
Group Datasheet
R8C/2K Group,
This hardware
Hardware manual Hardware specifications (pin assignments,
R8C/2L Group
manual
memory maps, peripheral function
Hardware Manual
specifications, electrical characteristics, timing
charts) and operation description
Note: Refer to the application notes for details on
using peripheral functions.
Software manual Description of CPU instruction set
R8C/Tiny Series
REJ09B0001
Software Manual
Available from Renesas
Application note Information on using peripheral functions and
Technology Web site.
application examples
Sample programs
Information on writing programs in assembly
language and C
Renesas
Product specifications, updates on documents,
technical update etc.
2.
Notation of Numbers and Symbols
The notation conventions for register names, bit names, numbers, and symbols used in this manual are described
below.
(1)
Register Names, Bit Names, and Pin Names
Registers, bits, and pins are referred to in the text by symbols. The symbol is accompanied by the word
“register,” “bit,” or “pin” to distinguish the three categories.
Examples the PM03 bit in the PM0 register
P3_5 pin, VCC pin
(2)
Notation of Numbers
The indication “b” is appended to numeric values given in binary format. However, nothing is appended to the
values of single bits. The indication “h” is appended to numeric values given in hexadecimal format. Nothing
is appended to numeric values given in decimal format.
Examples Binary: 11b
Hexadecimal: EFA0h
Decimal: 1234
3.
Register Notation
The symbols and terms used in register diagrams are described below.
XXX Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
*1
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
XXX
0
Bit Symbol
XXX0
Address
XXX
Bit Name
XXX bits
XXX1
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
1 0: XXX
0 1: XXX
1 0: Do not set.
1 1: XXX
RW
RW
(b2)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
(b3)
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
RW
XXX bits
Function varies according to the operating
mode.
RW
XXX4
*3
XXX5
WO
XXX6
RW
XXX7
XXX bit
*2
b1 b0
0: XXX
1: XXX
*4
RO
*1
Blank: Set to 0 or 1 according to the application.
0: Set to 0.
1: Set to 1.
X: Nothing is assigned.
*2
RW: Read and write.
RO: Read only.
WO: Write only.
−: Nothing is assigned.
*3
• Reserved bit
Reserved bit. Set to specified value.
*4
• Nothing is assigned
Nothing is assigned to the bit. As the bit may be used for future functions, if necessary, set to 0.
• Do not set to a value
Operation is not guaranteed when a value is set.
• Function varies according to the operating mode.
The function of the bit varies with the peripheral function mode. Refer to the register diagram for information
on the individual modes.
4.
List of Abbreviations and Acronyms
Abbreviation
ACIA
bps
CRC
DMA
DMAC
GSM
Hi-Z
IEBus
I/O
IrDA
LSB
MSB
NC
PLL
PWM
SFR
SIM
UART
VCO
Full Form
Asynchronous Communication Interface Adapter
bits per second
Cyclic Redundancy Check
Direct Memory Access
Direct Memory Access Controller
Global System for Mobile Communications
High Impedance
Inter Equipment bus
Input/Output
Infrared Data Association
Least Significant Bit
Most Significant Bit
Non-Connection
Phase Locked Loop
Pulse Width Modulation
Special Function Registers
Subscriber Identity Module
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter
Voltage Controlled Oscillator
All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Table of Contents
SFR Page Reference ........................................................................................................................... B - 1
1.
Overview ......................................................................................................................................... 1
1.1
1.1.1
1.1.2
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
2.
Features ..................................................................................................................................................... 1
Applications .......................................................................................................................................... 1
Specifications ........................................................................................................................................ 2
Product List ............................................................................................................................................... 6
Block Diagram ......................................................................................................................................... 8
Pin Assignment .......................................................................................................................................... 9
Pin Functions ........................................................................................................................................... 11
Central Processing Unit (CPU) ..................................................................................................... 12
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
2.8.1
2.8.2
2.8.3
2.8.4
2.8.5
2.8.6
2.8.7
2.8.8
2.8.9
2.8.10
3.
Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) ......................................................................................................
Address Registers (A0 and A1) ...............................................................................................................
Frame Base Register (FB) .......................................................................................................................
Interrupt Table Register (INTB) ..............................................................................................................
Program Counter (PC) .............................................................................................................................
User Stack Pointer (USP) and Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP) ..................................................................
Static Base Register (SB) ........................................................................................................................
Flag Register (FLG) ................................................................................................................................
Carry Flag (C) .....................................................................................................................................
Debug Flag (D) ...................................................................................................................................
Zero Flag (Z) .......................................................................................................................................
Sign Flag (S) .......................................................................................................................................
Register Bank Select Flag (B) ............................................................................................................
Overflow Flag (O) ..............................................................................................................................
Interrupt Enable Flag (I) .....................................................................................................................
Stack Pointer Select Flag (U) ..............................................................................................................
Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) .............................................................................................
Reserved Bit ........................................................................................................................................
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
14
14
14
14
Memory ......................................................................................................................................... 15
3.1
3.2
R8C/2K Group ........................................................................................................................................ 15
R8C/2L Group ......................................................................................................................................... 16
4.
Special Function Registers (SFRs) ............................................................................................... 17
5.
Resets ........................................................................................................................................... 24
5.1
5.1.1
5.1.2
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
Hardware Reset .......................................................................................................................................
When Power Supply is Stable .............................................................................................................
Power On ............................................................................................................................................
Power-On Reset Function .......................................................................................................................
Voltage Monitor 0 Reset .........................................................................................................................
Voltage Monitor 1 Reset .........................................................................................................................
Voltage Monitor 2 Reset .........................................................................................................................
Watchdog Timer Reset ............................................................................................................................
Software Reset .........................................................................................................................................
A-1
27
27
27
29
30
30
30
31
31
6.
Voltage Detection Circuit .............................................................................................................. 32
6.1
6.1.1
6.1.2
6.1.3
6.2
6.3
6.4
7.
VCC Input Voltage ..................................................................................................................................
Monitoring Vdet0 ...............................................................................................................................
Monitoring Vdet1 ...............................................................................................................................
Monitoring Vdet2 ...............................................................................................................................
Voltage Monitor 0 Reset .........................................................................................................................
Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 1 Reset .....................................................................
Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset .....................................................................
39
39
39
39
40
41
43
Programmable I/O Ports ............................................................................................................... 45
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
8.
Functions of Programmable I/O Ports .....................................................................................................
Effect on Peripheral Functions ................................................................................................................
Pins Other than Programmable I/O Ports ................................................................................................
Port settings .............................................................................................................................................
Unassigned Pin Handling ........................................................................................................................
45
46
46
58
68
Processor Mode ............................................................................................................................ 69
8.1
Processor Modes ...................................................................................................................................... 69
9.
Bus ................................................................................................................................................ 70
10.
Clock Generation Circuit ............................................................................................................... 71
10.1
10.2
10.2.1
10.2.2
10.3
10.3.1
10.3.2
10.3.3
10.3.4
10.3.5
10.3.6
10.3.7
10.3.8
10.4
10.4.1
10.4.2
10.4.3
10.5
10.5.1
10.6
10.6.1
10.6.2
10.6.3
10.6.4
XIN Clock ...............................................................................................................................................
On-Chip Oscillator Clocks ......................................................................................................................
Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock ................................................................................................
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock ...............................................................................................
CPU Clock and Peripheral Function Clock .............................................................................................
System Clock ......................................................................................................................................
CPU Clock ..........................................................................................................................................
Peripheral Function Clock (f1, f2, f4, f8, and f32) .............................................................................
fOCO ...................................................................................................................................................
fOCO40M ...........................................................................................................................................
fOCO-F ...............................................................................................................................................
fOCO-S ...............................................................................................................................................
fOCO128 .............................................................................................................................................
Power Control ..........................................................................................................................................
Standard Operating Mode ...................................................................................................................
Wait Mode ..........................................................................................................................................
Stop Mode ...........................................................................................................................................
Oscillation Stop Detection Function .......................................................................................................
How to Use Oscillation Stop Detection Function ...............................................................................
Notes on Clock Generation Circuit .........................................................................................................
Stop Mode ...........................................................................................................................................
Wait Mode ..........................................................................................................................................
Oscillation Stop Detection Function ...................................................................................................
Oscillation Circuit Constants ..............................................................................................................
A-2
81
82
82
82
83
83
83
83
83
83
83
83
83
84
84
86
89
92
92
95
95
95
95
95
11.
Protection ...................................................................................................................................... 96
12.
Interrupts ....................................................................................................................................... 97
12.1
12.1.1
12.1.2
12.1.3
12.1.4
12.1.5
12.1.6
12.2
12.2.1
12.2.2
12.3
12.4
12.5
12.6
12.6.1
12.6.2
12.6.3
12.6.4
12.6.5
13.
Interrupt Overview .................................................................................................................................. 97
Types of Interrupts .............................................................................................................................. 97
Software Interrupts ............................................................................................................................. 98
Special Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ 99
Peripheral Function Interrupt .............................................................................................................. 99
Interrupts and Interrupt Vectors ........................................................................................................ 100
Interrupt Control ............................................................................................................................... 102
INT Interrupt ......................................................................................................................................... 111
INTi Interrupt (i = 0, 1, 3) ................................................................................................................. 111
INTi Input Filter (i = 0, 1, 3) ............................................................................................................. 113
Key Input Interrupt ................................................................................................................................ 114
Address Match Interrupt ........................................................................................................................ 116
Timer RC Interrupt, Timer RD Interrupt (Interrupts with Multiple Interrupt Request Sources) .......... 118
Notes on Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ 120
Reading Address 00000h .................................................................................................................. 120
SP Setting .......................................................................................................................................... 120
External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt ....................................................................................... 120
Changing Interrupt Sources .............................................................................................................. 121
Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents ................................................................................. 122
ID Code Areas ............................................................................................................................ 123
13.1
Overview ............................................................................................................................................... 123
13.2
Functions ............................................................................................................................................... 123
13.3
Notes on ID Code Areas ........................................................................................................................ 124
13.3.1 Setting Example of ID Code Areas ................................................................................................... 124
14.
Option Function Select Area ....................................................................................................... 125
14.1
Overview ...............................................................................................................................................
14.2
OFS Register .........................................................................................................................................
14.3
Notes on Option Function Select Area ..................................................................................................
14.3.1 Setting Example of Option Function Select Area .............................................................................
15.
15.1
15.2
16.
125
126
127
127
Watchdog Timer .......................................................................................................................... 128
Count Source Protection Mode Disabled .............................................................................................. 132
Count Source Protection Mode Enabled ............................................................................................... 133
Timers ......................................................................................................................................... 134
16.1
Timer RA ...............................................................................................................................................
16.1.1 Timer Mode ......................................................................................................................................
16.1.2 Pulse Output Mode ...........................................................................................................................
16.1.3 Event Counter Mode .........................................................................................................................
16.1.4 Pulse Width Measurement Mode ......................................................................................................
16.1.5 Pulse Period Measurement Mode .....................................................................................................
16.1.6 Notes on Timer RA ...........................................................................................................................
16.2
Timer RB ...............................................................................................................................................
16.2.1 Timer Mode ......................................................................................................................................
A-3
136
139
141
143
145
148
151
152
157
16.2.2 Programmable Waveform Generation Mode ....................................................................................
16.2.3 Programmable One-shot Generation Mode ......................................................................................
16.2.4 Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode .............................................................................
16.2.5 Notes on Timer RB ...........................................................................................................................
16.3
Timer RC ...............................................................................................................................................
16.3.1 Overview ...........................................................................................................................................
16.3.2 Registers Associated with Timer RC ................................................................................................
16.3.3 Common Items for Multiple Modes .................................................................................................
16.3.4 Timer Mode (Input Capture Function) .............................................................................................
16.3.5 Timer Mode (Output Compare Function) .........................................................................................
16.3.6 PWM Mode .......................................................................................................................................
16.3.7 PWM2 Mode .....................................................................................................................................
16.3.8 Timer RC Interrupt ...........................................................................................................................
16.3.9 Notes on Timer RC ...........................................................................................................................
16.4
Timer RD ...............................................................................................................................................
16.4.1 Count Sources ...................................................................................................................................
16.4.2 Buffer Operation ...............................................................................................................................
16.4.3 Synchronous Operation .....................................................................................................................
16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced Cutoff ..............................................................................................................
16.4.5 Input Capture Function .....................................................................................................................
16.4.6 Output Compare Function ................................................................................................................
16.4.7 PWM Mode .......................................................................................................................................
16.4.8 Reset Synchronous PWM Mode .......................................................................................................
16.4.9 Complementary PWM Mode ............................................................................................................
16.4.10 PWM3 Mode .....................................................................................................................................
16.4.11 Timer RD Interrupt ...........................................................................................................................
16.4.12 Notes on Timer RD ...........................................................................................................................
17.
Serial Interface ............................................................................................................................ 316
17.1
Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode .....................................................................................................
17.1.1 Polarity Select Function ....................................................................................................................
17.1.2 LSB First/MSB First Select Function ...............................................................................................
17.1.3 Continuous Receive Mode ................................................................................................................
17.2
Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode ....................................................................................
17.2.1 Bit Rate .............................................................................................................................................
17.3
Notes on Serial Interface .......................................................................................................................
18.
160
163
167
170
174
174
176
186
192
197
203
208
214
215
216
221
222
224
225
227
241
258
271
281
295
308
310
322
325
325
326
327
331
332
Hardware LIN .............................................................................................................................. 333
18.1
18.2
18.3
18.4
18.4.1
18.4.2
18.4.3
18.4.4
18.5
18.6
Features .................................................................................................................................................
Input/Output Pins ..................................................................................................................................
Register Configuration ..........................................................................................................................
Functional Description ..........................................................................................................................
Master Mode .....................................................................................................................................
Slave Mode .......................................................................................................................................
Bus Collision Detection Function .....................................................................................................
Hardware LIN End Processing .........................................................................................................
Interrupt Requests ..................................................................................................................................
Notes on Hardware LIN ........................................................................................................................
A-4
333
334
335
337
337
340
344
345
346
347
19.
A/D Converter ............................................................................................................................. 348
19.1
19.2
19.3
19.4
19.5
19.6
19.7
20.
One-Shot Mode .....................................................................................................................................
Repeat Mode ..........................................................................................................................................
Sample and Hold ...................................................................................................................................
A/D Conversion Cycles .........................................................................................................................
Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input ..........................................................................................
Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion ............................................................................
Notes on A/D Converter ........................................................................................................................
Flash Memory ............................................................................................................................. 362
20.1
20.2
20.3
20.3.1
20.3.2
20.4
20.4.1
20.4.2
20.4.3
20.4.4
20.5
20.5.1
20.6
20.6.1
20.7
20.7.1
21.
352
355
358
358
359
360
361
Overview ...............................................................................................................................................
Memory Map .........................................................................................................................................
Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory ................................................................................
ID Code Check Function ..................................................................................................................
ROM Code Protect Function ............................................................................................................
CPU Rewrite Mode ...............................................................................................................................
Register Description .........................................................................................................................
Status Check Procedure ....................................................................................................................
EW0 Mode ........................................................................................................................................
EW1 Mode ........................................................................................................................................
Standard Serial I/O Mode ......................................................................................................................
ID Code Check Function ..................................................................................................................
Parallel I/O Mode ..................................................................................................................................
ROM Code Protect Function ............................................................................................................
Notes on Flash Memory ........................................................................................................................
CPU Rewrite Mode ...........................................................................................................................
362
363
364
364
365
366
367
373
374
384
392
392
395
395
396
396
Reducing Power Consumption ................................................................................................... 398
21.1
Overview ...............................................................................................................................................
21.2
Key Points and Processing Methods for Reducing Power Consumption .............................................
21.2.1 Voltage Detection Circuit .................................................................................................................
21.2.2 Ports ..................................................................................................................................................
21.2.3 Clocks ...............................................................................................................................................
21.2.4 Wait Mode, Stop Mode .....................................................................................................................
21.2.5 Stopping Peripheral Function Clocks ...............................................................................................
21.2.6 Timers ...............................................................................................................................................
21.2.7 A/D Converter ...................................................................................................................................
21.2.8 Reducing Internal Power Consumption ............................................................................................
21.2.9 Stopping Flash Memory ....................................................................................................................
21.2.10 Low-Current-Consumption Read Mode ...........................................................................................
398
398
398
398
398
398
398
398
398
399
400
401
22.
Electrical Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 402
23.
Usage Notes ............................................................................................................................... 423
23.1
Notes on Clock Generation Circuit ....................................................................................................... 423
23.1.1 Stop Mode ......................................................................................................................................... 423
23.1.2 Wait Mode ........................................................................................................................................ 423
23.1.3 Oscillation Stop Detection Function ................................................................................................. 423
23.1.4 Oscillation Circuit Constants ............................................................................................................ 423
A-5
23.2
23.2.1
23.2.2
23.2.3
23.2.4
23.2.5
23.3
23.3.1
23.3.2
23.3.3
23.3.4
23.4
23.5
23.6
23.7
23.7.1
23.8
23.8.1
Notes on Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ 424
Reading Address 00000h .................................................................................................................. 424
SP Setting .......................................................................................................................................... 424
External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt ....................................................................................... 424
Changing Interrupt Sources .............................................................................................................. 425
Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents ................................................................................. 426
Notes on Timers .................................................................................................................................... 427
Notes on Timer RA ........................................................................................................................... 427
Notes on Timer RB ........................................................................................................................... 428
Notes on Timer RC ........................................................................................................................... 432
Notes on Timer RD ........................................................................................................................... 433
Notes on Serial Interface ....................................................................................................................... 439
Notes on Hardware LIN ........................................................................................................................ 440
Notes on A/D Converter ........................................................................................................................ 441
Notes on Flash Memory ........................................................................................................................ 442
CPU Rewrite Mode ........................................................................................................................... 442
Notes on Noise ...................................................................................................................................... 444
Inserting a Bypass Capacitor between VCC and VSS Pins as a Countermeasure against Noise and
Latch-up ........................................................................................................................................... 444
23.8.2 Countermeasures against Noise Error of Port Control Registers ..................................................... 444
24.
Notes for On-Chip Debugger ...................................................................................................... 445
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions ........................................................................................................ 446
Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging Emulator ............ 447
Appendix 3. Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit ......................................................................... 448
Index ..................................................................................................................................................... 449
A-6
SFR Page Reference
Address
0000h
0001h
0002h
0003h
0004h
0005h
0006h
0007h
0008h
0009h
000Ah
000Bh
000Ch
000Dh
000Eh
000Fh
0010h
0011h
0012h
0013h
0014h
0015h
0016h
0017h
0018h
0019h
001Ah
001Bh
001Ch
001Dh
001Eh
001Fh
0020h
0021h
0022h
0023h
0024h
0025h
0026h
0027h
0028h
0029h
002Ah
002Bh
002Ch
002Dh
002Eh
002Fh
0030h
0031h
0032h
0033h
0034h
0035h
0036h
0037h
0038h
0039h
003Ah
003Bh
003Ch
003Dh
003Eh
003Fh
NOTE:
1.
Register
Symbol
Page
Processor Mode Register 0
Processor Mode Register 1
System Clock Control Register 0
System Clock Control Register 1
PM0
PM1
CM0
CM1
69
69
74
75
Protect Register
PRCR
96
Oscillation Stop Detection Register
Watchdog Timer Reset Register
Watchdog Timer Start Register
Watchdog Timer Control Register
Address Match Interrupt Register 0
OCD
WDTR
WDTS
WDC
RMAD0
76
130
130
130
117
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register
Address Match Interrupt Register 1
Count Source Protection Mode Register
AIER
RMAD1
CSPR
117
117
131
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 0 FRA0
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 1 FRA1
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 2 FRA2
77
77
78
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 6 FRA6
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 7 FRA7
78
78
Voltage Detection Register 1
Voltage Detection Register 2
VCA1
VCA2
35
35, 79
Voltage Monitor 1 Circuit Control Register
Voltage Monitor 2 Circuit Control Register
Voltage Monitor 0 Circuit Control Register
VW1C
VW2C
VW0C
37
38
36
Address
0040h
0041h
0042h
0043h
0044h
0045h
0046h
0047h
0048h
0049h
004Ah
004Bh
004Ch
004Dh
004Eh
004Fh
0050h
0051h
0052h
0053h
0054h
0055h
0056h
0057h
0058h
0059h
005Ah
005Bh
005Ch
005Dh
005Eh
005Fh
0060h
0061h
0062h
0063h
0064h
0065h
0066h
0067h
0068h
0069h
006Ah
006Bh
006Ch
006Dh
006Eh
006Fh
0070h
0071h
0072h
0073h
0074h
0075h
0076h
0077h
0078h
0079h
007Ah
007Bh
007Ch
007Dh
007Eh
007Fh
The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these
regions.
B-1
Register
Symbol
Page
Timer RC Interrupt Control Register
Timer RD0 Interrupt Control Register
Timer RD1 Interrupt Control Register
TRCIC
TRD0IC
TRD1IC
103
103
103
UART2 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Receive Interrupt Control Register
Key Input Interrupt Control Register
A/D Conversion Interrupt Control Register
S2TIC
S2RIC
KUPIC
ADIC
102
102
102
102
UART0 Transmit Interrupt Control Register S0TIC
UART0 Receive Interrupt Control Register S0RIC
102
102
Timer RA Interrupt Control Register
TRAIC
102
Timer RB Interrupt Control Register
INT1 Interrupt Control Register
INT3 Interrupt Control Register
TRBIC
INT1IC
INT3IC
102
104
104
INT0 Interrupt Control Register
INT0IC
104
Address
0080h
0081h
0082h
0083h
0084h
0085h
0086h
0087h
0088h
0089h
008Ah
008Bh
008Ch
008Dh
008Eh
008Fh
0090h
0091h
0092h
0093h
0094h
0095h
0096h
0097h
0098h
0099h
009Ah
009Bh
009Ch
009Dh
009Eh
009Fh
00A0h
00A1h
00A2h
00A3h
00A4h
00A5h
00A6h
00A7h
00A8h
00A9h
00AAh
00ABh
00ACh
00ADh
00AEh
00AFh
00B0h
00B1h
00B2h
00B3h
00B4h
00B5h
00B6h
00B7h
00B8h
00B9h
00BAh
00BBh
00BCh
00BDh
00BEh
00BFh
NOTE:
1.
Register
UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART0 Bit Rate Register
UART0 Transmit Buffer Register
Symbol
U0MR
U0BRG
U0TB
UART0 Transmit / Receive Control Register 0 U0C0
UART0 Transmit / Receive Control Register 1 U0C1
UART0 Receive Buffer Register
U0RB
Page
Address
00C0h
00C1h
00C2h
00C3h
00C4h
00C5h
00C6h
00C7h
00C8h
00C9h
00CAh
00CBh
00CCh
00CDh
00CEh
00CFh
00D0h
00D1h
00D2h
00D3h
00D4h
00D5h
00D6h
00D7h
00D8h
00D9h
00DAh
00DBh
00DCh
00DDh
00DEh
00DFh
00E0h
00E1h
00E2h
00E3h
00E4h
00E5h
00E6h
00E7h
00E8h
00E9h
00EAh
00EBh
00ECh
00EDh
00EEh
00EFh
00F0h
00F1h
00F2h
00F3h
00F4h
00F5h
00F6h
00F7h
00F8h
00F9h
00FAh
00FBh
00FCh
00FDh
00FEh
00FFh
318
318
319
319
320
320
The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these
regions.
B-2
Register
Symbol
Page
351
A/D Register
AD
A/D Control Register 2
ADCON2
351
A/D Control Register 0
A/D Control Register 1
ADCON0
ADCON1
350
351
Port P0 Register
Port P1 Register
Port P0 Direction Register
Port P1 Direction Register
Port P2 Register
Port P3 Register
Port P2 Direction Register
Port P3 Direction Register
Port P4 Register
P0
P1
PD0
PD1
P2
P3
PD2
PD3
P4
55
55
54
54
55
55
54
54
55
Port P4 Direction Register
PD4
54
Port P2 Drive Capacity Control Register
Pin Select Register 1
Pin Select Register 2
Pin Select Register 3
Port Mode Register
External Input Enable Register
INT Input Filter Select Register
Key Input Enable Register
Pull-Up Control Register 0
Pull-Up Control Register 1
P2DRR
PINSR1
PINSR2
PINSR3
PMR
INTEN
INTF
KIEN
PUR0
PUR1
55
56
56
56
56
111
112
115
57
57
Address
Register
0100h Timer RA Control Register
0101h Timer RA I/O Control Register
Symbol
TRACR
TRAIOC
0102h
0103h
0104h
0105h
0106h
0107h
0108h
0109h
010Ah
Timer RA Mode Register
Timer RA Prescaler Register
Timer RA Register
LIN Control Register 2
LIN Control Register
LIN Status Register
Timer RB Control Register
Timer RB One-Shot Control Register
Timer RB I/O Control Register
TRAMR
TRAPRE
TRA
LINCR2
LINCR
LINST
TRBCR
TRBOCR
TRBIOC
010Bh
010Ch
010Dh
010Eh
010Fh
0110h
0111h
0112h
0113h
0114h
0115h
0116h
0117h
Timer RB Mode Register
Timer RB Prescaler Register
Timer RB Secondary Register
Timer RB Primary Register
TRBMR
TRBPRE
TRBSC
TRBPR
0118h
0119h
011Ah
011Bh
011Ch
011Dh
011Eh
011Fh
0120h
0121h
0122h
0123h
0124h
0125h
0126h
0127h
0128h
0129h
012Ah
012Bh
012Ch
012Dh
012Eh
012Fh
NOTE:
1.
Page
137
137, 139, 142,
144, 146, 149
138
138
138
335
335
336
154
154
155, 157, 161,
164, 168
155
156
156
156
Address
Register
0130h Timer RC Control Register 2
0131h Timer RC Digital Filter Function Select
Register
0132h Timer RC Output Master Enable Register
0133h
0134h
0135h
0136h
0137h Timer RD Start Register
TRCMR
TRCCR1
Timer RC Interrupt Enable Register
Timer RC Status Register
Timer RC I/O Control Register 0
Timer RC I/O Control Register 1
Timer RC Counter
TRCIER
TRCSR
TRCIOR0
TRCIOR1
TRC
177
178, 201, 205,
210
179
180
185, 194, 199
185, 195, 200
181
Timer RC General Register A
TRCGRA
181
Timer RC General Register B
TRCGRB
181
Timer RC General Register C
TRCGRC
181
Timer RC General Register D
TRCGRD
181
The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these
regions.
Page
182
183
TRCOER
184
TRDSTR
0138h
Timer RD Mode Register
TRDMR
0139h
013Ah
Timer RD PWM Mode Register
Timer RD Function Control Register
TRDPMR
TRDFCR
013Bh
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
TRDOER1
013Ch
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
TRDOER2
013Dh
013Eh
TRDOCR
TRDDF0
TRDDF1
232
0140h
Timer RD Output Control Register
Timer RD Digital Filter Function Select
Register 0
Timer RD Digital Filter Function Select
Register 1
Timer RD Control Register 0
229, 243, 260,
273, 283, 297
229, 243, 260,
273, 284, 298
230, 244, 261
231, 245, 262,
274, 285, 299
246, 263, 275,
286, 300
246, 263, 275,
286, 300
247, 264, 301
232
0141h
0142h
0143h
Timer RD I/O Control Register A0
Timer RD I/O Control Register C0
Timer RD Status Register 0
0144h
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register 0
0145h
Timer RD PWM Mode Output Level Control
Register 0
Timer RD Counter 0
013Fh
Timer RC Mode Register
Timer RC Control Register 1
Symbol
TRCCR2
TRCDF
0146h
0147h
0148h
0149h
014Ah
014Bh
014Ch
014Dh
014Eh
014Fh
0150h
B-3
233, 248, 264,
276, 287, 302
TRDIORA0
234, 249
TRDIORC0
235, 250
TRDSR0
236, 251, 265,
277, 288, 303
TRDIER0
237, 252, 266,
278, 289, 304
TRDPOCR0
267
TRD0
237, 253, 267,
278, 290, 304
Timer RD General Register A0
TRDGRA0
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD General Register B0
TRDGRB0
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD General Register C0
TRDGRC0
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD General Register D0
TRDGRD0
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD Control Register 1
TRDCR1
0151h
0152h
0153h
Timer RD I/O Control Register A1
Timer RD I/O Control Register C1
Timer RD Status Register 1
0154h
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register 1
0155h
Timer RD PWM Mode Output Level Control
Register 1
Timer RD Counter 1
0156h
0157h
0158h
0159h
015Ah
015Bh
015Ch
015Dh
015Eh
015Fh
TRDCR0
233, 248, 264,
287
TRDIORA1
234, 249
TRDIORC1
235, 250
TRDSR1
236, 251, 265,
277, 288, 303
TRDIER1
237, 252, 266,
278, 289, 304
TRDPOCR1
267
TRD1
237, 253, 267,
290
Timer RD General Register A1
TRDGRA1
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD General Register B1
TRDGRB1
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD General Register C1
TRDGRC1
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Timer RD General Register D1
TRDGRD1
238, 253, 268,
279, 290, 305
Address
0160h
0161h
0162h
0163h
0164h
0165h
0166h
0167h
0168h
0169h
016Ah
016Bh
016Ch
016Dh
016Eh
016Fh
0170h
0171h
0172h
0173h
0174h
0175h
0176h
0177h
0178h
0179h
017Ah
017Bh
017Ch
017Dh
017Eh
017Fh
0180h
0181h
0182h
0183h
0184h
0185h
0186h
0187h
0188h
0189h
018Ah
018Bh
018Ch
018Dh
018Eh
018Fh
0190h
0191h
0192h
0193h
0194h
0195h
0196h
0197h
0198h
0199h
019Ah
019Bh
019Ch
019Dh
019Eh
019Fh
NOTE:
1.
Register
UART2 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART2 Bit Rate Register
UART2 Transmit Buffer Register
Symbol
U2MR
U2BRG
U2TB
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
UART2 Receive Buffer Register
U2C0
U2C1
U2RB
Page
318
318
319
319
320
320
Address
Register
01A0h
01A1h
01A2h
01A3h
01A4h
01A5h
01A6h
01A7h
01A8h
01A9h
01AAh
01ABh
01ACh
01ADh
01AEh
01AFh
01B0h
01B1h
01B2h
01B3h Flash Memory Control Register 4
01B4h
01B5h Flash Memory Control Register 1
01B6h
01B7h Flash Memory Control Register 0
01B8h
01B9h
01BAh
01BBh
01BCh
01BDh
01BEh
01BFh
FFFFh
The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these
regions.
B-4
Option Function Select Register
Symbol
Page
FMR4
371
FMR1
370
FMR0
367
OFS
26, 126, 131,
365
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
RENESAS MCU
1.
REJ09B0406-0110
Rev.1.10
Dec 21, 2007
Overview
1.1
Features
The R8C/2K Group and R8C/2L Group of single-chip MCUs incorporates the R8C/Tiny Series CPU core,
employing sophisticated instructions for a high level of efficiency. With 1 Mbyte of address space, and it is capable
of executing instructions at high speed. In addition, the CPU core boasts a multiplier for high-speed operation
processing.
Power consumption is low, and the supported operating modes allow additional power control. These MCUs also
use an anti-noise configuration to reduce emissions of electromagnetic noise and are designed to withstand EMI.
Integration of many peripheral functions, including multifunction timer and serial interface, reduces the number of
system components.
Furthermore, the R8C/2L Group has on-chip data flash (1 KB × 2 blocks).
The difference between the R8C/2K Group and R8C/2L Group is only the presence or absence of data flash. Their
peripheral functions are the same.
1.1.1
Applications
Electronic household appliances, office equipment, audio equipment, consumer equipment, etc.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 1 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
1.1.2
1. Overview
Specifications
Tables 1.1 and 1.2 outlines the Specifications for R8C/2K Group and Tables 1.3 and 1.4 outlines the
Specifications for R8C/2L Group.
Table 1.1
Item
CPU
Specifications for R8C/2K Group (1)
Function
Central processing
unit
Memory
Power Supply
Voltage
Detection
I/O Ports
ROM, RAM
Voltage detection
circuit
Clock
Clock generation
circuits
Programmable I/O
ports
Interrupts
Watchdog Timer
Timer
Timer RA
Timer RB
Timer RC
Timer RD
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Specification
R8C/Tiny series core
• Number of fundamental instructions: 89
• Minimum instruction execution time:
50 ns (f(XIN) = 20 MHz, VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V)
100 ns (f(XIN) = 10 MHz, VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V)
200 ns (f(XIN) = 5 MHz, VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V)
• Multiplier: 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits
• Multiply-accumulate instruction: 16 bits × 16 bits + 32 bits → 32 bits
• Operation mode: Single-chip mode (address space: 1 Mbyte)
Refer to Table 1.5 Product List for R8C/2K Group.
• Power-on reset
• Voltage detection 3
• Input-only: 3 pins
• CMOS I/O ports: 25, selectable pull-up resistor
• High current drive ports: 8
2 circuits: XIN clock oscillation circuit (with on-chip feedback resistor),
On-chip oscillator (high-speed, low-speed)
(high-speed on-chip oscillator has a frequency adjustment function)
• Oscillation stop detection: XIN clock oscillation stop detection function
• Frequency divider circuit: Dividing selectable 1, 2, 4, 8, and 16
• Low power consumption modes:
Standard operating mode (high-speed clock, high-speed on-chip oscillator,
low-speed on-chip oscillator), wait mode, stop mode
• External: 4 sources, Internal: 15 sources, Software: 4 sources
• Priority levels: 7 levels
15 bits × 1 (with prescaler), reset start selectable
8 bits × 1 (with 8-bit prescaler)
Timer mode (period timer), pulse output mode (output level inverted every
period), event counter mode, pulse width measurement mode, pulse period
measurement mode
8 bits × 1 (with 8-bit prescaler)
Timer mode (period timer), programmable waveform generation mode (PWM
output), programmable one-shot generation mode, programmable wait oneshot generation mode
16 bits × 1 (with 4 capture/compare registers)
Timer mode (input capture function, output compare function), PWM mode
(output 3 pins), PWM2 mode (PWM output pin)
16 bits × 2 (with 4 capture/compare registers)
Timer mode (input capture function, output compare function), PWM mode
(output 6 pins), reset synchronous PWM mode (output three-phase
waveforms (6 pins), sawtooth wave modulation), complementary PWM mode
(output three-phase waveforms (6 pins), triangular wave modulation), PWM3
mode (PWM output 2 pins with fixed period)
Page 2 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 1.2
1. Overview
Specifications for R8C/2K Group (2)
Item
Function
Serial
UART0, UART2
Interface
LIN Module
A/D Converter
Flash Memory
Operating Frequency/Supply
Voltage
Current consumption
Operating Ambient Temperature
Package
Specification
Clock synchronous serial I/O/UART × 2
Hardware LIN: 1 (timer RA, UART0)
10-bit resolution × 9 channels, includes sample and hold function
• Programming and erasure voltage: VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V
• Programming and erasure endurance: 100 times
• Program security: ROM code protect, ID code check
• Debug functions: On-chip debug, on-board flash rewrite function
f(XIN) = 20 MHz (VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V)
f(XIN) = 10 MHz (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V)
f(XIN) = 5 MHz (VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V) (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V for A/D converter only)
Typ. 10 mA (VCC = 5.0 V, f(XIN) = 20 MHz)
Typ. 6 mA (VCC = 3.0 V, f(XIN) = 10 MHz)
Typ. 23 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, wait mode, low-speed on-chip oscillator used)
Typ. 0.7 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, stop mode)
-20 to 85°C (N version)
-40 to 85°C (D version)(1)
-20 to 105°C (Y version)(2)
32-pin LQFP
• Package code: PLQP0032GB-A (previous code: 32P6U-A)
NOTES:
1. Specify the D version if D version functions are to be used.
2. Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 3 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 1.3
Item
CPU
1. Overview
Specifications for R8C/2L Group (1)
Function
Central processing
unit
Memory
Power Supply
Voltage
Detection
I/O Ports
ROM, RAM
Voltage detection
circuit
Clock
Clock generation
circuits
Programmable I/O
ports
Interrupts
Watchdog Timer
Timer
Timer RA
Timer RB
Timer RC
Timer RD
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Specification
R8C/Tiny series core
• Number of fundamental instructions: 89
• Minimum instruction execution time:
50 ns (f(XIN) = 20 MHz, VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V)
100 ns (f(XIN) = 10 MHz, VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V)
200 ns (f(XIN) = 5 MHz, VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V)
• Multiplier: 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits
• Multiply-accumulate instruction: 16 bits × 16 bits + 32 bits → 32 bits
• Operation mode: Single-chip mode (address space: 1 Mbyte)
Refer to Table 1.6 Product List for R8C/2L Group.
• Power-on reset
• Voltage detection 3
• Input-only: 3 pins
• CMOS I/O ports: 25, selectable pull-up resistor
• High current drive ports: 8
2 circuits: XIN clock oscillation circuit (with on-chip feedback resistor),
On-chip oscillator (high-speed, low-speed)
(high-speed on-chip oscillator has a frequency adjustment function)
• Oscillation stop detection: XIN clock oscillation stop detection function
• Frequency divider circuit: Dividing selectable 1, 2, 4, 8, and 16
• Low power consumption modes:
Standard operating mode (high-speed clock, high-speed on-chip oscillator,
low-speed on-chip oscillator), wait mode, stop mode
• External: 4 sources, Internal: 15 sources, Software: 4 sources
• Priority levels: 7 levels
15 bits × 1 (with prescaler), reset start selectable
8 bits × 1 (with 8-bit prescaler)
Timer mode (period timer), pulse output mode (output level inverted every
period), event counter mode, pulse width measurement mode, pulse period
measurement mode
8 bits × 1 (with 8-bit prescaler)
Timer mode (period timer), programmable waveform generation mode (PWM
output), programmable one-shot generation mode, programmable wait oneshot generation mode
16 bits × 1 (with 4 capture/compare registers)
Timer mode (input capture function, output compare function), PWM mode
(output 3 pins), PWM2 mode (PWM output pin)
16 bits × 2 (with 4 capture/compare registers)
Timer mode (input capture function, output compare function), PWM mode
(output 6 pins), reset synchronous PWM mode (output three-phase
waveforms (6 pins), sawtooth wave modulation), complementary PWM mode
(output three-phase waveforms (6 pins), triangular wave modulation), PWM3
mode (PWM output 2 pins with fixed period)
Page 4 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 1.4
1. Overview
Specifications for R8C/2L Group (2)
Item
Function
Serial
UART0, UART2
Interface
LIN Module
A/D Converter
Flash Memory
Operating Frequency/Supply
Voltage
Current consumption
Operating Ambient Temperature
Package
Specification
Clock synchronous serial I/O/UART × 2
Hardware LIN: 1 (timer RA, UART0)
10-bit resolution × 9 channels, includes sample and hold function
• Programming and erasure voltage: VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V
• Programming and erasure endurance: 10,000 times (data flash)
1,000 times (program ROM)
• Program security: ROM code protect, ID code check
• Debug functions: On-chip debug, on-board flash rewrite function
f(XIN) = 20 MHz (VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V)
f(XIN) = 10 MHz (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V)
f(XIN) = 5 MHz (VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V) (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V for A/D converter only)
Typ. 10 mA (VCC = 5.0 V, f(XIN) = 20 MHz)
Typ. 6 mA (VCC = 3.0 V, f(XIN) = 10 MHz)
Typ. 23 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, wait mode, low-speed on-chip oscillator used)
Typ. 0.7 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, stop mode)
-20 to 85°C (N version)
-40 to 85°C (D version)(1)
-20 to 105°C (Y version)(2)
32-pin LQFP
• Package code: PLQP0032GB-A (previous code: 32P6U-A)
NOTES:
1. Specify the D version if D version functions are to be used.
2. Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 5 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
1.2
1. Overview
Product List
Table 1.5 lists the Product List for R8C/2K Group, Figure 1.1 shows a Part Number, Memory Size, and Package of
R8C/2K Group, Table 1.6 lists the Product List for R8C/2L Group, and Figure 1.2 shows a Part Number, Memory
Size, and Package of R8C/2L Group.
Table 1.5
Product List for R8C/2K Group
Part No.
R5F212K2SNFP
R5F212K4SNFP
R5F212K2SDFP
R5F212K4SDFP
R5F212K2SNXXXFP (D)
ROM Capacity
8 Kbytes
16 Kbytes
8 Kbytes
16 Kbytes
8 Kbytes
Current of Dec. 2007
RAM Capacity
1 Kbyte
1.5 Kbytes
1 Kbyte
1.5 Kbytes
1 Kbyte
Package Type
PLQP0032GB-A
PLQP0032GB-A
PLQP0032GB-A
PLQP0032GB-A
PLQP0032GB-A
R5F212K4SNXXXFP (D) 16 Kbytes
1.5 Kbytes
PLQP0032GB-A
R5F212K2SDXXXFP (D) 8 Kbytes
1 Kbyte
PLQP0032GB-A
R5F212K4SDXXXFP (D) 16 Kbytes
1.5 Kbytes
PLQP0032GB-A
Remarks
N version
D version
N version
Factory programming
product(1)
D version
Factory programming
product(1)
(D): Under development
NOTE:
1. The user ROM is programmed before shipment.
Part No.
R 5 F 21 2K 2 S N XXX FP
Package type:
FP: PLQP0032GB-A
ROM number
Classification
N: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 85°C
D: Operating ambient temperature -40°C to 85°C
Y: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 105°C (1)
S: Low-voltage version
ROM capacity
2: 8 KB
4: 16 KB
R8C/2K Group
R8C/Tiny Series
Memory type
F: Flash memory
Renesas MCU
Renesas semiconductor
NOTE:
1: Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version.
Figure 1.1
Part Number, Memory Size, and Package of R8C/2K Group
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 6 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 1.6
1. Overview
Product List for R8C/2L Group
Current of Dec. 2007
ROM Capacity
Program ROM Data flash
R5F212L2SNFP
8 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
R5F212L4SNFP
16 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
R5F212L2SDFP
8 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
R5F212L4SDFP
16 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
R5F212L2SNXXXFP (D) 8 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
RAM
Capacity
1 Kbyte
1.5 Kbytes
1 Kbyte
1.5 Kbytes
1 Kbyte
R5F212L4SNXXXFP (D) 16 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
1.5 Kbytes
R5F212L2SDXXXFP (D) 8 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
1 Kbyte
R5F212L4SDXXXFP (D) 16 Kbytes
1 Kbyte × 2
1.5 Kbytes
Part No.
Package Type
Remarks
PLQP0032GB-A N version
PLQP0032GB-A
PLQP0032GB-A D version
PLQP0032GB-A
PLQP0032GB-A N version
Factory
PLQP0032GB-A programming
product(1)
PLQP0032GB-A D version
Factory
PLQP0032GB-A programming
product(1)
(D): Under development
NOTE:
1. The user ROM is programmed before shipment.
Part No.
R 5 F 21 2L 2 S N XXX FP
Package type:
FP: PLQP0032GB-A
ROM number
Classification
N: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 85°C
D: Operating ambient temperature -40°C to 85°C
Y: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 105°C (1)
S: Low-voltage version
ROM capacity
2: 8 KB
4: 16 KB
R8C/2L Group
R8C/Tiny Series
Memory type
F: Flash memory
Renesas MCU
Renesas semiconductor
NOTE:
1: Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version.
Figure 1.2
Part Number, Memory Size, and Package of R8C/2L Group
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 7 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
1.3
1. Overview
Block Diagram
Figure 1.3 shows a Block Diagram.
I/O ports
5
8
8
3
Port P0
Port P1
Port P2
Port P3
1
3
Port P4
Peripheral functions
Timers
Timer RA (8 bits × 1)
Timer RB (8 bits × 1)
Timer RC (16 bits × 1)
Timer RD (16 bits × 2)
UART or
clock synchronous serial I/O
(8 bits × 2)
System clock
generation circuit
XIN-XOUT
High-speed on-chip oscillator
Low-speed on-chip oscillator
LIN module
Watchdog timer
(15 bits)
A/D converter
(10 bits × 9 channels)
R8C/Tiny Series CPU core
R0H
R1H
R0L
R1L
R2
R3
SB
ROM(1)
USP
ISP
INTB
A0
A1
FB
Memory
RAM(2)
PC
FLG
Multiplier
NOTES:
1. ROM size varies with MCU type.
2. RAM size varies with MCU type.
Figure 1.3
Block Diagram
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 8 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
1.4
1. Overview
Pin Assignment
P4_5/INT0
P1_5/RXD0/(TRAIO)/(INT1)(2)
P1_6/CLK0
P1_7/TRAIO/INT1
P1_2/KI2/AN10/TRCIOB
P1_3/KI3/AN11/TRBO
P1_4/TXD0
P1_1/KI1/AN9/TRCIOA/TRCTRG
Figure 1.4 shows the Pin Assignment (Top View). Table 1.7 outlines the Pin Name Information by Pin Number.
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
16
26
15
14
27
R8C/2K Group
R8C/2L Group
28
29
30
13
12
11
PLQP0032GB-A
(32P6U-A)
(top view)
2
3
4
5
6
10
9
7
8
P3_3/INT3/TRCCLK
1
RESET
XOUT/P4_7 (1)
VSS/AVSS
XIN/P4_6
32
VCC/AVCC
31
MODE
P3_5/TRCIOD
P0_5/AN2
P0_3/AN4/CLK2
P0_2/AN5/RXD2
P0_1/AN6/TXD2
P0_0/AN7
25
VREF/P4_2
P1_0/KI0/AN8
P3_4/TRCIOC
P2_0/TRDIOA0/TRDCLK
P2_2/TRDIOC0
P2_1/TRDIOB0
P2_3/TRDIOD0
P2_4/TRDIOA1
P2_5/TRDIOB1
P2_6/TRDIOC1
P2_7/TRDIOD1
NOTES:
1. P4_7 are an input-only port.
2. Can be assigned to the pin in parentheses by a program.
3. Confirm the pin 1 position on the package by referring to the package dimensions.
Figure 1.4
Pin Assignment (Top View)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 9 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 1.7
Pin
Number
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
1. Overview
Pin Name Information by Pin Number
Control Pin
Port
VREF
MODE
RESET
XOUT
VSS/AVSS
XIN
VCC/AVCC
P4_2
I/O Pin Functions for of Peripheral Modules
Interrupt
Timer
INT3
TRCCLK
TRDIOD1
TRDIOC1
TRDIOB1
TRDIOA1
TRDIOD0
TRDIOB0
TRDIOC0
TRDIOA0/TRDCLK
A/D Converter
P4_7
P4_6
P3_3
P2_7
P2_6
P2_5
P2_4
P2_3
P2_1
P2_2
P2_0
P4_5
P1_7
P1_6
P1_5
21
22
23
24
P1_4
P1_3
P1_2
P1_1
25
26
P1_0
P3_4
INT0
INT1
TRAIO
(INT1)(1)
(TRAIO)(1)
KI3
KI2
KI1
TRBO
TRCIOB
TRCIOA/TRCTRG
Page 10 of 450
CLK0
RXD0
TXD0
AN11
AN10
AN9
AN8
KI0
TRCIOC
27
P3_5
TRCIOD
28
P0_5
29
P0_3
30
P0_2
31
P0_1
32
P0_0
NOTE:
1. Can be assigned to the pin in parentheses by a program.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Serial Interface
CLK2
RXD2
TXD2
AN2
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
1.5
1. Overview
Pin Functions
Table 1.8 lists Pin Functions.
Table 1.8
Pin Functions
Item
Pin Name
I/O Type
Description
Power supply input
VCC, VSS
−
Apply 2.2 V to 5.5 V to the VCC pin. Apply 0 V to the VSS pin.
Analog power
supply input
AVCC, AVSS
−
Power supply for the A/D converter.
Connect a capacitor between AVCC and AVSS.
Reset input
RESET
I
Input “L” on this pin resets the MCU.
MODE
MODE
I
Connect this pin to VCC via a resistor.
XIN clock input
XIN
I
XIN clock output
XOUT
O
These pins are provided for XIN clock generation circuit I/O.
Connect a ceramic resonator or a crystal oscillator between
the XIN and XOUT pins(1). To use an external clock, input it to
the XIN pin and leave the XOUT pin open.
INT interrupt input
INT0, INT1, INT3
I
INT interrupt input pins.
INT0 is timer RB, timer RC and timer RD input pins.
Key input interrupt
KI0 to KI3
I
Key input interrupt input pins
Timer RA
TRAIO
I/O
Timer RB
TRBO
O
Timer RB output pin
Timer RC
TRCCLK
I
External clock input pin
TRCTRG
Timer RD
External trigger input pin
TRCIOA, TRCIOB,
TRCIOC, TRCIOD
I/O
Timer RC I/O pins
TRDIOA0, TRDIOA1,
TRDIOB0, TRDIOB1,
TRDIOC0, TRDIOC1,
TRDIOD0, TRDIOD1
I/O
Timer RD I/O pins
TRDCLK
Serial interface
I
Timer RA I/O pin
I
External clock input pin
CLK0, CLK2
I/O
RXD0, RXD2
I
Serial data input pins
Transfer clock I/O pins
TXD0, TXD2
O
Serial data output pins
Reference voltage
input
VREF
I
Reference voltage input pin to A/D converter
A/D converter
AN2, AN4 to AN11
I
Analog input pins to A/D converter
I/O port
P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5,
P1_0 to P1_7,
P2_0 to P2_7,
P3_3 to P3_5,
P4_5,
Input port
P4_2, P4_6, P4_7
I/O
I
CMOS I/O ports. Each port has an I/O select direction
register, allowing each pin in the port to be directed for input
or output individually.
Any port set to input can be set to use a pull-up resistor or not
by a program.
P2_0 to P2_7 also function as LED drive ports.
Input-only ports
I: Input
O: Output
I/O: Input and output
NOTE:
1. Refer to the oscillator manufacturer for oscillation characteristics.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 11 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
2.
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU)
Central Processing Unit (CPU)
Figure 2.1 shows the CPU Registers. The CPU contains 13 registers. R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, and FB configure a
register bank. There are two sets of register bank.
b31
b15
R2
R3
b8b7
b0
R0H (high-order of R0) R0L (low-order of R0)
R1H (high-order of R1) R1L (low-order of R1)
Data registers(1)
R2
R3
A0
A1
FB
b19
b15
Address registers(1)
Frame base register(1)
b0
Interrupt table register
INTBL
INTBH
The 4 high order bits of INTB are INTBH and
the 16 low order bits of INTB are INTBL.
b19
b0
Program counter
PC
b15
b0
USP
User stack pointer
ISP
Interrupt stack pointer
SB
Static base register
b15
b0
FLG
b15
b8
IPL
b7
Flag register
b0
U I O B S Z D C
Carry flag
Debug flag
Zero flag
Sign flag
Register bank select flag
Overflow flag
Interrupt enable flag
Stack pointer select flag
Reserved bit
Processor interrupt priority level
Reserved bit
NOTE:
1. These registers comprise a register bank. There are two register banks.
Figure 2.1
CPU Registers
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 12 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
2.1
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU)
Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3)
R0 is a 16-bit register for transfer, arithmetic, and logic operations. The same applies to R1 to R3. R0 can be split
into high-order bits (R0H) and low-order bits (R0L) to be used separately as 8-bit data registers. R1H and R1L are
analogous to R0H and R0L. R2 can be combined with R0 and used as a 32-bit data register (R2R0). R3R1 is
analogous to R2R0.
2.2
Address Registers (A0 and A1)
A0 is a 16-bit register for address register indirect addressing and address register relative addressing. It is also
used for transfer, arithmetic, and logic operations. A1 is analogous to A0. A1 can be combined with A0 and as a 32bit address register (A1A0).
2.3
Frame Base Register (FB)
FB is a 16-bit register for FB relative addressing.
2.4
Interrupt Table Register (INTB)
INTB is a 20-bit register that indicates the start address of an interrupt vector table.
2.5
Program Counter (PC)
PC is 20 bits wide and indicates the address of the next instruction to be executed.
2.6
User Stack Pointer (USP) and Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP)
The stack pointers (SP), USP, and ISP, are each 16 bits wide. The U flag of FLG is used to switch between
USP and ISP.
2.7
Static Base Register (SB)
SB is a 16-bit register for SB relative addressing.
2.8
Flag Register (FLG)
FLG is an 11-bit register indicating the CPU state.
2.8.1
Carry Flag (C)
The C flag retains carry, borrow, or shift-out bits that have been generated by the arithmetic and logic unit.
2.8.2
Debug Flag (D)
The D flag is for debugging only. Set it to 0.
2.8.3
Zero Flag (Z)
The Z flag is set to 1 when an arithmetic operation results in 0; otherwise to 0.
2.8.4
Sign Flag (S)
The S flag is set to 1 when an arithmetic operation results in a negative value; otherwise to 0.
2.8.5
Register Bank Select Flag (B)
Register bank 0 is selected when the B flag is 0. Register bank 1 is selected when this flag is set to 1.
2.8.6
Overflow Flag (O)
The O flag is set to 1 when an operation results in an overflow; otherwise to 0.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 13 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
2.8.7
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU)
Interrupt Enable Flag (I)
The I flag enables maskable interrupts.
Interrupt are disabled when the I flag is set to 0, and are enabled when the I flag is set to 1. The I flag is set to 0
when an interrupt request is acknowledged.
2.8.8
Stack Pointer Select Flag (U)
ISP is selected when the U flag is set to 0; USP is selected when the U flag is set to 1.
The U flag is set to 0 when a hardware interrupt request is acknowledged or the INT instruction of software
interrupt numbers 0 to 31 is executed.
2.8.9
Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL)
IPL is 3 bits wide and assigns processor interrupt priority levels from level 0 to level 7.
If a requested interrupt has higher priority than IPL, the interrupt is enabled.
2.8.10
Reserved Bit
If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 14 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
3.
3. Memory
Memory
3.1
R8C/2K Group
Figure 3.1 is a Memory Map of R8C/2K Group. The R8C/2K Group has 1 Mbyte of address space from addresses
00000h to FFFFFh.
The internal ROM is allocated lower addresses, beginning with address 0FFFFh. For example, a 16-Kbyte internal
ROM area is allocated addresses 0C000h to 0FFFFh.
The fixed interrupt vector table is allocated addresses 0FFDCh to 0FFFFh. They store the starting address of each
interrupt routine.
The internal RAM is allocated higher addresses beginning with address 00400h. For example, a 1.5-Kbyte internal
RAM area is allocated addresses 00400h to 009FFh. The internal RAM is used not only for storing data but also for
calling subroutines and as stacks when interrupt requests are acknowledged.
Special function registers (SFRs) are allocated addresses 00000h to 002FFh. The peripheral function control
registers are allocated here. All addresses within the SFR, which have nothing allocated are reserved for future use
and cannot be accessed by users.
00000h
002FFh
SFR
(Refer to 4. Special
Function Registers
(SFRs))
00400h
Internal RAM
0XXXh
0FFDCh
Undefined instruction
Overflow
BRK instruction
Address match
Single step
Watchdog timer/oscillation stop detection/voltage monitor
0YYYYh
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
Reset
Internal ROM
(program ROM)
0FFFFh
0FFFFh
FFFFFh
NOTE:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
Part Number
R5F212K2SNFP, R5F212K2SDFP,
R5F212K2SNXXXFP, R5F212K2SDXXXFP
R5F212K4SNFP, R5F212K4SDFP,
R5F212K4SNXXXFP, R5F212K4SDXXXFP
Figure 3.1
Internal ROM
Size
Address 0YYYYh
Size
Address 0XXXXh
8 Kbytes
0E000h
1 Kbyte
007FFh
16 Kbytes
0C000h
1.5 Kbytes
009FFh
Memory Map of R8C/2K Group
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 15 of 450
Internal RAM
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
3.2
3. Memory
R8C/2L Group
Figure 3.2 is a Memory Map of R8C/2L Group. The R8C/2L Group has 1 Mbyte of address space from addresses
00000h to FFFFFh.
The internal ROM (program ROM) is allocated lower addresses, beginning with address 0FFFFh. For example, a
16-Kbyte internal ROM area is allocated addresses 0C000h to 0FFFFh.
The fixed interrupt vector table is allocated addresses 0FFDCh to 0FFFFh. They store the starting address of each
interrupt routine.
The internal ROM (data flash) is allocated addresses 02400h to 02BFFh.
The internal RAM area is allocated higher addresses, beginning with address 00400h. For example, a 1.5-Kbyte
internal RAM is allocated addresses 00400h to 009FFh. The internal RAM is used not only for storing data but also
for calling subroutines and as stacks when interrupt requests are acknowledged.
Special function registers (SFRs) are allocated addresses 00000h to 002FFh. The peripheral function control
registers are allocated here. All addresses within the SFR, which have nothing allocated are reserved for future use
and cannot be accessed by users.
00000h
002FFh
SFR
(Refer to 4. Special
Function Registers
(SFRs))
00400h
Internal RAM
0XXXXh
02400h
0FFDCh
Internal ROM
(data flash)(1)
02BFFh
Undefined instruction
Overflow
BRK instruction
Address match
Single step
0YYYYh
Watchdog timer/oscillation stop detection/voltage monitor
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
Reset
Internal ROM
(program ROM)
0FFFFh
0FFFFh
FFFFFh
NOTES:
1. Data flash block A (1 Kbyte) and B (1 Kbyte) are shown.
2. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
R5F212L2SNFP, R5F212L2SDFP,
R5F212L2SNXXXFP, R5F212L2SDXXXFP
R5F212L4SNFP, R5F212L4SDFP,
R5F212L4SNXXXFP, R5F212L4SDXXXFP
Figure 3.2
Size
Address 0YYYYh
Size
Address 0XXXXh
8 Kbytes
0E000h
1 Kbyte
007FFh
16 Kbytes
0C000h
1.5 Kbytes
009FFh
Memory Map of R8C/2L Group
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 16 of 450
Internal RAM
Internal ROM
Part Number
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
4.
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
Special Function Registers (SFRs)
An SFR (special function register) is a control register for a peripheral function. Tables 4.1 to 4.7 list the special
function registers.
Table 4.1
Address
0000h
0001h
0002h
0003h
0004h
0005h
0006h
0007h
0008h
0009h
000Ah
000Bh
000Ch
000Dh
000Eh
000Fh
0010h
0011h
0012h
0013h
0014h
0015h
0016h
0017h
0018h
0019h
001Ah
001Bh
001Ch
SFR Information (1)(1)
Register
Symbol
After reset
Processor Mode Register 0
Processor Mode Register 1
System Clock Control Register 0
System Clock Control Register 1
PM0
PM1
CM0
CM1
00h
00h
01101000b
00100000b
Protect Register
PRCR
00h
Oscillation Stop Detection Register
Watchdog Timer Reset Register
Watchdog Timer Start Register
Watchdog Timer Control Register
Address Match Interrupt Register 0
OCD
WDTR
WDTS
WDC
RMAD0
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register
Address Match Interrupt Register 1
AIER
RMAD1
00000100b
XXh
XXh
00X11111b
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
Count Source Protection Mode Register
CSPR
00h
10000000b(6)
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 0
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 1
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 2
FRA0
FRA1
FRA2
00h
When shipping
00h
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 6
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 7
FRA6
FRA7
When Shipping
When Shipping
0030h
0031h
0032h
Voltage Detection Register 1(2)
Voltage Detection Register 2(2)
VCA1
VCA2
00001000b
00h(3)
00100000b(4)
0033h
0034h
0035h
0036h
0037h
0038h
Voltage Monitor 1 Circuit Control Register(5)
Voltage Monitor 2 Circuit Control Register(5)
Voltage Monitor 0 Circuit Control Register(2)
VW1C
VW2C
VW0C
00001000b
00h
0000X000b(3)
0100X001b(4)
001Dh
001Eh
001Fh
0020h
0021h
0022h
0023h
0024h
0025h
0026h
0027h
0028h
0029h
002Ah
002Bh
002Ch
0039h
003Ah
003Eh
003Fh
X: Undefined
NOTES:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
2. Software reset, watchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, or voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this register.
3. The LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is set to 1 and hardware reset.
4. Power-on reset, voltage monitor 0 reset, or the LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is set to 0 and hardware reset.
5. Software reset, watchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, or voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect b2 and b3.
6. The CSPROINI bit in the OFS register is set to 0.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 17 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 4.2
Address
0040h
0041h
0042h
0043h
0044h
0045h
0046h
0047h
0048h
0049h
004Ah
004Bh
004Ch
004Dh
004Eh
004Fh
0050h
0051h
0052h
0053h
0054h
0055h
0056h
0057h
0058h
0059h
005Ah
005Bh
005Ch
005Dh
005Eh
005Fh
0060h
0061h
0062h
0063h
0064h
0065h
0066h
0067h
0068h
0069h
006Ah
006Bh
006Ch
006Dh
006Eh
006Fh
0070h
0071h
0072h
0073h
0074h
0075h
0076h
0077h
0078h
0079h
007Ah
007Bh
007Ch
007Dh
007Eh
007Fh
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
SFR Information (2)(1)
Register
Symbol
After reset
Timer RC Interrupt Control Register
Timer RD0 Interrupt Control Register
Timer RD1 Interrupt Control Register
TRCIC
TRD0IC
TRD1IC
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
UART2 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Receive Interrupt Control Register
Key Input Interrupt Control Register
A/D Conversion Interrupt Control Register
S2TIC
S2RIC
KUPIC
ADIC
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
UART0 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Receive Interrupt Control Register
S0TIC
S0RIC
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
Timer RA Interrupt Control Register
TRAIC
XXXXX000b
Timer RB Interrupt Control Register
INT1 Interrupt Control Register
INT3 Interrupt Control Register
TRBIC
INT1IC
INT3IC
XXXXX000b
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
INT0 Interrupt Control Register
INT0IC
XX00X000b
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 18 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 4.3
Address
0080h
0081h
0082h
0083h
0084h
0085h
0086h
0087h
0088h
0089h
008Ah
008Bh
008Ch
008Dh
008Eh
008Fh
0090h
0091h
0092h
0093h
0094h
0095h
0096h
0097h
0098h
0099h
009Ah
009Bh
009Ch
009Dh
009Eh
009Fh
00A0h
00A1h
00A2h
00A3h
00A4h
00A5h
00A6h
00A7h
00A8h
00A9h
00AAh
00ABh
00ACh
00ADh
00AEh
00AFh
00B0h
00B1h
00B2h
00B3h
00B4h
00B5h
00B6h
00B7h
00B8h
00B9h
00BAh
00BBh
00BCh
00BDh
00BEh
00BFh
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
SFR Information (3)(1)
Register
Symbol
UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART0 Bit Rate Register
UART0 Transmit Buffer Register
U0MR
U0BRG
U0TB
UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0
UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
UART0 Receive Buffer Register
U0C0
U0C1
U0RB
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 19 of 450
After reset
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
00001000b
00000010b
XXh
XXh
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 4.4
Address
00C0h
00C1h
00C2h
00C3h
00C4h
00C5h
00C6h
00C7h
00C8h
00C9h
00CAh
00CBh
00CCh
00CDh
00CEh
00CFh
00D0h
00D1h
00D2h
00D3h
00D4h
00D5h
00D6h
00D7h
00D8h
00D9h
00DAh
00DBh
00DCh
00DDh
00DEh
00DFh
00E0h
00E1h
00E2h
00E3h
00E4h
00E5h
00E6h
00E7h
00E8h
00E9h
00EAh
00EBh
00ECh
00EDh
00EEh
00EFh
00F0h
00F1h
00F2h
00F3h
00F4h
00F5h
00F6h
00F7h
00F8h
00F9h
00FAh
00FBh
00FCh
00FDh
00FEh
00FFh
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
SFR Information (4)(1)
Register
Symbol
After reset
A/D Register
AD
XXh
XXh
A/D Control Register 2
ADCON2
00h
A/D Control Register 0
A/D Control Register 1
ADCON0
ADCON1
00h
00h
Port P0 Register
Port P1 Register
Port P0 Direction Register
Port P1 Direction Register
Port P2 Register
Port P3 Register
Port P2 Direction Register
Port P3 Direction Register
Port P4 Register
P0
P1
PD0
PD1
P2
P3
PD2
PD3
P4
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
Port P4 Direction Register
PD4
00h
Port P2 Drive Capacity Control Register
Pin Select Register 1
Pin Select Register 2
Pin Select Register 3
Port Mode Register
External Input Enable Register
INT Input Filter Select Register
Key Input Enable Register
Pull-Up Control Register 0
Pull-Up Control Register 1
P2DRR
PINSR1
PINSR2
PINSR3
PMR
INTEN
INTF
KIEN
PUR0
PUR1
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
XX000000b
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 20 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 4.5
Address
0100h
0101h
0102h
0103h
0104h
0105h
0106h
0107h
0108h
0109h
010Ah
010Bh
010Ch
010Dh
010Eh
010Fh
0110h
0111h
0112h
0113h
0114h
0115h
0116h
0117h
0118h
0119h
011Ah
011Bh
011Ch
011Dh
011Eh
011Fh
0120h
0121h
0122h
0123h
0124h
0125h
0126h
0127h
0128h
0129h
012Ah
012Bh
012Ch
012Dh
012Eh
012Fh
0130h
0131h
0132h
0133h
0134h
0135h
0136h
0137h
0138h
0139h
013Ah
013Bh
013Ch
013Dh
013Eh
013Fh
NOTE:
1.
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
SFR Information (5)(1)
Timer RA Control Register
Timer RA I/O Control Register
Timer RA Mode Register
Timer RA Prescaler Register
Timer RA Register
LIN Control Register 2
LIN Control Register
LIN Status Register
Timer RB Control Register
Timer RB One-Shot Control Register
Timer RB I/O Control Register
Timer RB Mode Register
Timer RB Prescaler Register
Timer RB Secondary Register
Timer RB Primary Register
Register
Symbol
TRACR
TRAIOC
TRAMR
TRAPRE
TRA
LINCR2
LINCR
LINST
TRBCR
TRBOCR
TRBIOC
TRBMR
TRBPRE
TRBSC
TRBPR
Timer RC Mode Register
Timer RC Control Register 1
Timer RC Interrupt Enable Register
Timer RC Status Register
Timer RC I/O Control Register 0
Timer RC I/O Control Register 1
Timer RC Counter
TRCMR
TRCCR1
TRCIER
TRCSR
TRCIOR0
TRCIOR1
TRC
Timer RC General Register A
TRCGRA
Timer RC General Register B
TRCGRB
Timer RC General Register C
TRCGRC
Timer RC General Register D
TRCGRD
Timer RC Control Register 2
Timer RC Digital Filter Function Select Register
Timer RC Output Master Enable Register
TRCCR2
TRCDF
TRCOER
01001000b
00h
01110000b
01110000b
10001000b
10001000b
00h
00h
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
00011111b
00h
01111111b
Timer RD Start Register
Timer RD Mode Register
Timer RD PWM Mode Register
Timer RD Function Control Register
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
Timer RD Output Control Register
Timer RD Digital Filter Function Select Register 0
Timer RD Digital Filter Function Select Register 1
TRDSTR
TRDMR
TRDPMR
TRDFCR
TRDOER1
TRDOER2
TRDOCR
TRDDF0
TRDDF1
11111100b
00001110b
10001000b
10000000b
FFh
01111111b
00h
00h
00h
The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 21 of 450
After reset
00h
00h
00h
FFh
FFh
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
FFh
FFh
FFh
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 4.6
Address
0140h
0141h
0142h
0143h
0144h
0145h
0146h
0147h
0148h
0149h
014Ah
014Bh
014Ch
014Dh
014Eh
014Fh
0150h
0151h
0152h
0153h
0154h
0155h
0156h
0157h
0158h
0159h
015Ah
015Bh
015Ch
015Dh
015Eh
015Fh
0160h
0161h
0162h
0163h
0164h
0165h
0166h
0167h
0168h
0169h
016Ah
016Bh
016Ch
016Dh
016Eh
016Fh
0170h
0171h
0172h
0173h
0174h
0175h
0176h
0177h
0178h
0179h
017Ah
017Bh
017Ch
017Dh
017Eh
017Fh
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
SFR Information (6)(1)
Register
Timer RD Control Register 0
Timer RD I/O Control Register A0
Timer RD I/O Control Register C0
Timer RD Status Register 0
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register 0
Timer RD PWM Mode Output Level Control Register 0
Timer RD Counter 0
Symbol
TRDCR0
TRDIORA0
TRDIORC0
TRDSR0
TRDIER0
TRDPOCR0
TRD0
Timer RD General Register A0
TRDGRA0
Timer RD General Register B0
TRDGRB0
Timer RD General Register C0
TRDGRC0
Timer RD General Register D0
TRDGRD0
Timer RD Control Register 1
Timer RD I/O Control Register A1
Timer RD I/O Control Register C1
Timer RD Status Register 1
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register 1
Timer RD PWM Mode Output Level Control Register 1
Timer RD Counter 1
TRDCR1
TRDIORA1
TRDIORC1
TRDSR1
TRDIER1
TRDPOCR1
TRD1
Timer RD General Register A1
TRDGRA1
Timer RD General Register B1
TRDGRB1
Timer RD General Register C1
TRDGRC1
Timer RD General Register D1
TRDGRD1
UART2 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART2 Bit Rate Register
UART2 Transmit Buffer Register
U2MR
U2BRG
U2TB
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
UART2 Receive Buffer Register
U2C0
U2C1
U2RB
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 22 of 450
After reset
00h
10001000b
10001000b
11100000b
11100000b
11111000b
00h
00h
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
00h
10001000b
10001000b
11000000b
11100000b
11111000b
00h
00h
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
FFh
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
00001000b
00000010b
XXh
XXh
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 4.7
Address
0180h
0181h
0182h
0183h
0184h
0185h
0186h
0187h
0188h
0189h
018Ah
018Bh
018Ch
018Dh
018Eh
018Fh
0190h
0191h
0192h
0193h
0194h
0195h
0196h
0197h
0198h
0199h
019Ah
019Bh
019Ch
019Dh
019Eh
019Fh
01A0h
01A1h
01A2h
01A3h
01A4h
01A5h
01A6h
01A7h
01A8h
01A9h
01AAh
01ABh
01ACh
01ADh
01AEh
01AFh
01B0h
01B1h
01B2h
01B3h
01B4h
01B5h
01B6h
01B7h
01B8h
01B9h
01BAh
01BBh
01BCh
01BDh
01BEh
01BFh
FFFFh
4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)
SFR Information (7)(1)
Register
Symbol
After reset
Flash Memory Control Register 4
FMR4
01000000b
Flash Memory Control Register 1
FMR1
1000000Xb
Flash Memory Control Register 0
FMR0
00000001b
Option Function Select Register
OFS
(Note 2)
X: Undefined
NOTES:
1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions.
2. The OFS register cannot be changed by a program. Use a flash programmer to write to it.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 23 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5.
5. Resets
Resets
The following resets are implemented: hardware reset, power-on reset, voltage monitor 0 reset, voltage monitor 1 reset,
voltage monitor 2 reset, watchdog timer reset, and software reset.
Table 5.1 lists the Reset Names and Sources.
Table 5.1
Reset Names and Sources
Reset Name
Source
Hardware reset
Power-on reset
Voltage monitor 0 reset
Voltage monitor 1 reset
Voltage monitor 2 reset
Watchdog timer reset
Software reset
Input voltage of RESET pin is held “L”
VCC rises
VCC falls (monitor voltage: Vdet0)
VCC falls (monitor voltage: Vdet1)
VCC falls (monitor voltage: Vdet2)
Underflow of watchdog timer
Write 1 to PM03 bit in PM0 register
Hardware reset
RESET
SFRs
Bits VCA25,
VW0C0, and
VW0C6
SFRs
Power-on reset
circuit
VCC
Bits VCA25,
VW0C0, and
VW0C6
Power-on reset
Voltage monitor 0 reset
Voltage
detection
circuit
Voltage monitor 1 reset
Voltage monitor 2
reset
Watchdog
timer
CPU
SFRs
Bits VCA13, VCA26, VCA27,
VW1C2, VW1C3,
VW2C2, VW2C3,
VW0C1, VW0F0,
VW0F1, and VW0C7
Watchdog timer
reset
Pin, CPU, and
SFR bits other than
those listed above
Software reset
VCA13: Bit in VCA1 register
VCA25, VCA26, VCA27: Bits in VCA2 register
VW0C0, VW0C1, VW0C6, VW0F0, VW0F1, VW0C7: Bits in VW0C register
VW1C2, VW1C3: Bits in VW1C register
VW2C2, VW2C3: Bits in VW2C register
Figure 5.1
Block Diagram of Reset Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 24 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5. Resets
Table 5.2 shows the Pin Functions while RESET Pin Level is “L”, Figure 5.2 shows the CPU Register Status after
Reset, Figure 5.3 shows the Reset Sequence, and Figure 5.4 shows the OFS Register.
Table 5.2
Pin Functions while RESET Pin Level is “L”
Pin Name
P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5
P1, P2
P3_3 to P3_5
P4_2, P4_5 to P4_7
Pin Functions
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
b15
b0
0000h
Data register(R0)
0000h
Data register(R1)
0000h
Data register(R2)
0000h
0000h
0000h
0000h
Data register(R3)
b19
Address register(A0)
Address register(A1)
Frame base register(FB)
b0
00000h
Content of addresses 0FFFEh to 0FFFCh
b15
Interrupt table register(INTB)
Program counter(PC)
b0
0000h
User stack pointer(USP)
0000h
Interrupt stack pointer(ISP)
0000h
Static base register(SB)
b15
b0
Flag register(FLG)
0000h
b15
b8
IPL
Figure 5.2
b7
b0
U I O B S Z D C
CPU Register Status after Reset
fOCO-S
RESET pin
10 cycles or more are needed(1)
fOCO-S clock × 32 cycles(2)
Internal reset
signal
Start time of flash memory
(CPU clock × 14 cycles)
CPU clock × 28 cycles
CPU clock
0FFFCh
0FFFEh
Address
(internal address
signal)
0FFFDh
Content of reset vector
NOTES:
1. Hardware reset.
2. When the “L” input width to the RESET pin is set to fOCO-S clock × 32 cycles or more, setting the RESET pin to “H” also sets the internal
reset signal to “H” at the same.
Figure 5.3
Reset Sequence
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 25 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5. Resets
Option Function Select Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
1
Symbol
OFS
Bit Symbol
WDTON
—
(b1)
ROMCR
ROMCP1
—
(b4)
LVD0ON
—
(b6)
Address
0FFFFh
Bit Name
Watchdog timer start
select bit
When Shipping
FFh(3)
Function
0 : Starts w atchdog timer automatically after reset
1 : Watchdog timer is inactive after reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
ROM code protect
disabled bit
0 : ROM code protect disabled
1 : ROMCP1 enabled
RW
ROM code protect bit
0 : ROM code protect enabled
1 : ROM code protect disabled
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Voltage detection 0
circuit start bit(2)
0 : Voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are
reset
1 : Voltage monitor 0 reset disabled after hardw are
reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Count source protect
CSPROINI mode after reset select
bit
0 : Count source protect mode enabled after reset
1 : Count source protect mode disabled after reset
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. The OFS register is on the flash memory. Write to the OFS register w ith a program. After w riting is completed, do not
w rite additions to the OFS register.
2. Setting the LVD0ON bit is only valid after a hardw are reset. To use the pow er-on reset, set the LVD0ON bit to 0
(voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are reset).
3. If the block including the OFS register is erased, FFh is set to the OFS register.
Figure 5.4
OFS Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 26 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5.1
5. Resets
Hardware Reset
A reset is applied using the RESET pin. When an “L” signal is applied to the RESET pin while the supply voltage
meets the recommended operating conditions, pins, CPU, and SFRs are all reset (refer to Table 5.2 Pin Functions
while RESET Pin Level is “L”). When the input level applied to the RESET pin changes from “L” to “H”, a
program is executed beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector. After reset, the low-speed on-chip
oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU clock.
Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the state of the SFRs after reset.
The internal RAM is not reset. If the RESET pin is pulled “L” while writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the
contents of internal RAM will be undefined.
Figure 5.5 shows an Example of Hardware Reset Circuit and Operation and Figure 5.6 shows an Example of
Hardware Reset Circuit (Usage Example of External Supply Voltage Detection Circuit) and Operation.
5.1.1
When Power Supply is Stable
(1) Apply “L” to the RESET pin.
(2) Wait for 10 µs.
(3) Apply “H” to the RESET pin.
5.1.2
Power On
(1) Apply “L” to the RESET pin.
(2) Let the supply voltage increase until it meets the recommended operating conditions.
(3) Wait for td(P-R) or more to allow the internal power supply to stabilize (refer to 22. Electrical
Characteristics).
(4) Wait for 10 µs.
(5) Apply “H” to the RESET pin.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 27 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5. Resets
VCC
2.2 V
VCC
0V
RESET
RESET
0.2 VCC or below
0V
td(P-R) + 10µs or more
NOTE:
1. Refer to 22. Electrical Characteristics.
Figure 5.5
Example of Hardware Reset Circuit and Operation
Supply voltage
detection circuit
RESET
5V
VCC
2.2 V
VCC
0V
5V
RESET
0V
td(P-R) + 10µs or more
Example when
VCC = 5 V
NOTE:
1. Refer to 22. Electrical Characteristics.
Figure 5.6
Example of Hardware Reset Circuit (Usage Example of External Supply Voltage
Detection Circuit) and Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 28 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5.2
5. Resets
Power-On Reset Function
When the RESET pin is connected to the VCC pin via a pull-up resistor, and the VCC pin voltage level rises while
the rise gradient is trth or more, the power-on reset function is enabled and the MCU resets its pins, CPU, and SFR.
When a capacitor is connected to the RESET pin, too, always keep the voltage to the RESET pin 0.8VCC or more.
When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet0 level or above, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock
starts counting. When the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock count reaches 32, the internal reset signal is held “H”
and the MCU enters the reset sequence (refer to Figure 5.3). The low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is
automatically selected as the CPU clock after reset.
Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the states of the SFR after power-on reset.
The voltage monitor 0 reset is enabled after power-on reset.
Figure 5.7 shows an Example of Power-On Reset Circuit and Operation.
VCC
4.7 kΩ
(reference)
RESET
Vdet0(3)
Vdet0(3)
2.2V
trth
trth
External
Power VCC
Vpor2
Vpor1
Sampling time(1, 2)
tw(por1)
Internal
reset signal
(“L” valid)
1
× 32
fOCO-S
1
× 32
fOCO-S
NOTES:
1. When using the voltage monitor 0 digital filter, ensure that the voltage is within the MCU operation voltage
range (2.2 V or above) during the sampling time.
2. The sampling clock can be selected. Refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit for details.
3. Vdet0 indicates the voltage detection level of the voltage detection 0 circuit. Refer to 6. Voltage Detection
Circuit for details.
4. Refer to 22. Electrical Characteristics.
5. To use the power-on reset function, enable voltage monitor 0 reset by setting the LVD0ON bit in the OFS
register to 0, the VW0C0 and VW0C6 bits in the VW0C register to 1 respectively, and the VCA25 bit in the
VCA2 register to 1.
Figure 5.7
Example of Power-On Reset Circuit and Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 29 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5.3
5. Resets
Voltage Monitor 0 Reset
A reset is applied using the on-chip voltage detection 0 circuit. The voltage detection 0 circuit monitors the input
voltage to the VCC pin. The voltage to monitor is Vdet0.
When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet0 level or below, the pins, CPU, and SFR are reset.
When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet0 level or above, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock
start counting. When the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock count reaches 32, the internal reset signal is held “H”
and the MCU enters the reset sequence (refer to Figure 5.3). The low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is
automatically selected as the CPU clock after reset.
The LVD0ON bit in the OFS register can be used to enable or disable voltage monitor 0 reset after a hardware reset.
Setting the LVD0ON bit is only valid after a hardware reset.
To use the power-on reset function, enable voltage monitor 0 reset by setting the LVD0ON bit in the OFS register
to 0, the VW0C0 and VW0C6 bits in the VW0C register to 1 respectively, and the VCA25 bit in the VCA2 register
to 1.
The LVD0ON bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the LVD0ON bit, write 0 (voltage monitor 0 reset
enabled after hardware reset) or 1 (voltage monitor 0 reset disabled after hardware reset) to bit 5 of address 0FFFFh
using a flash programmer.
Refer to Figure 5.4 OFS Register for details of the OFS register.
Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the status of the SFR after voltage monitor 0 reset.
The internal RAM is not reset. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet0 level or below while
writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the contents of internal RAM are undefined.
Refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit for details of voltage monitor 0 reset.
5.4
Voltage Monitor 1 Reset
A reset is applied using the on-chip voltage detection 1 circuit. The voltage detection 1 circuit monitors the input
voltage to the VCC pin. The voltage to monitor is Vdet1.
When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet1 level or below, the pins, CPU, and SFR are reset and a
program is executed beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector. After reset, the low-speed on-chip
oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU clock.
The voltage monitor 1 does not reset some portions of the SFR. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for
details.
The internal RAM is not reset. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet1 level or below while
writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the contents of internal RAM are undefined.
Refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit for details of voltage monitor 1 reset.
5.5
Voltage Monitor 2 Reset
A reset is applied using the on-chip voltage detection 2 circuit. The voltage detection 2 circuit monitors the input
voltage to the VCC pin. The voltage to monitor is Vdet2.
When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet2 level or below, the pins, CPU, and SFR are reset and the
program beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector is executed. After reset, the low-speed on-chip
oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU clock.
The voltage monitor 2 does not reset some SFRs. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for details.
The internal RAM is not reset. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet2 level or below while
writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the contents of internal RAM are undefined.
Refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit for details of voltage monitor 2 reset.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 30 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
5.6
5. Resets
Watchdog Timer Reset
When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to 1 (reset when watchdog timer underflows), the MCU resets its pins,
CPU, and SFR if the watchdog timer underflows. Then the program beginning with the address indicated by the
reset vector is executed. After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as
the CPU clock.
The watchdog timer reset does not reset some SFRs. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for details.
The internal RAM is not reset. When the watchdog timer underflows, the contents of internal RAM are undefined.
Refer to 15. Watchdog Timer for details of the watchdog timer.
5.7
Software Reset
When the PM03 bit in the PM0 register is set to 1 (MCU reset), the MCU resets its pins, CPU, and SFR. The
program beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector is executed. After reset, the low-speed on-chip
oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected for the CPU clock.
The software reset does not reset some SFRs. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for details.
The internal RAM is not reset.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 31 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6.
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Detection Circuit
The voltage detection circuit monitors the input voltage to the VCC pin. This circuit can be used to monitor the VCC
input voltage by a program. Alternately, voltage monitor 0 reset, voltage monitor 1 interrupt, voltage monitor 1 reset,
voltage monitor 2 interrupt, and voltage monitor 2 reset can also be used.
Table 6.1 lists the Specifications of Voltage Detection Circuit and Figures 6.1 to 6.4 show the Block Diagrams. Figures
6.5 to 6.8 show the Associated Registers.
Table 6.1
VCC Monitor
Specifications of Voltage Detection Circuit
Item
Voltage to monitor
Detection target
Monitor
Process
Reset
When Voltage
is Detected
Voltage monitor 0 reset
Reset at Vdet0 > VCC;
restart CPU operation
at VCC > Vdet0
None
Interrupt
Digital Filter
Switch
enabled/disabled
Sampling time
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Voltage Detection 0
Vdet0
Whether passing
through Vdet0 by rising
or falling
None
Available
Voltage Detection 1
Voltage Detection 2
Vdet1
Vdet2
Passing through Vdet1 by Passing through Vdet2 by
rising or falling
rising or falling
VW1C3 bit in VW1C
register
Whether VCC is higher or
lower than Vdet1
Voltage monitor 1 reset
Reset at Vdet1 > VCC;
restart CPU operation
after a specified time
Voltage monitor 1
interrupt
Interrupt request at Vdet1
> VCC and VCC > Vdet1
when digital filter is
enabled;
interrupt request at Vdet1
> VCC or VCC > Vdet1
when digital filter is
disabled
Available
(Divide-by-n of fOCO-S) (Divide-by-n of fOCO-S)
×4
×4
n: 1, 2, 4, and 8
n: 1, 2, 4, and 8
Page 32 of 450
VCA13 bit in VCA1
register
Whether VCC is higher or
lower than Vdet2
Voltage monitor 2 reset
Reset at Vdet2 > VCC;
restart CPU operation
after a specified time
Voltage monitor 2
interrupt
Interrupt request at Vdet2
> VCC and VCC > Vdet2
when digital filter is
enabled;
interrupt request at Vdet2
> VCC or VCC > Vdet2
when digital filter is
disabled
Available
(Divide-by-n of fOCO-S)
×4
n: 1, 2, 4, and 8
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
VCA27
VCC
-
Voltage detection 2
signal
Noise
filter
+
Internal
reference
voltage
≥ Vdet2
VCA1 register
b3
VCA13 bit
VCA26
-
Voltage detection 1
signal
Noise
filter
+
≥ Vdet1
VW1C register
b3
VW1C3 bit
VCA25
Voltage detection 0
signal
+
-
Figure 6.1
≥ Vdet0
Block Diagram of Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage monitor 0 reset generation circuit
VW0F1 to VW0F0
= 00b
= 01b
Voltage detection 0 circuit
= 10b
fOCO-S
1/2
1/2
1/2
= 11b
VCA25
VW0C1
VCC
Internal
reference
voltage
+
Digital
filter
Voltage
detection 0
signal
-
Voltage detection 0
signal is held “H” when
VCA25 bit is set to 0
(disabled)
Voltage monitor 0
reset signal
VW0C1
VW0C0
VW0C7
VW0C0 to VW0C1, VW0F0 to VW0F1, VW0C6, VW0C7: Bits in VW0C register
VCA25: Bit in VCA2 register
Figure 6.2
Block Diagram of Voltage Monitor 0 Reset Generation Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 33 of 450
VW0C6
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt/reset generation circuit
VW1F1 to VW1F0
= 00b
= 01b
Voltage detection 1 circuit
VW1C2 bit is set to 0 (not detected) by
writing 0 by a program.
When VCA26 bit is set to 0 (voltage
detection 1 circuit disabled), VW1C2
bit is set to 0
= 10b
fOCO-S
1/2
1/2
1/2
= 11b
VCA26
VW1C1
VW1C3
VCC
+
Noise filter
Internal
reference
voltage
(Filter width: 200 ns)
Digital
filter
Voltage
detection
1 signal
Watchdog
timer interrupt
signal
VW1C2
Voltage detection 1 signal
is held “H” when VCA26 bit
is set to 0 (disabled)
Voltage monitor 1
interrupt signal
Non-maskable
interrupt signal
VW1C1
Oscillation stop
detection
interrupt signal
VW1C7
VW1C0
VW1C6
Voltage monitor 1
reset signal
VW1C0 to VW1C3, VW1F0, VW1F1, VW1C6, VW1C7: Bits in VW1C register
VCA26: Bit in VCA2 register
Figure 6.3
Block Diagram of Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt/Reset Generation Circuit
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset generation circuit
VW2F1 to VW2F0
= 00b
= 01b
Voltage detection 2 circuit
= 10b
fOCO-S
1/2
1/2
1/2
VW2C2 bit is set to 0 (not detected) by
writing 0 by a program.
When VCA27 bit is set to 0 (voltage
detection 2 circuit disabled), VW2C2
bit is set to 0
= 11b
VCA27
VW2C1
VCA13
VCC
+
Noise filter
Internal
reference
voltage
(Filter width: 200 ns)
Digital
filter
Voltage
detection
2 signal
Watchdog
timer interrupt
signal
VW2C2
Voltage detection 2 signal
is held “H” when VCA27 bit
is set to 0 (disabled)
Voltage monitor 2
interrupt signal
Non-maskable
interrupt signal
VW2C1
Oscillation stop
detection
interrupt signal
Watchdog timer block
VW2C3
VW2C7
Watchdog timer
underflow signal
This bit is set to 0 (not detected) by writing 0
by a program.
VW2C0
VW2C6
VW2C0 to VW2C3, VW2F0, VW2F1, VW2C6, VW2C7: Bits in VW2C register
VCA13: Bit in VCA1 register
VCA27: Bit in VCA2 register
Figure 6.4
Block Diagram of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt/Reset Generation Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 34 of 450
Voltage monitor 2
reset signal
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Detection Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0
0 0 0
After Reset(2)
00001000b
Function
Symbol
Address
0031h
VCA1
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Reserved bits
—
(b2-b0)
VCA13
—
(b7-b4)
Set to 0.
Voltage detection 2 signal monitor
flag(1)
0 : VCC < Vdet2
1 : VCC ≥ Vdet2 or voltage detection 2
circuit disabled
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
RW
RW
RO
RW
NOTES:
1. The VCA13 bit is enabled w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled).
The VCA13 bit is set to 1 (VCC ≥ Vdet 2) w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 0 (voltage detection 2
circuit disabled).
2. The softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this
register.
Voltage Detection Register 2(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0
Symbol
VCA2
Bit Symbol
VCA20
—
(b4-b1)
Address
0032h
Bit Name
Internal pow er low
consumption enable bit(6)
After Reset(5)
The LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is
set to 1 and hardw are reset
: 00h
Pow er-on reset, voltage monitor 0 reset
or LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is
set to 0, and hardw are reset
: 00100000b
Function
0 : Disables low consumption
1 : Enables low consumption
RW
RW
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
VCA25
Voltage detection 0 enable
bit(2)
0 : Voltage detection 0 circuit disabled
1 : Voltage detection 0 circuit enabled
RW
VCA26
Voltage detection 1 enable
bit(3)
0 : Voltage detection 1 circuit disabled
1 : Voltage detection 1 circuit enabled
RW
VCA27
Voltage detection 2 enable
bit(4)
0 : Voltage detection 2 circuit disabled
1 : Voltage detection 2 circuit enabled
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before w riting to the VCA2 register.
2. To use the voltage monitor 0 reset, set the VCA25 bit to 1.
After the VCA25 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting
operation.
3. To use the voltage monitor 1 interrupt/reset or the VW1C3 bit in the VW1C register, set the VCA26 bit to 1.
After the VCA26 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting
operation.
4. To use the voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset or the VCA13 bit in the VCA1 register, set the VCA27 bit to 1.
After the VCA27 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting
operation.
5. Softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this
register.
6. Use the VCA20 bit only w hen entering to w ait mode. To set the VCA20 bit, follow the procedure show n in Figure
10.9 Procedure for Enabling Reduced Internal Pow er Consum ption Using VCA20 bit.
Figure 6.5
Registers VCA1 and VCA2
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 35 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Monitor 0 Circuit Control Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
VW0C
Bit Symbol
VW0C0
VW0C1
VW0C2
—
(b3)
0038h
Bit Name
Voltage monitor 0 reset
enable bit(3)
Function
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
Set to 0.
Reserved bit
When read, the content is undefined.
Sampling clock select bits
b5 b4
0 0 : fOCO-S divided by
0 1 : fOCO-S divided by
1 0 : fOCO-S divided by
1 1 : fOCO-S divided by
RW
RW
Reserved bit
VW0F1
VW0C7
The LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is
set to 1 and hardw are reset
: 0000X000b
Pow er-on reset, voltage monitor 0 reset
or LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is set
to 0, and hardw are reset
: 0100X001b
Voltage monitor 0 digital filter 0 : Digital filter enabled mode
(digital filter circuit enabled)
disable mode select bit
1 : Digital filter disabled mode
(digital filter circuit disabled)
VW0F0
VW0C6
After Reset(2)
Address
RW
RW
1
2
4
8
RO
RW
RW
Voltage monitor 0 circuit
mode select bit
When the VW0C0 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 0
reset enabled), set to 1.
RW
Voltage monitor 0 reset
generation condition select
bit(4)
When the VW0C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter
disabled mode), set to 1.
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before w riting to the VW0C register.
2. The value remains unchanged after a softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, and voltage
monitor 2 reset.
3. The VW0C0 bit is enabled w hen the VCA25 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 0 circuit
enabled). Set the VW0C0 bit to 0 (disable), w hen the VCA25 bit is set to 0 (voltage detection 0 circuit disabled).
4. The VW0C7 bit is enabled w hen the VW0C1 bit set to 1 (digital filter disabled mode).
Figure 6.6
VW0C Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 36 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Monitor 1 Circuit Control Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
VW1C
Bit Symbol
Address
0036h
Bit Name
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt/reset
enable bit(6)
After Reset(8)
00001000b
Function
RW
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
Voltage monitor 1 digital filter
disable mode select bit(2)
0 : Digital filter enabled mode
(digital filter circuit enabled)
1 : Digital filter disabled mode
(digital filter circuit disabled)
RW
VW1C2
Voltage change detection
flag(3, 4, 8)
0 : Not detected
1 : Vdet1 crossing detected
RW
VW1C3
Voltage detection 1 signal monitor 0 : VCC < Vdet1
1 : VCC ≥ Vdet1 or voltage detection 1
flag(3, 8)
circuit disabled
VW1C0
VW1C1
Sampling clock select bits
VW1F0
VW1C6
VW1C7
b5 b4
0 0 : fOCO-S divided by
0 1 : fOCO-S divided by
1 0 : fOCO-S divided by
1 1 : fOCO-S divided by
VW1F1
RO
1
2
4
8
Voltage monitor 1 circuit mode
select bit(5)
0 : Voltage monitor 1 interrupt mode
1 : Voltage monitor 1 reset mode
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt/reset
generation condition select bit(7, 9)
0 : When VCC reaches Vdet1 or above
1 : When VCC reaches Vdet1 or below
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (rew rite enable) before w riting to the VW1C register.
2. To use the voltage monitor 1 interrupt to exit stop mode and to return again, w rite 0 to the VW1C1 bit before w riting
1.
3. Bits VW1C2 and VW1C3 are enabled w hen the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit
enabled).
4. Set this bit to 0 by a program. When 0 is w ritten by a program, it is set to 0 (and remains unchanged even if 1 is
w ritten to it).
5. The VW1C6 bit is enabled w hen the VW1C0 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 1 interrupt/enabled reset).
6. The VW1C0 bit is enabled w hen the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled).
Set the VW1C0 bit to 0 (disable) w hen the VCA26 bit is set to 0 (voltage detection 1 circuit disabled).
7. The VW1C7 bit is enabled w hen the VW1C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled mode).
8. Bits VW1C2 and VW1C3 remain unchanged after a softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset,
or voltage monitor 2 reset.
9. When the VW1C6 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 1 reset mode), set the VW1C7 bit to 1 (w hen VCC reaches Vdet1 or
below ). (Do not set to 0.)
Figure 6.7
VW1C Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 37 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Monitor 2 Circuit Control Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
VW2C
Bit Symbol
VW2C0
VW2C1
VW2C2
VW2C3
Address
0037h
Bit Name
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset
enable bit(6)
RW
Voltage monitor 2 digital filter
disable mode select bit(2)
0 : Digital filter enabled mode
(digital filter circuit enabled)
1 : Digital filter disabled mode
(digital filter circuit disabled)
RW
Voltage change detection
flag(3, 4, 8)
0 : Not detected
1 : VCC has crossed Vdet2
RW
WDT detection flag(4, 8)
0 : Not detected
1 : Detected
RW
Sampling clock select bits
b5 b4
0 0 : fOCO-S divided by
0 1 : fOCO-S divided by
1 0 : fOCO-S divided by
1 1 : fOCO-S divided by
VW2F1
VW2C7
RW
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
VW2F0
VW2C6
After Reset(8)
00h
Function
1
2
4
8
Voltage monitor 2 circuit mode
select bit(5)
0 : Voltage monitor 2 interrupt mode
1 : Voltage monitor 2 reset mode
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset
generation condition select bit(7, 9)
0 : When VCC reaches Vdet2 or above
1 : When VCC reaches Vdet2 or below
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before w riting to the VW2C register.
2. To use the voltage monitor 2 interrupt to exit stop mode and to return again, w rite 0 to the VW2C1
bit before w riting 1.
3. The VW2C2 bit is enabled w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit
enabled).
4. Set this bit to 0 by a program. When 0 is w ritten by a program, it is set to 0 (and remains unchanged even if 1 is
w ritten to it).
5. The VW2C6 bit is enabled w hen the VW2C0 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt/enables reset).
6. The VW2C0 bit is enabled w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit
enabled). Set the VW2C0 bit to 0 (disable) w hen the VCA27 bit is set to 0 (voltage detection 2 circuit disabled).
7. The VW2C7 bit is enabled w hen the VW2C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled mode).
8. Bits VW2C2 and VW2C3 remain unchanged after a softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset,
or voltage monitor 2 reset.
9. When the VW2C6 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 2 reset mode), set the VW2C7 bit to 1 (w hen VCC reaches Vdet2
or below ). (Do not set to 0.)
Figure 6.8
VW2C Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 38 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6.1
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
VCC Input Voltage
6.1.1
Monitoring Vdet0
Vdet0 cannot be monitored.
6.1.2
Monitoring Vdet1
Set the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled). After td(E-A) has elapsed
(refer to 22. Electrical Characteristics), Vdet1 can be monitored by the VW1C3 bit in the VW1C register.
6.1.3
Monitoring Vdet2
Set the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled). After td(E-A) has elapsed
(refer to 22. Electrical Characteristics), Vdet2 can be monitored by the VCA13 bit in the VCA1 register.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 39 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6.2
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Monitor 0 Reset
Table 6.2 lists the Procedure for Setting Bits Associated with Voltage Monitor Reset and Figure 6.9 shows an
Example of Voltage Monitor 0 Reset Operation. To use the voltage monitor 0 reset to exit stop mode, set the
VW0C1 bit in the VW0C register to 1 (digital filter disabled).
Table 6.2
Step
1
2
3
4(1)
5(1)
6
7
8
9
Procedure for Setting Bits Associated with Voltage Monitor Reset
When Using Digital Filter
When Not Using Digital Filter
Set the VCA25 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 0 circuit enabled)
Wait for td(E-A)
Select the sampling clock of the digital filter Set the VW0C7 bit in the VW0C register to
by the VW0F0 to VW0F1 bits in the VW0C 1
register
Set the VW0C1 bit in the VW0C register to Set the VW0C1 bit in the VW0C register to
0 (digital filter enabled)
1 (digital filter disabled)
Set the VW0C6 bit in the VW0C register to 1 (voltage monitor 0 reset mode)
Set the VW0C2 bit in the VW0C register to 0
Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0 −
(low-speed on-chip oscillator on)
Wait for 4 cycles of the sampling clock of
− (No wait time required)
the digital filter
Set the VW0C0 bit in the VW0C register to 1 (voltage monitor 0 reset enabled)
NOTE:
1. When the VW0C0 bit is set to 0, steps 3, 4, and 5 can be executed simultaneously (with 1
instruction).
VCC
Vdet0
Sampling clock of
digital filter × 4 cycles
When the VW0C1 bit is set
to 0 (digital filter enabled)
1
× 32
fOCO-S
Internal reset signal
1
× 32
fOCO-S
When the VW0C1 bit is set
to 1 (digital filter disabled)
and the VW0C7 bit is set
to 1
Internal reset signal
VW0C1 and VW0C7: Bits in VW0C register
The above applies under the following conditions.
• VCA25 bit in VCA2 register = 1 (voltage detection 0 circuit enabled)
• VW0C0 bit in VW0C register = 1 (voltage monitor 0 reset enabled)
• VW0C6 bit in VW0C register = 1 (voltage monitor 0 reset mode)
When the internal reset signal is held “L”, the pins, CPU and SFR are reset.
The internal reset signal level changes from “L” to “H”, and a program is executed beginning with the address indicated by
the reset vector.
Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the SFR status after reset.
Figure 6.9
Example of Voltage Monitor 0 Reset Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 40 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6.3
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 1 Reset
Table 6.3 lists the Procedure for Setting Bits Associated with Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt and Reset. Figure 6.10
shows an Example of Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Operation. To use the voltage
monitor 1 interrupt or voltage monitor 1 reset to exit stop mode, set the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register to 1
(digital filter disabled).
Table 6.3
Step
1
2
3
4(2)
5(2)
6
7
8
9
Procedure for Setting Bits Associated with Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt and Reset
When Using Digital Filter
When Not Using Digital Filter
Voltage Monitor 1
Voltage Monitor 1
Voltage Monitor 1
Voltage Monitor 1
Interrupt
Reset
Interrupt
Reset
Set the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled)
Wait for td(E-A)
Select the sampling clock of the digital filter Select the timing of the interrupt and reset
by the VW1F0 to VW1F1 bits in the VW1C
request by the VW1C7 bit in the VW1C
register
register(1)
Set the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register to 0 Set the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register to 1
(digital filter enabled)
(digital filter disabled)
Set the VW1C6 bit in Set the VW1C6 bit in Set the VW1C6 bit in Set the VW1C6 bit in
the VW1C register to the VW1C register to the VW1C register to the VW1C register to
0 (voltage monitor 1 1 (voltage monitor 1 0 (voltage monitor 1 1 (voltage monitor 1
reset mode)
interrupt mode)
reset mode)
interrupt mode)
Set the VW1C2 bit in the VW1C register to 0 (passing of Vdet1 is not detected)
Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0
−
(low-speed on-chip oscillator on)
Wait for 4 cycles of the sampling clock of the − (No wait time required)
digital filter
Set the VW1C0 bit in the VW1C register to 1 (voltage monitor 1 interrupt/reset enabled)
NOTES:
1. Set the VW1C7 bit to 1 (when VCC reaches Vdet1 or below) for the voltage monitor 1 reset.
2. When the VW1C0 bit is set to 0, steps 3, 4, and 5 can be executed simultaneously (with 1
instruction).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 41 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
VCC
Vdet1
2.2 V(1)
1
VW1C3 bit
0
4 cycles of sampling clock of
digital filter
4 cycles of sampling clock of
digital filter
1
VW1C2 bit
0
Set to 0 by a program
When the VW1C1 bit is set
to 0 (digital filter enabled)
Set to 0 by interrupt request
acknowledgement
Voltage monitor 1
interrupt request
(VW1C6 = 0)
Internal reset signal
(VW1C6 = 1)
Set to 0 by a program
1
When the VW1C1 bit is
set to 1 (digital filter
disabled) and the
VW1C7 bit is set to 0
(Vdet1 or above)
VW1C2 bit
0
Set to 0 by interrupt
request
acknowledgement
Voltage monitor 1
interrupt request
(VW1C6 = 0)
Set to 0 by a program
1
VW1C2 bit
0
When the VW1C1 bit is
set to 1 (digital filter
disabled) and the
VW1C7 bit is set to 1
(Vdet1 or below)
Voltage monitor 1
interrupt request
(VW1C6 = 0)
Set to 0 by interrupt
request acknowledgement
Internal reset signal
(VW1C6 = 1)
VW1C1, VW1C2, VW1C3, VW1C6, VW1C7: Bit in VW1C Register
The above applies under the following conditions.
• VCA26 bit in VCA2 register = 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled)
• VW1C0 bit in VW1C register = 1 (voltage monitor 1 interrupt and voltage monitor 1 reset enabled)
NOTE:
1. If voltage monitor 0 reset is not used, set the power supply to VCC ≥ 2.2.
Figure 6.10
Example of Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 42 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6.4
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset
Table 6.4 lists the Procedure for Setting Bits Associated with Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Reset. Figure 6.11
shows an Example of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset Operation. To use the voltage
monitor 2 interrupt or voltage monitor 2 reset to exit stop mode, set the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register to 1
(digital filter disabled).
Table 6.4
Step
1
2
3
4
5(2)
6
7
8
9
Procedure for Setting Bits Associated with Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Reset
When Using Digital Filter
When Not Using Digital Filter
Voltage Monitor 2
Voltage Monitor 2
Voltage Monitor 2
Voltage Monitor 2
Interrupt
Reset
Interrupt
Reset
Set the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled)
Wait for td(E-A)
Select the sampling clock of the digital filter Select the timing of the interrupt and reset
by the VW2F0 to VW2F1 bits in the VW2C
request by the VW2C7 bit in the VW2C
register
register(1)
Set the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register to 0 Set the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register to 1
(digital filter enabled)
(digital filter disabled)
Set the VW2C6 bit in Set the VW2C6 bit in Set the VW2C6 bit in Set the VW2C6 bit in
the VW2C register to the VW2C register to the VW2C register to the VW2C register to
0 (voltage monitor 2 1 (voltage monitor 2 0 (voltage monitor 2 1 (voltage monitor 2
reset mode)
interrupt mode)
reset mode)
interrupt mode)
Set the VW2C2 bit in the VW2C register to 0 (passing of Vdet2 is not detected)
Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0
−
(low-speed on-chip oscillator on)
Wait for 4 cycles of the sampling clock of the − (No wait time required)
digital filter
Set the VW2C0 bit in the VW2C register to 1 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset enabled)
NOTES:
1. Set the VW2C7 bit to 1 (when VCC reaches Vdet2 or below) for the voltage monitor 2 reset.
2. When the VW2C0 bit is set to 0, steps 3, 4, and 5 can be executed simultaneously (with 1
instruction).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 43 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
VCC
Vdet2
2.2 V(1)
1
VCA13 bit
0
4 cycles of sampling clock of
digital filter
4 cycles of sampling clock of
digital filter
1
VW2C2 bit
0
Set to 0 by a program
When the VW2C1 bit is set
to 0 (digital filter enabled)
Set to 0 by interrupt request
acknowledgement
Voltage monitor 2
interrupt request
(VW2C6 = 0)
Internal reset signal
(VW2C6 = 1)
Set to 0 by a program
1
When the VW2C1 bit is
set to 1 (digital filter
disabled) and the
VW2C7 bit is set to 0
(Vdet2 or above)
VW2C2 bit
0
Set to 0 by interrupt
request
acknowledgement
Voltage monitor 2
interrupt request
(VW2C6 = 0)
Set to 0 by a program
1
VW2C2 bit
0
When the VW2C1 bit is
set to 1 (digital filter
disabled) and the
VW2C7 bit is set to 1
(Vdet2 or below)
Voltage monitor 2
interrupt request
(VW2C6 = 0)
Set to 0 by interrupt
request acknowledgement
Internal reset signal
(VW2C6 = 1)
VCA13: Bit in VCA1 register
VW2C1, VW2C2, VW2C6, VW2C7: Bits in VW2C register
The above applies under the following conditions.
• VCA27 bit in VCA2 register = 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled)
• VW2C0 bit in VW2C register = 1 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt and voltage monitor 2 reset enabled)
NOTE:
1. When voltage monitor 0 reset is not used, set the power supply to VCC ≥ 2.2.
Figure 6.11
Example of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 44 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7.
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Programmable I/O Ports
There are 25 programmable Input/Output ports (I/O ports) P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5, P1, P2, P3_3 to P3_5, P4_5. Also, if
the XIN clock oscillation circuit is not used, P4_6 and P4_7 can be used as input-only ports. If the A/D converter is not
used, P4_2 can be used as an input-only port.
Table 7.1 lists an Overview of Programmable I/O Ports.
Table 7.1
Overview of Programmable I/O Ports
Ports
P0_0 to P0_3, P1, P2
I/O
I/O
Type of Output
CMOS3 State
I/O Setting
Set per bit
Set every 4 bits(1)
P3_4, P3_5
I/O
CMOS3 State
Set per bit
Set every 2 bits(1)
I/O
CMOS3 State
Set per bit
(No output function)
None
Set every bit(1)
None
P0_5, P3_3, P4_5
P4_2,
P4_6(2),
P4_7(2)
I
Internal Pull-Up Resister
NOTES:
1. In input mode, whether an internal pull-up resistor is connected or not can be selected by registers
PUR0, and PUR1.
2. When the XIN clock oscillation circuit is not used, these ports can be used as the input-only ports.
7.1
Functions of Programmable I/O Ports
The PDi_j (j = 0 to 7) bit in the PDi (i = 0 to 4) register controls I/O of the ports P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5, P1, P2, P3_3
to P3_5, P4_5. The Pi register consists of a port latch to hold output data and a circuit to read pin states.
Figures 7.1 to 7.6 show the Configurations of Programmable I/O Ports. Table 7.2 lists the Functions of
Programmable I/O Ports. Also, Figure 7.8 shows the PDi (i = 0 to 4) Registers. Figure 7.9 shows the Pi (i = 0 to 4)
Registers, Figure 7.10 shows the P2DRR Register, Figure 7.11 shows Registers PINSR1, PINSR2, PINSR3, and
PMR, Figure 7.12 shows Registers PUR0, and PUR1.
Table 7.2
Functions of Programmable I/O Ports
Operation When
Value of PDi_j Bit in PDi Register(1)
Accessing
When PDi_j Bit is Set to 0 (Input Mode) When PDi_j Bit is Set to 1 (Output Mode)
Pi Register
Reading
Read pin input level
Read the port latch
Writing
Write to the port latch
Write to the port latch. The value written to
the port latch is output from the pin.
i = 0 to 4, j = 0 to 7
NOTE:
1. Nothing is assigned to the following bits:
PD0_4, PD0_6, PD0_7, PD3_0 to PD3_2, PD3_6, PD3_7, PD4_0 to PD4_4, PD4_6, PD4_7
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 45 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7.2
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Effect on Peripheral Functions
Programmable I/O ports function as I/O ports for peripheral functions (Refer to Table 1.7 Pin Name Information
by Pin Number).
Table 7.3 lists the Setting of PDi_j Bit when Functioning as I/O Ports for Peripheral Functions (i = 0 to 4, j = 0 to
7).
Refer to the description of each function for information on how to set peripheral functions.
Table 7.3
Setting of PDi_j Bit when Functioning as I/O Ports for Peripheral Functions
(i = 0 to 4, j = 0 to 7)
I/O of Peripheral Functions
PDi_j Bit Settings for Shared Pin Functions
Input
Set this bit to 0 (input mode).
Output
This bit can be set to either 0 or 1 (output regardless of the port setting)
7.3
Pins Other than Programmable I/O Ports
Figure 7.7 shows the Configuration of I/O Pins.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 46 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
P0_0 to P0_3
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
(Note 1)
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Analog input
P0_5
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Input to individual peripheral function
Analog input
NOTE:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
Figure 7.1
Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (1)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 47 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
P1_0 to P1_3
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Input to individual peripheral function
Analog input
P1_4
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Pull-up selection
P1_5 and P1_7
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
INT1 input
Digital
filter
Input to individual peripheral function
NOTE:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
Figure 7.2
Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (2)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 48 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
P1_6
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Input to individual peripheral function
Drive capacity selection
P2
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Input to individual peripheral function
Drive capacity selection
NOTE:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
Figure 7.3
Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (3)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 49 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
P3_3, P3_4, P3_5
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
1
(Note 1)
Output from individual peripheral function
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
Input to individual peripheral function
NOTE:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
Figure 7.4
Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (4)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 50 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
(Note 1)
P4_2/VREF
Data bus
(Note 1)
P4_5
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
(Note 1)
Data bus
Port latch
(Note 1)
INT0 input
Digital
filter
NOTE:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
Figure 7.5
Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (5)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 51 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
(Note 1)
P4_6/XIN
Data bus
(Note 1)
Clocked inverter(2)
(Note 3)
(Note 1)
P4_7/XOUT
(Note 4)
Data bus
(Note 1)
NOTES:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
2. When CM05 = 1, CM10 = 1, or CM13 = 0, the clocked inverter is cut off.
3. When CM10 = 1 or CM13 = 0, the feedback resistor is disconnected.
4. When CM05 = CM13 = 1 or CM10 = CM13 = 1, this pin is pulled up.
Figure 7.6
Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (6)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 52 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
MODE
MODE signal input
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
RESET
RESET signal input
(Note 1)
NOTE:
1.
symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC.
Figure 7.7
Configuration of I/O Pins
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 53 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port Pi Direction Register (i = 0 to 4)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
PD0(1)
PD1
PD2
PD3(2)
PD4(3)
Bit Symbol
PDi_0
PDi_1
PDi_2
PDi_3
PDi_4
PDi_5
PDi_6
PDi_7
Address
00E2h
00E3h
00E6h
00E7h
00EAh
Bit Name
Port Pi_0 direction bit
Port Pi_1 direction bit
Port Pi_2 direction bit
Port Pi_3 direction bit
Port Pi_4 direction bit
Port Pi_5 direction bit
Port Pi_6 direction bit
Port Pi_7 direction bit
After Reset
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
Function
0 : Input mode
(functions as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(functions as an output port)
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to the PD0 register w ith the next instruction after that used to set the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite
enabled).
Bits PD0_4, PD0_6, and PD0_7 in the PD0 register are unavailable on this MCU.
If it is necessary to set bits PD0_4, PD0_6, and PD0_7 in the PD0 register, set to 0 (input mode). When read, the
content is 0.
2. Bits PD3_0 to PD3_2, PD3_6, and PD3_7 in the PD3 register are unavailable on this MCU.
If it is necessary to set bits PD3_0 to PD3_2, PD3_6, and PD3_7 in the PD3 register, set to 0 (input mode). When read,
the content is 0.
3. Bits PD4_0 to PD4_4, PD4_6, and PD4_7 in the PD4 register are unavailable on this MCU.
If it is necessary to set bits PD4_0 to PD4_4, PD4_6, and PD4_7 in the PD4 register, set to 0 (input mode). When read,
the content is 0.
Figure 7.8
PDi (i = 0 to 4) Registers
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 54 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port Pi Register (i = 0 to 4)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
P0(1)
P1
P2
P3(2)
P4(3)
Bit Symbol
Pi_0
Pi_1
Pi_2
Pi_3
Pi_4
Pi_5
Pi_6
Pi_7
Address
00E0h
00E1h
00E4h
00E5h
00E8h
Bit Name
Port Pi_0 bit
Port Pi_1 bit
Port Pi_2 bit
Port Pi_3 bit
Port Pi_4 bit
Port Pi_5 bit
Port Pi_6 bit
Port Pi_7 bit
After Reset
Undefined
Undefined
Undefined
Undefined
Undefined
Function
The pin level of any I/O port w hich is set to
input mode can be read by reading the
corresponding bit in this register. The pin level
of any I/O port w hich is set to output mode
can be controlled by w riting to the
corresponding bit in this register.
0 : “L” level
1 : “H” level
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Bits P0_4, P0_6, and P0_7 in the P0 register are unavailable on this MCU.
If it is necessary to set bits P0_4, P0_6, and P0_7, set to 0 (“L” level). When read, the content is 0.
2. Bits P3_0 to P3_2, P3_6, and P3_7 in the P3 register are unavailable on this MCU.
If it is necessary to set bits P3_0 to P3_2, P3_6, and P3_7, set to 0 (“L” level). When read, the content is 0.
3. Bits P4_0, P4_1, P4_3, and P4_4 in the P4 register are unavailable on this MCU.
If it is necessary to set bits P4_0, P4_1, P4_3, and P4_4, set to 0 (“L” level). When read, the content is 0.
Figure 7.9
Pi (i = 0 to 4) Registers
Port P2 Drive Capacity Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
P2DRR
Bit Symbol
P2DRR0
P2DRR1
P2DRR2
P2DRR3
P2DRR4
P2DRR5
P2DRR6
P2DRR7
Address
00F4h
Bit Name
P2_0 drive capacity
P2_1 drive capacity
P2_2 drive capacity
P2_3 drive capacity
P2_4 drive capacity
P2_5 drive capacity
P2_6 drive capacity
P2_7 drive capacity
NOTE:
1. Both “H” and “L” output are set to high drive capacity.
Figure 7.10
P2DRR Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 55 of 450
After Reset
00h
Function
Set P2 output transistor drive capacity
0 : Low
1 : High(1)
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Pin Select Register 1
b7
b0
Symbol
PINSR1
Address
00F5h
Function
After Reset
Undefined
RW
Set to “70h” w hen using UART2.
Do not set values other than “70h”.
When read, its content is undefined.
WO
Pin Select Register 2
b7
b0
Symbol
PINSR2
Address
00F6h
Function
After Reset
Undefined
RW
Set to “40h” w hen using Timer RB.
Do not set values other than “40h”.
When read, its content is undefined.
WO
Pin Select Register 3
b7
b0
Symbol
PINSR3
Address
00F7h
Function
After Reset
Undefined
RW
Set to “1Fh” w hen using Timer RC.
Do not set values other than “1Fh”.
When read, its content is undefined.
WO
Port Mode Register
b7
b0
Symbol
PMR
_____
Address
00F8h
Function
Set to “04h” w hen using INT3.
Do not set values other than “04h”.
When read, its content is undefined.
Figure 7.11
Registers PINSR1, PINSR2, PINSR3, and PMR
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 56 of 450
After Reset
00h
RW
WO
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-Up Control Register 0
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
PUR0
Bit Symbol
PU00
PU01
PU02
PU03
PU04
PU05
PU06
PU07
Address
00FCh
Bit Name
P0_0 to P0_3 pull-up(1)
P0_5 pull-up(1)
P1_0 to P1_3 pull-up(1)
P1_4 to P1_7 pull-up(1)
P2_0 to P2_3 pull-up(1)
P2_4 to P2_7 pull-up(1)
P3_3 pll-up(1)
P3_4 to P3_5 pll-up(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Not pulled up
1 : Pulled up
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. When this bit is set to 1 (pulled up), the pin w hose direction bit is set to 0 (input mode) is pulled up.
Pull-Up Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
00FDh
PUR1
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
—
When read, the content is undefined.
(b0)
PU11
—
(b7-b2)
P4_5 pull-up(1)
After Reset
XX000000b
Function
0 : Not pulled up
1 : Pulled up
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
NOTE:
1. When this bit is set to 1 (pulled up), the pin w hose direction bit is set to 0 (input mode) is pulled up.
Figure 7.12
Registers PUR0, and PUR1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 57 of 450
RW
—
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7.4
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port settings
Tables 7.4 to 7.36 list the port settings.
Table 7.4
Port P0_0/AN7
Register
PD0
Bit
PD0_0
ADCON0
0
X
X
X
X
Setting
Value
Input port(1)
1
X
X
X
X
Output port
0
1
1
1
0
A/D converter input (AN7)
CH2
CH1
CH0
Function
ADGSEL0
X: 0 or 1
NOTE:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU00 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
Table 7.5
Port P0_1/AN6/TXD2
Register
PD0
Bit
PD0_1
CH2
CH1
CH0
ADGSEL0
SMD2
SMD1
SMD0
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port
Setting
Value
ADCON0
U2MR
0
X
X
X
X
X
0
1
1
0
0
Function
1
0
0
1
1
X
1
0
X
X
TXD2 output(2, 3)
A/D converter input (AN6)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU00 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. N-channel open drain output by setting the NCH bit in the U2C0 register to 1.
3. To use the UART2, set the PINSR1 register to “70h”.
Table 7.6
Port P0_2/AN5/RXD2
Register
PD0
Bit
PD0_2
ADCON0
0
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
Setting
Value
1
X
X
X
X
Output port
CH2
CH1
CH0
Function
ADGSEL0
0
1
0
1
0
A/D converter input (AN5)
0
X
X
X
X
RXD2 output(2)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU00 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the UART2, set the PINSR1 register to “70h”.
Table 7.7
Port P0_3/AN4/CLK2
Register
PD0
Bit
PD0_3
Setting
Value
ADCON0
CH2
CH1
CH0
U2MR
ADGSEL0
SMD2
SMD1
SMD0
CKDIR
X
X
X
X
0
X
X
X
X
1
X
X
X
X
Other than 001b
Function
Input port(1)
X
Output port
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
CLK2 (external clock)
input(2)
X
X
X
X
X
0
0
1
0
CLK2 (internal clock)
output(2)
0
1
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
A/D converter input
(AN4)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU00 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the UART2, set the PINSR1 register to “70h”.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 58 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.8
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P0_5/AN2
Register
PD0
Bit
PD0_5
CH2
CH1
CH0
ADGSEL0
0
X
X
X
X
1
X
X
X
X
Output port
0
0
1
0
0
A/D converter input (AN2)
Setting
Value
ADCON0
Function
Input port(1)
X: 0 or 1
NOTE:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU01 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
Table 7.9
Port P1_0/AN8/KI0
Register
PD0
KIEN
Bit
PD0_3
KI0EN
CH2
CH1
ADCON0
CH0
ADGSEL0
0
0
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
Setting
Value
1
0
X
X
X
X
Output port
0
1
X
X
X
X
KI0 input
0
0
1
0
0
1
A/D converter input (AN8)
Function
X: 0 or 1
NOTE:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU02 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
Table 7.10
Register
Bit
Setting
value
Port P1_1/AN9/KI1/TRCIOA/TRCTRG
PD1
KIEN
Timer RC Setting
ADCON0
−
PD1_1 KI1EN
CH2
CH1
CH0 ADGSEL0
Function
0
0
Other than TRCIOA usage conditions
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
1
0
Other than TRCIOA usage conditions
X
X
X
X
Output port
0
0
Other than TRCIOA usage conditions
1
0
1
1
A/D converter input (AN9)
0
1
Other than TRCIOA usage conditions
X
X
X
X
KI1 input(1)
X
0
Refer to Table 7.11 TRCIOA Pin
Setting
X
X
X
X
TRCIOA output(2)
0
0
Refer to Table 7.11 TRCIOA Pin
Setting
X
X
X
X
TRCIOA input(1, 2)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU02 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the Timer RC, set the PINSR3 register to “1Fh”.
Table 7.11
TRCIOA Pin Setting
Register
TRCOER
TRCMR
Bit
EA
PWM2
0
1
Setting
value
0
1
1
TRCIOR0
IOA2
IOA1
TCEG1
TCEG0
0
0
1
X
X
0
1
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
0
X
X
X
Other than above
X: 0 or 1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
TRCCR2
IOA0
Page 59 of 450
X
X
X
X
0
1
1
X
Function
Timer waveform output
(output compare function)
Timer mode (input capture function)
PWM2 mode TRCTRG input
Other than TRCIOA usage conditions
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.12
Register
Bit
Setting
value
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P1_2/AN10/KI2/TRCIOB
PD1
KIEN
Timer RC Setting
PD1_2 KI2EN
ADCON0
−
CH2
CH1
Function
CH0 ADGSEL0
0
0
Other than TRCIOB usage conditions
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
1
0
Other than TRCIOB usage conditions
X
X
X
X
Output port
0
0
Other than TRCIOB usage conditions
1
1
0
1
A/D converter input (AN10)
0
1
Other than TRCIOB usage conditions
X
X
X
X
KI2 input(1)
X
0
Refer to Table 7.13 TRCIOB Pin
Setting
X
X
X
X
TRCIOB output(2)
0
0
Refer to Table 7.13 TRCIOB Pin
Setting
X
X
X
X
TRCIOB input(1, 2)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU02 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the Timer RC, set the PINSR3 register to “1Fh”.
Table 7.13
TRCIOB Pin Setting
Register
TRCOER
Bit
EB
PWM2
PWMB
0
0
X
X
X
X
PWM2 mode waveform output
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer waveform output (output compare
function)
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
Setting
value
TRCMR
0
1
TRCIOR0
IOB2
IOB1
Function
IOB0
Other than above
Other than TRCIOB usage conditions
X: 0 or 1
Table 7.14
Port P1_3/AN11/KI3/ TRBO
Register
PD1
KIEN
Timer RB Setting
Bit
PD1_3
KI3EN
−
CH2
CH1
CH0
ADGSEL0
0
0
Other than TRBO usage conditions
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
Setting
value
ADCON0
Function
1
0
Other than TRBO usage conditions
X
X
X
X
Output port
0
0
Other than TRBO usage conditions
1
1
1
1
A/D converter input (AN11)
0
1
Other than TRBO usage conditions
X
X
X
X
KI3 input(1)
0
Refer to Table 7.15 TRBO Pin
Setting
X
X
X
X
TRBO output(2)
X
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU02 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the Timer RB, set the PINSR2 register to “40h”.
Table 7.15
TRBO Pin Setting
Register
TRBIOC
Bit
TOCNT(1)
TMOD1
TMOD0
0
0
1
Programmable waveform generation mode
0
1
0
Programmable one-shot generation mode
0
1
1
Programmable wait one-shot generation mode
1
0
1
P1_3 output port
Setting
value
TRBMR
Other than above
Function
Other than TRBO usage conditions
NOTE:
1. Set the TOCNT bit in the TRBIOC register to 0 in modes except for programmable waveform generation mode.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 60 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.16
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P1_4/TXD0
Register
PD1
Bit
PD1_4
SMD2
U0MR
SMD1
SMD0
0
0
0
0
Input port(1)
1
0
0
0
Output port
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
Setting
value
X
Function
TXD0 output(2)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU03 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. N-channel open drain output by setting the NCH bit in the U0C0 register to 1.
Table 7.17
Port P1_5/RXD0/(TRAIO)/(INT1)
Register
PD1
Bit
PD1_5
TIOSEL
TOPCR(2)
TMOD2
TMOD1
TMOD0
INT1EN
0
X
X
X
X
X
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
Setting
value
0
X
TRAIOC
TRAMR
INTEN
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
1
0
0
0
0
X
0
X
X
X
X
X
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
Other than 001b
0
Other than 000b, 001b
0
Other than 000b, 001b
0
0
1
Function
Input port(1)
Output port
RXD0 input(1)
TRAIO input(1)
INT1
1
TRAIO input/INT1(1)
X
TRAIO pulse output
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU03 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Set the TOPCR bit in the TRAIOC register to 0 in modes except for pulse output mode.
Table 7.18
Port P1_6/CLK0
Register
PD1
Bit
PD1_6
SMD2
SMD1
SMD0
CKDIR
0
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
Setting
Value
U2MR
1
Other than 001b
Function
X
Output port
X
0
0
1
0
CLK0 output
0
X
X
X
1
CLK0 input(1)
X: 0 or 1
NOTE:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU03 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 61 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.19
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P1_7/TRAIO/INT1
Register
PD1
Bit
PD1_7
TRAIOC
TRAMR
INTEN
TIOSEL
TOPCR(2)
TMOD2
TMOD1
TMOD0
INT1EN
1
X
X
X
X
X
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
Setting
value
0
X
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
0
0
0
0
0
X
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
Other than 000b, 001b
0
Other than 000b, 001b
0
0
1
Function
Input port(1)
Output port
TRAIO input(1)
INT1
1
TRAIO input/INT1(1)
X
TRAIO pulse output
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU03 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Set the TOPCR bit in the TRAIOC register to 0 in modes except for pulse output mode.
Table 7.20
Port P2_0/TRDIOA0/TRDCLK
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_0
EA0
CMD1
CMD0
0
1
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
0
X
0
0
0
X
X
X
1
1
0
X
0
0
0
0
0
X
0
0
Setting
Value
X
TRDFCR
0
0
TRDIORA0
STCLK PWM3
0
Function
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
1
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
0
0
External clock input (TRDCLK)
X
X
PWM3 mode waveform output(2)
0
1
1
X
Timer mode waveform output
(output compare function)(2)
0
1
Input port(1)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU04 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR0 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Table 7.21
Port P2_1/TRDIOB0
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORA0
Bit
PD2_1
EB0
CMD1 CMD0 PWM3
PWMB0
IOB2 IOB1 IOB0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
X
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
X
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
X
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
PWM3 mode waveform output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer mode waveform output (output compare
function)(2)
Setting
Value
X
X
Function
Input port(1)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU04 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR1 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 62 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.22
Port P2_2/TRDIOC0
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_2
EC0
Setting
Value
7. Programmable I/O Ports
TRDFCR
CMD1
CMD0 PWM3
TRDPMR
TRDIORC0
PWMC0
IOC2 IOC1 IOC0
Function
Input port(1)
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
X
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
0
Timer mode waveform output (output
compare function)(2)
0
0
1
0
1
X
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU04 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR2 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Table 7.23
Port P2_3/TRDIOD0
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_3
ED0
Setting
Value
TRDFCR
CMD1
CMD0 PWM3
TRDPMR
TRDIORC0
PWMD0
IOD2 IOD1 IOD0
Function
Input port(1)
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
X
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output(2)
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer mode waveform output (output
compare function)(2)
X
0
0
0
1
0
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU04 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR3 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Table 7.24
Port P2_4/TRDIOA1
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_4
EA1
CMD1
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform output(2)
0
1
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output(2)
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer mode waveform output
(output compare function)(2)
Setting
Value
X
0
X
0
X
0
TRDFCR
0
TRDIORA1
CMD0 PWM3 IOA2
0
1
Function
IOA1 IOA0
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU05 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR4 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 63 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.25
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P2_5/TRDIOB1
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_5
EB1
CMD1
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
X
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
0
Timer mode waveform output (output
compare function)(2)
Setting
Value
TRDFCR
CMD0 PWM3
TRDPMR
TRDIORA1
PWMB1
IOB2 IOB1 IOB0
0
0
1
0
1
X
Function
Input port(1)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU05 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR5 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Table 7.26
Port P2_6/TRDIOC1
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_6
EC1
CMD1
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
X
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output(2)
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer mode waveform output (output
compare function)(2)
Setting
Value
X
0
TRDFCR
0
CMD0 PWM3
0
1
TRDPMR
TRDIORC1
PWMC1
IOC2 IOC1 IOC0
0
Function
Input port(1)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU05 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR6 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Table 7.27
Port P2_7/TRDIOD1
Register
PD2
TRDOER1
Bit
PD2_7
ED1
CMD1
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Input port(1)
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Output port(2)
0
X
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
Timer mode (input capture function)
1
0
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
Complementary PWM mode waveform
output(2)
Setting
Value
TRDFCR
CMD0 PWM3
TRDPMR
TRDIORC1
PWMD1
IOD2 IOD1 IOD0
Function
X
0
X
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform
output(2)
X
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output(2)
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer mode waveform output
(output compare function)(2)
X
0
0
0
1
0
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU05 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. Output drive capacity high by setting the P2DRR7 bit in the P2DRR register to 1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 64 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.28
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P3_3/INT3/ TRCCLK
Register
PD3
Bit
PD3_3
Setting
Value
TRCCR1
TCK2
INTEN
TCK1
TCK0
Function
INT3EN
0
Other than 101b
0
Input port(1)
1
Other than 101b
0
Output port
0
Other than 101b
1
INT3 input(1, 2)
0
TRCCLK input(1, 3)
0
1
0
1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU06 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the INT3, set the PMR register to “04h”.
3. To use the Timer RC, set the PINSR3 register to “1Fh”.
Table 7.29
Port P3_4/TRCIOC
Register
PD3
Timer RC Setting
Bit
PD3_3
−
0
Other than TRCIOC usage conditions
Input port(1)
1
Other than TRCIOC usage conditions
Output port
X
Refer to Table 7.30 TRCIOC Pin Setting
TRCIOC output(2)
0
Refer to Table 7.30 TRCIOC Pin Setting
TRCIOC input(1, 2)
Setting
Value
Function
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU07 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the Timer RC, set the PINSR3 register to “1Fh”.
Table 7.30
TRCIOC Pin Setting
Register
TRCOER
Bit
EC
PWM2
PWMC
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output
0
0
1
0
1
X
Timer waveform output (output compare
function)
Setting
value
0
0
1
TRCMR
TRCIOR1
1
0
1
0
1
X
X
1
X
X
Other than above
Function
Timer mode (input capture function)
Other than TRCIOC usage conditions
X: 0 or 1
Table 7.31
Port P3_5/TRCIOD
Register
PD3
Timer RC Setting
Bit
PD3_5
−
0
Other than TRCIOD usage conditions
Setting
Value
Function
Input port(1)
1
Other than TRCIOD usage conditions
X
Refer to Table 7.32 TRCIOD Pin Setting
TRCIOD output(2)
0
Refer to Table 7.32 TRCIOD Pin Setting
TRCIOD input(1, 2)
X: 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU07 bit in the PUR0 register to 1.
2. To use the Timer RC, set the PINSR3 register to “1Fh”.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 65 of 450
Output port
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.32
7. Programmable I/O Ports
TRCIOD Pin Setting
Register
TRCOER
Bit
EC
PWM2
TRCMR
PWMD
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
0
1
1
X
X
X
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
1
X
Timer waveform output (output compare
function)
0
Setting
value
0
1
TRCIOR1
1
0
0
1
0
1
X
X
X
X
Other than above
Function
Timer mode (input capture function)
Other than TRCIOD usage conditions
X: 0 or 1
Table 7.33
Port P4_2/VREF
Register
ADCON1
Bit
VCUT
Setting
value
0
Input port
1
Input port/VREF input
Table 7.34
Function
Port P4_5/INT0
Register
PD4
INTEN
Bit
PD4_5
INT0EN
0
0
Input port(1)
Setting
Value
1
0
Output port
0
1
INT0 input(1)
Function
NOTE:
1. Pulled up by setting the PU11 bit in the PUR1 register to 1.
Table 7.35
Register
Bit
Setting
Value
Port P4_6/XIN
CM0
CM1
Circuit specifications
CM13
CM11
CM10
1
0
X
0
OFF
−
0
1
0
0
ON
ON
XIN clock oscillation (on-chip feedback resistor
enabled)
0
1
1
0
ON
OFF
XIN clock oscillation (on-chip feedback resistor
disabled)
1
1
0
0
OFF
ON
External clock input
1
1
0
0
OFF
ON
XIN clock oscillation stop (on-chip feedback resistor
enabled)
1
1
1
0
OFF
OFF
XIN clock oscillation stop (on-chip feedback resistor
disabled)
1
1
1
1
OFF
OFF
XIN clock oscillation stop (stop mode)
X: 0 or 1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 66 of 450
Feedback
resistor
Function
CM5
Oscillation
buffer
Input port
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 7.36
Register
Bit
Setting
Value
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Port P4_7/XOUT
CM0
CM1
Circuit specifications
Function
CM5
CM13
CM11
CM10
Oscillation
buffer
1
0
X
0
OFF
−
0
1
0
0
ON
ON
XIN clock oscillation (on-chip feedback resistor
enabled)
0
1
1
0
ON
OFF
XIN clock oscillation (on-chip feedback resistor
disabled)
1
1
0
0
OFF
ON
External clock input
1
1
0
0
OFF
ON
XIN clock oscillation stop (on-chip feedback resistor
enabled)
1
1
1
0
OFF
OFF
XIN clock oscillation stop (on-chip feedback resistor
disabled)
1
1
1
1
OFF
OFF
XIN clock oscillation stop (stop mode)
X: 0 or 1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 67 of 450
Feedback
resistor
Input port
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
7.5
7. Programmable I/O Ports
Unassigned Pin Handling
Table 7.37 lists the Unassigned Pin Handling.
Table 7.37
Unassigned Pin Handling
Pin Name
Ports P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5, P1,
P2, P3_3 to P3_5, P4_5
Connection
• After setting to input mode, connect each pin to VSS via a resistor
(pull-down) or connect each pin to VCC via a resistor (pull-up).(2)
• After setting to output mode, leave these pins open.(1,2)
Ports P4_2, P4_6, P4_7
VREF
Connect to VCC via a pull-up resistor(2)
Connect to VCC
RESET (3)
Connect to VCC via a pull-up resistor(2)
NOTES:
1. If these ports are set to output mode and left open, they remain in input mode until they are switched
to output mode by a program. The voltage level of these pins may be undefined and the power
current may increase while the ports remain in input mode.
The content of the direction registers may change due to noise or program runaway caused by
noise. In order to enhance program reliability, the program should periodically repeat the setting of
the direction registers.
2. Connect these unassigned pins to the MCU using the shortest wire length (2 cm or less) possible.
3. When the power-on reset function is in use.
MCU
Ports P0_0 to P0_3, (Input mode )
:
P0_5, P1, P2,
:
P3_3 to P3_5,
P4_5 (Input mode)
(Output mode)
Port P4_2, P4_6, P4_7
RESET(1)
VREF
NOTE:
1. When the power-on reset function is in use.
Figure 7.13
Unassigned Pin Handling
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 68 of 450
:
:
Open
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
8.
8. Processor Mode
Processor Mode
8.1
Processor Modes
Single-chip mode can be selected as the processor mode.
Table 8.1 lists Features of Processor Mode. Figure 8.1 shows the PM0 Register and Figure 8.2 shows the PM1
Register.
Table 8.1
Features of Processor Mode
Processor Mode
Single-chip mode
Accessible Areas
Pins Assignable as I/O Port Pins
SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM All pins are I/O ports or peripheral
function I/O pins
Processor Mode Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
PM0
0004h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Reserved bits
—
(b2-b0)
PM03
—
(b7-b4)
Softw are reset bit
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to 0.
RW
RW
The MCU is reset w hen this bit is set to 1.
When read, the content is 0.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
—
NOTE:
1. Set the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the PM0 register.
Figure 8.1
PM0 Register
Processor Mode Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0 0
Symbol
Address
PM1
0005h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Reserved bits
(b1-b0)
PM12
—
(b6-b3)
—
(b7)
WDT interrupt/reset sw itch bit
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to 0.
0 : Watchdog timer interrupt
1 : Watchdog timer reset(2)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the PM1 register.
2. The PM12 bit is set to 1 by a program (and remains unchanged even if 0 is w ritten to it).
When the CSPRO bit in the CSPR register is set to 1 (count source protect mode enabled), the PM12 bit is
automatically set to 1.
Figure 8.2
PM1 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 69 of 450
RW
RW
RW
—
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
9.
9. Bus
Bus
The bus cycles differ when accessing ROM/RAM, and when accessing SFR.
Table 9.1 lists Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/2K Group and Table 9.2 lists Bus Cycles by Access Space of
the R8C/2L Group.
ROM/RAM and SFR are connected to the CPU by an 8-bit bus. When accessing in word (16-bit) units, these areas are
accessed twice in 8-bit units.
Table 9.3 lists Access Units and Bus Operations.
Table 9.1
Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/2K Group
Access Area
SFR
ROM/RAM
Table 9.2
Bus Cycle
2 cycles of CPU clock
1 cycle of CPU clock
Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/2L Group
Access Area
SFR/Data flash
Program ROM/RAM
Table 9.3
Bus Cycle
2 cycles of CPU clock
1 cycle of CPU clock
Access Units and Bus Operations
SFR, data flash
Area
Even address
Byte access
CPU clock
CPU clock
Even
Address
Data
Odd address
Byte access
CPU clock
Odd
Data
Even
Data
Even+1
Data
CPU clock
Data
Data
Odd
Data
Data
CPU clock
Data
Address
Data
Address
CPU clock
Address
Even
CPU clock
Data
Odd address
Word access
Address
Data
Address
Even address
Word access
ROM (program ROM), RAM
Address
Data
Even
Data
Even+1
Data
CPU clock
Odd
Odd+1
Data
Data
Address
Data
Odd+1
Odd
Data
Data
However, only following SFRs are connected with the 16-bit bus:
Timer RC: registers TRC, TRCGRA, TRCGRB, TRCGRC, and TRCGRD
Timer RD: registers TRDi (i=0, 1), TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRCi, and TRDGRDi
Therefore, when accessing in word (16-bit) unit, 16-bit data is accessed at a time. The bus operation is the same as
“Area: SFR, data flash, even address byte access” in Table 9.3 Access Units and Bus Operations, and 16-bit data is
accessed at a time.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 70 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
10. Clock Generation Circuit
The clock generation circuit has:
• XIN clock oscillation circuit
• Low-speed on-chip oscillator
• High-speed on-chip oscillator
Table 10.1 lists the Specifications of Clock Generation Circuit. Figure 10.1 shows a Clock Generation Circuit. Figure
10.2 shows a Peripheral Function Clock. Figures 10.3 to 10.8 show clock associated registers.
Table 10.1
Specifications of Clock Generation Circuit
Item
Applications
XIN Clock Oscillation Circuit
• CPU clock source
• Peripheral function clock
source
On-Chip Oscillator
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator
• CPU clock source
• CPU clock source
• Peripheral function clock
• Peripheral function clock
source
source
• CPU and peripheral function
• CPU and peripheral function
clock sources when XIN clock
clock sources when XIN clock
stops oscillating
stops oscillating
(3)
Approx. 125 kHz
Approx. 40 MHz
Clock frequency
0 to 20 MHz
Connectable
oscillator
Oscillator
connect pins
Oscillation stop,
restart function
Oscillator status
after reset
Others
• Ceramic resonator
• Crystal oscillator
−
−
XIN, XOUT(1)
−(1)
−(1)
Usable
Usable
Usable
Stop
Stop
Oscillate
• Externally generated clock
can be input(2)
• On-chip feedback resistor
RfXIN (connected/ not
connected, selectable)
−
−
NOTES:
1. These pins can be used as P4_6 or P4_7 when using the on-chip oscillator clock as the CPU clock while the
XIN clock oscillation circuit is not used.
2. Set the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (XIN clock stopped), and the CM13 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (XINXOUT pin) when an external clock is input.
3. The clock frequency is automatically set to up to 20 MHz by a divider when using the high-speed on-chip
oscillator as the CPU clock source.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 71 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
FRA1 register
Frequency adjustable
FRA00
High-speed
on-chip oscillator
fOCO40M
FRA2 register
Divider
fOCO-F
FRA01 = 1
Divider
(1/128)
fOCO
fOCO128
On-chip oscillator
clock
FRA01 = 0
fOCO
fOCO-F
Low-speed
on-chip oscillator
CM14
Power-on
reset circuit
fOCO-S
S Q
CM10 = 1 (stop mode)
Peripheral
function
clock
Voltage
detection
circuit
fOCO-S
b
f1
R
RESET
c
Power-on reset
Software reset
Interrupt request
Oscillation
stop
detection
S Q
WAIT instruction
R
f2
d
f4
e
XIN clock
OCD2 = 1
f8
g
f32
CM13
XIN
a
Divider
h
CPU clock
OCD2 = 0
XOUT
CM13
CM05
System clock
CM02
1/2
a
g
e
d
c
b
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
CM06 = 0
CM17 to CM16 = 11b
CM06 = 1
CM06 = 0
CM17 to
CM16 = 10b
h
CM06 = 0
CM17 to CM16 = 01b
CM02, CM04, CM05, CM06: Bits in CM0 register
CM10, CM13, CM14, CM16, CM17: Bits in CM1 register
OCD0, OCD1, OCD2: Bits in OCD register
FRA00, FRA01: Bits in FRA0 register
CM06 = 0
CM17 to CM16 = 00b
Detail of divider
Oscillation Stop Detection Circuit
Forcible discharge when OCD0 = 0
XIN clock
Pulse generation
circuit for clock
edge detection and
charge, discharge
control circuit
Charge,
discharge circuit
OCD1
Oscillation stop detection
interrupt generation
circuit detection
Watchdog timer
interrupt
Voltage monitor 1
interrupt
Voltage monitor 2
interrupt
OCD2 bit switch signal
CM14 bit switch signal
Figure 10.1
Clock Generation Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 72 of 450
Oscillation stop detection,
Watchdog timer,
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt,
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
fOCO40M
fOCO128
fOCO
fOCO-F
Watchdog
timer
fOCO-S
INT0
Timer RA
Timer RB
Timer RC
Timer RD
A/D converter
f1
f2
f4
f8
f32
CPU
CPU clock
Figure 10.2
Peripheral Function Clock
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 73 of 450
UART0 UART2
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
System Clock Control Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0 1
0 0
Symbol
Address
0006h
CM0
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Reserved bits
(b1-b0)
After Reset
01101000b
Function
Set to 0.
RW
RW
WAIT peripheral function clock
stop bit
0 : Peripheral function clock does not stop
in w ait mode
1 : Peripheral function clock stops in w ait
mode
—
(b3)
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
—
(b4)
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
CM05
XIN clock (XIN-XOUT)
stop bit(2, 3)
0 : XIN clock oscillates
1 : XIN clock stops (4)
RW
CM06
System clock division select bit
0(5)
0 : CM16, CM17 enabled
1 : Divide-by-8 mode
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
CM02
—
(b7)
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the CM0 register.
2. P4_6 and P4_7 can be used as input ports w hen the CM05 bit is set to 1 (XIN clock stops) and the CM13 bit in the
CM1 register is set to 0 (P4_6, P4_7).
3. The CM05 bit stops the XIN clock w hen the high-speed on-chip oscillator mode or low -speed on-chip oscillator mode
is selected. Do not use this bit to detect w hether the XIN clock is stopped. To stop the XIN clock, set the bits in the
follow ing order:
(a) Set bits OCD1 to OCD0 in the OCD register to 00b.
(b) Set the OCD2 bit to 1 (selects on-chip oscillator clock).
4. During external clock input, only the clock oscillation buffer is turned off and clock input is acknow ledged.
5. When entering stop mode, the CM06 bit is set to 1 (divide-by-8 mode).
Figure 10.3
CM0 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 74 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
System Clock Control Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
CM1
Bit Symbol
CM10
CM11
—
(b2)
Address
0007h
Bit Name
All clock stop control bit(2,
After Reset
00100000b
Function
0 : Clock operates
1 : Stops all clocks (stop mode)
3, 4)
XIN-XOUT on-chip feedback resistor 0 : On-chip feedback resistor enabled
select bit
1 : On-chip feedback resistor disabled
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
(3, 5)
CM13
CM14
RW
RW
RW
Port XIN-XOUT sw itch bit
0 : Input ports P4_6, P4_7
1 : XIN-XOUT pin
RW
Low -speed on-chip oscillation stop
bit(4, 6, 7)
0 : Low -speed on-chip oscillator on
1 : Low -speed on-chip oscillator off
RW
0 : Low
1 : High
RW
(8)
CM15
RW
XIN-XOUT drive capacity select bit
(9)
System clock division select bits 1
CM16
CM17
b7 b6
0 0 : No division mode
0 1 : Divide-by-2 mode
1 0 : Divide-by-4 mode
1 1 : Divide-by-16 mode
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the CM1 register.
2. If the CM10 bit is set to 1 (stop mode), the on-chip feedback resistor is disabled.
3. When the CM10 bit is set to 1 (stop mode) and the CM13 bit is set to 1 (XIN-XOUT pin), the XOUT (P4_7) pin goes “H”.
When the CM13 bit is set to 0 (input ports, P4_6, P4_7), P4_7 (XOUT) enters input mode.
4. In count source protect mode (Refer to 15.2 Count Source Protection Mode Enabled), the value remains
unchanged even if bits CM10 and CM14 are set.
5. Once the CM13 bit is set to 1 by a program, it cannot be set to 0.
6. When the OCD2 bit is set to 0 (XIN clock selected), the CM14 bit is set to 1 (low -speed on-chip oscillator stopped).
When the OCD2 bit is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected), the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low -speed on-chip
oscillator on). It remains unchanged even if 1 is w ritten to it.
7. When using the voltage monitor 1 interrupt or voltage monitor 2 interrupt (w hen using the digital filter), set the CM14
bit to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on).
8. When entering stop mode, the CM15 bit is set to 1 (drive capacity high).
9. When the CM06 bit is set to 0 (bits CM16, CM17 enabled), bits CM16 to CM17 are enabled.
Figure 10.4
CM1 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 75 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Oscillation Stop Detection Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0
Symbol
OCD
Bit Symbol
OCD0
OCD1
OCD2
OCD3
—
(b7-b4)
Address
After Reset
000Ch
00000100b
Bit Name
Function
Oscillation stop detection enable 0 : Oscillation stop detection function
bit(7)
disabled(2)
1 : Oscillation stop detection function
enabled
RW
RW
Oscillation stop detection
interrupt enable bit
0 : Disabled(2)
1 : Enabled
RW
System clock select bit(4)
0 : Selects XIN clock(7)
1 : Selects on-chip oscillator clock(3)
RW
Clock monitor bit(5, 6)
0 : XIN clock oscillates
1 : XIN clock stops
RO
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting to the OCD register.
2. Set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b before entering stop mode, high-speed on-chip oscillator mode, or low -speed on-chip
oscillator mode (XIN clock stops).
3. The CM14 bit is set to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on) if the OCD2 bit is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock
selected).
4. The OCD2 bit is automatically set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected) if a XIN clock oscillation stop is detected
w hile bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 11b. If the OCD3 bit is set to 1 (XIN clock stopped), the OCD2 bit remains
unchanged even w hen set to 0 (XIN clock selected).
5. The OCD3 bit is enabled w hen the OCD0 bit is set to 1 (oscillation stop detection function enabled).
6. The OCD3 bit remains 0 (XIN clock oscillates) if bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 00b.
7. Refer to Figure 10.14 Procedure for Sw itching Clock Source from Low -Speed On-Chip Oscillator to XIN
Clock for the sw itching procedure w hen the XIN clock re-oscillates after detecting an oscillation stop.
Figure 10.5
OCD Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 76 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 0 0
Symbol
FRA0
Bit Symbol
FRA00
FRA01
—
(b7-b2)
Address
0023h
Bit Name
High-speed on-chip oscillator
enable bit
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : High-speed on-chip oscillator off
1 : High-speed on-chip oscillator on
RW
RW
(3)
High-speed on-chip oscillator
select bit(2)
0 : Selects low -speed on-chip oscillator
1 : Selects high-speed on-chip oscillator
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the FRA0 register.
2. Change the FRA01 bit under the follow ing conditions.
• FRA00 = 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillation)
• The CM14 bit in the CM1 register = 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on)
• Bits FRA22 to FRA20 in the FRA2 register:
All divide ratio mode settings are supported w hen VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V 000b to 111b
Divide ratio of 4 or more w hen VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V
010b to 111b (divide by 4 or more)
Divide ratio of 8 or more w hen VCC = 2.2 V to 5.5 V
110b to 111b (divide by 8 or more)
3. When setting the FRA01 bit to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator selected), do not set the FRA00 bit to 0 (high-speed
on-chip oscillator off) at the same time. Set the FRA00 bit to 0 after setting the FRA01 bit to 0.
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
FRA1
Address
0024h
After Reset
When Shipping
Function
The frequency of the high-speed on-chip oscillator is adjusted w ith bits 0 to 7.
High-speed on-chip oscillator frequency = 40 MHz (FRA1 register = value w hen shipping)
Setting the FRA1 register to a low er value results in a higher frequency.
Setting the FRA1 register to a higher value results in a low er frequency.(2)
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the FRA1 register.
2. When changing the values of the FRA1 register, adjust the FRA1 register so that the frequency of the high-speed
on-chip oscillator clock w ill be 40 MHz or less.
Figure 10.6
Registers FRA0 and FRA1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 77 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 2(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 0
Symbol
FRA2
Bit Symbol
FRA20
Address
0025h
Bit Name
High-speed on-chip oscillator
frequency sw itching bits
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0: Divide-by-2 mode
0 0 1: Divide-by-3 mode
0 1 0: Divide-by-4 mode
0 1 1: Divide-by-5 mode
1 0 0: Divide-by-6 mode
1 0 1: Divide-by-7 mode
1 1 0: Divide-by-8 mode
1 1 1: Divide-by-9 mode
FRA21
FRA22
—
(b7-b3)
After Reset
00h
Function
Selects the dividing ratio for the highspeed on-chip oscillator clock.
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the FRA2 register.
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 6
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
FRA6
Address
002Bh
After Reset
When Shipping
Function
Stores data for frequency correction w hen VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V. Optimal frequency correction
to match the voltage conditions can be achieved by transferring this value to the FRA1
register.
RW
RO
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 7
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
FRA7
Address
002Ch
After Reset
When Shipping
Function
36.864 MHz frequency correction data is stored.
The oscillation frequency of the high-speed on-chip oscillator can be adjusted to 36.864 MHz
by transferring this value to the FRA1 register.
Figure 10.7
Registers FRA2, FRA6 and FRA7
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 78 of 450
RW
RO
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Voltage Detection Register 2(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0
Symbol
VCA2
Bit Symbol
VCA20
—
(b4-b1)
Address
0032h
Bit Name
Internal pow er low
consumption enable bit(6)
After Reset(5)
The LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is
set to 1 and hardw are reset
: 00h
Pow er-on reset, voltage monitor 0 reset
or LVD0ON bit in the OFS register is
set to 0, and hardw are reset
: 00100000b
Function
0 : Disables low consumption
1 : Enables low consumption
RW
RW
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
VCA25
Voltage detection 0 enable
bit(2)
0 : Voltage detection 0 circuit disabled
1 : Voltage detection 0 circuit enabled
RW
VCA26
Voltage detection 1 enable
bit(3)
0 : Voltage detection 1 circuit disabled
1 : Voltage detection 1 circuit enabled
RW
VCA27
Voltage detection 2 enable
bit(4)
0 : Voltage detection 2 circuit disabled
1 : Voltage detection 2 circuit enabled
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before w riting to the VCA2 register.
2. To use the voltage monitor 0 reset, set the VCA25 bit to 1.
After the VCA25 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting
operation.
3. To use the voltage monitor 1 interrupt/reset or the VW1C3 bit in the VW1C register, set the VCA26 bit to 1.
After the VCA26 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting
operation.
4. To use the voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset or the VCA13 bit in the VCA1 register, set the VCA27 bit to 1.
After the VCA27 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting
operation.
5. Softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this
register.
6. Use the VCA20 bit only w hen entering to w ait mode. To set the VCA20 bit, follow the procedure show n in Figure
10.9 Procedure for Enabling Reduced Internal Pow er Consum ption Using VCA20 bit.
Figure 10.8
VCA2 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 79 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Exit wait mode by interrupt
Handling procedure of internal power
low consumption enabled by VCA20 bit
(Note 1)
In interrupt routine
Step (1)
Enter low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (5)
VCA20 ← 0 (internal power low consumption
disabled)(2)
Step (2)
Stop XIN clock and high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (6)
Start XIN clock or high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (3)
VCA20 ← 1 (internal power low consumption
enabled)(2, 3)
Step (7)
(Wait until XIN clock oscillation stabilizes)
Step (4)
Enter wait mode(4)
Step (8)
Enter high-speed clock mode or
high-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (5)
VCA20 ← 0 (internal power low consumption
disabled)(2)
Step (6)
Start XIN clock or high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (7)
(Wait until XIN clock oscillation stabilizes)
Step (8)
Enter high-speed clock mode or
high-speed on-chip oscillator mode
If it is necessary to start
the high-speed clock or
the high-speed on-chip
oscillator in the interrupt
routine, execute steps (5)
to (7) in the interrupt
routine.
Interrupt handling
Step (1)
Enter low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (2)
Stop XIN clock and high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (3)
VCA20 ← 1 (internal power low consumption
enabled)(2, 3)
If the high-speed clock or
high-speed on-chip
oscillator is started in the
interrupt routine, execute
steps (1) to (3) at the last of
the interrupt routine.
Interrupt handling completed
NOTES:
1. Execute this routine to handle all interrupts generated in wait mode.
However, this does not apply if it is not necessary to start the high-speed clock or high-speed on-chip oscillator during the interrupt routine.
2. Do not set the VCA20 bit to 0 with the instruction immediately after setting the VCA20 bit to 1. Also, do not do the opposite.
3. When the VCA20 bit is set to 1, do not set the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode).
4. When entering wait mode, follow 10.6.2 Wait Mode.
VCA20: Bit in VCA2 register
Figure 10.9
Procedure for Enabling Reduced Internal Power Consumption Using VCA20 bit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 80 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
The clocks generated by the clock generation circuits are described below.
10.1
XIN Clock
This clock is supplied by the XIN clock oscillation circuit. This clock is used as the clock source for the CPU and
peripheral function clocks. The XIN clock oscillation circuit is configured by connecting a resonator between the
XIN and XOUT pins. The XIN clock oscillation circuit includes an on-chip feedback resistor, which is
disconnected from the oscillation circuit in stop mode in order to reduce the amount of power consumed by the
chip. The XIN clock oscillation circuit may also be configured by feeding an externally generated clock to the XIN
pin.
Figure 10.10 shows Examples of XIN Clock Connection Circuit.
In reset and after reset, the XIN clock stops.
The XIN clock starts oscillating when the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is set to 0 (XIN clock oscillates) after
setting the CM13 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (XIN- XOUT pin). To use the XIN clock for the CPU clock source,
set the OCD2 bit in the OCD register to 0 (select XIN clock) after the XIN clock is oscillating stably.
The power consumption can be reduced by setting the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (XIN clock stops) if the
OCD2 bit is set to 1 (select on-chip oscillator clock).
When an external clock is input to the XIN pin are input, the XIN clock does not stop if the CM05 bit is set to 1. If
necessary, use an external circuit to stop the clock.
This MCU has an on-chip feedback resistor and on-chip resistor disable/enable switching is possible by the CM11
bit in the CM1 register.
In stop mode, all clocks including the XIN clock stop. Refer to 10.4 Power Control for details.
MCU
(on-chip feedback resistor)
MCU
(on-chip feedback resistor)
XIN
XIN
XOUT
XOUT
Open
Rf(1)
Rd(1)
Externally derived clock
CIN
COUT
VCC
VSS
Ceramic resonator external circuit
External clock input circuit
NOTE:
1. Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive
capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the manufacturer of the oscillator.
Use high drive when oscillation starts and, if it is necessary to switch the oscillation drive capacity, do so after
oscillation stabilizes.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable. Also, if the oscillator manufacturer's
data sheet specifies that a feedback resistor be added to the chip externally, insert a feedback resistor between XIN
and XOUT following the instructions.
To use this MCU with supply voltage below VCC = 2.7 V, it is recommended to set the CM11 bit in the CM1 register
to 1 (on-chip feedback resistor disabled), the CM15 bit to 1 (high drive capacity), and connect the feedback resistor
to the chip externally.
Figure 10.10
Examples of XIN Clock Connection Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 81 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.2
10. Clock Generation Circuit
On-Chip Oscillator Clocks
These clocks are supplied by the on-chip oscillators (high-speed on-chip oscillator and a low-speed on-chip
oscillator). The on-chip oscillator clock is selected by the FRA01 bit in the FRA0 register.
10.2.1
Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock
The clock generated by the low-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the clock source for the CPU clock,
peripheral function clock, fOCO, and fOCO-S.
After reset, the on-chip oscillator clock generated by the low-speed on-chip oscillator divided by 8 is selected as
the CPU clock.
If the XIN clock stops oscillating when bits OCD1 to OCD0 in the OCD register are set to 11b, the low-speed
on-chip oscillator automatically starts operating, supplying the necessary clock for the MCU.
The frequency of the low-speed on-chip oscillator varies depending on the supply voltage and the operating
ambient temperature. Application products must be designed with sufficient margin to allow for frequency
changes.
10.2.2
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock
The clock generated by the high-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the clock source for the CPU clock,
peripheral function clock, fOCO, fOCO-F, and fOCO40M.
To use the high-speed on-chip oscillator clock as the clock source for the CPU clock, peripheral clock, fOCO,
and fOCO-F, set bits FRA20 to FRA22 in the FRA2 register as follows:
• All divide ratio mode settings are supported when VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V 000b to 111b
• Divide ratio of 4 or more when VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V
010b to 111b (divide by 4 or more)
• Divide ratio of 8 or more when VCC = 2.2 V to 5.5 V
110b to 111b (divide by 8 or more)
After reset, the on-chip oscillator clock generated by the high-speed on-chip oscillator stops. Oscillation is
started by setting the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on). The frequency can
be adjusted by registers FRA1 and FRA2.
Furthermore, frequency correction data corresponding to the supply voltage ranges VCC = 2.2 V to 5.5 V is
stored in FRA6 register. To use separate correction values to match this voltage ranges, transfer them from the
FRA6 register to the FRA1 register.
The frequency correction data of 36.864 MHz is stored in the FRA7 register. To set the frequency of the highspeed on-chip oscillator to 36.864 MHz, transfer the correction value in the FRA7 register to the FRA1 register
before use. This enables the setting errors of bit rates such as 9600 bps and 38400 bps to be 0% when the serial
interface is used in UART mode (refer to Table 17.7 Bit Rate Setting Example in UART Mode).
Since there are differences in the amount of frequency adjustment among the bits in the FRA1 register, make
adjustments by changing the settings of individual bits. Adjust the FRA1 register so that the frequency of the
high-speed on-chip oscillator clock will be 40 MHz or less.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 82 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.3
10. Clock Generation Circuit
CPU Clock and Peripheral Function Clock
There are a CPU clock to operate the CPU and a peripheral function clock to operate the peripheral functions. Refer
to Figure 10.1 Clock Generation Circuit.
10.3.1
System Clock
The system clock is the clock source for the CPU and peripheral function clocks. Either the XIN clock or the
on-chip oscillator clock can be selected.
10.3.2
CPU Clock
The CPU clock is an operating clock for the CPU and watchdog timer.
The system clock can be divided by 1 (no division), 2, 4, 8, or 16 to produce the CPU clock. Use the CM06 bit
in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register to select the value of the division.
After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 provides the CPU clock.
When entering stop mode from high-speed clock mode, the CM06 bit is set to 1 (divide-by-8 mode).
10.3.3
Peripheral Function Clock (f1, f2, f4, f8, and f32)
The peripheral function clock is the operating clock for the peripheral functions.
The clock fi (i = 1, 2, 4, 8, and 32) is generated by the system clock divided by i. The clock fi is used for timers
RA, RB, RC, and RD, the serial interface and the A/D converter.
When the WAIT instruction is executed after setting the CM02 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (peripheral function
clock stops in wait mode), the clock fi stop.
10.3.4
fOCO
fOCO is an operating clock for the peripheral functions.
fOCO runs at the same frequency as the on-chip oscillator clock and can be used as the source for timer RA.
When the WAIT instruction is executed, the clocks fOCO does not stop.
10.3.5
fOCO40M
fOCO40M is used as the count source for timer RC and timer RD. fOCO40M is generated by the high-speed
on-chip oscillator and supplied by setting the FRA00 bit to 1.
When the WAIT instruction is executed, the clock fOCO40M does not stop.
fOCO40M can be used with supply voltage VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V.
10.3.6
fOCO-F
fOCO-F is used as the count source for the A/D converter. fOCO-F is generated by the high-speed on-chip
oscillator and supplied by setting the FRA00 bit to 1.
When the WAIT instruction is executed, the clock fOCO-F does not stop.
10.3.7
fOCO-S
fOCO-S is an operating clock for the watchdog timer and voltage detection circuit. fOCO-S is supplied by
setting the CM14 bit to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) and uses the clock generated by the low-speed onchip oscillator. When the WAIT instruction is executed or in count source protect mode of the watchdog timer,
fOCO-S does not stop.
10.3.8
fOCO128
fOCO128 is generated by fOCO divided by 128.
The clock fOCO128 is used for capture signal of timer RC’s TRCGRA register and timer RD (channel 0).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 83 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.4
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Power Control
There are three power control modes. All modes other than wait mode and stop mode are referred to as standard
operating mode.
10.4.1
Standard Operating Mode
Standard operating mode is further separated into four modes.
In standard operating mode, the CPU clock and the peripheral function clock are supplied to operate the CPU
and the peripheral function clocks. Power consumption control is enabled by controlling the CPU clock
frequency. The higher the CPU clock frequency, the more processing power increases. The lower the CPU
clock frequency, the more power consumption decreases. When unnecessary oscillator circuits stop, power
consumption is further reduced.
Before the clock sources for the CPU clock can be switched over, the new clock source needs to be oscillating
and stable. If the new clock source is the XIN clock, allow sufficient wait time in a program until oscillation is
stabilized before exiting.
Table 10.2
Settings and Modes of Clock Associated Bits
Modes
High-speed
clock mode
High-speed
on-chip
oscillator
mode
Low-speed
on-chip
oscillator
mode
No division
Divide-by-2
Divide-by-4
Divide-by-8
Divide-by-16
No division
Divide-by-2
Divide-by-4
Divide-by-8
Divide-by-16
No division
Divide-by-2
Divide-by-4
Divide-by-8
Divide-by-16
OCD Register
OCD2
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
−: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 84 of 450
CM1 Register
CM17, CM16 CM14
00b
−
01b
−
10b
−
−
−
11b
−
00b
−
01b
−
10b
−
−
−
11b
−
00b
0
01b
0
10b
0
−
0
11b
0
CM13
1
1
1
1
1
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
CM0 Register
CM06 CM05
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
−
0
−
0
−
1
−
0
−
0
−
0
−
0
−
1
−
0
−
FRA0 Register
FRA01 FRA00
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
−
0
−
0
−
0
−
0
−
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.4.1.1
10. Clock Generation Circuit
High-Speed Clock Mode
The XIN clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 4, 8, or 16 provides the CPU clock. Set the CM06 bit to 1 (divideby-8 mode) when transiting to high-speed on-chip oscillator mode, low-speed on-chip oscillator mode. If the
CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) or the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register is set to 1 (highspeed on-chip oscillator on), fOCO can be used as timer RA. When the FRA00 bit is set to 1, fOCO40M can be
used as timer RC and timer RD.
When the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on), fOCO-S can be used as the watchdog timer
and voltage detection circuit.
10.4.1.2
High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Mode
The high-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the on-chip oscillator clock when the FRA00 bit in the FRA0
register is set to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on) and the FRA01 bit in the FRA0 register is set to 1. The onchip oscillator divided by 1 (no division), 2, 4, 8, or 16 provides the CPU clock. Set the CM06 bit to 1 (divideby-8 mode) when transiting to high-speed clock mode. If the FRA00 bit is set to 1, fOCO40M can be used as
timer RC and timer RD.
When the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on), fOCO-S can be used as the watchdog timer
and voltage detection circuit.
10.4.1.3
Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Mode
If the CM14 bit in the CM1 register is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) or the FRA01bit in the FRA0
register is set to 0, the low-speed on-chip oscillator provides the on-chip oscillator clock.
The on-chip oscillator clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 4, 8 or 16 provides the CPU clock. The on-chip
oscillator clock is also the clock source for the peripheral function clocks. Set the CM06 bit to 1 (divide-by-8
mode) when transiting to high-speed clock mode. When the FRA00 bit is set to 1, fOCO40M can be used as
timer RC and timer RD.
When the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on), fOCO-S can be used as the watchdog timer
and voltage detection circuit.
In this mode, stopping the XIN clock and high-speed on-chip oscillator, and setting the FMR47 bit in the FMR4
register to 1 (flash memory low consumption current read mode enabled) enables low consumption operation.
To enter wait mode from low-speed on-chip oscillator mode, setting the VCA20 bit in the VCA2 register to 1
(internal power low consumption enabled) enables lower consumption current in wait mode.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 85 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.4.2
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Wait Mode
Since the CPU clock stops in wait mode, the CPU, which operates using the CPU clock, and the watchdog
timer, when count source protection mode is disabled, stop. The XIN clock and on-chip oscillator clock do not
stop and the peripheral functions using these clocks continue operating.
10.4.2.1
Peripheral Function Clock Stop Function
If the CM02 bit is set to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait mode), the f1, f2, f4, f8, and f32 clocks stop
in wait mode. This reduces power consumption.
10.4.2.2
Entering Wait Mode
The MCU enters wait mode when the WAIT instruction is executed.
When the OCD2 bit in the OCD register is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator selected as system clock), set the OCD1
bit in the OCD register to 0 (oscillation stop detection interrupt disabled) before executing the WAIT
instruction.
If the MCU enters wait mode while the OCD1 bit is set to 1 (oscillation stop detection interrupt enabled),
current consumption is not reduced because the CPU clock does not stop.
10.4.2.3
Pin Status in Wait Mode
The I/O port is the status before wait mode was entered is maintained.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 86 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.4.2.4
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Exiting Wait Mode
The MCU exits wait mode by a reset or a peripheral function interrupt.
The peripheral function interrupts are affected by the CM02 bit. When the CM02 bit is set to 0 (peripheral
function clock does not stop in wait mode), all peripheral function interrupts can be used to exit wait mode.
When the CM02 bit is set to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait mode), the peripheral functions using the
peripheral function clock stop operating and the peripheral functions operated by external signals or on-chip
oscillator clock can be used to exit wait mode.
Table 10.3 lists Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode and Usage Conditions.
Table 10.3
Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode and Usage Conditions
Interrupt
Serial interface interrupt
Key input interrupt
A/D conversion interrupt
Timer RA interrupt
CM02 = 0
Usable when operating with
internal or external clock
Usable
Usable in one-shot mode
Usable in all modes
Timer RB interrupt
Timer RC interrupt
Timer RD interrupt
Usable in all modes
Usable in all modes
Usable in all modes
INT interrupt
Usable
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt
Oscillation stop detection
interrupt
Usable
Usable
Usable
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 87 of 450
CM02 = 1
Usable when operating with external
clock
Usable
(Do not use)
Can be used if there is no filter in
event counter mode.
Usable by selecting fOCO or fC32 as
count source.
(Do not use)
(Do not use)
Usable by selecting fOCO40M as
count source.
Usable (INT0, INT1, INT3 can be used
if there is no filter.)
Usable
Usable
(Do not use)
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Figure 10.11 shows the Time from Wait Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution.
When using a peripheral function interrupt to exit wait mode, set up the following before executing the WAIT
instruction.
(1) Set the interrupt priority level in bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the interrupt control registers of the peripheral
function interrupts to be used for exiting wait mode. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the peripheral function
interrupts that are not to be used for exiting wait mode to 000b (interrupt disabled).
(2) Set the I flag to 1.
(3) Operate the peripheral function to be used for exiting wait mode.
When exiting by a peripheral function interrupt, the time (number of cycles) between interrupt request
generation and interrupt routine execution is determined by the settings of the FMSTP bit in the FMR0 register,
as described in Figure 10.11.
The CPU clock, when exiting wait mode by a peripheral function interrupt, is the same clock as the CPU clock
when the WAIT instruction is executed.
FMR0 Register
FMSTP Bit
Time until Flash Memory
is Activated (T1)
Time until CPU Clock
is Supplied (T2)
0
(flash memory operates)
Period of XIN clock
× 12 cycles + 30 µs (max.)
Period of CPU clock
× 6 cycles
1
(flash memory stops)
Period of XIN clock
× 12 cycles
Same as above
Wait mode
Time for Interrupt
Sequence (T3)
Period of CPU clock Following total time is
× 20 cycles
the time from wait
mode until an interrupt
Same as above
routine is executed.
T1
T2
T3
Flash memory
activation sequence
CPU clock restart sequence
Interrupt sequence
Interrupt request generated
Figure 10.11
Time from Wait Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Remarks
Page 88 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.4.3
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Stop Mode
Since the oscillator circuits stop in stop mode, the CPU clock and peripheral function clock stop and the CPU
and peripheral functions that use these clocks stop operating. The least power required to operate the MCU is in
stop mode. If the voltage applied to the VCC pin is VRAM or more, the contents of internal RAM is
maintained.
The peripheral functions clocked by external signals continue operating.
Table 10.4 lists Interrupts to Exit Stop Mode and Usage Conditions.
Table 10.4
Interrupts to Exit Stop Mode and Usage Conditions
Interrupt
Key input interrupt
Usage Conditions
−
INT0, INT1, INT3 interrupt
Timer RA interrupt
Serial interface interrupt
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt
10.4.3.1
Can be used if there is no filter
When there is no filter and external pulse is counted in event counter
mode
When external clock is selected
Usable in digital filter disabled mode (VW1C1 bit in VW1C register is set
to 1)
Usable in digital filter disabled mode (VW2C1 bit in VW2C register is set
to 1)
Entering Stop Mode
The MCU enters stop mode when the CM10 bit in the CM1 register is set to 1 (all clocks stop). At the same
time, the CM06 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (divide-by-8 mode) and the CM15 bit in the CM1 register is
set to 1 (XIN clock oscillator circuit drive capacity high).
When using stop mode, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b before entering stop mode.
10.4.3.2
Pin Status in Stop Mode
The status before wait mode was entered is maintained.
However, when the CM13 bit in the CM1 register is set to 1 (XIN-XOUT pins), the XOUT(P4_7) pin is held
“H”. When the CM13 bit is set to 0 (input ports P4_6 and P4_7), the P4_7(XOUT pin) is held in input status.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 89 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.4.3.3
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Exiting Stop Mode
The MCU exits stop mode by a reset or peripheral function interrupt.
Figure 10.12 shows the Time from Stop Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution.
When using a peripheral function interrupt to exit stop mode, set up the following before setting the CM10 bit
to 1.
(1) Set the interrupt priority level in bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the peripheral function interrupts to be used for
exiting stop mode. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the peripheral function interrupts that are not to be used for
exiting stop mode to 000b (interrupt disabled).
(2) Set the I flag to 1.
(3) Operates the peripheral function to be used for exiting stop mode.
When exiting by a peripheral function interrupt, the interrupt sequence is executed when an interrupt request is
generated and the CPU clock supply is started.
If the clock used immediately before stop mode is a system clock and stop mode is exited by a peripheral
function interrupt, the CPU clock becomes the previous system clock divided by 8.
FMR0 Register
Time until Flash Memory
is Activated (T2)
Time until CPU Clock
is Supplied (T3)
0
(flash memory
operates)
Period of XIN clock
× 12 cycles + 30 µs (max.)
Period of CPU clock
× 6 cycles
1
(flash memory stops)
Period of XIN clock
× 12 cycles
Same as above
FMSTP Bit
Stop
mode
Time for Interrupt
Sequence (T4)
Period of CPU clock Following total
time of T0 to T4
× 20 cycles
is the time from
stop mode until
an interrupt
Same as above
handling is
executed.
T0
T1
T2
T3
T4
Internal
power
stability time
Oscillation time of
CPU clock source
used immediately
before stop mode
Flash memory
activation sequence
CPU clock restart
sequence
Interrupt sequence
150 µs
Interrupt (max.)
request
generated
Figure 10.12
Time from Stop Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 90 of 450
Remarks
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Figure 10.13 shows the State Transitions in Power Control Mode.
State Transitions in Power Control Mode
Reset
Standard operating mode
Low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
CM14 = 0
OCD2 = 1
FRA01 = 0
CM14 = 0
OCD2 = 1
FRA01 = 0
CM05 = 0
CM13 = 1
OCD2 = 0
High-speed clock mode
CM14 = 0
FRA01 = 0
CM05 = 0
CM13 = 1
OCD2 = 0
FRA00 = 1
FRA01 = 1
OCD2 = 1
FRA00 = 1
FRA01 = 1
CM05 = 0
CM13 = 1
OCD2 = 0
High-speed on-chip oscillator mode
OCD2 = 1
FRA00 = 1
FRA01 = 1
Interrupt
WAIT instruction
Wait mode
Stop mode
CPU operation stops
All oscillators stop
CM05: Bit in CM0 register
CM13, CM14: Bits in CM1 register
OCD2: Bit in OCD register
FRA00, FRA01: Bits in FRA0 register
Figure 10.13
CM10 = 1
Interrupt
State Transitions in Power Control Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 91 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.5
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Oscillation Stop Detection Function
The oscillation stop detection function detects the stop of the XIN clock oscillating circuit. The oscillation stop
detection function can be enabled and disabled by the OCD0 bit in the OCD register.
Table 10.5 lists the Specifications of Oscillation Stop Detection Function.
When the XIN clock is the CPU clock source and bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 11b, the system is placed in the
following state if the XIN clock stops.
• OCD2 bit in OCD register = 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected)
• OCD3 bit in OCD register = 1 (XIN clock stops)
• CM14 bit in CM1 register = 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator oscillates)
• Oscillation stop detection interrupt request is generated.
Table 10.5
Specifications of Oscillation Stop Detection Function
Item
Oscillation stop detection clock and
frequency bandwidth
Enabled condition for oscillation stop
detection function
Operation at oscillation stop detection
10.5.1
Specification
f(XIN) ≥ 2 MHz
Set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 11b
Oscillation stop detection interrupt is generated
How to Use Oscillation Stop Detection Function
• The oscillation stop detection interrupt shares a vector with the voltage monitor 1 interrupt, the voltage
monitor 2 interrupt, and the watchdog timer interrupt. When using the oscillation stop detection interrupt and
watchdog timer interrupt, the interrupt source needs to be determined.
Table 10.6 lists the Determining Interrupt Source for Oscillation Stop Detection, Watchdog Timer, Voltage
Monitor 1, and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupts. Figure 10.15 shows the Example of Determining Interrupt
Source for Oscillation Stop Detection, Watchdog Timer, Voltage Monitor 1, or Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt.
• When the XIN clock restarts after oscillation stop, switch the XIN clock to the clock source of the CPU clock
and peripheral functions by a program.
Figure 10.14 shows the Procedure for Switching Clock Source from Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator to XIN
Clock.
• To enter wait mode while using the oscillation stop detection function, set the CM02 bit to 0 (peripheral
function clock does not stop in wait mode).
• Since the oscillation stop detection function is a function for cases where the XIN clock is stopped by an
external cause, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b when the XIN clock stops or is started by a program, (stop
mode is selected or the CM05 bit is changed).
• This function cannot be used when the XIN clock frequency is 2 MHz or below. In this case, set bits OCD1 to
OCD0 to 00b.
• To use the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock for the CPU clock and clock sources of peripheral functions
after detecting the oscillation stop, set the FRA01 bit in the FRA0 register to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator
selected) and bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 11b.
To use the high-speed on-chip oscillator clock for the CPU clock and clock sources of peripheral functions
after detecting the oscillation stop, set the FRA00 bit to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on) and the FRA01
bit to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator selected) and then set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 11b.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 92 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 10.6
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Determining Interrupt Source for Oscillation Stop Detection, Watchdog Timer,
Voltage Monitor 1, and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupts
Generated Interrupt Source
Bit Showing Interrupt Cause
Oscillation stop detection
(a) OCD3 bit in OCD register = 1
((a) or (b))
(b) OCD1 to OCD0 bits in OCD register = 11b and OCD2 bit = 1
Watchdog timer
VW2C3 bit in VW2C register = 1
Voltage monitor 1
VW1C2 bit in VW1C register = 1
Voltage monitor 2
VW2C2 bit in VW2C register = 1
Switch to XIN clock
NO
Multiple confirmations
that OCD3 bit is set to 0 (XIN
clock oscillates) ?
YES
Set OCD1 to OCD0 bits to 00b
Set OCD2 bit to 0
(select XIN clock)
End
OCD3 to OCD0: Bits in OCD register
Figure 10.14
Procedure for Switching Clock Source from Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator to XIN
Clock
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 93 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Interrupt sources judgment
OCD3 = 1 ?
(XIN clock stopped)
NO
YES
OCD1 = 1
(oscillation stop detection
interrupt enabled) and OCD2 = 1
(on-chip oscillator clock selected
as system clock) ?
NO
YES
VW2C3 = 1 ?
(Watchdog timer
underflow)
NO
YES
VW2C2 = 1 ?
(passing Vdet2)
NO
YES
Set OCD1 bit to 0 (oscillation stop
detection interrupt disabled). (1)
To oscillation stop detection
interrupt routine
To watchdog timer
interrupt routine
To voltage monitor 2
interrupt routine
To voltage monitor 1
interrupt routine
NOTE:
1. This disables multiple oscillation stop detection interrupts.
OCD1 to OCD3: Bits in OCD register
VW2C2, VW2C3: Bits in VW2C register
Figure 10.15
Example of Determining Interrupt Source for Oscillation Stop Detection, Watchdog
Timer, Voltage Monitor 1, or Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 94 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
10.6
10. Clock Generation Circuit
Notes on Clock Generation Circuit
10.6.1
Stop Mode
When entering stop mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and the
CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (stop mode). An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the instruction
which sets the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode) and the program stops.
Insert at least 4 NOP instructions following the JMP.B instruction after the instruction which sets the CM10 bit
to 1.
• Program example to enter stop mode
BCLR
BSET
FSET
BSET
JMP.B
LABEL_001 :
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
10.6.2
1,FMR0
0,PRCR
I
0,CM1
LABEL_001
; CPU rewrite mode disabled
; Protect disabled
; Enable interrupt
; Stop mode
Wait Mode
When entering wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and
execute the WAIT instruction. An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the WAIT instruction and the
program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions after the WAIT instruction.
• Program example to execute the WAIT instruction
BCLR
1,FMR0
FSET
I
WAIT
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
10.6.3
; CPU rewrite mode disabled
; Enable interrupt
; Wait mode
Oscillation Stop Detection Function
Since the oscillation stop detection function cannot be used if the XIN clock frequency is 2 MHz or below, set
bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b.
10.6.4
Oscillation Circuit Constants
Ask the manufacturer of the oscillator to specify the best oscillation circuit constants for your system.
To use this MCU with supply voltage below VCC = 2.7 V, it is recommended to set the CM11 bit in the CM1
register to 1 (on-chip feedback resistor disabled), the CM15 bit to 1 (high drive capacity), and connect the
feedback resistor to the chip externally.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 95 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
11. Protection
11. Protection
The protection function protects important registers from being easily overwritten when a program runs out of control.
Figure 11.1 shows the PRCR Register. The registers protected by the PRCR register are listed below.
• Registers protected by PRC0 bit: Registers CM0, CM1, OCD, FRA0, FRA1, and FRA2
• Registers protected by PRC1 bit: Registers PM0 and PM1
• Registers protected by PRC2 bit: PD0 register
• Registers protected by PRC3 bit: Registers VCA2, VW0C, VW1C, and VW2C
Protect Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
PRCR
Bit Symbol
Address
000Ah
Bit Name
Protect bit 0
PRC0
Protect bit 1
PRC1
Protect bit 2
PRC2
Protect bit 3
PRC3
After Reset
00h
Function
Writing to registers CM0, CM1, OCD, FRA0, FRA1,
and FRA2 is enabled.
0 : Disables w riting
1 : Enables w riting
RW
RW
Writing to registers PM0 and PM1 is enabled.
0 : Disables w riting
1 : Enables w riting
RW
Writing to the PD0 register is enabled.
0 : Disables w riting
1 : Enables w riting(1)
RW
Writing to registers VCA2, VW0C, VW1C, and
VW2C is enabled.
0 : Disables w riting
1 : Enables w riting
RW
—
(b5-b4)
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
—
(b7-b6)
Reserved bits
When read, the content is 0.
RW
RO
NOTE:
1. This bit is set to 0 after w riting 1 to the PRC2 bit and executing a w rite to any address. Since the other bits are not
set to 0, set them to 0 by a program.
Figure 11.1
PRCR Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 96 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
12. Interrupts
12.1
Interrupt Overview
12.1.1
Types of Interrupts
Figure 12.1 shows the types of Interrupts.
Software
(non-maskable interrupts)
Interrupts
Special
(non-maskable interrupts)
Hardware
Peripheral functions(1)
(maskable interrupts)
Undefined instruction (UND instruction)
Overflow (INTO instruction)
BRK instruction
INT instruction
Watchdog timer
Oscillation stop detection
Voltage monitor 1
Voltage monitor 2
Single step(2)
Address break(2)
Address match
NOTES:
1. Peripheral function interrupts in the MCU are used to generate peripheral interrupts.
2. Do not use this interrupt. This is for use with development tools only.
Figure 12.1
Interrupts
• Maskable Interrupts:
• Non-Maskable Interrupts:
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
The interrupt enable flag (I flag) enables or disables these interrupts. The
interrupt priority order can be changed based on the interrupt priority level.
The interrupt enable flag (I flag) does not enable or disable these interrupts.
The interrupt priority order cannot be changed based on interrupt priority
level.
Page 97 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.2
12. Interrupts
Software Interrupts
A software interrupt is generated when an instruction is executed. Software interrupts are non-maskable.
12.1.2.1
Undefined Instruction Interrupt
The undefined instruction interrupt is generated when the UND instruction is executed.
12.1.2.2
Overflow Interrupt
The overflow interrupt is generated when the O flag is set to 1 (arithmetic operation overflow) and the INTO
instruction is executed. Instructions that set the O flag are: ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, CMP, DIV, DIVU, DIVX,
NEG, RMPA, SBB, SHA, and SUB.
12.1.2.3
BRK Interrupt
A BRK interrupt is generated when the BRK instruction is executed.
12.1.2.4
INT Instruction Interrupt
An INT instruction interrupt is generated when the INT instruction is executed. The INT instruction can select
software interrupt numbers 0 to 63. Software interrupt numbers 3 to 31 are assigned to the peripheral function
interrupt. Therefore, the MCU executes the same interrupt routine when the INT instruction is executed as
when a peripheral function interrupt is generated. For software interrupt numbers 0 to 31, the U flag is saved to
the stack during instruction execution and the U flag is set to 0 (ISP selected) before the interrupt sequence is
executed. The U flag is restored from the stack when returning from the interrupt routine. For software interrupt
numbers 32 to 63, the U flag does not change state during instruction execution, and the selected SP is used.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 98 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.3
12. Interrupts
Special Interrupts
Special interrupts are non-maskable.
12.1.3.1
Watchdog Timer Interrupt
The watchdog timer interrupt is generated by the watchdog timer. For details, refer to 15. Watchdog Timer.
12.1.3.2
Oscillation Stop Detection Interrupt
The oscillation stop detection interrupt is generated by the oscillation stop detection function. For details of the
oscillation stop detection function, refer to 10. Clock Generation Circuit.
12.1.3.3
Voltage Monitor 1 Interrupt
The voltage monitor 1 interrupt is generated by the voltage detection circuit. For details of the voltage detection
circuit, refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit.
12.1.3.4
Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt
The voltage monitor 2 interrupt is generated by the voltage detection circuit. For details of the voltage detection
circuit, refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit.
12.1.3.5
Single-Step Interrupt, and Address Break Interrupt
Do not use these interrupts. They are for use by development tools only.
12.1.3.6
Address Match Interrupt
The address match interrupt is generated immediately before executing an instruction that is stored at an
address indicated by registers RMAD0 to RMAD1 when the AIER0 or AIER1 bit in the AIER register is set to
1 (address match interrupt enable). For details of the address match interrupt, refer to 12.4 Address Match
Interrupt.
12.1.4
Peripheral Function Interrupt
The peripheral function interrupt is generated by the internal peripheral function of the MCU and is a maskable
interrupt. Refer to Table 12.2 Relocatable Vector Tables for sources of the peripheral function interrupt. For
details of peripheral functions, refer to the descriptions of individual peripheral functions.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 99 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.5
12. Interrupts
Interrupts and Interrupt Vectors
There are 4 bytes in each vector. Set the starting address of an interrupt routine in each interrupt vector. When
an interrupt request is acknowledged, the CPU branches to the address set in the corresponding interrupt vector.
Figure 12.2 shows an Interrupt Vector.
MSB
LSB
Vector address (L)
Low address
Mid address
Vector address (H)
Figure 12.2
12.1.5.1
0000
High address
0000
0000
Interrupt Vector
Fixed Vector Tables
The fixed vector tables are allocated addresses 0FFDCh to 0FFFFh.
Table 12.1 lists the Fixed Vector Tables. The vector addresses (H) of fixed vectors are used by the ID code
check function. For details, refer to 20.3 Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory.
Table 12.1
Fixed Vector Tables
Interrupt Source
Undefined instruction
Overflow
BRK instruction
Address match
Single step(1)
Watchdog timer,
Oscillation stop detection,
Voltage monitor 1,
Voltage monitor 2
Address break(1)
(Reserved)
Reset
Vector Addresses
Remarks
Reference
Address (L) to (H)
0FFDCh to 0FFDFh Interrupt on UND
R8C/Tiny Series Software
instruction
Manual
0FFE0h to 0FFE3h Interrupt on INTO
instruction
0FFE4h to 0FFE7h If the content of address
0FFE7h is FFh,
program execution
starts from the address
shown by the vector in
the relocatable vector
table.
0FFE8h to 0FFEBh
12.4 Address Match
Interrupt
0FFECh to 0FFEFh
0FFF0h to 0FFF3h
15. Watchdog Timer
10. Clock Generation Circuit
6. Voltage Detection Circuit
0FFF4h to 0FFF7h
0FFF8h to 0FFFBh
0FFFCh to 0FFFFh
5. Resets
NOTE:
1. Do not use these interrupts. They are for use by development tools only.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 100 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.5.2
12. Interrupts
Relocatable Vector Tables
The relocatable vector tables occupy 256 bytes beginning from the starting address set in the INTB register.
Table 12.2 lists the Relocatable Vector Tables.
Table 12.2
Relocatable Vector Tables
+28 to +31 (001Ch to 001Fh)
+32 to +35 (0020h to 0023h)
Software
Interrupt Control
Interrupt
Reference
Register
Number
0
−
R8C/Tiny Series Software
Manual
1 to 6
−
−
7
TRCIC
16.3 Timer RC
8
TRD0IC
16.4 Timer RD
+36 to +39 (0024h to 0027h)
9
TRD1IC
+96 to +99 (0060h to 0063h)
+100 to +103 (0064h to 0067h)
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
−
S2TIC
S2RIC
KUPIC
ADIC
−
−
S0TIC
S0RIC
−
−
−
TRAIC
−
TRBIC
INT1IC
INT3
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
+104 to +107 (0068h to 006Bh)
26
INT3IC
INT0
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
Software interrupt(2)
+116 to +119 (0074h to 0077h)
27
28
29
−
−
INT0IC
Vector Addresses(1)
Address (L) to Address (H)
Interrupt Source
BRK instruction(2)
(Reserved)
Timer RC
Timer RD
(channel 0)
Timer RD
(channel 1)
(Reserved)
UART2 transmit
UART2 receive
Key input
A/D
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
UART0 transmit
UART0 receive
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
(Reserved)
Timer RA
(Reserved)
Timer RB
INT1
+0 to +3 (0000h to 0003h)
+44 to +47 (002Ch to 002Fh)
+48 to +51 (0030h to 0033h)
+52 to +55 (0034h to 0037h)
+56 to +59 (0038h to 003Bh)
+68 to +71 (0044h to 0047h)
+72 to +75 (0048h to 004Bh)
+88 to +91 (0058h to 005Bh)
30
31
+128 to +131 (0080h to 0083h) to 32 to 63
+252 to +255 (00FCh to 00FFh)
NOTES:
1. These addresses are relative to those in the INTB register.
2. The I flag does not disable these interrupts.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 101 of 450
−
−
−
−
17. Serial Interface
12.3 Key Input Interrupt
19. A/D Converter
−
−
17. Serial Interface
−
−
−
16.1 Timer RA
−
16.2 Timer RB
12.2 INT Interrupt
−
−
12.2 INT Interrupt
−
−
R8C/Tiny Series Software
Manual
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.6
12. Interrupts
Interrupt Control
The following describes enabling and disabling the maskable interrupts and setting the priority for
acknowledgement. The explanation does not apply to nonmaskable interrupts.
Use the I flag in the FLG register, IPL, and bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in each interrupt control register to enable or
disable maskable interrupts. Whether an interrupt is requested is indicated by the IR bit in each interrupt control
register.
Figure 12.3 shows the Interrupt Control Register, Figure 12.4 shows Registers TRCIC, TRD0IC, and TRD1IC
and Figure 12.5 shows the INTiIC Register.
Interrupt Control Register(2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
S2TIC
S2RIC
KUPIC
ADIC
S0TIC
S0RIC
TRAIC
TRBIC
Bit Symbol
Address
004Bh
004Ch
004Dh
004Eh
0051h
0052h
0056h
After Reset
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
0058h
XXXXX000b
Bit Name
Interrupt priority level select bits
0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disable)
0 0 1 : Level 1
0 1 0 : Level 2
0 1 1 : Level 3
1 0 0 : Level 4
1 0 1 : Level 5
1 1 0 : Level 6
1 1 1 : Level 7
ILVL0
ILVL1
ILVL2
IR
—
(b7-b4)
Function
Interrupt request bit
RW
b2 b1 b0
0 : Requests no interrupt
1 : Requests interrupt
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
RW
RW
RW
RW(1)
—
NOTES:
1. Only 0 can be w ritten to the IR bit. Do not w rite 1.
2. Rew rite the interrupt control register w hen the interrupt request w hich is applicable for the register is not generated.
Refer to 12.6.5 Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents.
Figure 12.3
Interrupt Control Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 102 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
Interrupt Control Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCIC
TRD0IC
TRD1IC
Bit Symbol
Address
0047h
0048h
After Reset
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
0049h
XXXXX000b
Bit Name
Interrupt priority level select bits
ILVL0
ILVL1
ILVL2
IR
—
(b7-b4)
Interrupt request bit
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disable)
0 0 1 : Level 1
0 1 0 : Level 2
0 1 1 : Level 3
1 0 0 : Level 4
1 0 1 : Level 5
1 1 0 : Level 6
1 1 1 : Level 7
RW
0 : Requests no interrupt
1 : Requests interrupt
RO
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
RW
RW
—
NOTE:
1. Rew rite the interrupt control register w hen the interrupt request w hich is applicable for the register is not generated.
Refer to 12.6.5 Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents.
Figure 12.4
Registers TRCIC, TRD0IC, and TRD1IC
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 103 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
INTi Interrupt Control Register (i=0, 1, 3)(2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
INT1IC
INT3IC
Address
0059h
005Ah
After Reset
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
INT0IC
005Dh
XX00X000b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Interrupt priority level select bits
0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disable)
0 0 1 : Level 1
0 1 0 : Level 2
0 1 1 : Level 3
1 0 0 : Level 4
1 0 1 : Level 5
1 1 0 : Level 6
1 1 1 : Level 7
ILVL0
ILVL1
ILVL2
IR
POL
—
(b5)
—
(b7-b6)
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
RW
RW
RW
Interrupt request bit
0 : Requests no interrupt
1 : Requests interrupt
RW(1)
Polarity sw itch bit(4)
0 : Selects falling edge
1 : Selects rising edge(3)
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
RW
—
NOTES:
1. Only 0 can be w ritten to the IR bit. (Do not w rite 1.)
2. Rew rite the interrupt control register w hen the interrupt request w hich is applicable for the register is not generated.
Refer to 12.6.5 Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents .
3. If the INTiPL bit in the INTEN register is set to 1 (both edges), set the POL bit to 0 (selects falling edge).
4. The IR bit may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the POL bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.6.4 Changing Interrupt
Sources.
Figure 12.5
INTiIC Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 104 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.6.1
12. Interrupts
I Flag
The I flag enables or disables maskable interrupts. Setting the I flag to 1 (enabled) enables maskable interrupts.
Setting the I flag to 0 (disabled) disables all maskable interrupts.
12.1.6.2
IR Bit
The IR bit is set to 1 (interrupt requested) when an interrupt request is generated. Then, when the interrupt
request is acknowledged and the CPU branches to the corresponding interrupt vector, the IR bit is set to 0 (=
interrupt not requested).
The IR bit can be set to 0 by a program. Do not write 1 to this bit.
However, the IR bit operations of the timer RD Interrupt, Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select
Interrupt and the I2C bus Interface Interrupt are different. Refer to 12.5 Timer RC Interrupt, Timer RD
Interrupt (Interrupts with Multiple Interrupt Request Sources).
12.1.6.3
Bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 and IPL
Interrupt priority levels can be set using bits ILVL2 to ILVL0.
Table 12.3 lists the Settings of Interrupt Priority Levels and Table 12.4 lists the Interrupt Priority Levels
Enabled by IPL.
The following are conditions under which an interrupt is acknowledged:
• I flag = 1
• IR bit = 1
• Interrupt priority level > IPL
The I flag, IR bit, bits ILVL2 to ILVL0, and IPL are independent of each other. They do not affect one another.
Table 12.3
ILVL2 to ILVL0
Bits
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
Settings of Interrupt Priority
Levels
Interrupt Priority Level
Priority Order
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Level 4
Level 5
Level 6
Level 7
−
Low
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 105 of 450
High
Table 12.4
IPL
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
Interrupt Priority Levels Enabled by
IPL
Enabled Interrupt Priority Levels
Interrupt level 1 and above
Interrupt level 2 and above
Interrupt level 3 and above
Interrupt level 4 and above
Interrupt level 5 and above
Interrupt level 6 and above
Interrupt level 7 and above
All maskable interrupts are disabled
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.6.4
12. Interrupts
Interrupt Sequence
An interrupt sequence is performed between an interrupt request acknowledgement and interrupt routine
execution.
When an interrupt request is generated while an instruction is being executed, the CPU determines its interrupt
priority level after the instruction is completed. The CPU starts the interrupt sequence from the following cycle.
However, for the SMOVB, SMOVF, SSTR, or RMPA instruction if an interrupt request is generated while the
instruction is being executed, the MCU suspends the instruction to start the interrupt sequence. The interrupt
sequence is performed as indicated below.
Figure 12.6 shows the Time Required for Executing Interrupt Sequence.
(1) The CPU gets interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) by reading address
00000h. The IR bit for the corresponding interrupt is set to 0 (interrupt not requested).(2)
(2) The FLG register is saved to a temporary register(1) in the CPU immediately before entering the interrupt
sequence.
(3) The I, D and U flags in the FLG register are set as follows:
The I flag is set to 0 (interrupts disabled).
The D flag is set to 0 (single-step interrupt disabled).
The U flag is set to 0 (ISP selected).
However, the U flag does not change state if an INT instruction for software interrupt number 32 to 63 is
executed.
(4) The CPU’s internal temporary register(1) is saved to the stack.
(5) The PC is saved to the stack.
(6) The interrupt priority level of the acknowledged interrupt is set in the IPL.
(7) The starting address of the interrupt routine set in the interrupt vector is stored in the PC.
After the interrupt sequence is completed, instructions are executed from the starting address of the interrupt
routine.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
CPU Clock
Address Bus
Data Bus
Address
0000h
Undefined
Interrupt
information
RD
Undefined
SP-2 SP-1
SP-4
SP-2
SP-1
SP-4
contents contents contents
SP-3
SP-3
contents
VEC
VEC
contents
VEC+1
VEC+1
contents
VEC+2
PC
VEC+2
contents
Undefined
WR
The indeterminate state depends on the instruction queue buffer. A read cycle occurs when the instruction queue buffer is
ready to acknowledge instructions.
Figure 12.6
Time Required for Executing Interrupt Sequence
NOTES:
1. This register cannot be accessed by the user.
2. Refer to 12.5 Timer RC Interrupt, Timer RD Interrupt (Interrupts with Multiple Interrupt
Request Sources) for the IR bit operations of the timer RC Interrupt, timer RD Interrupt, Clock
Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Interrupt, and the I2C bus Interface Interrupt.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 106 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.6.5
12. Interrupts
Interrupt Response Time
Figure 12.7 shows the Interrupt Response Time. The interrupt response time is the period between an interrupt
request generation and the execution of the first instruction in the interrupt routine. The interrupt response time
includes the period between interrupt request generation and the completion of execution of the instruction
(refer to (a) in Figure 12.7) and the period required to perform the interrupt sequence (20 cycles, refer to (b) in
Figure 12.7).
Interrupt request is generated. Interrupt request is acknowledged.
Time
Instruction
(a)
Instruction in
interrupt routine
Interrupt sequence
20 cycles (b)
Interrupt response time
(a) Period between interrupt request generation and the completion of execution of an
instruction. The length of time varies depending on the instruction being executed. The
DIVX instruction requires the longest time, 30 cycles (assuming no wait states and that a
register is set as the divisor).
(b) 21 cycles for address match and single-step interrupts.
Figure 12.7
12.1.6.6
Interrupt Response Time
IPL Change when Interrupt Request is Acknowledged
When an interrupt request of a maskable interrupt is acknowledged, the interrupt priority level of the
acknowledged interrupt is set in the IPL.
When a software interrupt or special interrupt request is acknowledged, the level listed in Table 12.5 is set in the
IPL.
Table 12.5 lists the IPL Value When Software or Special Interrupt Is Acknowledged.
Table 12.5
IPL Value When Software or Special Interrupt Is Acknowledged
Interrupt Source
Watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor 1,
voltage monitor 2, Address break
Software, address match, single-step
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 107 of 450
Value Set in IPL
7
Not changed
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.6.7
12. Interrupts
Saving a Register
In the interrupt sequence, the FLG register and PC are saved to the stack.
After an extended 16 bits, 4 high-order bits in the PC and 4 high-order (IPL) and 8 low-order bits in the FLG
register, are saved to the stack, the 16 low-order bits in the PC are saved.
Figure 12.8 shows the Stack State Before and After Acknowledgement of Interrupt Request.
The other necessary registers are saved by a program at the beginning of the interrupt routine. The PUSHM
instruction can save several registers in the register bank being currently used(1) with a single instruction.
NOTE:
1. Selectable from registers R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, SB, and FB.
Stack
Address
Stack
Address
MSB
LSB
MSB
LSB
m−4
m−4
PCL
m−3
m−3
PCM
m−2
m−2
FLGL
m−1
m−1
m
Previous stack contents
m+1
Previous stack contents
[SP]
SP value before
interrupt is generated
m
m+1
Stack state before interrupt request
is acknowledged
FLGH
[SP]
New SP value
PCH
Previous stack contents
Previous stack contents
PCH
PCM
PCL
FLGH
FLGL
: 4 high-order bits of PC
: 8 middle-order bits of PC
: 8 low-order bits of PC
: 4 high-order bits of FLG
: 8 low-order bits of FLG
Stack state after interrupt request
is acknowledged
NOTE:
1.When executing software number 32 to 63 INT instructions,
this SP is specified by the U flag. Otherwise it is ISP.
Figure 12.8
Stack State Before and After Acknowledgement of Interrupt Request
The register saving operation, which is performed as part of the interrupt sequence, saved in 8 bits at a time in
four steps.
Figure 12.9 shows the Register Saving Operation.
Stack
Address
Sequence in which
order registers are
saved
[SP]−5
[SP]−4
PCL
(3)
[SP]−3
PCM
(4)
[SP]−2
FLGL
(1)
Saved, 8 bits at a time
[SP]−1
FLGH
PCH
(2)
[SP]
Completed saving
registers in four
operations.
PCH
PCM
PCL
FLGH
FLGL
NOTE:
1. [SP] indicates the initial value of the SP when an interrupt request is acknowledged.
After registers are saved, the SP content is [SP] minus 4. When executing
software number 32 to 63 INT instructions, this SP is specified by the U
flag. Otherwise it is ISP.
Figure 12.9
Register Saving Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 108 of 450
: 4 high-order bits of PC
: 8 middle-order bits of PC
: 8 low-order bits of PC
: 4 high-order bits of FLG
: 8 low-order bits of FLG
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.1.6.8
12. Interrupts
Returning from an Interrupt Routine
When the REIT instruction is executed at the end of an interrupt routine, the FLG register and PC, which have
been saved to the stack, are automatically restored. The program, that was running before the interrupt request
was acknowledged, starts running again.
Restore registers saved by a program in an interrupt routine using the POPM instruction or others before
executing the REIT instruction.
12.1.6.9
Interrupt Priority
If two or more interrupt requests are generated while a single instruction is being executed, the interrupt with
the higher priority is acknowledged.
Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 to select the desired priority level for maskable interrupts (peripheral functions).
However, if two or more maskable interrupts have the same priority level, their interrupt priority is resolved by
hardware, and the higher priority interrupts acknowledged.
The priority levels of special interrupts, such as reset (reset has the highest priority) and watchdog timer, are set
by hardware.
Figure 12.10 shows the Priority Levels of Hardware Interrupts.
The interrupt priority does not affect software interrupts. The MCU jumps to the interrupt routine when the
instruction is executed.
Reset
High
Address break
Watchdog timer
Oscillation stop detection
Voltage monitor 1
Voltage monitor 2
Peripheral function
Single step
Address match
Figure 12.10
Priority Levels of Hardware Interrupts
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 109 of 450
Low
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
12.1.6.10 Interrupt Priority Judgement Circuit
The interrupt priority judgement circuit selects the highest priority interrupt, as shown in Figure 12.11.
Priority level of interrupt
Level 0 (default value)
Highest
INT3
Timer RB
Timer RA
INT0
INT1
Timer RC
Priority of peripheral function interrupts
(if priority levels are same)
UART0 receive
A/D conversion
UART2 receive
Timer RD0
UART0 transmit
Key input
UART2 transmit
Timer RD1
Lowest
IPL
Interrupt request level
judgment output signal
I flag
Address match
Watchdog timer
Oscillation stop detection
Voltage monitor 1
Voltage monitor 2
Figure 12.11
Interrupt Priority Level Judgement Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 110 of 450
Interrupt request
acknowledged
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.2
12. Interrupts
INT Interrupt
12.2.1
INTi Interrupt (i = 0, 1, 3)
The INTi interrupt is generated by an INTi input. When using the INTi interrupt, the INTiEN bit in the INTEN
register is set to 1 (enable). The edge polarity is selected using the INTiPL bit in the INTEN register and the
POL bit in the INTiIC register.
Inputs can be passed through a digital filter with three different sampling clocks.
The INT0 pin is shared with the pulse output forced cutoff of timer RC and timer RD, and the external trigger
input of timer RB.
Figure 12.12 shows the PMR Register, Figure 12.13 shows the INTEN Register, Figure 12.14 shows the INTF
Register, and Figure 12.15 shows the TRAIOC Register.
Port Mode Register
b7
b0
Symbol
PMR
_____
Address
00F8h
Function
After Reset
00h
RW
Set to “04h” w hen using INT3.
Do not set values other than “04h”.
When read, its content is undefined.
Figure 12.12
WO
PMR Register
External Input Enable Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
INTEN
Bit Symbol
INT0EN
Address
00F9h
Bit Name
_____
INT0 input enable bit
RW
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges
RW
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
INT1 input polarity select bit(1,2)
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
INT0 input polarity select bit(1,2)
_____
INT1EN
INT1 input enable bit
_____
INT1PL
—
(b5-b4)
_____
INT3EN
INT3 input enable bit
_____
INT3PL
RW
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
_____
INT0PL
After Reset
00h
Function
INT3 input polarity select bit(1,2)
RW
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges
RW
NOTES:
1. When setting the INTiPL bit (i = 0, 1, 3) to 1 (both edges), set the POL bit in the INTiIC register to 0 (selects falling
edge).
2. The IR bit in the INTiIC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the INTiPL bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.6.4
Changing Interrupt Sources.
Figure 12.13
INTEN Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 111 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
_____
INT Input Filter Select Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
INTF
Bit Symbol
Address
00FAh
Bit Name
_____
INT0F0
INT0 input filter select bits
INT0F1
_____
INT1F0
INT1 input filter select bits
INT1F1
—
(b5-b4)
INT3F0
0 0 : No filter
0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling
1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling
1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling
RW
RW
b3 b2
0 0 : No filter
0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling
1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling
1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling
Set to 0.
_____
b7 b6
INT3 input filter select bits
RW
b1 b0
Reserved bit
INT3F1
Figure 12.14
After Reset
00h
Function
0 0 : No filter
0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling
1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling
1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
INTF Register
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
TRAIO output control bit
Reserved bit
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
TIPF1
—
(b7-b6)
Figure 12.15
Set to 0.
RW
RW
_____
0 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_7)
_____
1 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_5)
TRAIO input filter select bits Function varies depending on operating mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Page 112 of 450
RW
RW
INT1/TRAIO select bit
TRAIOC Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
After Reset
00h
Function
Function varies depending on operating mode.
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.2.2
12. Interrupts
INTi Input Filter (i = 0, 1, 3)
The INTi input contains a digital filter. The sampling clock is selected by bits INTiF1 to INTiF0 in the INTF
register.
The INTi level is sampled every sampling clock cycle and if the sampled input level matches three times, the IR
bit in the INTiIC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested).
Figure 12.16 shows the Configuration of INTi Input Filter. Figure 12.17 shows an Operating Example of INTi
Input Filter.
INTiF1 to INTiF0
f1
f8
f32
INTi
Port direction
register(1)
= 01b
= 10b
Sampling clock
= 11b
INTiEN
Digital filter
(input level
matches 3x)
Other than
INTiF1 to INTiF0
= 00b
= 00b
INTi interrupt
INTiPL = 0
Both edges
detection
INTiPL = 1
circuit
INTiF0, INTiF1: Bits in INTF register
INTiEN, INTiPL: Bits in INTEN register
i = 0, 1, 3
NOTE:
1. INT0: Port P4_5 direction register
INT1: Port P1_5 direction register when using the P1_5 pin
Port P1_7 direction register when using the P1_7 pin
INT3: Port P3_3 direction register
Figure 12.16
Configuration of INTi Input Filter
INTi input
Sampling
timing
IR bit in
INTiIC register
Set to 0 by a program
This is an operation example when bits INTiF1 to INTiF0 in the
INTiF register are set to 01b, 10b, or 11b (digital filter enabled).
i = 0, 1, 3
Figure 12.17
Operating Example of INTi Input Filter
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 113 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.3
12. Interrupts
Key Input Interrupt
A key input interrupt request is generated by one of the input edges of pins K10 to K13. The key input interrupt can
be used as a key-on wake-up function to exit wait or stop mode.
The KIiEN (i = 0 to 3) bit in the KIEN register can select whether or not the pins are used as KIi input. The KIiPL
bit in the KIEN register can select the input polarity.
When inputting “L” to the KIi pin which sets the KIiPL bit to 0 (falling edge), the input of the other pins K10 to
K13 is not detected as interrupts. Also, when inputting “H” to the KIi pin, which sets the KIiPL bit to 1 (rising
edge), the input of the other pins K10 to K13 is not detected as interrupts.
Figure 12.18 shows a Block Diagram of Key Input Interrupt.
PU02 bit in PUR0 register
KUPIC register
Pull-up
transistor
PD1_3 bit in PD1 register
KI3EN bit
PD1_3 bit
KI3PL = 0
KI3
KI3PL = 1
Pull-up
transistor
KI2EN bit
PD1_2 bit
KI2PL = 0
Interrupt control
circuit
KI2
KI2PL = 1
Pull-up
transistor
Key input interrupt
request
KI1EN bit
PD1_1 bit
KI1PL = 0
KI1
KI1PL = 1
Pull-up
transistor
KI0EN bit
PD1_0 bit
KI0PL = 0
KI0
KI0PL = 1
Figure 12.18
Block Diagram of Key Input Interrupt
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 114 of 450
KI0EN, KI1EN, KI2EN, KI3EN,
KI0PL, KI1PL, KI2PL, KI3PL: Bits in KIEN register
PD1_0, PD1_1, PD1_2, PD1_3: Bits in PD1 register
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
Key Input Enable Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
KIEN
Bit Symbol
KI0EN
KI0PL
KI1EN
KI1PL
KI2EN
KI2PL
KI3EN
KI3PL
Address
00FBh
Bit Name
KI0 input enable bit
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
KI0 input polarity select bit
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
RW
KI1 input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
KI1 input polarity select bit
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
RW
KI2 input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
KI2 input polarity select bit
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
RW
KI3 input enable bit
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
KI3 input polarity select bit
0 : Falling edge
1 : Rising edge
RW
NOTE:
1. The IR bit in the KUPIC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the KIEN register is rew ritten.
Refer to 12.6.4 Changing Interrupt Sources.
Figure 12.19
KIEN Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
0 : Disable
1 : Enable
Page 115 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.4
12. Interrupts
Address Match Interrupt
An address match interrupt request is generated immediately before execution of the instruction at the address
indicated by the RMADi register (i = 0 or 1). This interrupt is used as a break function by the debugger. When
using the on-chip debugger, do not set an address match interrupt (registers of AIER, RMAD0, and RMAD1 and
fixed vector tables) in a user system.
Set the starting address of any instruction in the RMADi register. Bits AIER0 and AIER1 in the AIER0 register can
be used to select enable or disable of the interrupt. The I flag and IPL do not affect the address match interrupt.
The value of the PC (Refer to 12.1.6.7 Saving a Register for the value of the PC) which is saved to the stack when
an address match interrupt is acknowledged varies depending on the instruction at the address indicated by the
RMADi register. (The appropriate return address is not saved on the stack.) When returning from the address match
interrupt, return by one of the following means:
• Change the content of the stack and use the REIT instruction.
• Use an instruction such as POP to restore the stack as it was before the interrupt request was acknowledged. Then
use a jump instruction.
Table 12.6 lists the Values of PC Saved to Stack when Address Match Interrupt is Acknowledged.
Figure 12.20 shows Registers AIER and RMAD0 to RMAD1.
Table 12.6
Values of PC Saved to Stack when Address Match Interrupt is Acknowledged
Address Indicated by RMADi Register (i = 0 or 1)
• Instruction with 2-byte operation code(2)
• Instruction with 1-byte operation code(2)
ADD.B:S
#IMM8,dest SUB.B:S #IMM8,dest AND.B:S #IMM8,dest
OR.B:S
#IMM8,dest MOV.B:S #IMM8,dest STZ
#IMM8,dest
STNZ
#IMM8,dest STZX
#IMM81,#IMM82,dest
CMP.B:S
#IMM8,dest PUSHM src
POPM
dest
JMPS
#IMM8
JSRS
#IMM8
MOV.B:S
#IMM,dest (however, dest = A0 or A1)
• Instructions other than the above
PC Value Saved(1)
Address indicated by
RMADi register + 2
Address indicated by
RMADi register + 1
NOTES:
1. Refer to the 12.1.6.7 Saving a Register for the PC value saved.
2. Operation code: Refer to the R8C/Tiny Series Software Manual (REJ09B0001).
Chapter 4. Instruction Code/Number of Cycles contains diagrams showing
operation code below each syntax. Operation code is shown in the bold frame in
the diagrams.
Table 12.7
Correspondence Between Address Match Interrupt Sources and Associated Registers
Address Match Interrupt Source Address Match Interrupt Enable Bit Address Match Interrupt Register
Address match interrupt 0
AIER0
RMAD0
Address match interrupt 1
AIER1
RMAD1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 116 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
AIER
Bit Symbol
AIER0
AIER1
—
(b7-b2)
Address
0013h
Bit Name
Address match interrupt 0 enable bit 0 : Disable
1 : Enable
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
RW
Address match interrupt 1 enable bit 0 : Disable
1 : Enable
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
Address Match Interrupt Register i (i = 0 or 1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16) (b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
RMAD0
RMAD1
Address
0012h-0010h
0016h-0014h
Function
Address setting register for address match interrupt
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b7-b4)
When read, the content is 0.
Figure 12.20
Registers AIER and RMAD0 to RMAD1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 117 of 450
After Reset
000000h
000000h
Setting Range
RW
00000h to FFFFFh
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.5
12. Interrupts
Timer RC Interrupt, Timer RD Interrupt (Interrupts with Multiple Interrupt
Request Sources)
The timer RC interrupt, timer RD (channel 0) interrupt, and timer RD (channel 1) interrupt each have multiple
interrupt request sources. An interrupt request is generated by the logical OR of several interrupt request factors
and is reflected in the IR bit in the corresponding interrupt control register. Therefore, each of these peripheral
functions has its own interrupt request source status register (status register) and interrupt request source enable
register (enable register) to control the generation of interrupt requests (change the IR bit in the interrupt control
register). Table 12.8 lists the Registers Associated with Timer RC Interrupt and Timer RD Interrupt and Figure
12.21 shows a Block Diagram of Timer RD Interrupt.
Table 12.8
Registers Associated with Timer RC Interrupt and Timer RD Interrupt
Peripheral Function
Name
Timer RC
Timer RD Channel 0
Channel 1
Status Register of
Interrupt Request Source
TRCSR
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Enable Register of
Interrupt Control
Interrupt Request Source
Register
TRCIER
TRCIC
TRDIER0
TRD0IC
TRDIER1
TRD1IC
Channel i
IMFA bit
IMIEA bit
IMFB bit
IMIEB bit
IMFC bit
IMIEC bit
IMFD bit
IMIED bit
UDF bit
OVF bit
OVIE bit
i = 0 or 1
IMFA, IMFB, IMFC, IMFD, OVF, UDF: Bits in TRDSRi register
IMIEA, IMIEB, IMIEC, IMIED, OVIE: Bits in TRDIER register
Figure 12.21
Block Diagram of Timer RD Interrupt
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 118 of 450
Timer RD (channel i)
interrupt request
(IR bit in TRDiIC register)
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12. Interrupts
As with other maskable interrupts, the timer RC interrupt, timer RD (channel 0) interrupt, and timer RD (channel 1)
interrupt are controlled by the combination of the I flag, IR bit, bits ILVL0 to ILVL2, and IPL. However, since each
interrupt source is generated by a combination of multiple interrupt request sources, the following differences from
other maskable interrupts apply:
• When bits in the enable register corresponding to bits set to 1 in the status register are set to 1 (enable interrupt),
the IR bit in the interrupt control register is set to 1 (interrupt requested).
• When either bits in the status register or bits in the enable register corresponding to bits in the status register, or
both, are set to 0, the IR bit is set to 0 (interrupt not requested). Basically, even though the interrupt is not
acknowledged after the IR bit is set to 1, the interrupt request will not be maintained. Also, the IR bit is not set to
0 even if 0 is written to the IR bit.
• Individual bits in the status register are not automatically set to 0 even if the interrupt is acknowledged. Therefore,
the IR bit is also not automatically set to 0 when the interrupt is acknowledged. Set each bit in the status register
to 0 in the interrupt routine. Refer to the status register figure for how to set individual bits in the status register to
0.
• When multiple bits in the enable register are set to 1 and other request sources are generated after the IR bit is set
to 1, the IR bit remains 1.
• When multiple bits in the enable register are set to 1, determine by the status register which request source causes
an interrupt.
Refer to chapters of the individual peripheral functions (16.3 Timer RC and 16.4 Timer RD) for the status register
and enable register.
Refer to 12.1.6 Interrupt Control for the interrupt control register.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 119 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.6
12. Interrupts
Notes on Interrupts
12.6.1
Reading Address 00000h
Do not read address 00000h by a program. When a maskable interrupt request is acknowledged, the CPU reads
interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) from 00000h in the interrupt sequence. At
this time, the acknowledged interrupt IR bit is set to 0.
If address 00000h is read by a program, the IR bit for the interrupt which has the highest priority among the
enabled interrupts is set to 0. This may cause the interrupt to be canceled, or an unexpected interrupt to be
generated.
12.6.2
SP Setting
Set any value in the SP before an interrupt is acknowledged. The SP is set to 0000h after reset. Therefore, if an
interrupt is acknowledged before setting a value in the SP, the program may run out of control.
12.6.3
External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt
Either “L” level or an “H” level of width shown in the Electrical Characteristics is necessary for the signal input
to pins INT0, INT1, INT3 and pins KI0 to KI3, regardless of the CPU clock.
For details, refer to Table 22.19 (VCC = 5V), Table 22.25 (VCC = 3V), Table 22.31 (VCC = 2.2V) External
Interrupt INTi (i = 0, 1, 3) Input.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 120 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.6.4
12. Interrupts
Changing Interrupt Sources
The IR bit in the interrupt control register may be set to 1 (interrupt requested) when the interrupt source
changes. When using an interrupt, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after changing the interrupt source.
In addition, changes of interrupt sources include all factors that change the interrupt sources assigned to
individual software interrupt numbers, polarities, and timing. Therefore, if a mode change of a peripheral
function involves interrupt sources, edge polarities, and timing, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after
the change. Refer to the individual peripheral function for its related interrupts.
Figure 12.22 shows an Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources.
Interrupt source change
Disable interrupts(2, 3)
Change interrupt source (including mode
of peripheral function)
Set the IR bit to 0 (interrupt not requested)
using the MOV instruction(3)
Enable interrupts (2, 3)
Change completed
IR bit:
The interrupt control register bit of an
interrupt whose source is changed.
NOTES:
1. Execute the above settings individually. Do not execute two
or more settings at once (by one instruction).
2. To prevent interrupt requests from being generated disable
the peripheral function before changing the interrupt
source. In this case, use the I flag if all maskable interrupts
can be disabled. If all maskable interrupts cannot be
disabled, use bits ILVL0 to ILVL2 of the interrupt whose
source is changed.
3. Refer to 12.6.5 Changing Interrupt Control Register
Contents for the instructions to be used and usage notes.
Figure 12.22
Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 121 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
12.6.5
12. Interrupts
Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents
(a) The contents of an interrupt control register can only be changed while no interrupt requests corresponding
to that register are generated. If interrupt requests may be generated, disable interrupts before changing the
interrupt control register contents.
(b) When changing the contents of an interrupt control register after disabling interrupts, be careful to choose
appropriate instructions.
Changing any bit other than IR bit
If an interrupt request corresponding to a register is generated while executing the instruction, the IR bit
may not be set to 1 (interrupt requested), and the interrupt request may be ignored. If this causes a problem,
use the following instructions to change the register: AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
Changing IR bit
If the IR bit is set to 0 (interrupt not requested), it may not be set to 0 depending on the instruction used.
Therefore, use the MOV instruction to set the IR bit to 0.
(c) When disabling interrupts using the I flag, set the I flag as shown in the sample programs below. Refer to
(b) regarding changing the contents of interrupt control registers by the sample programs.
Sample programs 1 to 3 are for preventing the I flag from being set to 1 (interrupts enabled) before the interrupt
control register is changed for reasons of the internal bus or the instruction queue buffer.
Example 1:
Use NOP instructions to prevent I flag from being set to 1 before interrupt control register
is changed
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupts
AND.B #00H,0056H
; Set TRAIC register to 00h
NOP
;
NOP
FSET
I
; Enable interrupts
Example 2: Use dummy read to delay FSET instruction
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupts
AND.B #00H,0056H
; Set TRAIC register to 00h
MOV.W MEM,R0
; Dummy read
FSET
I
; Enable interrupts
Example 3: Use POPC instruction to change I flag
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupts
AND.B #00H,0056H
; Set TRAIC register to 00h
POPC
FLG
; Enable interrupts
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 122 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
13. ID Code Areas
13. ID Code Areas
13.1
Overview
The ID code areas are used to implement a function that prevents the flash memory from being rewritten in
standard serial I/O mode. This function prevents the flash memory from read, rewritten, or erased.
The ID code areas are assigned to 0FFDFh, 0FFE3h, 0FFEBh, 0FFEFh, 0FFF3h, 0FFF7h, and 0FFFBh of the
respective vector highest-order addresses of the fixed vector table. Figure 13.1 shows the ID Code Areas.
ID code areas
Address
0FFDFh to 0FFDCh
ID1
Undefined instruction vector
0FFE3h to 0FFE0h
ID2
Overflow vector
BRK instruction vector
0FFE7h to 0FFE4h
0FFEBh to 0FFE8h
ID3
Address match vector
0FFEFh to 0FFECh
ID4
Single step vector
0FFF3h to 0FFF0h
ID5
Oscillation stop detection/watchdog timer/
voltage monitor 1 and voltage monitor 2
0FFF7h to 0FFF4h
ID6
Address break vector
0FFFBh to 0FFF8h
ID7
0FFFFh to 0FFFCh
OFS
(Reserved)
Reset vector
4 bytes
Figure 13.1
13.2
ID Code Areas
Functions
The ID code areas are used in standard serial I/O mode. Unless 3 bytes (addresses from 0FFFCh to 0FFFEh) of the
reset vector are set to FFFFFFh, the ID codes stored in the ID code areas and the ID codes sent from the serial
programmer or the on-chip debugging emulator are checked to see if they match. If the ID codes match, the
commands sent from the serial programmer or the on-chip debugging emulator are acknowledged. If the ID codes
do not match, the commands are not acknowledged. To use the serial programmer or the on-chip debugging
simulator, first write predetermined ID codes to the ID code areas.
As the ID code areas are allocated in the flash memory (not in the SFRs), they cannot be rewritten by executing an
instruction. Write appropriate values when creating a program.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 123 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
13.3
13. ID Code Areas
Notes on ID Code Areas
13.3.1
Setting Example of ID Code Areas
As the ID code areas are allocated in the flash memory (not in the SFRs), they cannot be rewritten by executing
an instruction. Write appropriate values when creating a program. The following shows a setting example.
• To set 55h in all of the ID code areas
.org 00FFDCH
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; UND
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; INTO
.lword dummy ; BREAK
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; ADDRESS MATCH
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; SET SINGLE STEP
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; WDT
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; ADDRESS BREAK
.lword dummy | (55000000h) ; RESERVE
(Programming formats vary depending on the compiler. Check the compiler manual.)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 124 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
14. Option Function Select Area
14. Option Function Select Area
14.1
Overview
The option function select area is used to select the MCU state after reset or the function to prevent rewriting in
parallel I/O mode. The reset vector highest-order-address, 0FFFFh, is assigned as the option function select area.
Figure 14.1 shows the Option Function Select Area.
Option function select area
Address
0FFFFh to 0FFFCh
OFS
Reset vector
4 bytes
Figure 14.1
Option Function Select Area
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 125 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
14.2
14. Option Function Select Area
OFS Register
The OFS register is used to select the MCU state after reset or the function to prevent rewriting in parallel I/O
mode. Figure 14.2 shows the OFS Register.
Option Function Select Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
1
Symbol
OFS
Bit Symbol
WDTON
—
(b1)
ROMCR
ROMCP1
—
(b4)
LVD0ON
—
(b6)
Address
0FFFFh
Bit Name
Watchdog timer start
select bit
When Shipping
FFh(3)
Function
0 : Starts w atchdog timer automatically after reset
1 : Watchdog timer is inactive after reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
ROM code protect
disabled bit
0 : ROM code protect disabled
1 : ROMCP1 enabled
RW
ROM code protect bit
0 : ROM code protect enabled
1 : ROM code protect disabled
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Voltage detection 0
circuit start bit(2)
0 : Voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are
reset
1 : Voltage monitor 0 reset disabled after hardw are
reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Count source protect
CSPROINI mode after reset select
bit
0 : Count source protect mode enabled after reset
1 : Count source protect mode disabled after reset
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. The OFS register is on the flash memory. Write to the OFS register w ith a program. After w riting is completed, do not
w rite additions to the OFS register.
2. Setting the LVD0ON bit is only valid after a hardw are reset. To use the pow er-on reset, set the LVD0ON bit to 0
(voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are reset).
3. If the block including the OFS register is erased, FFh is set to the OFS register.
Figure 14.2
OFS Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 126 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
14.3
14. Option Function Select Area
Notes on Option Function Select Area
14.3.1
Setting Example of Option Function Select Area
As the option function select area is allocated in the flash memory (not in the SFRs), they cannot be rewritten by
executing an instruction. Write appropriate values when creating a program. The following shows a setting
example.
• To set FFh in the OFS register
.org 00FFFCH
.lword reset | (0FF000000h)
; RESET
(Programming formats vary depending on the compiler. Check the compiler manual.)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 127 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
15. Watchdog Timer
15. Watchdog Timer
The watchdog timer is a function that detects when a program is out of control. Use of the watchdog timer is
recommended to improve the reliability of the system. The watchdog timer contains a 15-bit counter and allows
selection of count source protection mode enable or disable.
Table 15.1 lists information on the Watchdog Timer Specifications.
Refer to 5.6 Watchdog Timer Reset for details on the watchdog timer.
Figure 15.1 shows the Block Diagram of Watchdog Timer. Figure 15.2 shows the Registers WDTR, WDTS, and
WDC. Figure 15.3 shows the Registers CSPR and OFS.
Table 15.1
Watchdog Timer Specifications
Item
Count source
Count Source Protection
Mode Disabled
CPU clock
Count operation
Count start condition
Count Source Protection
Mode Enabled
Low-speed on-chip oscillator
clock
Decrement
Either of the following can be selected
• After reset, count starts automatically
• Count starts by writing to WDTS register
Count stop condition
Stop mode, wait mode
None
Reset condition of watchdog
• Reset
timer
• Write 00h to the WDTR register before writing FFh
• Underflow
Operation at the time of underflow Watchdog timer interrupt or
Watchdog timer reset
watchdog timer reset
Select functions
• Division ratio of prescaler
Selected by the WDC7 bit in the WDC register
• Count source protection mode
Whether count source protection mode is enabled or disabled after
a reset can be selected by the CSPROINI bit in the OFS register
(flash memory). If count source protection mode is disabled after a
reset, it can be enabled or disabled by the CSPRO bit in the CSPR
register (program).
• Starts or stops of the watchdog timer after a reset
Selected by the WDTON bit in the OFS register (flash memory).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 128 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
15. Watchdog Timer
Prescaler
1/16
CM07 = 0,
WDC7 = 0
CSPRO = 0
1/128
CPU clock
CM07 = 0,
WDC7 = 1
PM12 = 0
Watchdog timer
interrupt request
Watchdog timer
1/2
CM07 = 1
fOCO-S
CSPRO = 1
Write to WDTR register
Set to
7FFFh(1)
PM12 = 1
Watchdog
timer reset
Internal reset signal
(“L” active)
CSPRO: Bit in CSPR register
WDC7: Bit in WDC register
PM12: Bit in PM1 register
CM07: Bit in CM0 register
NOTE:
1. When the CSPRO bit is set to 1 (count source protection mode enabled), 0FFFh is set.
Figure 15.1
Block Diagram of Watchdog Timer
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 129 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
15. Watchdog Timer
Watchdog Timer Reset Register
b7
b0
Symbol
WDTR
Address
000Dh
After Reset
Undefined
Function
When 00h is w ritten before w riting FFh, the w atchdog timer is reset.(1)
The default value of the w atchdog timer is 7FFFh w hen count source protection
mode is disabled and 0FFFh w hen count source protection mode is enabled.(2)
RW
WO
NOTES:
1. Do not generate an interrupt betw een w hen 00h and FFh are w ritten.
2. When the CSPRO bit in the CSPR register is set to 1 (count source protection mode enabled),
0FFFh is set in the w atchdog timer.
Watchdog Timer Start Register
b7
b0
Symbol
WDTS
Address
000Eh
After Reset
Undefined
Function
The w atchdog timer starts counting after a w rite instruction to this register.
RW
WO
Watchdog Timer Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
Address
000Fh
WDC
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
High-order bits of w atchdog timer
(b4-b0)
—
(b5)
Reserved bit
Set to 0. When read, the content is undefined.
—
(b6)
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
Prescaler select bit
0 : Divide-by-16
1 : Divide-by-128
WDC7
Figure 15.2
Registers WDTR, WDTS, and WDC
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
After Reset
00X11111b
Function
Page 130 of 450
RW
RO
RW
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
15. Watchdog Timer
Count Source Protection Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Symbol
Address
001Ch
CSPR
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Reserved bits
(b6-b0)
CSPRO
After Reset(1)
00h
Function
Set to 0.
Count source protection mode 0 : Count source protection mode disabled
1 : Count source protection mode enabled
select bit(2)
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. When 0 is w ritten to the CSPROINI bit in the OFS register, the value after reset is 10000000b.
2. Write 0 before w riting 1 to set the CSPRO bit to 1. 0 cannot be set by a program.
Option Function Select Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
1
Symbol
OFS
Bit Symbol
WDTON
—
(b1)
ROMCR
ROMCP1
—
(b4)
LVD0ON
—
(b6)
Address
0FFFFh
Bit Name
Watchdog timer start
select bit
When Shipping
FFh(3)
Function
0 : Starts w atchdog timer automatically after reset
1 : Watchdog timer is inactive after reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
ROM code protect
disabled bit
0 : ROM code protect disabled
1 : ROMCP1 enabled
RW
ROM code protect bit
0 : ROM code protect enabled
1 : ROM code protect disabled
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Voltage detection 0
circuit start bit(2)
0 : Voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are
reset
1 : Voltage monitor 0 reset disabled after hardw are
reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Count source protect
CSPROINI mode after reset select
bit
0 : Count source protect mode enabled after reset
1 : Count source protect mode disabled after reset
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. The OFS register is on the flash memory. Write to the OFS register w ith a program. After w riting is completed, do not
w rite additions to the OFS register.
2. Setting the LVD0ON bit is only valid after a hardw are reset. To use the pow er-on reset, set the LVD0ON bit to 0
(voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are reset).
3. If the block including the OFS register is erased, FFh is set to the OFS register.
Figure 15.3
Registers CSPR and OFS
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 131 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
15.1
15. Watchdog Timer
Count Source Protection Mode Disabled
The count source of the watchdog timer is the CPU clock when count source protection mode is disabled.
Table 15.2 lists the Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Disabled).
Table 15.2
Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Disabled)
Item
Specification
Count source
Count operation
Period
CPU clock
Decrement
Reset condition of watchdog
timer
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Operation at time of underflow
Division ratio of prescaler (n) × count value of watchdog timer (32768)(1)
CPU clock
n: 16 or 128 (selected by WDC7 bit in WDC register)
Example: When the CPU clock frequency is 16 MHz and prescaler
divided by 16, the period is approximately 32.8 ms
• Reset
• Write 00h to the WDTR register before writing FFh
• Underflow
The WDTON bit(2) in the OFS register (0FFFFh) selects the operation
of the watchdog timer after a reset
• When the WDTON bit is set to 1 (watchdog timer is in stop state after
reset)
The watchdog timer and prescaler stop after a reset and the count
starts when the WDTS register is written to
• When the WDTON bit is set to 0 (watchdog timer starts automatically
after exiting)
The watchdog timer and prescaler start counting automatically after a
reset
Stop and wait modes (inherit the count from the held value after exiting
modes)
• When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to 0
Watchdog timer interrupt
• When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to 1
Watchdog timer reset (Refer to 5.6 Watchdog Timer Reset.)
NOTES:
1. The watchdog timer is reset when 00h is written to the WDTR register before FFh. The prescaler is
reset after the MCU is reset. Some errors in the period of the watchdog timer may be caused by the
prescaler.
2. The WDTON bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the WDTON bit, write 0 to bit 0 of address
0FFFFh with a flash programmer.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 132 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
15.2
15. Watchdog Timer
Count Source Protection Mode Enabled
The count source of the watchdog timer is the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock when count source protection
mode is enabled. If the CPU clock stops when a program is out of control, the clock can still be supplied to the
watchdog timer.
Table 15.3 lists the Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Enabled).
Table 15.3
Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Enabled)
Item
Count source
Count operation
Period
Reset condition of watchdog
timer
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Operation at time of underflow
Registers, bits
Specification
Low-speed on-chip oscillator clock
Decrement
Count value of watchdog timer (4096)
Low-speed on-chip oscillator clock
Example: Period is approximately 32.8 ms when the low-speed onchip oscillator clock frequency is 125 kHz
• Reset
• Write 00h to the WDTR register before writing FFh
• Underflow
The WDTON bit(1) in the OFS register (0FFFFh) selects the operation
of the watchdog timer after a reset.
• When the WDTON bit is set to 1 (watchdog timer is in stop state
after reset)
The watchdog timer and prescaler stop after a reset and the count
starts when the WDTS register is written to
• When the WDTON bit is set to 0 (watchdog timer starts
automatically after reset)
The watchdog timer and prescaler start counting automatically after
a reset
None (The count does not stop in wait mode after the count starts.
The MCU does not enter stop mode.)
Watchdog timer reset (Refer to 5.6 Watchdog Timer Reset.)
• When setting the CSPPRO bit in the CSPR register to 1 (count
source protection mode is enabled)(2), the following are set
automatically
- Set 0FFFh to the watchdog timer
- Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0 (low-speed on-chip
oscillator on)
- Set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 1 (The watchdog timer is
reset when watchdog timer underflows)
• The following conditions apply in count source protection mode
- Writing to the CM10 bit in the CM1 register is disabled (It remains
unchanged even if it is set to 1. The MCU does not enter stop
mode.)
- Writing to the CM14 bit in the CM1 register is disabled (It remains
unchanged even if it is set to 1. The low-speed on-chip oscillator
does not stop.)
NOTES:
1. The WDTON bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the WDTON bit, write 0 to bit 0 of address
0FFFFh with a flash programmer.
2. Even if 0 is written to the CSPROINI bit in the OFS register, the CSPRO bit is set to 1. The CSPROINI
bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the CSPROINI bit, write 0 to bit 7 of address 0FFFFh with
a flash programmer.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 133 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
16. Timers
The MCU has two 8-bit timers with 8-bit prescalers and two 16-bit timers. The two 8-bit timers with 8-bit prescalers
are timer RA and timer RB. These timers contain a reload register to store the default value of the counter. The two 16bit timers are timer RC, timer RD, and have input capture and output compare functions. All the timers operate
independently.
Tables 16.1 lists Functional Comparison of Timers.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 134 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.1
16. Timers
Functional Comparison of Timers
Item
Configuration
Count
Count sources
Function Count of the internal
count source
Count of the external
count source
External pulse width/
period measurement
Timer RA
8-bit timer with 8-bit
prescaler (with reload
register)
Decrement
• f1
• f2
• f8
• fOCO
Timer RB
8-bit timer with 8-bit
prescaler (with reload
register)
Decrement
• f1
• f2
• f8
• Timer RA underflow
Timer mode
Timer mode
Event counter mode
—
Pulse width
measurement mode,
pulse period
measurement mode
—
Timer RC
16-bit timer (with input
capture and output
compare)
Increment
• f1
• f2
• f4
• f8
• f32
• fOCO40M
• TRCCLK
Timer mode (output
compare function)
Timer mode (output
compare function)
Timer mode (input
capture function; 4
pins)
Timer RD
16-bit timer × 2 (with
input capture and
output compare)
Increment/Decrement
• f1
• f2
• f4
• f8
• f32
• fOCO40M
• TRDIOA0
Timer mode (output
compare function)
Timer mode (output
compare function)
Timer mode (input
compare function; 2
channels × 4 pins)
Timer mode (output
compare function; 2
channels × 4 pins)(1),
PWM mode
(2 channels × 3 pins),
PWM3 mode
(2 channels × 2 pins)
PWM mode
(2 channels × 3 pins)
PWM output
Pulse output mode(1), Programmable
Event counter mode(1) waveform generation
mode
Timer mode (output
compare function; 4
pins)(1),
PWM mode (3 pins),
PWM2 mode (1 pin)
One-shot waveform
output
—
PWM mode (3 pins)
Three-phase
waveforms output
—
Programmable oneshot generation mode,
Programmable wait
one-shot generation
mode
—
—
Reset synchronous
PWM mode
(2 channels × 3 pins,
Sawtooth wave
modulation),
Complementary PWM
mode
(2 channels × 3 pins,
triangular wave
modulation, dead time)
Input pin
TRAIO
INT0
INT0, TRCCLK,
TRCTRG, TRCIOA,
TRCIOB, TRCIOC,
TRCIOD
Output pin
TRAO
TRAIO
TRBO
TRCIOA,
TRCIOB, TRCIOC,
TRCIOD
Related interrupt
Timer RA interrupt,
INT1 interrupt
Timer RB interrupt,
INT0 interrupt
Compare match/input
capture A to D
interrupt,
Overflow interrupt,
INT0 interrupt
Timer stop
Provided
Provided
Provided
INT0, TRDCLK,
TRDIOA0, TRDIOA1,
TRDIOB0, TRDIOB1,
TRDIOC0, TRDIOC1,
TRDIOD0, TRDIOD1
TRDIOA0, TRDIOA1,
TRDIOB0, TRDIOB1,
TRDIOC0, TRDIOC1,
TRDIOD0, TRDIOD1
Compare match/input
capture A0 to D0
interrupt,
Compare match/input
capture A1 to D1
interrupt,
Overflow interrupt,
Underflow interrupt(2),
INT0 interrupt
Provided
NOTES:
1. Rectangular waves are output in these modes. Since the waves are inverted at each overflow, the “H” and “L” level widths of
the pulses are the same.
2. The underflow interrupt can be set to channel 1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 135 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1
16. Timers
Timer RA
Timer RA is an 8-bit timer with an 8-bit prescaler.
The prescaler and timer each consist of a reload register and counter. The reload register and counter are allocated
at the same address, and can be accessed when accessing registers TRAPRE and TRA (refer to Tables 16.2 to 16.6
the Specification of Each Modes).
The count source for timer RA is the operating clock that regulates the timing of timer operations such as counting
and reloading.
Figure 16.1 shows a Block Diagram of Timer RA. Figures 16.2 and 16.3 show the registers associated with Timer
RA.
Timer RA contains the following five operating modes:
• Timer mode:
The timer counts the internal count source.
• Pulse output mode:
The timer counts the internal count source and outputs pulses which
invert the polarity by underflow of the timer.
• Event counter mode:
The timer counts external pulses.
• Pulse width measurement mode:
The timer measures the pulse width of an external pulse.
• Pulse period measurement mode:
The timer measures the pulse period of an external pulse.
Data bus
TCK2 to TCK0 bit
= 000b
f1
= 001b
f8
= 010b
fOCO
= 011b
f2
TCKCUT bit
TMOD2 to TMOD0
= other than 010b
TIPF1 to TIPF0 bits
TMOD2 to TMOD0
= 010b
Reload
register
Reload
register
TCSTF bit
Counter
TRAPRE register
(prescaler)
Counter
TRA register
(timer)
Underflow signal
Timer RA interrupt
= 01b
f1
= 10b
f8
= 11b
f32
TIPF1 to TIPF0 bits
TIOSEL = 0 = other than
Digital
000b
INT1/TRAIO (P1_7) pin
filter
INT1/TRAIO (P1_5) pin
TIOSEL = 1
TMOD2 to TMOD0
= 011b or 100b
Polarity
switching
Count control
circle
= 00b
TMOD2 to TMOD0 = 001b
TEDGSEL = 1
TOPCR bit
Q
Q
TEDGSEL = 0
Measurement completion
signal
Toggle
flip-flop
CK
CLR
Write to TRAMR register
Write 1 to TSTOP bit
TCSTF, TSTOP: TRACR register
TEDGSEL, TOPCR, TIOSEL, TIPF1, TIPF0: TRAIOC register
TMOD2 to TMOD0, TCK2 to TCK0, TCKCUT: TRAMR register
Figure 16.1
Block Diagram of Timer RA
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 136 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RA Control Register(4)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRACR
Bit Symbol
Address
0100h
Bit Name
Timer RA count start bit(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
0 : Count stops
1 : Count starts
RW
TCSTF
Timer RA count status flag(1) 0 : Count stops
1 : During count
RO
TSTOP
Timer RA count forcible stop When this bit is set to 1, the count is forcibly
bit(2)
stopped. When read, its content is 0.
RW
TSTART
—
(b3)
TEDGF
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Active edge judgment
flag(3, 5)
0 : Active edge not received
1 : Active edge received
(end of measurement period)
—
RW
TUNDF
Timer RA underflow flag(3, 5) 0 : No underflow
1 : Underflow
RW
—
(b7-b6)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
NOTES:
1. Refer to 16.1.6 Notes on Tim er RA for precautions regarding bits TSTART and TCSTF.
2. When the TSTOP bit is set to 1, bits TSTART and TCSTF and registers TPRAPRE and TRA are set to the values after
a reset.
3. Bits TEDGF and TUNDF can be set to 0 by w riting 0 to these bits by a program. How ever, their value remains
unchanged w hen 1 is w ritten.
4. In pulse w idth measurement mode and pulse period measurement mode, use the MOV instruction to set the TRACR
register. If it is necessary to avoid changing the values of bits TEDGF and TUNDF, w rite 1 to them.
5. Set to 0 in timer mode, pulse output mode, and event counter mode.
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
TRAIO output control bit
Reserved bit
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
TIPF1
—
(b7-b6)
Figure 16.2
INT1/TRAIO select bit
Set to 0.
Function varies depending on operating mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Page 137 of 450
RW
RW
RW
TRAIO input filter select bits
Registers TRACR and TRAIOC
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
After Reset
00h
Function
Function varies depending on operating mode.
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RA Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRAMR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
Address
0102h
Bit Name
Timer RA operating mode
select bits (1)
TMOD1
TMOD2
After Reset
00h
Function
0 0 0 : Timer mode
0 0 1 : Pulse output mode
0 1 0 : Event counter mode
0 1 1 : Pulse w idth measurement mode
1 0 0 : Pulse period measurement mode
101:
1 1 0 : Do not set.
111:
—
(b3)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
TCK0
Timer RA count source
select bits
TCK1
TCK2
TCKCUT
Timer RA count source
cutoff bit
RW
b2 b1 b0
RW
RW
RW
—
b6 b5 b4
0 0 0 : f1
0 0 1 : f8
0 1 0 : fOCO
0 1 1 : f2
100:
1 0 1 : Do not set.
110:
111:
RW
0 : Provides count source
1 : Cuts off count source
RW
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. When both the TSTART and TCSTF bits in the TRACR register are set to 0 (count stops), rew rite this register.
Timer RA Prescaler Register
b7
b0
Symbol
TRAPRE
Mode
Timer mode
Pulse output mode
Event counter mode
Pulse w idth
measurement mode
Address
0103h
Function
Counts an internal count source
Pulse period
measurement mode
Measure pulse period of input pulses from
external (counts internal count source)
Counts an external count source
Measure pulse w idth of input pulses from
external (counts internal count source)
After Reset
FFh(1)
Setting Range
00h to FFh
00h to FFh
00h to FFh
RW
RW
RW
RW
00h to FFh
RW
00h to FFh
RW
After Reset
FFh(1)
Setting Range
RW
00h to FFh
RW
NOTE:
1. When the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register is set to 1, the TRAPRE register is set to FFh.
Timer RA Register
b7
b0
Symbol
TRA
Mode
All modes
Address
0104h
Function
Counts on underflow of timer RA prescaler
register
NOTE:
1. When the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register is set to 1, the TRA register is set to FFh.
Figure 16.3
Registers TRAMR, TRAPRE, and TRA
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 138 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.1
16. Timers
Timer Mode
In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source (refer to Table 16.2 Timer Mode
Specifications).
Figure 16.4 shows the TRAIOC Register in Timer Mode.
Table 16.2
Timer Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request
generation timing
INT1/TRAIO pin
function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Specification
f1, f2, f8, fOCO
• Decrement
• When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded
and the count is continued.
1/(n+1)(m+1)
n: Value set in TRAPRE register, m: Value set in TRA register
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stops) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register.
When timer RA underflows [timer RA interrupt].
Programmable I/O port, or INT1 interrupt input
The count value can be read by reading registers TRA and TRAPRE.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written while the count is stopped,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written during the count, values are
written to the reload register and counter. (Refer to 16.1.1.1 Timer Write
Control during Count Operation.)
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
0 0 0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
TRAIO output control bit
Reserved bit
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
TIPF1
—
(b7-b6)
Figure 16.4
Set to 0.
RW
RW
_____
0 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_7)
_____
1 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_5)
TRAIO input filter select bits Set to 0 in timer mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Page 139 of 450
RW
RW
INT1/TRAIO select bit
TRAIOC Register in Timer Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to 0 in timer mode.
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.1.1
16. Timers
Timer Write Control during Count Operation
Timer RA has a prescaler and a timer (which counts the prescaler underflows). The prescaler and timer each
consist of a reload register and a counter. When writing to the prescaler or timer, values are written to both the
reload register and counter.
However, values are transferred from the reload register to the counter of the prescaler in synchronization with
the count source. In addition, values are transferred from the reload register to the counter of the timer in
synchronization with prescaler underflows. Therefore, if the prescaler or timer is written to when count
operation is in progress, the counter value is not updated immediately after the WRITE instruction is executed.
Figure 16.5 shows an Operating Example of Timer RA when Counter Value is Rewritten during Count
Operation.
Set 01h to the TRAPRE register and 25h to
the TRA register by a program.
Count source
After writing, the reload register is
written to at the first count source.
Reloads register of
timer RA prescaler
Previous value
New value (01h)
Reload at
second count
source
Counter of
timer RA prescaler
06h
05h
04h
01h
00h
Reload at
underflow
01h
00h
01h
00h
01h
00h
After writing, the reload register is
written to at the first underflow.
Reloads register of
timer RA
Previous value
New value (25h)
Reload at the second underflow
Counter of timer RA
IR bit in TRAIC
register
03h
02h
25h
24h
0
The IR bit remains unchanged until underflow is
generated by a new value.
The above applies under the following conditions.
Both bits TSTART and TCSTF in the TRACR register are set to 1 (During count).
Figure 16.5
Operating Example of Timer RA when Counter Value is Rewritten during Count
Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 140 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.2
16. Timers
Pulse Output Mode
In pulse output mode, the internally generated count source is counted, and a pulse with inverted polarity is
output from the TRAIO pin each time the timer underflows (refer to Table 16.3 Pulse Output Mode
Specifications).
Figure 16.6 shows the TRAIOC Register in Pulse Output Mode.
Table 16.3
Pulse Output Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Specification
f1, f2, f8, fOCO
• Decrement
• When the timer underflows, the contents in the reload register is reloaded and
the count is continued.
Divide ratio
1/(n+1)(m+1)
n: Value set in TRAPRE register, m: Value set in TRA register
Count start condition 1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
Count stop conditions • 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stops) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register.
Interrupt request
When timer RA underflows [timer RA interrupt].
generation timing
INT1/TRAIO pin
function
Pulse output, programmable output port, or INT1 interrupt(1)
Read from timer
Write to timer
The count value can be read by reading registers TRA and TRAPRE.
Select functions
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written while the count is stopped, values
are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written during the count, values are
written to the reload register and counter. (Refer to 16.1.1.1 Timer Write
Control during Count Operation.)
• TRAIO signal polarity switch function
The TEDGSEL bit in the TRAIOC register selects the level at the start of pulse
output.(1)
• Pulse output stop function
Output from the TRAIO pin is stopped by the TOPCR bit in the TRAIOC
register.
• INT1/TRAIO pin select function
P1_7 or P1_5 is selected by the TIOSEL bit in the TRAIOC register.
NOTE:
1. The level of the output pulse becomes the level when the pulse output starts when the TRAMR
register is written to.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 141 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : TRAIO output starts at “H”
1 : TRAIO output starts at “L”
RW
TRAIO output control bit
0 : TRAIO output
1 : Port P1_7 or P1_5
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
TIPF1
—
(b7-b6)
Figure 16.6
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
0 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_7)
_____
1 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_5)
TRAIO input filter select bits Set to 0 in pulse output mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Page 142 of 450
RW
_____
INT1/TRAIO select bit
TRAIOC Register in Pulse Output Mode
RW
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.3
16. Timers
Event Counter Mode
In event counter mode, external signal inputs to the INT1/TRAIO pin are counted (refer to Table 16.4 Event
Counter Mode Specifications).
Figure 16.7 shows the TRAIOC Register in Event Counter Mode.
Table 16.4
Event Counter Mode Specifications
Item
Count source
Count operations
Specification
External signal which is input to TRAIO pin (active edge selectable by a program)
• Decrement
• When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded and
the count is continued.
Divide ratio
1/(n+1)(m+1)
n: setting value of TRAPRE register, m: setting value of TRA register
Count start condition 1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
Count stop conditions • 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stops) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register.
• When timer RA underflows [timer RA interrupt].
Interrupt request
generation timing
INT1/TRAIO pin
function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Count source input (INT1 interrupt input)
Select functions
• INT1 input polarity switch function
The TEDGSEL bit in the TRAIOC register selects the active edge of the count
source.
• Count source input pin select function
P1_7 or P1_5 is selected by the TIOSEL bit in the TRAIOC register.
• Digital filter function
Bits TIPF0 and TIPF1 in the TRAIOC register enable or disable the digital filter
and select the sampling frequency.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
The count value can be read by reading registers TRA and TRAPRE.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written while the count is stopped, values
are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written during the count, values are
written to the reload register and counter. (Refer to 16.1.1.1 Timer Write
Control during Count Operation.)
Page 143 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
TRAIO output control bit
Set to 0 in event counter mode.
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
0 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_7)
_____
1 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_5)
TRAIO input filter select
bits (1)
b5 b4
0 0 : No filter
0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling
1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling
1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
NOTE:
1. When the same value from the TRAIO pin is sampled three times continuously, the input is determined.
Figure 16.7
TRAIOC Register in Event Counter Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 144 of 450
RW
RW
RW
RW
_____
INT1/TRAIO select bit
TIPF1
—
(b7-b6)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Starts counting at rising edge of the TRAIO
input or TRAIO starts output at “L”
1 : Starts counting at falling edge of the TRAIO
input or TRAIO starts output at “H”
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.4
16. Timers
Pulse Width Measurement Mode
In pulse width measurement mode, the pulse width of an external signal input to the INT1/TRAIO pin is
measured (refer to Table 16.5 Pulse Width Measurement Mode Specifications).
Figure 16.8 shows the TRAIOC Register in Pulse Width Measurement Mode and Figure 16.9 shows an
Operating Example of Pulse Width Measurement Mode.
Table 16.5
Pulse Width Measurement Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request
generation timing
Specification
f1, f2, f8, fOCO
• Decrement
• Continuously counts the selected signal only when measurement pulse is “H”
level, or conversely only “L” level.
• When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded
and the count is continued.
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stops) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register.
• When timer RA underflows [timer RA interrupt].
• Rising or falling of the TRAIO input (end of measurement period) [timer RA
interrupt]
INT1/TRAIO pin function Measured pulse input (INT1 interrupt input)
Read from timer
Write to timer
The count value can be read by reading registers TRA and TRAPRE.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written while the count is stopped,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written during the count, values are
written to the reload register and counter. (Refer to 16.1.1.1 Timer Write
Control during Count Operation.)
Select functions
• Measurement level select
The TEDGSEL bit in the TRAIOC register selects the “H” or “L” level period.
• Measured pulse input pin select function
P1_7 or P1_5 is selected by the TIOSEL bit in the TRAIOC register.
• Digital filter function
Bits TIPF0 and TIPF1 in the TRAIOC register enable or disable the digital
filter and select the sampling frequency.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 145 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : TRAIO input starts at “L”
1 : TRAIO input starts at “H”
TRAIO output control bit
Set to 0 in pulse w idth measurement mode.
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
—
(b7-b6)
0 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_7)
_____
1 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_5)
TRAIO input filter select
bits (1)
b5 b4
0 0 : No filter
0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling
1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling
1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
NOTE:
1. When the same value from the TRAIO pin is sampled three times continuously, the input is determined.
Figure 16.8
TRAIOC Register in Pulse Width Measurement Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 146 of 450
RW
RW
RW
_____
INT1/TRAIO select bit
TIPF1
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
n = high level: the contents of TRA register, low level: the contents of TRAPRE register
FFFFh
Count start
Underflow
Content of counter (hex)
n
Count stop
Count stop
Count start
0000h
Count start
Period
Set to 1 by program
TSTART bit in
TRACR register
1
Measured pulse
(TRAIO pin input)
1
0
0
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program
IR bit in TRAIC
register
1
0
Set to 0 by program
TEDGF bit in
TRACR register
1
0
Set to 0 by program
TUNDF bit in
TRACR register
1
0
The above applies under the following conditions.
• “H” level width of measured pulse is measured. (TEDGSEL = 1)
• TRAPRE = FFh
Figure 16.9
Operating Example of Pulse Width Measurement Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 147 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.5
16. Timers
Pulse Period Measurement Mode
In pulse period measurement mode, the pulse period of an external signal input to the INT1/TRAIO pin is
measured (refer to Table 16.6 Pulse Period Measurement Mode Specifications).
Figure 16.10 shows the TRAIOC Register in Pulse Period Measurement Mode and Figure 16.11 shows an
Operating Example of Pulse Period Measurement Mode.
Table 16.6
Pulse Period Measurement Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request
generation timing
Specification
f1, f2, f8, fOCO
• Decrement
• After the active edge of the measured pulse is input, the contents of the readout buffer are retained at the first underflow of timer RA prescaler. Then timer
RA reloads the contents in the reload register at the second underflow of
timer RA prescaler and continues counting.
1 (count start) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 0 (count stop) is written to TSTART bit in the TRACR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stops) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRACR register.
• When timer RA underflows or reloads [timer RA interrupt].
• Rising or falling of the TRAIO input (end of measurement period) [timer RA
interrupt]
INT1/TRAIO pin function Measured pulse input(1) (INT1 interrupt input)
Read from timer
The count value can be read by reading registers TRA and TRAPRE.
Write to timer
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written while the count is stopped,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRAPRE and TRA are written during the count, values are
written to the reload register and counter. (Refer to 16.1.1.1 Timer Write
Control during Count Operation.)
Select functions
• Measurement period select
The TEDGSEL bit in the TRAIOC register selects the measurement period
of the input pulse.
• Measured pulse input pin select function
P1_7 or P1_5 is selected by the TIOSEL bit in the TRAIOC register.
• Digital filter function
Bits TIPF0 and TIPF1 in the TRAIOC register enable or disable the digital
filter and select the sampling frequency.
NOTE:
1. Input a pulse with a period longer than twice the timer RA prescaler period. Input a pulse with a
longer “H” and “L” width than the timer RA prescaler period. If a pulse with a shorter period is input to
the TRAIO pin, the input may be ignored.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 148 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RA I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
TRAIOC
Bit Symbol
Address
0101h
Bit Name
TRAIO polarity sw itch bit
TEDGSEL
TOPCR
—
(b2)
TRAIO output control bit
Set to 0 in pulse period measurement mode.
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
_____
TIOSEL
TIPF0
0 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_7)
_____
1 : INT1/TRAIO pin (P1_5)
TRAIO input filter select
bits (1)
b5 b4
0 0 : No filter
0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling
1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling
1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
NOTE:
1. When the same value from the TRAIO pin is sampled three times continuously, the input is determined.
Figure 16.10
TRAIOC Register in Pulse Period Measurement Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 149 of 450
RW
RW
RW
RW
_____
INT1/TRAIO select bit
TIPF1
—
(b7-b6)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Measures measurement pulse from one
rising edge to next rising edge
1 : Measures measurement pulse from one
falling edge to next falling edge
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Underflow signal of
timer RA prescaler
Set to 1 by program
TSTART bit in
TRACR register
1
0
Starts counting
Measurement pulse
(TRAIO pin input)
1
0
TRA reloads
TRA reloads
0Fh 0Eh 0Dh 0Fh 0Eh 0Dh 0Ch 0Bh 0Ah 09h 0Fh 0Eh 0Dh
Contents of TRA
01h 00h 0Fh 0Eh
Underflow
Retained
Contents of read-out
buffer(1)
0Fh
Retained
0Dh
0Eh
0Bh 0Ah
09h
0Dh
01h 00h 0Fh 0Eh
TRA read(3)
(Note 2)
TEDGF bit in
TRACR register
(Note 2)
1
0
Set to 0 by program
(Note 4)
(Note 6)
TUNDF bit in
TRACR register
1
0
Set to 0 by program
IR bit in TRAIC
register
(Note 5)
1
0
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program
Conditions: The period from one rising edge to the next rising edge of the measured pulse is measured (TEDGSEL = 0) with
the default value of the TRA register as 0Fh.
NOTES:
1. The contents of the read-out buffer can be read by reading the TRA register in pulse period measurement mode.
2. After an active edge of the measured pulse is input, the TEDGF bit in the TRACR register is set to 1 (active edge found) when the timer
RA prescaler underflows for the second time.
3. The TRA register should be read before the next active edge is input after the TEDGF bit is set to 1 (active edge found).
The contents in the read-out buffer are retained until the TRA register is read. If the TRA register is not read before the next active edge
is input, the measured result of the previous period is retained.
4. To set to 0 by a program, use a MOV instruction to write 0 to the TEDGF bit in the TRACR register. At the same time, write 1 to the
TUNDF bit in the TRACR register.
5. To set to 0 by a program, use a MOV instruction to write 0 to the TUNDF bit. At the same time, write 1 to the TEDGF bit.
6. Bits TUNDF and TEDGF are both set to 1 if timer RA underflows and reloads on an active edge simultaneously.
Figure 16.11
Operating Example of Pulse Period Measurement Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 150 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.1.6
16. Timers
Notes on Timer RA
• Timer RA stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer RA and timer RA prescalers before the
count starts.
• Even if the prescaler and timer RA are read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by
the MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are
being read.
• In pulse period measurement mode, bits TEDGF and TUNDF in the TRACR register can be set to 0 by
writing 0 to these bits by a program. However, these bits remain unchanged if 1 is written. When using the
READ-MODIFY-WRITE instruction for the TRACR register, the TEDGF or TUNDF bit may be set to 0
although these bits are set to 1 while the instruction is being executed. In this case, write 1 to the TEDGF or
TUNDF bit which is not supposed to be set to 0 with the MOV instruction.
• When changing to pulse period measurement mode from another mode, the contents of bits TEDGF and
TUNDF are undefined. Write 0 to bits TEDGF and TUNDF before the count starts.
• The TEDGF bit may be set to 1 by the first timer RA prescaler underflow generated after the count starts.
• When using the pulse period measurement mode, leave two or more periods of the timer RA prescaler
immediately after the count starts, then set the TEDGF bit to 0.
• The TCSTF bit retains 0 (count stops) for 0 to 1 cycle of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 1
(count starts) while the count is stopped.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RA(1) other than the TCSTF bit. Timer RA
starts counting at the first valid edge of the count source after The TCSTF bit is set to 1 (during count).
The TCSTF bit remains 1 for 0 to 1 cycle of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 0 (count
stops) while the count is in progress. Timer RA counting is stopped when the TCSTF bit is set to 0.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RA(1) other than the TCSTF bit.
NOTE:
1. Registers associated with timer RA: TRACR, TRAIOC, TRAMR, TRAPRE, and TRA.
• When the TRAPRE register is continuously written during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow
three or more cycles of the count source clock for each write interval.
• When the TRA register is continuously written during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow three
or more cycles of the prescaler underflow for each write interval.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 151 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2
16. Timers
Timer RB
Timer RB is an 8-bit timer with an 8-bit prescaler.
The prescaler and timer each consist of a reload register and counter (refer to Tables 16.7 to 16.10 the
Specifications of Each Mode).
Timer RB has timer RB primary and timer RB secondary as reload registers.
The count source for timer RB is the operating clock that regulates the timing of timer operations such as counting
and reloading.
Figure 16.12 shows a Block Diagram of Timer RB. Figures 16.13 to 16.16 show the registers associated with timer
RB.
Timer RB has four operation modes listed as follows:
• Timer mode:
• Programmable waveform generation mode:
• Programmable one-shot generation mode:
• Programmable wait one-shot generation mode:
Reload
register
TCK1 to TCK0 bits
f1
f8
= 00b
Timer RA underflow
= 10b
= 11b
f2
The timer counts an internal count source (peripheral
function clock or timer RA underflows).
The timer outputs pulses of a given width successively.
The timer outputs a one-shot pulse.
The timer outputs a delayed one-shot pulse.
Data bus
TRBSC
register
Reload
register
TRBPR
register
Reload
register
TCKCUT bit
= 01b
Counter
TRBPRE register
(prescaler)
Timer RB interrupt
Counter (timer RB)
(Timer)
TMOD1 to TMOD0 bits
= 10b or 11b
TSTRAT bit
TOSSTF bit
INT0 interrupt
Digital filter
INT0 pin
Input polarity
selected to be one
edge or both edges
INT0PL bit
TMOD1 to TMOD0 bits
= 01b, 10b, 11b
INT0EN bit
Polarity
select
INOSEG bit
TOPL = 1
TOCNT = 0
TRBO pin
P3_1 bit in P3 register
TOCNT = 1
TSTART, TCSTF: Bits in TRBCR register
TOSSTF: Bit in TRBOCR register
TOPL, TOCNT, INOSTG, INOSEG: Bits in TRBIOC register
TMOD1 to TMOD0, TCK1 to TCK0, TCKCUT: Bits in TRBMR register
Figure 16.12
Block Diagram of Timer RB
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 152 of 450
INOSTG bit
TOPL = 0
Q
Toggle
flip-flop
Q
CLR
CK
TCSTF bit
TMOD1 to TMOD0 bits
= 01b, 10b, 11b
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Pin Select Register 2
b7
b0
Symbol
PINSR2
Set to “40h” w hen using Timer RB.
Do not set values other than “40h”.
When read, its content is undefined.
Figure 16.13
PINSR2 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 153 of 450
Address
00F6h
Function
After Reset
Undefined
RW
WO
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RB Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRBCR
Bit Symbol
TSTART
Address
0108h
Bit Name
Timer RB count start bit(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Count stops
1 : Count starts
RW
RW
TCSTF
Timer RB count status flag(1) 0 : Count stops
1 : During count(3)
RO
TSTOP
Timer RB count forcible stop When this bit is set to 1, the count is forcibly
bit(1, 2)
stopped. When read, its content is 0.
RW
—
(b7-b3)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
NOTES:
1. Refer to 16.2.5 Notes on Tim er RB for precautions regarding bits TSTART, TCSTF and TSTOP.
2. When the TSTOP bit is set to 1, registers TRBPRE, TRBSC, TRBPR, and bits TSTART and TCSTF, and the TOSSTF bit
in the TRBOCR register are set to values after a reset.
3. Indicates that count operation is in progress in timer mode or programmable w aveform mode. In programmable oneshot generation mode or programmable w ait one-shot generation mode, indicates that a one-shot pulse trigger has
been acknow ledged.
Timer RB One-Shot Control Register(2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRBOCR
Bit Symbol
TOSST
Address
0109h
Bit Name
Timer RB one-shot start bit
After Reset
00h
Function
When this bit is set to 1, one-shot trigger
generated. When read, its content is 0.
Timer RB one-shot stop bit
When this bit is set to 1, counting of one-shot
pulses (including programmable w ait one-shot
pulses) stops. When read, its content is 0.
RW
0 : One-shot stopped
1 : One-shot operating (Including w ait period)
RO
TOSSP
TOSSTF
Timer RB one-shot status
flag(1)
—
(b7-b3)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. When 1 is set to the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register, the TOSSTF bit is set to 0.
2. This register is enabled w hen bits TMOD1 to TMOD0 in the TRBMR register is set to 10b (programmable one-shot
generation mode) or 11b (programmable w ait one-shot generation mode).
Figure 16.14
Registers TRBCR and TRBOCR
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 154 of 450
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RB I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRBIOC
Bit Symbol
TOPL
TOCNT
INOSTG
Address
After Reset
010Ah
00h
Bit Name
Function
Timer RB output level select Function varies depending on operating mode.
bit
Timer RB output sw itch bit
RW
RW
RW
One-shot trigger control bit
RW
INOSEG
One-shot trigger polarity
select bit
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
Timer RB Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRBMR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
Address
010Bh
Bit Name
Timer RB operating mode
select bits (1)
TMOD1
—
(b2)
TWRC
TCK0
TCKCUT
RW
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Programmable w aveform generation mode
1 0 : Programmable one-shot generation mode
1 1 : Programmable w ait one-shot generation mode
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Timer RB w rite control bit(2)
0 : Write to reload register and counter
1 : Write to reload register only
Timer RB count source
select bits (1)
b5 b4
TCK1
—
(b6)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 0 : f1
0 1 : f8
1 0 : Timer RA underflow
1 1 : f2
RW
RW
—
RW
RW
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
Timer RB count source
cutoff bit(1)
RW
0 : Provides count source
1 : Cuts off count source
NOTES:
1. Change bits TMOD1 and TMOD0; TCK1 and TCK0; and TCKCUT w hen both the TSTART and TCSTF bits in the TRBCR
register set to 0 (count stops).
2. The TWRC bit can be set to either 0 or 1 in timer mode. In programmable w aveform generation mode, programmable
one-shot generation mode, or programmable w ait one-shot generation mode, the TWRC bit must be set to 1 (w rite to
reload register only).
Figure 16.15
Registers TRBIOC and TRBMR
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 155 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RB Prescaler Register(1)
b7
b0
Symbol
TRBPRE
Mode
Timer mode
Address
010Ch
Function
Counts an internal count source or timer RA
underflow s
After Reset
FFh
Setting Range
00h to FFh
Programmable w aveform
generation mode
00h to FFh
Programmable one-shot
generation mode
00h to FFh
Programmable w ait one-shot
generation mode
00h to FFh
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. When the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1, the TRBPRE register is set to FFh.
Timer RB Secondary Register(3, 4)
b7
b0
Symbol
TRBSC
Mode
Timer mode
Address
010Dh
Function
Disabled
After Reset
FFh
Setting Range
00h to FFh
Programmable w aveform
generation mode
Counts timer RB prescaler underflow s (1)
00h to FFh
Programmable one-shot
generation mode
Disabled
00h to FFh
Programmable w ait one-shot Counts timer RB prescaler underflow s
generation mode
(one-shot w idth is counted)
00h to FFh
RW
—
WO(2)
—
WO(2)
NOTES:
1. The values of registers TRBPR and TRBSC are reloaded to the counter alternately and counted.
2. The count value can be read out by reading the TRBPR register even w hen the secondary period is being counted.
3. When the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1, the TRBSC register is set to FFh.
4. To w rite to the TRBSC register, perform the follow ing steps.
(1) Write the value to the TRBSC register.
(2) Write the value to the TRBPR register. (If the value does not change, w rite the same value second time.)
Timer RB Primary Register(2)
b7
b0
Symbol
TRBPR
Mode
Timer mode
Address
010Eh
Function
Counts timer RB prescaler underflow s
After Reset
FFh
Setting Range
00h to FFh
Programmable w aveform
generation mode
Counts timer RB prescaler underflow s (1)
00h to FFh
Programmable one-shot
generation mode
Counts timer RB prescaler underflow s
(one-shot w idth is counted)
00h to FFh
Programmable w ait one-shot Counts timer RB prescaler underflow s
generation mode
(w ait period w idth is counted)
00h to FFh
NOTES:
1. The values of registers TRBPR and TRBSC are reloaded to the counter alternately and counted.
2. When the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1, the TRBPR register is set to FFh.
Figure 16.16
Registers TRBPRE, TRBSC, and TRBPR
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 156 of 450
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.1
16. Timers
Timer Mode
In timer mode, a count source which is internally generated or timer RA underflows are counted (refer to Table
16.7 Timer Mode Specifications). Registers TRBOCR and TRBSC are not used in timer mode.
Figure 16.17 shows the TRBIOC Register in Timer Mode.
Table 16.7
Timer Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Specification
Divide ratio
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request
generation timing
TRBO pin function
f1, f2, f8, timer RA underflow
• Decrement
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents before the
count continues (when timer RB underflows, the contents of timer RB primary
reload register is reloaded).
1/(n+1)(m+1)
n: setting value in TRBPRE register, m: setting value in TRBPR register
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register.
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stop) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register.
When timer RB underflows [timer RB interrupt].
Programmable I/O port
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
The count value can be read out by reading registers TRBPR and TRBPRE.
• When registers TRBPRE and TRBPR are written while the count is stopped,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRBPRE and TRBPR are written to while count operation is in
progress:
If the TWRC bit in the TRBMR register is set to 0, the value is written to both
the reload register and the counter.
If the TWRC bit is set to 1, the value is written to the reload register only.
(Refer to 16.2.1.1 Timer Write Control during Count Operation.)
Timer RB I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0
Symbol
TRBIOC
Bit Symbol
TOPL
TOCNT
INOSTG
Figure 16.17
Address
After Reset
010Ah
00h
Bit Name
Function
Timer RB output level select Set to 0 in timer mode.
bit
Timer RB output sw itch bit
One-shot trigger control bit
RW
RW
RW
INOSEG
One-shot trigger polarity
select bit
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
TRBIOC Register in Timer Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 157 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.1.1
16. Timers
Timer Write Control during Count Operation
Timer RB has a prescaler and a timer (which counts the prescaler underflows). The prescaler and timer each
consist of a reload register and a counter. In timer mode, the TWRC bit in the TRBMR register can be used to
select whether writing to the prescaler or timer during count operation is performed to both the reload register
and counter or only to the reload register.
However, values are transferred from the reload register to the counter of the prescaler in synchronization with
the count source. In addition, values are transferred from the reload register to the counter of the timer in
synchronization with prescaler underflows. Therefore, even if the TWRC bit is set for writing to both the reload
register and counter, the counter value is not updated immediately after the WRITE instruction is executed. In
addition, if the TWRC bit is set for writing to the reload register only, the synchronization of the writing will be
shifted if the prescaler value changes. Figure 16.18 shows an Operating Example of Timer RB when Counter
Value is Rewritten during Count Operation.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 158 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
When the TWRC bit is set to 0 (write to reload register and counter)
Set 01h to the TRBPRE register and 25h to
the TRBPR register by a program.
Count source
After writing, the reload register is
written with the first count source.
Reloads register of
timer RB prescaler
Previous value
Counter of
timer RB prescaler
06h
05h
New value (01h)
04h
Reload with
the second
count source
Reload on
underflow
01h
01h
00h
00h
01h
00h
01h
00h
After writing, the reload register is
written on the first underflow.
Reloads register of
timer RB
Previous value
New value (25h)
Reload on the second
underflow
Counter of timer RB
IR bit in TRBIC
register
03h
02h
25h
24h
0
The IR bit remains unchanged until underflow
is generated by a new value.
When the TWRC bit is set to 1 (write to reload register only)
Set 01h to the TRBPRE register and 25h to
the TRBPR register by a program.
Count source
After writing, the reload register is
written with the first count source.
Reloads register of
timer RB prescaler
Previous value
New value (01h)
Reload on
underflow
Counter of
timer RB prescaler
06h
05h
04h
03h
02h
01h
00h
01h
00h
01h
00h
01h
00h
01h
After writing, the reload register is
written on the first underflow.
Reloads register of
timer RB
Previous value
New value (25h)
Reload on
underflow
Counter of timer RB
IR bit in TRBIC
register
03h
02h
01h
00h
25h
0
Only the prescaler values are updated,
extending the duration until timer RB underflow.
The above applies under the following conditions.
Both bits TSTART and TCSTF in the TRBCR register are set to 1 (During count).
Figure 16.18
Operating Example of Timer RB when Counter Value is Rewritten during Count
Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 159 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.2
16. Timers
Programmable Waveform Generation Mode
In programmable waveform generation mode, the signal output from the TRBO pin is inverted each time the
counter underflows, while the values in registers TRBPR and TRBSC are counted alternately (refer to Table
16.8 Programmable Waveform Generation Mode Specifications). Counting starts by counting the setting
value in the TRBPR register. The TRBOCR register is unused in this mode.
Figure 16.19 shows the TRBIOC Register in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode. Figure 16.20 shows
an Operating Example of Timer RB in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode.
Table 16.8
Programmable Waveform Generation Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Width and period of
output waveform
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request
generation timing
TRBO pin function
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
Specification
f1, f2, f8, timer RA underflow
• Decrement
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the contents of the primary reload and secondary
reload registers alternately before the count continues.
Primary period: (n+1)(m+1)/fi
Secondary period: (n+1)(p+1)/fi
Period: (n+1){(m+1)+(p+1)}/fi
fi: Count source frequency
n: Value set in TRBPRE register
m: Value set in TRBPR register
p: Value set in TRBSC register
1 (count start) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register.
• 0 (count stop) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register.
• 1 (count forcibly stop) is written to the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register.
In half a cycle of the count source, after timer RB underflows during the secondary period
(at the same time as the TRBO output change) [timer RB interrupt]
Programmable output port or pulse output
Programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
The count value can be read out by reading registers TRBPR and TRBPRE(1).
• When registers TRBPRE, TRBSC, and TRBPR are written while the count is stopped,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRBPRE, TRBSC, and TRBPR are written to during count operation,
values are written to the reload registers only.(2)
• Output level select function
The TOPL bit in the TRBIOC register selects the output level during primary and
secondary periods.
• TRBO pin output switch function
Timer RB pulse output or P1_3 latch output is selected by the TOCNT bit in the TRBIOC
register.(3)
NOTES:
1. Even when counting the secondary period, the TRBPR register may be read.
2. The set values are reflected in the waveform output beginning with the following primary period after writing to
the TRBPR register.
3. The value written to the TOCNT bit is enabled by the following.
• When counting starts.
• When a timer RB interrupt request is generated.
The contents after the TOCNT bit is changed are reflected from the output of the following primary period.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 160 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RB I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
TRBIOC
Bit Symbol
TOPL
TOCNT
INOSTG
Figure 16.19
Address
010Ah
Bit Name
Timer RB output level select 0 : Outputs
bit
Outputs
Outputs
1 : Outputs
Outputs
Outputs
After Reset
00h
Function
“H” for primary period
“L” for secondary period
“L” w hen the timer is stopped
“L” for primary period
“H” for secondary period
“H” w hen the timer is stopped
RW
Timer RB output sw itch bit
0 : Outputs timer RB w aveform
1 : Outputs value in P1_3 port register
RW
One-shot trigger control bit
Set to 0 in programmable w aveform generation
mode.
RW
INOSEG
One-shot trigger polarity
select bit
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
TRBIOC Register in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 161 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Set to 1 by program
TSTART bit in TRBCR
register
1
0
Count source
Timer RB prescaler
underflow signal
Timer RB secondary reloads
01h
Counter of timer RB
00h
02h
01h
Timer RB primary reloads
00h
01h
00h
02h
Set to 0 when interrupt
request is acknowledged,
or set by program.
IR bit in TRBIC
register
1
0
Set to 0 by program
TOPL bit in TRBIO
register
1
0
Waveform
output starts
Waveform output inverted
Waveform output starts
1
TRBO pin output
0
Initial output is the same level
as during secondary period.
Primary period
Secondary period
Primary period
The above applies under the following conditions.
TRBPRE = 01h, TRBPR = 01h, TRBSC = 02h
TRBIOC register TOCNT = 0 (timer RB waveform is output from the TRBO pin)
Figure 16.20
Operating Example of Timer RB in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 162 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.3
16. Timers
Programmable One-shot Generation Mode
In programmable one-shot generation mode, a one-shot pulse is output from the TRBO pin by a program or an
external trigger input (input to the INT0 pin) (refer to Table 16.9 Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode
Specifications). When a trigger is generated, the timer starts operating from the point only once for a given
period equal to the set value in the TRBPR register. The TRBSC register is not used in this mode.
Figure 16.21 shows the TRBIOC Register in Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode. Figure 16.22 shows
an Operating Example of Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode.
Table 16.9
Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Specification
f1, f2, f8, timer RA underflow
• Decrement the setting value in the TRBPR register
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the contents of the reload register before
the count completes and the TOSSTF bit is set to 0 (one-shot stops).
• When the count stops, the timer reloads the contents of the reload register
before it stops.
One-shot pulse
(n+1)(m+1)/fi
output time
fi: Count source frequency,
n: Setting value in TRBPRE register, m: Setting value in TRBPR register(2)
Count start conditions • The TSTART bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 (count starts) and the next
trigger is generated
• Set the TOSST bit in the TRBOCR register to 1 (one-shot starts)
• Input trigger to the INT0 pin
Count stop conditions • When reloading completes after timer RB underflows during primary period
• When the TOSSP bit in the TRBOCR register is set to 1 (one-shot stops)
• When the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register is set to 0 (stops counting)
• When the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 (forcibly stops counting)
Interrupt request
In half a cycle of the count source, after the timer underflows (at the same time as
generation timing
the TRBO output ends) [timer RB interrupt]
TRBP pin function
Pulse output
INT0 pin functions
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
• When the INOSTG bit in the TRBIOC register is set to 0 (INT0 one-shot trigger
disabled): programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
• When the INOSTG bit in the TRBIOC register is set to 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger
enabled): external trigger (INT0 interrupt input)
The count value can be read out by reading registers TRBPR and TRBPRE.
• When registers TRBPRE and TRBPR are written while the count is stopped,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRBPRE and TRBPR are written during the count, values are
written to the reload register only (the data is transferred to the counter at the
following reload)(1).
• Output level select function
The TOPL bit in the TRBIOC register selects the output level of the one-shot
pulse waveform.
• One-shot trigger select function
Refer to 16.2.3.1 One-Shot Trigger Selection.
NOTES:
1. The set value is reflected at the following one-shot pulse after writing to the TRBPR register.
2. Do not set both the TRBPRE and TRBPR registers to 00h.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 163 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RB I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
TRBIOC
Bit Symbol
TOPL
TOCNT
Address
010Ah
Bit Name
Timer RB Output Level
Select Bit
Timer RB Output Sw itch Bit
0 : Outputs
Outputs
1 : Outputs
Outputs
After Reset
00h
Function
one-shot pulse “H”
“L” w hen the timer is stopped
one-shot pulse “L”
“H” w hen the timer is stopped
Set to 0 in programmable one-shot generation
mode.
INOSTG
One-Shot Trigger Control
Bit(1)
INOSEG
One-Shot Trigger Polarity
Select Bit(1)
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. if necessary, set to 0.
When read, its content is 0.
0 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled
_____
1 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled
0 : Falling edge trigger
1 : Rising edge trigger
TRBIOC Register in Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 164 of 450
RW
RW
_____
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.2.3.1 One-Shot Trigger Selection.
Figure 16.21
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Set to 1 by program
TSTART bit in TRBCR
register
1
0
Set to 0 when
counting ends
Set to 1 by program
TOSSTF bit in TRBOCR
register
Set to 1 by INT0 pin
input trigger
1
0
INT0 pin input
Count source
Timer RB prescaler
underflow signal
Count starts
01h
Counter of timer RB
Timer RB primary reloads
00h
Count starts
01h
Timer RB primary reloads
00h
01h
Set to 0 when interrupt request is
acknowledged, or set by program
IR bit in TRBIC
register
1
0
Set to 0 by program
TOPL bit in
TRBIOC register
1
0
Waveform output starts
Waveform output ends
Waveform output starts
1
TRBIO pin output
0
The above applies under the following conditions.
TRBPRE = 01h, TRBPR = 01h
TRBIOC register TOPL = 0, TOCNT = 0
INOSTG = 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled)
INOSEG = 1 (edge trigger at rising edge)
Figure 16.22
Operating Example of Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 165 of 450
Waveform output ends
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.3.1
16. Timers
One-Shot Trigger Selection
In programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, operation starts
when a one-shot trigger is generated while the TCSTF bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 (count starts).
A one-shot trigger can be generated by either of the following causes:
• 1 is written to the TOSST bit in the TRBOCR register by a program.
• Trigger input from the INT0 pin.
When a one-shot trigger occurs, the TOSSTF bit in the TRBOCR register is set to 1 (one-shot operation in
progress) after one or two cycles of the count source have elapsed. Then, in programmable one-shot generation
mode, count operation begins and one-shot waveform output starts. (In programmable wait one-shot generation
mode, count operation starts for the wait period.) If a one-shot trigger occurs while the TOSSTF bit is set to 1,
no retriggering occurs.
To use trigger input from the INT0 pin, input the trigger after making the following settings:
• Set the PD4_5 bit in the PD4 register to 0 (input port).
• Select the INT0 digital filter with bits INT0F1 and INT0F0 in the INTF register.
• Select both edges or one edge with the INT0PL bit in INTEN register. If one edge is selected, further select
falling or rising edge with the INOSEG bit in TRBIOC register.
• Set the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register to 0 (enabled).
• After completing the above, set the INOSTG bit in the TRBIOC register to 1 (INT pin one-shot trigger
enabled).
Note the following points with regard to generating interrupt requests by trigger input from the INT0 pin.
• Processing to handle the interrupts is required. Refer to 12. Interrupts, for details.
• If one edge is selected, use the POL bit in the INT0IC register to select falling or rising edge. (The
INOSEG bit in the TRBIOC register does not affect INT0 interrupts).
• If a one-shot trigger occurs while the TOSSTF bit is set to 1, timer RB operation is not affected, but the
value of the IR bit in the INT0IC register changes.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 166 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.4
16. Timers
Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode
In programmable wait one-shot generation mode, a one-shot pulse is output from the TRBO pin by a program
or an external trigger input (input to the INT0 pin) (refer to Table 16.10 Programmable Wait One-Shot
Generation Mode Specifications). When a trigger is generated from that point, the timer outputs a pulse only
once for a given length of time equal to the setting value in the TRBSC register after waiting for a given length
of time equal to the setting value in the TRBPR register.
Figure 16.23 shows the TRBIOC Register in Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode. Figure 16.24
shows an Operating Example of Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode.
Table 16.10
Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Count operations
Wait time
One-shot pulse output time
Count start conditions
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request generation
timing
TRBO pin function
INT0 pin functions
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
Specification
f1, f2, f8, timer RA underflow
• Decrement the timer RB primary setting value.
• When a count of the timer RB primary underflows, the timer reloads the contents of
timer RB secondary before the count continues.
• When a count of the timer RB secondary underflows, the timer reloads the contents
of timer RB primary before the count completes and the TOSSTF bit is set to 0
(one-shot stops).
• When the count stops, the timer reloads the contents of the reload register before it
stops.
(n+1)(m+1)/fi
fi: Count source frequency
n: Value set in the TRBPRE register, m Value set in the TRBPR register(2)
(n+1)(p+1)/fi
fi: Count source frequency
n: Value set in the TRBPRE register, p: Value set in the TRBSC register
• The TSTART bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 (count starts) and the next trigger
is generated.
• Set the TOSST bit in the TRBOCR register to 1 (one-shot starts).
• Input trigger to the INT0 pin
• When reloading completes after timer RB underflows during secondary period.
• When the TOSSP bit in the TRBOCR register is set to 1 (one-shot stops).
• When the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register is set to 0 (starts counting).
• When the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 (forcibly stops counting).
In half a cycle of the count source after timer RB underflows during secondary period
(complete at the same time as waveform output from the TRBO pin) [timer RB
interrupt].
Pulse output
• When the INOSTG bit in the TRBIOC register is set to 0 (INT0 one-shot trigger
disabled): programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
• When the INOSTG bit in the TRBIOC register is set to 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger
enabled): external trigger (INT0 interrupt input)
The count value can be read out by reading registers TRBPR and TRBPRE.
• When registers TRBPRE, TRBSC, and TRBPR are written while the count stops,
values are written to both the reload register and counter.
• When registers TRBPRE, TRBSC, and TRBPR are written to during count
operation, values are written to the reload registers only.(1)
• Output level select function
The TOPL bit in the TRBIOC register selects the output level of the one-shot pulse
waveform.
• One-shot trigger select function
Refer to 16.2.3.1 One-Shot Trigger Selection.
NOTES:
1. The set value is reflected at the following one-shot pulse after writing to registers TRBSC and TRBPR.
2. Do not set both the TRBPRE and TRBPR registers to 00h.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 167 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RB I/O Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
TRBIOC
Bit Symbol
TOPL
TOCNT
Address
010Ah
Bit Name
Timer RB output level select 0 : Outputs
bit
Outputs
w ait.
1 : Outputs
Outputs
w ait.
Timer RB output sw itch bit
one-shot pulse “L”.
“H” w hen the timer stops or during
Set to 0 in programmable w ait one-shot generation
mode.
(1)
INOSTG
After Reset
00h
Function
one-shot pulse “H”.
“L” w hen the timer stops or during
One-shot trigger control bit
0 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled
_____
1 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled
0 : Falling edge trigger
1 : Rising edge trigger
INOSEG
One-shot trigger polarity
select bit(1)
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
TRBIOC Register in Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 168 of 450
RW
RW
_____
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.2.3.1 One-Shot Trigger Selection.
Figure 16.23
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Set to 1 by program
TSTART bit in TRBCR
register
1
0
Set to 1 by setting 1 to TOSST bit in TRBOCR
register, or INT0 pin input trigger.
TOSSTF bit in TRBOCR
register
Set to 0 when
counting ends
1
0
INT0 pin input
Count source
Timer RB prescaler
underflow signal
Count starts
Counter of timer RB
01h
Timer RB secondary reloads
00h
04h
Timer RB primary reloads
03h
02h
01h
00h
01h
Set to 0 when interrupt request is
acknowledged, or set by program.
IR bit in TRBIC
register
1
TOPL bit in
TRBIOC register
1
0
Set to 0 by program
0
Wait starts
Waveform output starts
Waveform output ends
1
TRBIO pin output
0
Wait
(primary period)
One-shot pulse
(secondary period)
The above applies under the following conditions.
TRBPRE = 01h, TRBPR = 01h, TRBSC = 04h
INOSTG = 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled)
INOSEG = 1 (edge trigger at rising edge)
Figure 16.24
Operating Example of Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 169 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.5
16. Timers
Notes on Timer RB
• Timer RB stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer RB and timer RB prescalers before the
count starts.
• Even if the prescaler and timer RB is read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the
MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being
read.
• In programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, when
setting the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register to 0, 0 (stops counting) or setting the TOSSP bit in the
TRBOCR register to 1 (stops one-shot), the timer reloads the value of reload register and stops. Therefore,
in programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, read the
timer count value before the timer stops.
• The TCSTF bit remains 0 (count stops) for 1 to 2 cycles of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to
1 (count starts) while the count is stopped.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RB(1) other than the TCSTF bit. Timer RB
starts counting at the first valid edge of the count source after the TCSTF bit is set to 1 (during count).
The TCSTF bit remains 1 for 1 to 2 cycles of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 0 (count
stops) while the count is in progress. Timer RB counting is stopped when the TCSTF bit is set to 0.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RB(1) other than the TCSTF bit.
NOTE:
1. Registers associated with timer RB: TRBCR, TRBOCR, TRBIOC, TRBMR, TRBPRE, TRBSC,
and TRBPR.
• If the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 during timer operation, timer RB stops immediately.
• If 1 is written to the TOSST or TOSSP bit in the TRBOCR register, the value of the TOSSTF bit changes
after one or two cycles of the count source have elapsed. If the TOSSP bit is written to 1 during the period
between when the TOSST bit is written to 1 and when the TOSSTF bit is set to 1, the TOSSTF bit may be
set to either 0 or 1 depending on the content state. Likewise, if the TOSST bit is written to 1 during the
period between when the TOSSP bit is written to 1 and when the TOSSTF bit is set to 0, the TOSSTF bit
may be set to either 0 or 1.
16.2.5.1
Timer mode
The following workaround should be performed in timer mode.
To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the following
points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the count source for each
write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow
for each write interval.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 170 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.5.2
16. Timers
Programmable waveform generation mode
The following three workarounds should be performed in programmable waveform generation mode.
(1) To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the
following points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the count source for each
write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow
for each write interval.
(2) To change registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), synchronize
the TRBO output cycle using a timer RB interrupt, etc. This operation should be preformed only once in
the same output cycle. Also, make sure that writing to the TRBPR register does not occur during period
A shown in Figures 16.25 and 16.26.
The following shows the detailed workaround examples.
• Workaround example (a):
As shown in Figure 16.25, write to registers TRBSC and TRBPR in the timer RB interrupt routine. These
write operations must be completed by the beginning of period A.
Period A
Count source/
prescaler
underflow signal
TRBO pin output
IR bit in
TRBIC register
Primary period
(a)
Interrupt request is
acknowledged
Secondary period
Ensure sufficient time
(b)
Interrupt request
is generated
Instruction in
Interrupt
sequence interrupt routine
Set the secondary and then
the primary register immediately
(a) Period between interrupt request generation and the completion of execution of an instruction. The length of time
varies depending on the instruction being executed.
The DIVX instruction requires the longest time, 30 cycles (assuming no wait states and that a register is set as
the divisor).
(b) 20 cycles. 21 cycles for address match and single-step interrupts.
Figure 16.25
Workaround Example (a) When Timer RB interrupt is Used
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 171 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
• Workaround example (b):
As shown in Figure 16.26 detect the start of the primary period by the TRBO pin output level and write to
registers TRBSC and TRBPR. These write operations must be completed by the beginning of period A.
If the port register’s bit value is read after the port direction register’s bit corresponding to the TRBO pin is
set to 0 (input mode), the read value indicates the TRBO pin output value.
Period A
Count source/
prescaler
underflow signal
TRBO pin output
Read value of the port register’s
bit corresponding to the TRBO pin
(when the bit in the port direction
register is set to 0)
Secondary period
Primary period
(i) (ii) (iii)
Ensure sufficient time
The TRBO output inversion
is detected at the end of the
secondary period.
Figure 16.26
Upon detecting (i), set the secondary and
then the primary register immediately.
Workaround Example (b) When TRBO Pin Output Value is Read
(3) To stop the timer counting in the primary period, use the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register. In this case,
registers TRBPRE and TRBPR are initialized and their values are set to the values after reset.
16.2.5.3
Programmable one-shot generation mode
The following two workarounds should be performed in programmable one-shot generation mode.
(1) To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the
following points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow
three or more cycles of the count source for each write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow
three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow for each write interval.
(2) Do not set both the TRBPRE and TRBPR registers to 00h.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 172 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.2.5.4
16. Timers
Programmable wait one-shot generation mode
The following three workarounds should be performed in programmable wait one-shot generation mode.
(1) To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the
following points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the count source for each
write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow
for each write interval.
(2) Do not set both the TRBPRE and TRBPR registers to 00h.
(3) Set registers TRBSC and TRBPR using the following procedure.
(a) To use “INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled” as the count start condition
Set the TRBSC register and then the TRBPR register. At this time, after writing to the TRBPR
register, allow an interval of 0.5 or more cycles of the count source before trigger input from the
INT0 pin.
(b) To use “writing 1 to TOSST bit” as the start condition
Set the TRBSC register, the TRBPR register, and then TOSST bit. At this time, after writing to the
TRBPR register, allow an interval of 0.5 or more cycles of the count source before writing to the
TOSST bit.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 173 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3
16. Timers
Timer RC
16.3.1
Overview
Timer RC is a 16-bit timer with four I/O pins.
Timer RC uses either f1 or fOCO40M as its operation clock. Table 16.11 lists the Timer RC Operation Clock.
Table 16.11
Timer RC Operation Clock
Condition
Timer RC Operation Clock
Count source is f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, or TRCCLK input (bits TCK2 to TCK0 in f1
TRCCR1 register are set to a value from 000b to 101b)
Count source is fOCO40M (bits TCK2 to TCK0 in TRCCR1 register are set fOCO40M
to 110b)
Table 16.12 lists the Timer RC I/O Pins, and Figure 16.27 shows a Timer RC Block Diagram.
Timer RC has three modes.
• Timer mode
- Input capture function
The counter value is captured to a register, using an external signal as the trigger.
- Output compare function Matches between the counter and register values are detected. (Pin output state
changes when a match is detected.)
The following two modes use the output compare function.
• PWM mode
Pulses of a given width are output continuously.
• PWM2 mode
A one-shot waveform or PWM waveform is output following the trigger after
the wait time has elapsed.
Input capture function, output compare function, and PWM mode settings may be specified independently for
each pin.
In PWM2 mode waveforms are output based on a combination of the counter or the register.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 174 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32,
fOCO40M
TRCMR register
TRCCR1 register
TRCIER register
INT0
Count source
select circuit
TRCSR register
TRCIOR0 register
TRCIOA/TRCTRG
TRCIOR1 register
Data bus
TRCCLK
TRCIOB
Timer RC control circuit
TRC register
TRCGRA register
TRCIOC
TRCIOD
TRCGRB register
TRCGRC register
TRCGRD register
TRCCR2 register
TRCDF register
Timer RC interrupt
request
TRCOER register
Figure 16.27
Table 16.12
Timer RC Block Diagram
Timer RC I/O Pins
Pin Name
TRCIOA(P1_1)
TRCIOB(P1_2)
TRCIOC(P3_4)
TRCIOD(P3_5)
TRCCLK(P3_3)
TRCTRG(P1_1)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
I/O
I/O
Function
Function differs according to the mode. Refer to descriptions of
individual modes for details
Input
Input
External clock input
PWM2 mode external trigger input
Page 175 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.2
16. Timers
Registers Associated with Timer RC
Table 16.13 lists the Registers Associated with Timer RC. Figures 16.28 to 16.38 show details of the registers
associated with timer RC.
Table 16.13
Registers Associated with Timer RC
00F7h
PINSR3
Mode
Timer
Input
Output
PWM
Capture Compare
Function Function
Valid
Valid
Valid
0120h
TRCMR
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
0121h
TRCCR1
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
0122h
TRCIER
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
0123h
TRCSR
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
0124h
TRCIOR0 Valid
Valid
−
−
0125h
TRCIOR1
0126h
0127h
0128h
0129h
012Ah
012Bh
012Ch
012Dh
012Eh
012Fh
0130h
TRC
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
TRCGRA
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
TRCCR2
−
−
−
Valid
0131h
TRCDF
Valid
−
−
Valid
0132h
TRCOER
−
Valid
Valid
Valid
Address
Symbol
PWM2
Valid
TRCGRB
Related Information
Pin Select Register 3
Figure 16.28 PINSR3 Register
Timer RC mode register
Figure 16.29 TRCMR Register
Timer RC control register 1
Figure 16.30 TRCCR1 Register
Figure 16.51 TRCCR1 Register for Output
Compare Function
Figure 16.54 TRCCR1 Register in PWM Mode
Figure 16.58 TRCCR1 Register in PWM2 Mode
Timer RC interrupt enable register
Figure 16.31 TRCIER Register
Timer RC status register
Figure 16.32 TRCSR Register
Timer RC I/O control register 0, timer RC I/O
control register 1
Figure 16.38 Registers TRCIOR0 and TRCIOR1
Figure 16.45 TRCIOR0 Register for Input
Capture Function
Figure 16.46 TRCIOR1 Register for Input
Capture Function
Figure 16.49 TRCIOR0 Register for Output
Compare Function
Figure 16.50 TRCIOR1 Register for Output
Compare Function
Timer RC counter
Figure 16.33 TRC Register
Timer RC general registers A, B, C, and D
Figure 16.34 Registers TRCGRA, TRCGRB,
TRCGRC, and TRCGRD
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
− : Invalid
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 176 of 450
Timer RC control register 2
Figure 16.35 TRCCR2 Register
Timer RC digital filter function select register
Figure 16.36 TRCDF Register
Timer RC output mask enable register
Figure 16.37 TRCOER Register
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Pin Select Register 3
b7
b0
Symbol
PINSR3
Address
00F7h
Function
After Reset
Undefined
RW
Set to “1Fh” w hen using Timer RC.
Do not set values other than “1Fh”.
When read, its content is undefined.
Figure 16.28
WO
PINSR3 Register
Timer RC Mode Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCMR
Bit Symbol
Address
0120h
Bit Name
PWM mode of TRCIOB select bit(2)
After Reset
01001000b
Function
RW
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
PWM mode of TRCIOD select bit
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
PWM2 mode select bit
0 : PWM 2 mode
1 : Timer mode or PWM mode
RW
BFC
TRCGRC register function select
bit(3)
0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRCGRA register
RW
BFD
TRCGRD register function select
bit
0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRCGRB register
RW
—
(b6)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
PWMB
(2)
PWMC
PWM mode of TRCIOC select bit
(2)
PWMD
PWM2
TSTART
TRC count start bit
0 : Count stops
1 : Count starts
NOTES:
1. For notes on PWM2 mode, refer to 16.3.9.5 TRCMR Register in PWM2 Mode.
2. These bits are enabled w hen the PWM2 bit is set to 1 (timer mode or PWM mode).
3. Set the BFC bit to 0 (general register) in PWM2 mode.
Figure 16.29
TRCMR Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
Page 177 of 450
—
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCCR1
Bit Symbol
TOA
Address
0121h
Bit Name
TRCIOA output level select bit(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
Function varies according to the
operating mode (function).(2)
RW
RW
(1)
TOB
TRCIOB output level select bit
RW
(1)
TOC
TRCIOC output level select bit
RW
(1)
TOD
TRCIOD output level select bit
Count source select bits
(1)
RW
b6 b5 b4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
TCK1
TCK2
TRC counter clear select bit(2, 3)
CCLR
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRCCLK input rising edge
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
0 : Disable clear (free-running
operation)
1 : Clear by compare match in the
TRCGRA register
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set to these bits w hen the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is set to 0 (count stops).
2. Bits CCLR, TOA, TOB, TOC and TOD are disabled for the input capture function of the timer mode.
3. The TRC counter performs free-running operation for the input capture function of the timer mode independent of the
CCLR bit setting.
Figure 16.30
TRCCR1 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 178 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Interrupt Enable Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCIER
Bit Symbol
IMIEA
IMIEB
IMIEC
IMIED
—
(b6-b4)
Address
0122h
Bit Name
Input capture / compare match
interrupt enable bit A
After Reset
01110000b
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
Input capture / compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
RW
Input capture / compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
RW
Input capture / compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
Overflow interrupt enable bit
OVIE
Figure 16.31
TRCIER Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 179 of 450
0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF bit
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF bit
RW
RW
—
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Status Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCSR
Bit Symbol
IMFA
Address
0123h
Bit Name
Input capture / compare match flag
A
After Reset
01110000b
Function
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
Refer to the table below .
Input capture / compare match flag
B
IMFC
Input capture / compare match flag
C
RW
IMFD
Input capture / compare match flag
D
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
Overflow flag
OVF
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
Refer to the table below .
NOTE:
1. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit. (This bit remains 1
even if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0.)
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten to it.
IMFA
IMFB
IMFC
IMFD
OVF
Timer Mode
PWM Mode
PWM2 Mode
Input capture Function
Output Compare
Function
When the values of the registers TRC and TRCGRA match.
TRCIOA pin input edge(1)
TRCIOB pin input edge(1)
When the values of the registers TRC and TRCGRB match.
TRCIOC pin input edge(1)
When the values of the registers TRC and TRCGRC
match.(2)
TRCIOD pin input edge(1)
When the values of the registers TRC and TRCGRD
match.(2)
When the TRC register overflow s.
NOTES:
1. Edge selected by bits IOj1 to IOj0 (j = A, B, C, or D).
2. Includes the condition that bits BFC and BFD are set to 1 (buffer registers of registers TRCGRA
and TRCGRB).
Figure 16.32
TRCSR Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
IMFB
—
(b6-b4)
Bit Symbol
RW
Page 180 of 450
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Counter(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRC
Address
0127h-0126h
Function
After Reset
0000h
Setting Range
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRCSR register is set to 1.
RW
0000h to FFFFh
RW
NOTE:
1. Access the TRC register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.33
TRC Register
Timer RC General Register A, B, C and D(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRCGRA
TRCGRB
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
Address
0129h-0128h
012Bh-012Ah
012Dh-012Ch
012Fh-012Eh
Function
Function varies according to the operating mode.
NOTE:
1. Access registers TRCGRA to TRCGRD in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.34
Registers TRCGRA, TRCGRB, TRCGRC, and TRCGRD
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 181 of 450
After Reset
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Control Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
TRCCR2
0130h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b4-b0)
When read, the content is 1.
CSEL
After Reset
00011111b
Function
TRC count operation select
bit(1, 2)
0 : Count continues at compare match w ith
the TRCGRA register
1 : Count stops at compare match w ith
the TRCGRA register
TRCTRG input edge select bits (3)
b7 b6
TCEG0
TCEG1
0 0 : Disable the trigger input from the
TRCTRG pin
0 1 : Rising edge selected
1 0 : Falling edge selected
1 1 : Both edges selected
RW
—
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. For notes on PWM2 mode, refer to 16.3.9.5 TRCMR Register in PWM2 Mode.
2. In timer mode and PWM mode this bit is disabled (the count operation continues independent of the CSEL bit setting).
3. In timer mode and PWM mode these bits are disabled.
Figure 16.35
TRCCR2 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 182 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Digital Filter Function Select Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCDF
Bit Symbol
DFA
Address
0131h
Bit Name
TRCIOA pin digital filter function
select bit(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Function is not used
1 : Function is used
RW
RW
DFB
TRCIOB pin digital filter function
select bit(1)
RW
DFC
TRCIOC pin digital filter function
select bit(1)
RW
DFD
TRCIOD pin digital filter function
select bit(1)
RW
DFTRG
TRCTRG pin digital filter function
select bit(2)
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
—
(b5)
DFCK0
Clock select bits for digital filter
function(1, 2)
DFCK1
b7 b6
0
0
1
1
0 : f32
1 : f8
0 : f1
1 : Count source (clock selected by
bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the
TRCCR1 register)
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. These bits are enabled for the input capture function.
2. These bits are enabled w hen in PWM2 mode and bits TCEG1 to TCEG0 in the TRCCR2 register are set to 01b, 10b, or
11b (TRCTRG trigger input enabled).
Figure 16.36
TRCDF Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 183 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Output Master Enable Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCOER
Bit Symbol
Address
0132h
Bit Name
TRCIOA output disable bit(1)
EA
TRCIOB output disable bit(1)
EB
TRCIOC output disable bit(1)
EC
TRCIOD output disable bit(1)
ED
—
(b6-b4)
After Reset
01111111b
Function
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRCIOA pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRCIOB pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRCIOC pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRCIOD pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
_____
PTO
INT0 of pulse output forced
cutoff signal input enabled
bit
0 : Pulse output forced cutoff input disabled
1 : Pulse output forced cutoff input enabled
(Bits EA, EB, EC, and ED are set to 1
(disable output) w hen “L” is applied to the
_____
INT0 pin)
NOTE:
1. These bits are disabled for input pins set to the input capture function.
Figure 16.37
TRCOER Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 184 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC I/O Control Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
TRCIOR0
0124h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
IOA0
TRCGRA control bits
IOA1
TRCGRA mode select bit(2)
IOA2
IOA3
IOB0
IOB1
IOB2
—
(b7)
After Reset
10001000b
Function
Function varies according to the operating mode
(function).
RW
RW
RW
0 : Output compare function
1 : Input capture function
RW
TRCGRA input capture input
sw itch bit(4)
0 : fOCO128 signal
1 : TRCIOA pin input
RW
TRCGRB control bits
Function varies according to the operating mode
(function).
RW
RW
TRCGRB mode select bit(3)
0 : Output compare function
1 : Input capture function
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
NOTES:
1. The TRCIOR0 register is enabled in timer mode. It is disabled in modes PWM and PWM2.
2. When the BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRA register), set the IOC2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
3. When the BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRB register), set the IOD2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
4. The IOA3 bit is enabled w hen the IOA2 bit is set to 1 (input capture function).
Timer RC I/O Control Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
TRCIOR1
0125h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
IOC0
TRCGRC control bits
IOC1
TRCGRC mode select bit(2)
IOC2
After Reset
10001000b
Function
Function varies according to the operating mode
(function).
0 : Output compare function
1 : Input capture function
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
IOD0
IOD1
TRCGRD control bits
Function varies according to the operating mode
(function).
RW
RW
TRCGRD mode select bit(3)
0 : Output compare function
1 : Input capture function
RW
—
(b7)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. The TRCIOR1 register is enabled in timer mode. It is disabled in modes PWM and PWM2.
2. When the BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRA register), set the IOC2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
3. When the BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRB register), set the IOD2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
Registers TRCIOR0 and TRCIOR1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
—
(b3)
IOD2
Figure 16.38
RW
RW
RW
Page 185 of 450
—
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.3
16. Timers
Common Items for Multiple Modes
16.3.3.1
Count Source
The method of selecting the count source is common to all modes.
Table 16.14 lists the Count Source Selection, and Figure 16.39 shows a Count Source Block Diagram.
Table 16.14
Count Source Selection
Count Source
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32
fOCO40M
Selection Method
Count source selected using bits TCK2 to TCK0 in TRCCR1 register
FRA00 bit in FRA0 register set to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on) and bits
TCK2 to TCK0 in TRCCR1 register are set to 110b (fOCO40M)
External signal input Bits TCK2 to TCK0 in TRCCR1 register are set to 101b (count source is rising edge
to TRCCLK pin
of external clock) and PD5_0 bit in PD5 register is set to 0 (input mode)
TCK2 to TCK0
f1
= 000b
= 001b
f2
= 010b
f4
Count source
= 011b
f8
TRC register
= 100b
f32
= 101b
TRCCLK
= 110b
fOCO40M
TCK2 to TCK0: Bits in TRCCR1 register
Figure 16.39
Count Source Block Diagram
The pulse width of the external clock input to the TRCCLK pin should be three cycles or more of the timer RC
operation clock (see Table 16.11 Timer RC Operation Clock).
To select fOCO40M as the count source, set the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register set to 1 (high-speed on-chip
oscillator on), and then set bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRCCR1 register to 110b (fOCO40M).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 186 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.3.2
16. Timers
Buffer Operation
Bits BFC and BFD in the TRCMR register are used to select the TRCGRC or TRCGRD register as the buffer
register for the TRCGRA or TRCGRB register.
• Buffer register for TRCGRA register: TRCGRC register
• Buffer register for TRCGRB register: TRCGRD register
Buffer operation differs depending on the mode.
Table 16.15 lists the Buffer Operation in Each Mode, Figure 16.40 shows the Buffer Operation for Input
Capture Function, and Figure 16.41 shows the Buffer Operation for Output Compare Function.
Table 16.15
Buffer Operation in Each Mode
Function, Mode
Input capture function
Transfer Timing
Input capture signal input
Transfer Destination Register
Contents of TRCGRA (TRCGRB)
register are transferred to buffer
register
Contents of buffer register are
transferred to TRCGRA (TRCGRB)
register
Contents of buffer register (TRCGRD)
are transferred to TRCGRB register
Output compare function Compare match between TRC
register and TRCGRA (TRCGRB)
PWM mode
register
PWM2 mode
• Compare match between TRC
register and TRCGRA register
• TRCTRG pin trigger input
TRCIOA input
(input capture signal)
TRCGRC
register
TRCGRA
register
TRC
TRCIOA input
TRC register
n
n-1
n+1
Transfer
TRCGRA register
m
n
Transfer
TRCGRC register
(buffer)
m
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (the TRCGRC register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRA register).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRCIOR0 register are set to 100b (input capture at the rising edge).
Figure 16.40
Buffer Operation for Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 187 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Compare match signal
TRCGRC
register
TRC register
TRCGRA register
TRCGRA
register
Comparator
m
m-1
TRC
m+1
m
n
Transfer
TRCGRC register
(buffer)
n
TRCIOA output
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (the TRCGRC register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRA register).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRCIOR0 register are set to 001b (“L” output at compare match).
Figure 16.41
Buffer Operation for Output Compare Function
Make the following settings in timer mode.
• To use the TRCGRC register as the buffer register for the TRCGRA register:
Set the IOC2 bit in the TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
• To use the TRCGRD register as the buffer register for the TRCGRB register:
Set the IOD2 bit in the TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
The output compare function, PWM mode, or PWM2 mode, and the TRCGRC or TRCGRD register is
functioning as a buffer register, the IMFC bit or IMFD bit in the TRCSR register is set to 1 when a compare
match with the TRC register occurs.
The input capture function and the TRCGRC register or TRCGRD register is functioning as a buffer register,
the IMFC bit or IMFD bit in the TRCSR register is set to 1 at the input edge of a signal input to the TRCIOC pin
or TRCIOD pin.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 188 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.3.3
16. Timers
Digital Filter
The input to TRCTRG or TRCIOj (j = A, B, C, or D) is sampled, and the level is considered to be determined
when three matches occur. The digital filter function and sampling clock are selected using the TRCDF register.
Figure 16.42 shows a Block Diagram of Digital Filter.
TCK2 to TCK0
f1
f2
f4
f8
f32
TRCCLK
DFCK1 to DFCK0
= 000b
= 00b
f32
= 001b
= 01b
f8
= 010b
= 10b
f1
= 011b
= 11b
Count source
= 100b
IOA2 to IOA0
IOB2 to IOB0
IOC2 to IOC0
IOD2 to IOD0
(or TCEG1 to TCEG0)
= 101b
= 110b
fOCO40M
Sampling clock
DFj (or DFTRG)
C
TRCIOj input signal
(or TRCTRG input
signal)
D
C
Q
Latch
C
D
Q
Latch
D
1
C
Q
Latch
D
Q
Match detect
circuit
Edge detect
circuit
Latch
0
Timer RC operation clock
f1 or fOCO40M
C
D
Q
Latch
Clock cycle selected by
TCK2 to TCK0
(or DFCK1 to DFCK0)
Sampling clock
TRCIOj input signal
(or TRCTRG input signal)
Three matches occur and a
signal change is confirmed.
Input signal after passing
through digital filter
Maximum signal transmission
delay is five sampling clock
pulses.
If fewer than three matches occur,
the matches are treated as noise
and no transmission is performed.
j = A, B, C, or D
TCK0 to TCK2: Bits in TRCCR1 register
DFTRG, DFCK0 to DFCK1, DFj: Bits in TRCDF register
IOA0 to IOA2, IOB0 to IOB2: Bits in TRCIOR0 register
IOC0 to IOC2, IOD0 to IOD2: Bits in TRCIOR1 register
TCEG1 to TCEG0: Bits in TRCCR2 register
Figure 16.42
Block Diagram of Digital Filter
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 189 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.3.4
16. Timers
Forced Cutoff of Pulse Output
When using the timer mode’s output compare function, the PWM mode, or the PWM2 mode, pulse output from
the TRCIOj (j = A, B, C, or D) output pin can be forcibly cut off and the TRCIOj pin set to function as a
programmable I/O port by means of input to the INT0 pin.
A pin used for output by the timer mode’s output compare function, the PWM mode, or the PWM2 mode can be
set to function as the timer RC output pin by setting the Ej bit in the TRCOER register to 0 (timer RC output
enabled). If “L” is input to the INT0 pin while the PTO bit in the TRCOER register is set to 1 (pulse output
forced cutoff signal input INT0 enabled), bits EA, EB, EC, and ED in the TRCOER register are all set to 1
(timer RC output disabled, TRCIOj output pin functions as the programmable I/O port). When one or two
cycles of the timer RC operation clock after “L” input to the INT0 pin (refer to Table 16.11 Timer RC
Operation Clock) has elapsed, the TRCIOj output pin becomes a programmable I/O port.
Make the following settings to use this function.
• Set the pin state following forced cutoff of pulse output (high impedance (input), “L” output, or “H”
output). (Refer to 7. Programmable I/O Ports.)
• Set the INT0EN bit to 1 (INT0 input enabled) and the INT0PL bit to 0 (one edge) in the INTEN register.
• Set the PD4_5 bit in the PD4 register to 0 (input mode).
• Select the INT0 digital filter by means of bits INT0F1 to INT0F0 in the INTF register.
• Set the PTO bit in the TRCOER register to 1 (pulse output forced cutoff signal input INT0 enabled).
The IR bit in the INT0IC register is set to 1 (interrupt request) in accordance with the setting of the POL bit and
a change in the INT0 pin input (refer to 12.6 Notes on Interrupts).
For details on interrupts, refer to 12. Interrupts.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 190 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
EA bit
write value
INT0 input
EA bit
D Q
S
Timer RC
output data
TRCIOA
Port P1_1
output data
PTO bit
Port P1_1
input data
EB bit
write value
EB bit
D Q
S
Timer RC
output data
TRCIOB
Port P1_2
output data
Port P1_2
input data
EC bit
write value
EC bit
D Q
S
Timer RC
output data
TRCIOC
Port P3_4
output data
Port P3_4
input data
ED bit
write value
ED bit
D Q
S
Timer RC
output data
Port P3_5
output data
Port P3_5
input data
EA, EB, EC, ED, PTO: Bits in TRCOER register
Figure 16.43
Forced Cutoff of Pulse Output
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 191 of 450
TRCIOD
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.4
16. Timers
Timer Mode (Input Capture Function)
This function measures the width or period of an external signal. An external signal input to the TRCIOj (j = A,
B, C, or D) pin acts as a trigger for transferring the contents of the TRC register (counter) to the TRCGRj
register (input capture). The input capture function, or any other mode or function, can be selected for each
individual pin.
The TRCGRA register can also select fOCO128 signal as input-capture trigger input.
Table 16.16 lists the Specifications of Input Capture Function, Figure 16.44 shows a Block Diagram of Input
Capture Function, Figures 16.45 and 16.46 show the registers associated with the input capture function, Table
16.17 lists the Functions of TRCGRj Register when Using Input Capture Function, and Figure 16.47 shows an
Operating Example of Input Capture Function.
Table 16.16
Specifications of Input Capture Function
Item
Count source
Count operation
Count period
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation
timing
TRCIOA, TRCIOB, TRCIOC,
and TRCIOD pin functions
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
Specification
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M, or external signal (rising edge) input to
TRCCLK pin
Increment
1/fk × 65,536 fk: Count source frequency
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
The TRC register retains a value before count stops.
• Input capture (valid edge of TRCIOj input or fOCO128 signal edge)
• The TRC register overflows.
Programmable I/O port or input capture input (selectable individually by
pin)
Programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
The count value can be read by reading TRC register.
The TRC register can be written to.
• Input capture input pin select
One or more of pins TRCIOA, TRCIOB, TRCIOC, and TRCIOD
• Input capture input valid edge selected
Rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Digital filter (Refer to 16.3.3.3 Digital Filter.)
• Input-capture trigger selected
fOCO128 can be selected for input-capture trigger input of the
TRCGRA register.
j = A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 192 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
fOCO
Divided
by 128
16. Timers
fOCO128
IOA3 = 0
Input capture signal(3)
TRCIOA
IOA3 = 1
(Note 1)
TRCGRA
register
TRC register
TRCGRC
register
TRCIOC
Input capture signal
Input capture signal
TRCIOB
(Note 2)
TRCGRB
register
TRCGRD
register
TRCIOD
Input capture signal
IOA3: Bit in TRCIOR0 register
NOTES:
1. The BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (TRCGRC register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRA register)
2. The BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (TRCGRD register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRB register)
3. The trigger input of the TRCGRA register can select the TRCIOA pin input or fOCO128 signal.
Figure 16.44
Block Diagram of Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 193 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC I/O Control Register 0
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
Symbol
TRCIOR0
Bit Symbol
Address
0124h
Bit Name
TRCGRA control bits
IOA1
IOA3
RW
TRCGRA input capture input
sw itch bit(3)
0 : fOCO128 signal
1 : TRCIOA pin input
RW
TRCGRB control bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRB register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRCGRB register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRB register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
TRCGRB mode select bit(2)
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. When the BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRA register), set the IOC2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
2. When the BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRB register), set the IOD2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
3. The IOA3 bit is enabled w hen the IOA2 bit is set to 1 (input capture function).
Figure 16.45
TRCIOR0 Register for Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
IOB1
—
(b7)
RW
TRCGRA mode select bit(1)
IOB0
IOB2
RW
b1 b0
0 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRA register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRCGRA register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRA register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOA0
IOA2
After Reset
10001000b
Function
Page 194 of 450
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC I/O Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
Symbol
TRCIOR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0125h
Bit Name
TRCGRC control bits
After Reset
10001000b
Function
0 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRC register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRCGRC register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRC register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOC0
IOC1
IOC2
—
(b3)
TRCGRC mode select bit(1)
RW
RW
RW
—
b5 b4
0 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRD register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRCGRD register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRCGRD register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOD0
IOD1
—
(b7)
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
TRCGRD control bits
IOD2
RW
b1 b0
TRCGRD mode select bit(2)
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
RW
RW
—
NOTES:
1. When the BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRA register), set the IOC2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
2. When the BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRB register), set the IOD2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
Figure 16.46
Table 16.17
TRCIOR1 Register for Input Capture Function
Functions of TRCGRj Register when Using Input Capture Function
Register
TRCGRA
TRCGRB
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
Setting
−
BFC = 0
BFD = 0
BFC = 1
BFD = 1
Input Capture
Input Pin
General register. Can be used to read the TRC register value TRCIOA
at input capture.
TRCIOB
General register. Can be used to read the TRC register value TRCIOC
at input capture.
TRCIOD
Buffer registers. Can be used to hold transferred value from TRCIOA
the general register. (Refer to 16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
TRCIOB
Register Function
j = A, B, C, or D
BFC, BFD: Bits in TRCMR register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 195 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
TRCCLK input
count source
TRC register
count value
FFFFh
0006h
0003h
0000h
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
1
0
65536
TRCIOA input
TRCGRA register
0006h
Transfer
TRCGRC register
0003h
Transfer
0006h
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
OVF bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
0
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRCCR1 register are set to 101b (the count source is TRCCLK input).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRCIORA register are set to 101b (input capture at the falling edge of the TRCIOA input).
• The BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (the TRCGRC register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRA register).
Figure 16.47
Operating Example of Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 196 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.5
16. Timers
Timer Mode (Output Compare Function)
This function detects when the contents of the TRC register (counter) and the TRCGRj register (j = A, B, C, or
D) match (compare match). When a match occurs a signal is output from the TRCIOj pin at a given level. The
output compare function, or other mode or function, can be selected for each individual pin.
Table 16.18 lists the Specifications of Output Compare Function, Figure 16.48 shows a Block Diagram of
Output Compare Function, Figures 16.49 to 16.51 show the registers associated with the output compare
function, Table 16.19 lists the Functions of TRCGRj Register when Using Output Compare Function, and
Figure 16.52 shows an Operating Example of Output Compare Function.
Table 16.18
Specifications of Output Compare Function
Item
Count source
Count operation
Count period
Waveform output timing
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation
timing
TRCIOA, TRCIOB, TRCIOC,
and TRCIOD pin functions
Specification
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M, or external signal (rising edge) input to
TRCCLK pin
Increment
• The CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 0 (free running
operation): 1/fk × 65,536
fk: Count source frequency
• The CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1 (TRC register set to
0000h at TRCGRA compare match):
1/fk × (n + 1)
n: TRCGRA register setting value
Compare match
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
The output compare output pin retains output level before count stops,
the TRC register retains a value before count stops.
• Compare match (contents of registers TRC and TRCGRj match)
• The TRC register overflows.
Programmable I/O port or output compare output (selectable individually
by pin)
INT0 pin function
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or INT0
interrupt input
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
The count value can be read by reading the TRC register.
The TRC register can be written to.
• Output compare output pin selected
One or more of pins TRCIOA, TRCIOB, TRCIOC, and TRCIOD
• Compare match output level select
“L” output, “H” output, or toggle output
• Initial output level select
Sets output level for period from count start to compare match
• Timing for clearing the TRC register to 0000h
Overflow or compare match with the TRCGRA register
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.3.3.4 Forced Cutoff
of Pulse Output.)
• Can be used as an internal timer by disabling timer RC output
j = A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 197 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
TRC
TRCIOA
TRCIOC
TRCIOB
TRCIOD
Figure 16.48
Output
control
Output
control
Output
control
Output
control
Compare match signal
TRCGRA
Comparator
TRCGRC
Comparator
TRCGRB
Comparator
TRCGRD
Compare match signal
Compare match signal
Compare match signal
Block Diagram of Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Comparator
Page 198 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC I/O Control Register 0
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
1 0
Symbol
TRCIOR0
Bit Symbol
Address
0124h
Bit Name
TRCGRA control bits
IOA1
IOA3
TRCGRA mode select bit(1)
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
TRCGRA input capture input
sw itch bit
Set to 1.
TRCGRB control bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Disable pin output by compare
match (TRCIOB pin functions as the
programmable I/O port)
0 1 : “L” output by compare match in
the TRCGRB register
1 0 : “H” output by compare match in
the TRCGRB register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
in the TRCGRB register
IOB0
IOB1
IOB2
—
(b7)
TRCGRB mode select bit(2)
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. When the BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRA register), set the IOC2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
2. When the BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRB register), set the IOD2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
Figure 16.49
TRCIOR0 Register for Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 199 of 450
RW
b1 b0
0 0 : Disable pin output by compare
match (TRCIOA pin functions as the
programmable I/O port)
0 1 : “L” output by compare match in
the TRCGRA register
1 0 : “H” output by compare match in
the TRCGRA register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
in the TRCGRA register
IOA0
IOA2
After Reset
10001000b
Function
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC I/O Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0
Symbol
TRCIOR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0125h
Bit Name
TRCGRC control bits
IOC1
—
(b3)
TRCGRC mode select bit(1)
IOD1
—
(b7)
TRCGRD mode select bit(2)
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. When the BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRA register), set the IOC2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
2. When the BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (buffer register of TRCGRB register), set the IOD2 bit in the
TRCIOR1 register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRCIOR0 register.
Figure 16.50
TRCIOR1 Register for Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 200 of 450
RW
RW
RW
—
b5 b4
0 0 : Disable pin output by compare
match
0 1 : “L” output by compare match in
the TRCGRD register
1 0 : “H” output by compare match in
the TRCGRD register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
in the TRCGRD register
IOD0
IOD2
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
TRCGRD control bits
RW
b1 b0
0 0 : Disable pin output by compare
match
0 1 : “L” output by compare match in
the TRCGRC register
1 0 : “H” output by compare match in
the TRCGRC register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
in the TRCGRC register
IOC0
IOC2
After Reset
10001000b
Function
RW
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCCR1
Bit Symbol
TOA
TOB
TOC
TOD
Address
0121h
Bit Name
TRCIOA output level select bit(1, 2)
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Initial output “L”
1 : Initial output “H”
RW
RW
TRCIOB output level select bit(1, 2)
RW
TRCIOC output level select bit(1, 2)
RW
TRCIOD output level select bit(1, 2)
Count source select bits (1)
RW
b6 b5 b4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
TCK1
TCK2
TRC counter clear select bit
CCLR
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRCCLK input rising edge
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
0 : Disable clear (free-running
operation)
1 : Clear by compare match in the
TRCGRA register
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set to these bits w hen the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is set to 0 (count stops).
2. If the pin function is set for w aveform output (refer to Tables 7.10 to 7.13 and Tables 7.29 to 7.32), the initial
output level is output w hen the TRCCR1 register is set.
Figure 16.51
Table 16.19
TRCCR1 Register for Output Compare Function
Functions of TRCGRj Register when Using Output Compare Function
Register
TRCGRA
TRCGRB
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
Setting
Register Function
−
General register. Write a compare value to one of these
registers.
BFC = 0
BFD = 0
BFC = 1
BFD = 1
General register. Write a compare value to one of these
registers.
Buffer register. Write the next compare value to one of
these registers. (Refer to 16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
j = A, B, C, or D
BFC, BFD: Bits in TRCMR register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 201 of 450
Output Compare
Output Pin
TRCIOA
TRCIOB
TRCIOC
TRCIOD
TRCIOA
TRCIOB
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
TRC register value
m
n
p
Count
restarts
Count
stops
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
1
0
m+1
m+1
Output level held
TRCIOA output
Output inverted at
compare match
Initial output “L”
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Output level held
n+1
TRCIOB output
“H” output at
compare match
Initial output “L”
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
P+1
Output level held
“L” output at compare match
TRCIOC output
Initial output “H”
IMFC bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRB register setting value
p: TRCGRC register setting value
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits BFC and BFD in the TRCMR register are set to 0 (TRCGRC and TRCGRD do not operate as buffers).
• Bits EA, EB, and EC in the TRCOER register are set to 0 (output from TRCIOA, TRCIOB, and TRCIOC enabled).
• The CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1 (set the TRC register to 0000h by TRCGRA compare match).
• In the TRCCR1 register, bits TOA and TOB are set to 0 (“L” initial output until compare match) and the TOC bit is set to 1 (“H” initial output until
compare match).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRCIOR0 register are set to 011b (TRCIOA output inverted at TRCGRA compare match).
• Bits IOB2 to IOB0 in the TRCIOR0 register are set to 010b (“H” TRCIOB output at TRCGRB compare match).
• Bits IOC2 to IOC2 in the TRCIOR1 register are set to 001b (“L” TRCIOC output at TRCGRC compare match).
Figure 16.52
Operating Example of Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 202 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.6
16. Timers
PWM Mode
This mode outputs PWM waveforms. A maximum of three PWM waveforms with the same period are output.
The PWM mode, or the timer mode, can be selected for each individual pin. (However, since the TRCGRA
register is used when using any pin for the PWM mode, the TRCGRA register cannot be used for the timer
mode.)
Table 16.20 lists the Specifications of PWM Mode, Figure 16.53 shows a Block Diagram of PWM Mode,
Figure 16.54 shows the registers associated with the PWM mode, Table 16.21 lists the Functions of TRCGRj
Register in PWM Mode, and Figures 16.55 and 16.56 show Operating Examples of PWM Mode.
Table 16.20
Specifications of PWM Mode
Item
Specification
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M, or external signal (rising edge) input to
TRCCLK pin
Increment
PWM period: 1/fk × (m + 1)
Active level width: 1/fk × (m - n)
Inactive width: 1/fk × (n + 1)
fk: Count source frequency
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRj register setting value
Count source
Count operation
PWM waveform
m+1
n+1
Count start condition
Count stop condition
Interrupt request generation
timing
TRCIOA pin function
TRCIOB, TRCIOC, and
TRCIOD pin functions
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
(“L” is active level)
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
PWM output pin retains output level before count stops, TRC register
retains value before count stops.
• Compare match (contents of registers TRC and TRCGRh match)
• The TRC register overflows.
Programmable I/O port
Programmable I/O port or PWM output (selectable individually by pin)
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or INT0
interrupt input
The count value can be read by reading the TRC register.
The TRC register can be written to.
• One to three pins selectable as PWM output pins per channel
One or more of pins TRCIOB, TRCIOC, and TRCIOD
• Active level selectable by individual pin
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.3.3.4 Forced
Cutoff of Pulse Output.)
j = B, C, or D
h = A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
m-n
Page 203 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
TRC
Compare match signal
Comparator
TRCIOB
TRCGRA
Compare match signal
(Note 1)
Output
control
TRCIOC
Comparator
TRCGRB
Comparator
TRCGRC
Compare match signal
TRCIOD
(Note 2)
Compare match signal
Comparator
TRCGRD
NOTES:
1. The BFC bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (TRCGRC register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRA register)
2. The BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (TRCGRD register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRB register)
Figure 16.53
Block Diagram of PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 204 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCCR1
Bit Symbol
TOA
Address
0121h
Bit Name
TRCIOA output level select bit(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
Disabled in PWM mode
TRCIOB output level select bit(1, 2)
0 : Active level “H”
(Initial output “L”
“H” output by compare match in
the TRCGRj register
“L” output by compare match in
the TRCGRA register
1 : Active level “L”
(Initial output “H”
“L” output by compare match in
the TRCGRj register
“H” output by compare match in
the TRCGRA register
TOB
TRCIOC output level select bit(1, 2)
TOC
TRCIOD output level select bit(1, 2)
TOD
Count source select bits (1)
TCK1
TCK2
TRC counter clear select bit
CCLR
RW
RW
RW
RW
b6 b5 b4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
RW
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRCCLK input rising edge
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
0 : Disable clear (free-running operation)
1 : Clear by compare match in the
TRCGRA register
RW
RW
RW
RW
j = B, C or D
NOTES:
1. Set to these bits w hen the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is set to 0 (count stops).
2. If the pin function is set for w aveform output (refer to Tables 7.12 to 7.13 and Tables 7.29 to 7.32), the initial output
level is output w hen the TRCCR1 register is set.
Figure 16.54
Table 16.21
TRCCR1 Register in PWM Mode
Functions of TRCGRj Register in PWM Mode
Register
TRCGRA
TRCGRB
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
TRCGRC
Setting
−
−
BFC = 0
BFD = 0
BFC = 1
TRCGRD
BFD = 1
Register Function
General register. Set the PWM period.
General register. Set the PWM output change point.
General register. Set the PWM output change point.
Buffer register. Set the next PWM period. (Refer to 16.3.3.2
Buffer Operation.)
Buffer register. Set the next PWM output change point. (Refer to
16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
PWM Output Pin
−
TRCIOB
TRCIOC
TRCIOD
−
TRCIOB
j = A, B, C, or D
BFC, BFD: Bits in TRCMR register
NOTE:
1. The output level does not change even when a compare match occurs if the TRCGRA register value (PWM
period) is the same as the TRCGRB, TRCGRC, or TRCGRD register value.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 205 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
TRC register value
m
n
p
q
m+1
n+1
Active level is “H”
TRCIOB output
m-n
Inactive level is “L”
p+1
m-p
“L” initial output until
compare match
TRCIOC output
q+1
m-q
Active level is “L”
TRCIOD output
“H” initial output until
compare match
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFC bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFD bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRB register setting value
p: TRCGRC register setting value
q: TRCGRD register setting value
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits BFC and BFD in the TRCMR register are set to 0 (registers TRCGRC and TRCGRD do not operate as buffers).
• Bits EB, EC, and ED in the TRCOER register are set to 0 (output from TRCIOB, TRCIOC, and TRCIOD enabled).
• In the TRCCR1 register, bits TOB and TOC are set to 0 (active level is “H”) and the TOD bit is set to 1 (active level is “L”).
Figure 16.55
Operating Example of PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 206 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
TRC register value
p
m
q
n
0000h
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
1
TRCIOB output does not switch to “L” because
no compare match with the TRCGRB register
has occurred
0
Duty 0%
TRCIOB output
TRCGRB register
n
q
p (p>m)
Rewritten by a program
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
TRC register value
m
p
n
0000h
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
1
If compare matches occur simultaneously with registers TRCGRA and
TRCGRB, the compare match with the TRCGRB register has priority.
TRCIOB output switches to “L”. (In other words, no change).
0
Duty 100%
TRCIOB output
TRCIOB output switches to “L” at compare match with the
TRCGRB register. (In other words, no change).
n
TRCGRB register
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
m
p
Rewritten by
a program
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
m: TRCGRA register setting value
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The EB bit in the TRCOER register is set to 0 (output from TRCIOB enabled).
• The TOB bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1 (active level is “L”).
Figure 16.56
Operating Example of PWM Mode (Duty 0% and Duty 100%)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 207 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.7
16. Timers
PWM2 Mode
This mode outputs a single PWM waveform. After a given wait duration has elapsed following the trigger, the
pin output switches to active level. Then, after a given duration, the output switches back to inactive level.
Furthermore, the counter stops at the same time the output returns to inactive level, making it possible to use
PWM2 mode to output a programmable wait one-shot waveform.
Since timer RC uses multiple general registers in PWM2 mode, other modes cannot be used in conjunction with
it.
Figure 16.57 shows a Block Diagram of PWM2 Mode, Table 16.22 lists the Specifications of PWM2 Mode,
Figure 16.58 shows the register associated with PWM2 mode, Table 16.23 lists the Functions of TRCGRj
Register in PWM2 Mode, and Figures 16.59 to 16.61 show Operating Examples of PWM2 Mode.
Trigger signal
Compare match signal
TRCTRG
TRCIOB
Input
control
Count clear signal
TRC
(Note 1)
Comparator
TRCGRA
Comparator
TRCGRB
Comparator
TRCGRC
TRCGRD
register
Output
control
NOTE:
1. The BFD bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (the TRCGRD register functions as the buffer register for the TRCGRB register).
Figure 16.57
Block Diagram of PWM2 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 208 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.22
16. Timers
Specifications of PWM2 Mode
Item
Count source
Count operation
PWM waveform
Specification
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M, or external signal (rising edge) input to TRCCLK pin
Increment TRC register
PWM period: 1/fk × (m + 1) (no TRCTRG input)
Active level width: 1/fk × (n - p)
Wait time from count start or trigger: 1/fk × (p + 1)
fk: Count source frequency
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRB register setting value
p: TRCGRC register setting value
TRCTRG input
m+1
n+1
n+1
p+1
p+1
TRCIOB output
n-p
n-p
(TRCTRG: Rising edge, active level is “H”)
Count start conditions
Count stop conditions
• Bits TCEG1 to TCEG0 in the TRCCR2 register are set to 00b (TRCTRG trigger
disabled) or the CSEL bit in the TRCCR2 register is set to 0 (count continues).
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register.
• Bits TCEG1 to TCEG0 in the TRCCR2 register are set to 01b, 10b, or 11b (TRCTRG
trigger enabled) and the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is set to 1 (count starts).
A trigger is input to the TRCTRG pin
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register while the CSEL bit in
the TRCCR2 register is set to 0 or 1.
The TRCIOB pin outputs the initial level in accordance with the value of the TOB bit in
the TRCCR1 register. The TRC register retains the value before count stops.
• The count stops due to a compare match with TRCGRA while the CSEL bit in the
TRCCR2 register is set to 1
The TRCIOB pin outputs the initial level. The TRC register retains the value before
count stops if the CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 0. The TRC register is set
to 0000h if the CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1.
• Compare match (contents of TRC and TRCGRj registers match)
• The TRC register overflows
Programmable I/O port or TRCTRG input
Interrupt request
generation timing
TRCIOA/TRCTRG pin
function
TRCIOB pin function
PWM output
TRCIOC and TRCIOD pin Programmable I/O port
functions
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or INT0 interrupt input
The count value can be read by reading the TRC register.
The TRC register can be written to.
• External trigger and valid edge selected
The edge or edges of the signal input to the TRCTRG pin can be used as the PWM
output trigger: rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edges
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.3.3.4 Forced Cutoff of Pulse
Output.)
• Digital filter (Refer to 16.3.3.3 Digital Filter.)
j = A, B, or C
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 209 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RC Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRCCR1
Bit Symbol
TOA
Address
0121h
Bit Name
TRCIOA output level select bit(1)
After Reset
00h
Function
Disabled in the PWM2 mode
TRCIOB output level select bit(1, 2)
0 : Active level “H”
(Initial output “L”
“H” output by compare match in the
TRCGRC register
“L” output by compare match in the
TRCGRB register
1 : Active level “L”
(Initial output “H”
“L” output by compare match in the
TRCGRC register
“H” output by compare match in the
TRCGRB register
TOB
TOC
TOD
TRCIOC output level select bit(1)
Disabled in the PWM2 mode
TRCIOD output level select bit(1)
Count source select bits (1)
TCK1
TCK2
TRC counter clear select bit
CCLR
RW
RW
RW
RW
b6 b5 b4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
RW
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRCCLK input rising edge
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
0 : Disable clear (free-running operation)
1 : Clear by compare match in the
TRCGRA register
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set to these bits w hen the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is set to 0 (count stops).
2. If the pin function is set for w aveform output (refer to Tables 7.12 and 7.13), the initial output level is output w hen
the TRCCR1 register is set.
Figure 16.58
Table 16.23
TRCCR1 Register in PWM2 Mode
Functions of TRCGRj Register in PWM2 Mode
Register
TRCGRA
TRCGRB
TRCGRC
Setting
−
−
BFC = 0
TRCGRD
TRCGRD
BFD = 0
BFD = 1
Register Function
PWM2 Output Pin
General register. Set the PWM period.
TRCIOB pin
General register. Set the PWM output change point.
General register. Set the PWM output change point (wait time
after trigger).
(Not used in PWM2 mode)
−
Buffer register. Set the next PWM output change point. (Refer to TRCIOB pin
16.3.3.2 Buffer Operation.)
j = A, B, C, or D
BFC, BFD: Bits in TRCMR register
NOTE:
1. Do not set the TRCGRB and TRCGRC registers to the same value.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 210 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
TRC register value
FFFFh
TRC register cleared
at TRCGRA register
compare match
m
n
Previous value held if the
TSTART bit is set to 0
Set to 0000h
by a program
p
0000h
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
Count stops
because the
CSEL bit is
set to 1
1
0
Set to 1 by
a program
CSEL bit in
TRCCR2 register
TSTART bit
is set to 0
1
0
m+1
n+1
p+1
“H” output at TRCGRC
register compare match
p+1
Return to initial output
if the TSTART bit is
set to 0
“L” initial output
TRCIOB output
“L” output at TRCGRB
register compare match
No change
No change
“H” output at TRCGRC register
compare match
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFC bit in
TRCSR register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
TRCGRB register
n
Transfer
TRCGRD register
n
Transfer
Next data
Transfer from buffer register to general register
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRB register setting value
p: TRCGRC register setting value
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The TOB bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 0 (initial level is “L”, “H” output at compare match with the TRCGRC register, “L” output at compare
match with the TRCGRB register).
• Bits TCEG1 and TCEG0 in the TRCCR2 register are set to 00b (TRCTRG trigger input disabled).
Figure 16.59
Operating Example of PWM2 Mode (TRCTRG Trigger Input Disabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 211 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
TRC register value
TRC register cleared
at TRCGRA register
compare match
FFFFh
m
TRC register (counter)
cleared at TRCTRG pin
trigger input
Previous value
held if the
TSTART bit is
set to 0
n
Set to 0000h
by a program
p
0000h
TRCTRG input
Count starts at
TRCTRG pin
trigger input
Count starts
TSTART bit
is set to 1
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
1
CSEL bit in
TRCCR2 register
1
Count stops
because the
CSEL bit is
set to 1
Changed by a program
The TSTART
bit is set to 0
0
Set to 1 by
a program
0
m+1
n+1
n+1
p+1
p+1
“H” output at
TRCGRC register
compare match
“L” output at
TRCGRB register
compare match
“L” initial output
TRCIOB output
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFC bit in
TRCSR register
1
TRCGRB register
p+1
Inactive level so
TRCTRG input is
enabled
Return to initial value if the
TSTART bit is set to 0
Active level so TRCTRG
input is disabled
0
Set to 0 by
a program
0
Set to 0 by
a program
Set to 0 by
a program
Set to 0 by
a program
0
n
n
n
Transfer
TRCGRD register
Transfer
n
Transfer from buffer register to general register
n
Transfer
Transfer
Next data
Transfer from buffer register to general register
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRB register setting value
p: TRCGRC register setting value
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The TOB bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 0 (initial level is “L”, “H” output at compare match with the TRCGRC register, “L” output at compare match with the
TRCGRB register).
• Bits TCEG1 and TCEG0 in the TRCCR2 register are set to 11b (trigger at both rising and falling edges of TRCTRG input).
Figure 16.60
Operating Example of PWM2 Mode (TRCTRG Trigger Input Enabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 212 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
• TRCGRB register setting value greater than TRCGRA
register setting value
TRC register value
• TRCGRC register setting value greater than TRCGRA
register setting value
TRC register value
n
p
m
m
n
p
0000h
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
0000h
1
TSTART bit in
TRCMR register
0
n+1
m+1
m+1
TRCIOB output
“H” output at TRCGRC register
compare match
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFC bit in
TRCSR register
0
p+1
No compare match with
TRCGRB register, so
“H” output continues
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
“L” initial
output
0
0
1
No compare match
with TRCGRC register,
so “L” output continues
TRCIOB output
IMFA bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFB bit in
TRCSR register
1
IMFC bit in
TRCSR register
1
Set to 0 by a
program
0
“L” output at
TRCGRB register
compare match
with no change.
“L” initial
output
0
0
0
m: TRCGRA register setting value
n: TRCGRB register setting value
p: TRCGRC register setting value
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The TOB bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 0 (initial level is “L”, “H” output at compare match with the TRCGRC register, “L” output at compare
match with the TRCGRB register).
• Bits TCEG1 and TCEG0 in the TRCCR2 register are set to 00b (TRCTRG trigger input disabled).
Figure 16.61
Operating Example of PWM2 Mode (Duty 0% and Duty 100%)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 213 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.8
16. Timers
Timer RC Interrupt
Timer RC generates a timer RC interrupt request from five sources. The timer RC interrupt uses the single
TRCIC register (bits IR and ILVL0 to ILVL2) and a single vector.
Table 16.24 lists the Registers Associated with Timer RC Interrupt, and Figure 16.62 is a Timer RC Interrupt
Block Diagram.
Table 16.24
Registers Associated with Timer RC Interrupt
Timer RC Status Register
TRCSR
Timer RC Interrupt Enable Register
TRCIER
Timer RC Interrupt Control Register
TRCIC
IMFA bit
IMIEA bit
Timer RC interrupt request
(IR bit in TRCIC register)
IMFB bit
IMIEB bit
IMFC bit
IMIEC bit
IMFD bit
IMIED bit
OVF bit
OVIE bit
IMFA, IMFB, IMFC, IMFD, OVF: Bits in TRCSR register
IMIEA, IMIEB, IMIEC, IMIED, OVIE: Bits in TRCIER register
Figure 16.62
Timer RC Interrupt Block Diagram
Like other maskable interrupts, the timer RC interrupt is controlled by the combination of the I flag, IR bit, bits
ILVL0 to ILVL2, and IPL. However, it differs from other maskable interrupts in the following respects because
a single interrupt source (timer RC interrupt) is generated from multiple interrupt request sources.
• The IR bit in the TRCIC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested) when a bit in the TRCSR register is set to
1 and the corresponding bit in the TRCIER register is also set to 1 (interrupt enabled).
• The IR bit is set to 0 (no interrupt request) when the bit in the TRCSR register or the corresponding bit in
the TRCIER register is set to 0, or both are set to 0. In other words, the interrupt request is not maintained
if the IR bit is once set to 1 but the interrupt is not acknowledged.
• If after the IR bit is set to 1 another interrupt source is triggered, the IR bit remains set to 1 and does not
change.
• If multiple bits in the TRCIER register are set to 1, use the TRCSR register to determine the source of the
interrupt request.
• The bits in the TRCSR register are not automatically set to 0 when an interrupt is acknowledged. Set them
to 0 within the interrupt routine. Refer to Figure 16.32 TRCSR Register, for the procedure for setting
these bits to 0.
Refer to Figure 16.31 TRCIER Register, for details of the TRCIER register.
Refer to 12.1.6 Interrupt Control, for details of the TRCIC register and 12.1.5.2 Relocatable Vector Tables,
for information on interrupt vectors.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 214 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.3.9
16. Timers
Notes on Timer RC
16.3.9.1
TRC Register
• The following note applies when the CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1 (clear TRC register at
compare match with TRCGRA register).
When using a program to write a value to the TRC register while the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is
set to 1 (count starts), ensure that the write does not overlap with the timing with which the TRC register is
set to 0000h.
If the timing of the write to the TRC register and the setting of the TRC register to 0000h coincide, the
write value will not be written to the TRC register and the TRC register will be set to 0000h.
• Reading from the TRC register immediately after writing to it can result in the value previous to the write
being read out. To prevent this, execute the JMP.B instruction between the read and the write instructions.
Program Example
MOV.W
#XXXXh, TRC
;Write
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B instruction
L1:
MOV.W
TRC,DATA
;Read
16.3.9.2
TRCSR Register
Reading from the TRCSR register immediately after writing to it can result in the value previous to the write
being read out. To prevent this, execute the JMP.B instruction between the read and the write instructions.
Program Example
MOV.B
#XXh, TRCSR
;Write
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B instruction
L1:
MOV.B
TRCSR,DATA
;Read
16.3.9.3
Count Source Switching
• Stop the count before switching the count source.
Switching procedure
(1) Set the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change the settings of bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRCCR1 register.
• After switching the count source from fOCO40M to another clock, allow a minimum of two cycles of f1 to
elapse after changing the clock setting before stopping fOCO40M.
Switching procedure
(1) Set the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change the settings of bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRCCR1 register.
(3) Wait for a minimum of two cycles of f1.
(4) Set the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register to 0 (high-speed on-chip oscillator off).
16.3.9.4
Input Capture Function
• The pulse width of the input capture signal should be three cycles or more of the timer RC operation clock
(refer to Table 16.11 Timer RC Operation Clock).
• The value of the TRC register is transferred to the TRCGRj register one or two cycles of the timer RC
operation clock after the input capture signal is input to the TRCIOj (j = A, B, C, or D) pin (when the
digital filter function is not used).
16.3.9.5
TRCMR Register in PWM2 Mode
When the CSEL bit in the TRCCR2 register is set to 1 (count stops at compare match with the TRCGRA
register), do not set the TRCMR register at compare match timing of registers TRC and TRCGRA.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 215 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4
16. Timers
Timer RD
Timer RD has 2 16-bit timers (channels 0 and 1). Each channel has 4 I/O pins.
The operation clock of timer RD is f1 or fOCO40M. Table 16.25 lists the Timer RD Operation Clocks.
Table 16.25
Timer RD Operation Clocks
Condition
Operation Clock of Timer RD
The count source is f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, or TRDCLK input
f1
(bits TCK2 to TCK0 in registers TRDCR0 and TRDCR1 are set to a value from 000b
to 101b).
The count source is fOCO40M
(bits TCK2 to TCK0 in registers TRDCR0 and TRDCR1 are set to 110b).
fOCO40M
Figure 16.63 shows a Block Diagram of Timer RD. Timer RD has 5 modes:
• Timer mode
- Input capture function
Transfer the counter value to a register with an external signal as the
trigger
- Output compare function
Detect register value matches with a counter
(Pin output can be changed at detection)
The following 4 modes use the output compare function.
• PWM mode
Output pulse of any width continuously
• Reset synchronous PWM mode
Output three-phase waveforms (6) without sawtooth wave modulation
and dead time
• Complementary PWM mode
Output three-phase waveforms (6) with triangular wave modulation and
dead time
• PWM3 mode
Output PWM waveforms (2) with a fixed period
In the input capture function, output compare function, and PWM mode, channels 0 and 1 have the equivalent
functions, and functions or modes can be selected individually for each pin. Also, a combination of these functions
and modes can be used in 1 channel.
In reset synchronous PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, and PWM3 mode, a waveform is output with a
combination of counters and registers in channels 0 and 1.
Tables 16.26 to 16.34 list the Pin Functions of timer RD.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 216 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.26
Pin Functions TRDIOA0/TRDCLK(P2_0)
Register TRDOER1
Bit
EA0
Setting
value
16. Timers
TRDFCR
TRDIORA0
Function
PWM3 STCLK CMD1, CMD0 IOA3 IOA2_IOA0
0
0
0
00b
X
XXXb
0
1
0
00b
1
001b, 01Xb
1
0
00b
X
1XXb
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
1
1
XXb
X
000b
External clock input (TRDCLK)(1)
X
Other than above
PWM3 mode waveform output
Timer mode waveform output (output compare
function)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_0 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function) and external clock
input (TRDCLK).
Table 16.27
Pin Functions TRDIOB0(P2_1)
Register TRDOER1
Bit
EB0
Setting
value
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORA0
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
PWMB0
IOB2_IOB0
1Xb
X
XXXb
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
Function
0
X
0
X
01b
X
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
0
00b
X
XXXb
PWM3 mode waveform output
0
1
00b
1
XXXb
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
0
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
0
1XXb
Other than above
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_1 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Table 16.28
Pin Functions TRDIOC0(P2_2)
Register
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORC0
Bit
EC0
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
PWMC0
IOC2_IOC0
1Xb
X
XXXb
Setting
value
Function
0
X
0
X
01b
X
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
1
XXXb
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
0
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
0
1XXb
Other than above
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_2 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 217 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.29
16. Timers
Pin Functions TRDIOD0(P2_3)
Register
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORC0
Bit
ED0
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
PWMD0
IOD2_IOD0
1Xb
X
XXXb
Setting
value
Function
0
X
0
X
01b
X
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
1
XXXb
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
0
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
0
1XXb
Other than above
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_3 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Table 16.30
Pin Functions TRDIOA1(P2_4)
Register
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDIORA1
Bit
EA1
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
IOA2_IOA0
Setting
value
Function
0
X
1Xb
XXXb
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
0
X
01b
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
1XXb
Other than above
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_4 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Table 16.31
Pin Functions TRDIOB1(P2_5)
Register
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORA1
Bit
EB1
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
PWMB1
IOB2_IOB0
1Xb
X
XXXb
Setting
value
Function
0
X
0
X
01b
X
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
1
XXXb
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
0
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
0
1XXb
Other than above
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_5 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 218 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.32
16. Timers
Pin Functions TRDIOC1(P2_6)
Register
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORC1
Bit
EC1
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
PWMC1
IOC2_IOC0
1Xb
X
XXXb
Setting
value
Function
0
X
0
X
01b
X
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
1
XXXb
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
0
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
0
1XXb
Other than above
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_6 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Table 16.33
Pin Functions TRDIOD1(P2_7)
Register
TRDOER1
TRDFCR
TRDPMR
TRDIORC1
Bit
ED1
PWM3 CMD1, CMD0
PWMD1
IOD2_IOD0
Setting
value
Function
0
X
1Xb
X
XXXb
Complementary PWM mode waveform output
0
X
01b
X
XXXb
Reset synchronous PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
1
XXXb
PWM mode waveform output
0
1
00b
0
001b, 01Xb
X
1
00b
0
1XXb
Other than above
Timer mode waveform output (output compare function)
Timer mode trigger input (input capture function)(1)
I/O port
X: can be 0 or 1, no change in outcome
NOTE:
1. Set the PD2_7 bit in the PD2 register to 0 (input mode) at timer mode trigger input (input capture function).
Table 16.34
Pin Functions INT0(P4_5)
Register
TRDOER2
Bit
PTO
Setting
value
1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
INTEN
PD4
INT0PL
INT0EN
PD4_5
0
1
0
Other than above
Page 219 of 450
Function
Pulse output forced cutoff signal input
I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32,
fOCO40M
Channel i
TRDi register
TRDGRAi register
TRDGRBi register
TRDGRCi register
INT0
Count source
select circuit
TRDGRDi register
TRDDFi register
Data bus
TRDCRi register
TRDIOA0/TRDCLK
TRDIOB0
Timer RD control
circuit
TRDIOC0
TRDIOD0
TRDIORAi register
TRDIOA1
TRDIORCi register
TRDIOB1
TRDSRi register
TRDIOC1
TRDIERi register
TRDIOD1
TRDPOCRi register
TRDSTR register
TRDMR register
TRDPMR register
TRDFCR register
TRDOER1 register
TRDOER2 register
TRDOCR register
i = 0 or 1
Figure 16.63
Block Diagram of Timer RD
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 220 of 450
Channel 0 interrupt
request
Channel 1 interrupt
request
A/D trigger
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.1
16. Timers
Count Sources
The count source selection method is the same in all modes. However, in PWM3 mode, the external clock
cannot be selected.
Table 16.35
Count Source Selection
Count Source
Selection
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32
The count source is selected by bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register.
fOCO40M(1)
The FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register is set to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator
frequency).
Bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register is set to 110b (fOCO40M).
External signal input
to TRDCLK pin
The STCLK bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
Bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 101b
(count source: external clock).
The valid edge is selected by bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 in the TRDCRi register.
The PD2_0 bit in the PD2 register is set to 0 (input mode).
i = 0 or 1
NOTE:
1. The count source fOCO40M can be used with VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V.
TCK2 to TCK0
f1
= 000b
= 001b
f2
= 010b
f4
Count source
= 011b
f8
TRDi register
= 100b
f32
= 110b
fOCO40M
= 101b
STCLK = 1
TRDCLK/
TRDIOA0
CKEG1 to CKEG0
Valid edge
selected
STCLK = 0
TRDIOA0 I/O or programmable I/O port
TCK2 to TCK0, CKEG1 to CKEG0: Bits in TRDCRi register
STCLK: Bit in TRDFCR register
Figure 16.64
Block Diagram of Count Source
Set the pulse width of the external clock which inputs to the TRDCLK pin to 3 cycles or above of the operation
clock of timer RD (refer to Table 16.25 Timer RD Operation Clocks).
When selecting fOCO40M for the count source, set the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register to 1 (high-speed onchip oscillator on) before setting bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register (i = 0 or 1) to 110b (fOCO40M).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 221 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.2
16. Timers
Buffer Operation
The TRDGRCi (i = 0 or 1) register can be used as the buffer register of the TRDGRAi register, and the
TRDGRDi register can be used as the buffer register of the TRDGRBi register by means of bits BFCi and BFDi
in the TRDMR register.
• TRDGRAi buffer register: TRDGRCi register
• TRDGRBi buffer register: TRDGRDi register
Buffer operation depends on the mode. Table 16.36 lists the Buffer Operation in Each Mode.
Table 16.36
Buffer Operation in Each Mode
Function and Mode
Transfer Timing
Transfer Register
Input capture function
Input capture signal input
Transfer content in TRDGRAi
(TRDGRBi) register to buffer register
Output compare function
Compare match with TRDi register
and TRDGRAi (TRDGRBi) register
Transfer content in buffer register to
TRDGRAi (TRDGRBi) register
Reset synchronous PWM Compare match withTRD0 register
mode
and TRDGRA0 register
Transfer content in buffer register to
TRDGRAi (TRDGRBi) register
PWM mode
Complementary PWM
mode
• Compare match with TRD0 register Transfer content in buffer register to
and TRDGRA0 register
registers TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and
• TRD1 register underflow
TRDGRB1
PWM3 mode
Compare match with TRD0 register
and TRDGRA0 register
Transfer content in buffer register to
registers TRDGRA0, TRDGRB0,
TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1
i = 0 or 1
TRDIOAi input
(input capture signal)
TRDGRCi register
(buffer)
TRDGRAi
register
TRDi
TRDIOAi input
TRDi register
n
n-1
n+1
Transfer
TRDGRAi register
m
n
Transfer
TRDGRCi register
(buffer)
m
i = 0 or 1
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The BFCi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as the buffer register of
the TRDGRAi register).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 100b (input capture at the falling edge).
Figure 16.65
Buffer Operation in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 222 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Compare match signal
TRDGRCi register
(buffer)
TRDi register
TRDGRAi
register
m
m-1
TRDGRAi register
Comparator
TRDi
m+1
m
n
Transfer
TRDGRCi register
(buffer)
n
TRDIOAi output
i = 0 or 1
The above applies under the following conditions:
• BFCi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as the buffer register of
the TRDGRAi register).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 001b (“L” output by the compare match).
Figure 16.66
Buffer Operation in Output Compare Function
Perform the following for the timer mode (input capture and output compare functions).
When using the TRDGRCi (i = 0 or 1) register as the buffer register of the TRDGRAi register
• Set the IOC3 bit in the TRDIORCi register to 1 (general register or buffer register).
• Set the IOC2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRDIORAi register.
When using the TRDGRDi register as the buffer register of the TRDGRBi register
• Set the IOD3 bit in the TRDIORDi register to 1 (general register or buffer register).
• Set the IOD2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRDIORAi register.
Bits IMFC and IMFD in the TRDSRi register are set to 1 at the input edge of the TRDIOCi pin when also using
registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi as the buffer register in the input capture function.
When also using registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi as buffer registers for the output compare function, reset
synchronous PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, and PWM3 mode, bits IMFC and IMFD in the TRDSRi
register are set to 1 by a compare match with the TRDi register.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 223 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.3
16. Timers
Synchronous Operation
The TRD1 register is synchronized with the TRD0 register.
• Synchronous preset
When the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (synchronous operation), the data is written to both
the TRD0 and TRD1 registers after writing to the TRDi register.
• Synchronous clear
When the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 and bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register
are set to 011b (synchronous clear), the TRD0 register is set to 0000h at the same time as the TRD1 register
is set to 0000h.
Also, when the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 and bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi
register are set to 011b (synchronous clear), the TRD1 register is set to 0000h at the same time as the TRD0
register is set to 0000h.
TRDIOA0 input
Set to 0000h by input capture
Value in
TRD0 register
n
n writing
n is set
Value in
TRD1 register
n is set
n
Set to 0000h with TRD0 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
• The SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (synchronous operation).
• Bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCR0 register are set to 001b (set the TRD0 register to 0000h in input capture).
Bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCR1 register are set to 011b (set the TRD1 register to 0000h synchronizing with
the TRD0 register).
• Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRDIORA0 register are set to 100b.
• Bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 00b.
(Input capture at the rising edge of the TRDIOA0 input)
The PWM 3 bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1.
Figure 16.67
Synchronous Operation
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 224 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.4
16. Timers
Pulse Output Forced Cutoff
In the output compare function, PWM mode, reset synchronous PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, and
PWM3 mode, the TRDIOji (i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D) output pin can be forcibly set to a programmable
I/O port by the INT0 pin input, and pulse output can be cut off.
The pins used for output in these functions or modes can function as the output pin of timer RD when the
applicable bit in the TRDOER1 register is set to 0 (enable timer RD output). When the PTO bit in the
TRDOER2 register to 1 (INT0 of pulse output forced cutoff signal input enabled), all bits in the TRDOER1
register are set to 1 (disable timer RD output, the TRDIOji output pin is used as the programmable I/O port)
after “L” is applied to the INT0 pin. The TRDIOji output pin is set to the programmable I/O port after “L” is
applied to the INT0 pin and waiting for 1 to 2 cycles of the timer RD operation clock (refer to Table 16.25
Timer RD Operation Clocks).
Set as below when using this function:
• Set the pin status (high impedance, “L” or “H” output) to pulse output forced cutoff by registers P2 and
PD2.
• Set the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register to 1 (enable INT0 input) and the INT0PL bit to 0 (one edge).
• Set the PD4_5 bit in the PD4 register to 0 (input mode).
• Set the INT0 digital filter by bits INT0F1 to INT0F0 in the INTF register.
• Set the PTO bit in the TRDOER2 register to 1 (enable pulse output forced cutoff signal input INT0).
According to the selection of the POL bit in the INT0IC register and change of the INT0 pin input, the IR bit in
the INT0IC register is set to 1 (interrupt request). Refer to 12. Interrupts for details of interrupts.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 225 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
EA0 bit
writing value
INT0 input
EA0 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOA0
Port P2_0
output data
PTO bit
Port P2_0
input data
EB0 bit
writing value
EB0 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOB0
Port P2_1
output data
Port P2_1
input data
EC0 bit
writing value
EC0 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOC0
Port P2_2
output data
Port P2_2
input data
ED0 bit writing
value
ED0 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOD0
Port P2_3
output data
Port P2_3
input data
EA1 bit writing
value
EA1 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOA1
Port P2_4
output data
Port P2_4
input data
EB1 bit writing
value
EB1 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOB1
Port P2_5
output data
Port P2_5
input data
EC1 bit
writing value
EC1 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
TRDIOC1
Port P2_6
output data
Port P2_6
input data
ED1 bit
writing value
ED1 bit
D Q
S
Timer RD
output data
Port P2_7
output data
Port P2_7
input data
PTO: Bit in TRDOER2 register
EA0, EB0, EC0, ED0, EA1, EB1, EC1, ED1: Bits in TRDOER1 register
Figure 16.68
Pulse Output Forced Cutoff
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 226 of 450
TRDIOD1
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.5
16. Timers
Input Capture Function
The input capture function measures the external signal width and period. The content of the TRDi register
(counter) is transferred to the TRDGRji register as a trigger of the TRDIOji (i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D)
pin external signal (input capture). Since this function is enabled with a combination of the TRDIOji pin and
TRDGRji register, the input capture function, or any other mode or function, can be selected for each individual
pin.
The TRDGRA0 register can also select fOCO128 signal as input-capture trigger input.
Figure 16.69 shows a Block Diagram of Input Capture Function, Table 16.37 lists the Input Capture Function
Specifications. Figures 16.70 to 16.80 show the Registers Associated with Input Capture Function, and Figure
16.81 shows an Operating Example of Input Capture Function.
Input capture signal
TRDIOAi(3)
(Note 1)
TRDGRAi
register
TRDi register
TRDGRCi
register
TRDIOCi
Input capture signal
Input capture signal
TRDIOBi
(Note 2)
TRDGRBi
register
fOCO
TRDIOA0
Divided
by 128
fOCO128
IOA3 = 0
Input capture
signal
IOA3 = 1
TRDGRDi
register
TRDIODi
Input capture signal
NOTE 3: The trigger input of the TRDGRA0 register
can select the TRDIOA0 pin input or
fOCO128 signal.
i = 0 or 1
NOTE 1: When the BFCi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as the buffer register of the
TRDGRAi register).
NOTE 2: When the BFDi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRDi register is used as the buffer register of the
TRDGRBi register).
Figure 16.69
Block Diagram of Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 227 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.37
16. Timers
Input Capture Function Specifications
Item
Specification
Count sources
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M
External signal input to the TRDCLK pin (valid edge selected by a
program)
Count operations
Increment
Count period
When bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 000b
(free-running operation).
1/fk × 65536 fk: Frequency of count source
Count start condition
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register.
Count stop condition
0 (count stops) is written to the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register
when the CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1.
Interrupt request generation
timing
• Input capture (valid edge of TRDIOji input or fOCO128 signal edge)
• TRDi register overflows
TRDIOA0 pin function
Programmable I/O port, input-capture input, or TRDCLK (external clock)
input
TRDIOB0, TRDIOC0,
TRDIOD0, TRDIOA1 to
TRDIOD1 pin functions
Programmable I/O port, or input-capture input (selectable by pin)
INT0 pin function
Programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input
Read from timer
The count value can be read by reading the TRDi register.
Write to timer
• When the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 0 (channels 0 and
1 operate independently).
Data can be written to the TRDi register.
• When the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (channels 0 and
1 operate synchronously).
Data can be written to both the TRD0 and TRD1 registers by writing to
the TRDi register.
Select functions
• Input-capture input pin selected
Either 1 pin or multiple pins among TRDIOAi, TRDIOBi, TRDIOCi, or
TRDIODi.
• Input-capture input valid edge selected
The rising edge, falling edge, or both the rising and falling edges
• The timing when the TRDi register is set to 0000h
At overflow or input capture
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Synchronous operation (Refer to 16.4.3 Synchronous Operation.)
• Digital filter
The TRDIOji input is sampled, and when the sampled input level
match as 3 times, the level is determined.
• Input-capture trigger selected
fOCO128 can be selected for input-capture trigger input of the
TRDGRA0 register.
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 228 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Start Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1 1
Symbol
TRDSTR
Bit Symbol
TSTART0
TSTART1
CSEL0
CSEL1
—
(b7-b4)
Address
0137h
Bit Name
TRD0 count start flag
After Reset
11111100b
Function
RW
0 : Count stops
1 : Count starts
RW
TRD1 count start flag
0 : Count stops
1 : Count starts
RW
TRD0 count operation select bit
Set to 1 in the input capture function.
TRD1 count operation select bit
Set to 1 in the input capture function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
RW
—
NOTE:
1. Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction (do not use the bit handling instruction). Refer to 16.4.12.1
TRDSTR Register of Notes on Tim er RD.
Timer RD Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDMR
Bit Symbol
Address
0138h
Bit Name
Timer RD synchronous bit
SYNC
RW
—
BFC0
TRDGRC0 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA0 register
RW
BFD0
TRDGRD0 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB0 register
RW
BFC1
TRDGRC1 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA1 register
RW
BFD1
TRDGRD1 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB1 register
RW
Registers TRDSTR and TRDMR in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
(b3-b1)
Figure 16.70
After Reset
00001110b
Function
0 : Registers TRD0 and TRD1
operate independently
1 : Registers TRD0 and TRD1
operate synchronously
Page 229 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD PWM Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0
0 0 0
Symbol
TRDPMR
Bit Symbol
PWMB0
PWMC0
PWMD0
—
(b3)
PWMB1
PWMC1
PWMD1
—
(b7)
Figure 16.71
Address
0139h
Bit Name
PWM mode of TRDIOB0 select bit
After Reset
10001000b
Function
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the input capture
function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOC0 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the input capture
function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOD0 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the input capture
function.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
PWM mode of TRDIOB1 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the input capture
function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOC1 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the input capture
function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOD1 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the input capture
function.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
TRDPMR Register in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 230 of 450
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Function Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
0 0
Symbol
TRDFCR
Bit Symbol
CMD0
Address
013Ah
Bit Name
Combination mode select bits (1)
After Reset
10000000b
Function
Set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or
PWM3 mode) in the input capture function.
CMD1
RW
OLS0
RW
OLS1
Counter-phase output level select bit This bit is disabled in the input capture
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or function.
complementary PWM mode)
RW
ADTRG
A/D trigger enable bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in the input capture
function.
RW
ADEG
A/D trigger edge select bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in the input capture
function.
RW
External clock input select bit
0 : External clock input disabled
1 : External clock input enabled
RW
Set this bit to 1 (other than PWM3 mode) in
the input capture function.
RW
(2)
PWM3
PWM3 mode select bit
NOTES:
1. Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits are set to 0 (count stops).
2. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or PWM3 mode), the setting of the PWM3 bit is
enabled.
TRDFCR Register in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Normal-phase output level select bit This bit is disabled in the input capture
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or function.
complementary PWM mode)
STCLK
Figure 16.72
RW
Page 231 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Digital Filter Function Select Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDDF0
TRDDF1
Bit Symbol
Address
013Eh
013Fh
Bit Name
TRDIOA pin digital filter function
select bit
Function
0 : Function is not used
1 : Function is used
DFB
TRDIOB pin digital filter function
select bit
0 : Function is not used
1 : Function is used
RW
DFC
TRDIOC pin digital filter function
select bit
0 : Function is not used
1 : Function is used
RW
DFD
TRDIOD pin digital filter function
select bit
0 : Function is not used
1 : Function is used
RW
DFA
—
(b5-b4)
DFCK0
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Clock select bits for digital filter
function
DFCK1
Figure 16.73
After Reset
00h
00h
Page 232 of 450
RW
—
b7 b6
0
0
1
1
0 : f32
1 : f8
0 : f1
1 : Count source (clock selected by
bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the
TRDCRi register)
Registers TRDDF0 to TRDDF1 in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Control Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDCR0
TRDCR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0140h
0150h
Bit Name
Count source select bits
After Reset
00h
00h
Function
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
TCK1
TCK2
External clock edge select bits (2)
CKEG1
TRDi counter clear select bits
CCLR0
CCLR1
CCLR2
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRDCLK input(1)
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
b4 b3
0
0
1
1
CKEG0
RW
b2 b1 b0
0 : Count at the rising edge
1 : Count at the falling edge
0 : Count at both edges
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
b7 b6 b5
0 0 0 : Disable clear (free-running
operation)
0 0 1 : Clear by input capture in the
TRDGRAi register
0 1 0 : Clear by input capture in the
TRDGRBi register
0 1 1 : Synchronous clear (clear
simultaneously w ith other
channel counter)(3)
1 0 0 : Do not set.
1 0 1 : Clear by input capture in the
TRDGRCi register
1 1 0 : Clear by input capture in the
TRDGRDi register
1 1 1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. This setting is enabled w hen the STCLK bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
2. Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 are enabled w hen bits TCK2 to TCK0 are set to 101b (TRDCLK input) and the STCLK bit in the
TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
3. This setting is enabled w hen the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (registers TRD0 and TRD1 operate
synchronously).
Figure 16.74
Registers TRDCR0 to TRDCR1 in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 233 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD I/O Control Register Ai (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
Symbol
TRDIORA0
TRDIORA1
Bit Symbol
Address
0141h
0151h
Bit Name
TRDGRA control bits
IOA1
IOA3
RW
RW
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
RW
Input capture input sw itch
bit(3, 4)
0 : fOCO128 Signal
1 : TRDIOA0 pin input
RW
TRDGRB control bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRBi register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRDGRBi register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRBi register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOB1
—
(b7)
RW
TRDGRA mode select bit(1)
IOB0
IOB2
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRAi register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRDGRAi register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRAi register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOA0
IOA2
After Reset
10001000b
10001000b
TRDGRB mode select bit(2)
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
RW
RW
—
NOTES:
1. To select 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRAi register) for this bit by the BFCi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOC2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
2. To select 1 (the TRDGRDi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRBi register) for this bit by the BFDi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOD2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
3. The IOA3 bit is enabled in the TRDIORA0 register only. Set to the IOA3 bit in TRDIORA1 to 1.
4. The IOA3 bit is enabled w hen the IOA2 bit is set to 1 (input capture function).
Figure 16.75
Registers TRDIORA0 to TRDIORA1 in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 234 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD I/O Control Register Ci (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1 1
1 1
Symbol
TRDIORC0
TRDIORC1
Bit Symbol
Address
0142h
0152h
Bit Name
TRDGRC control bits
IOC1
IOC3
RW
RW
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
RW
TRDGRC register function
select bit
Set to 1 (general register or buffer register) in
the input capture function.
RW
TRDGRD control bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRDi register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRDGRDi register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRDi register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOD1
IOD3
RW
TRDGRC mode select bit(1)
IOD0
IOD2
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRCi register
at the rising edge
0 1 : Input capture to the TRDGRCi register
at the falling edge
1 0 : Input capture to the TRDGRCi register
at both edges
1 1 : Do not set.
IOC0
IOC2
After Reset
10001000b
10001000b
RW
RW
TRDGRD mode select bit(2)
Set to 1 (input capture) in the input capture
function.
RW
TRDGRD register function
select bit
Set to 1 (general register or buffer register) in
the input capture function.
RW
NOTES:
1. To select 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRAi register) for this bit by the BFCi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOC2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
2. To select 1 (the TRDGRDi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRBi register) for this bit by the BFDi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOD2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
Figure 16.76
Registers TRDIORC0 to TRDIORC1 in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 235 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Status Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0143h
0153h
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
flag A
IMFA
After Reset
11100000b
11000000b
Function
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2)
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
TRDSR0 register:
fOCO128 signal edge w hen the IOA3 bit in the
TRDIORA0 register is set to 0 (fOCO128 signal)
TRDIOA0 pin input edge w hen the IOA3 bit in the
TRDIORA0 register is set to 1 (TRDIOA0 input)(3)
RW
RW
TRDSR1 register:
Input edge of TRDIOA1 pin(3)
IMFB
IMFC
IMFD
Input capture/compare match
flag B
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2)
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
Input edge of TRDIOBi pin(3)
RW
Input capture/compare match
flag C
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2)
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
Input edge of TRDIOCi pin(4)
RW
Input capture/compare match
flag D
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2)
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
Input edge of TRDIODi pin(4)
RW
Overflow flag
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2)
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRDi register overflow s
RW
OVF
UDF
—
(b7-b6)
Underflow flag(1)
This bit is disabled in the input capture function.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. Nothing is assigned to b5 in the TRDSR0 register. When w riting to b5, w rite 0. When reading, the content is 1.
2. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit. (This bit remains 1 even
if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0.)
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten to it.
3. Edge selected by bits IOj1 to IOj0 (j = A or B) in the TRDIORAi register.
4. Edge selected by bits IOk1 to IOk0 (k = C or D) in the TRDIORCi register
Including w hen the BFki bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRDGRki is used as the buffer register).
Figure 16.77
Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 236 of 450
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDIER0
TRDIER1
Bit Symbol
After Reset
11100000b
11100000b
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit A
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the IMFA bit
IMIEB
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the IMFB bit
RW
IMIEC
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the IMFC bit
RW
IMIED
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the IMFD bit
RW
OVIE
Overflow /underflow interrupt
enable bit
0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the OVF bit
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the OVF bit
RW
IMIEA
—
(b7-b5)
Figure 16.78
Address
0144h
0154h
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
RW
—
Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in Input Capture Function
Timer RD Counter i (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRD0
TRD1
Address
0147h-0146h
0157h-0156h
Function
Count the count source. Count operation is incremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRDSRi register is set to 1.
NOTE:
1. Access the TRDi register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.79
Registers TRD0 to TRD1 in Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 237 of 450
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD General Registers Ai, Bi, Ci, and Di (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
TRDGRA0
TRDGRB0
TRDGRC0
TRDGRD0
TRDGRA1
TRDGRB1
TRDGRC1
TRDGRD1
0149h-0148h
014Bh-014Ah
014Dh-014Ch
014Fh-014Eh
0159h-0158h
015Bh-015Ah
015Dh-015Ch
015Fh-015Eh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
Function
Refer to Table 16.38 TRDGRji Register Functions in Input Capture Function
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access registers TRDGRAi to TRDGRDi in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.80
Registers TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRCi, and TRDGRDi in Input Capture Function
The following registers are disabled in the input capture function: TRDOER1, TRDOER2, TRDOCR,
TRDPOCR0, and TRDPOCR1.
Table 16.38
TRDGRji Register Functions in Input Capture Function
Register
TRDGRAi
Setting
−
TRDGRBi
TRDGRCi
BFCi = 0
TRDGRDi
BFDi = 0
TRDGRCi
BFCi = 1
TRDGRDi
BFDi = 1
Register Function
General register
The value in the TRDi register can be read at input
capture.
General register
The value in the TRDi register can be read at input
capture.
Buffer register
The value in the TRDi register can be read at input
capture. (Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation)
Input-Capture Input Pin
TRDIOAi
TRDIOBi
TRDIOCi
TRDIODi
TRDIOAi
TRDIOBi
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
BFCi, BFDi: Bits in TRDMR register
Set the pulse width of the input capture signal applied to the TRDIOji pin to 3 cycles or more of the timer RD
operation clock (refer to Table 16.25 Timer RD Operation Clocks) for no digital filter (the DFj bit in the
TRDDFi register set to 0).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 238 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
TRDCLK input
count source
Count value
in TRDi register
FFFFh
0009h
0006h
0000h
TSTARTi bit in
TRDSTR register
1
0
65536
TRDIOAi input
TRDGRAi register
0006h
Transfer
TRDGRCi register
0009h
Transfer
0006h
IMFA bit in
TRDSRi register
1
OVF bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
0
i = 0 or 1
The above applies under the following conditions:
Bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 001b. (the TRDi register set to 0000h by TRDGRAi register input capture).
Bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 101b (TRDCLK input for the count source).
Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 01b (count at the falling edge for the count source).
Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 101b (input capture at the falling edge of the TRDIOAi input).
The BFCi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as the buffer register of the TRDGRAi register).
Figure 16.81
Operating Example of Input Capture Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 239 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.5.1
16. Timers
Digital Filter
The TRDIOji input is sampled, and when the sampled input level matches 3 times, its level is determined.
Select the digital filter function and sampling clock by the TRDDFi register.
Figure 16.82 shows a Block Diagram of Digital Filter.
TCK2 to TCK0
fOCO40M
TRDCLK
f32
f8
f4
f2
DFCK1 to DFCK0
= 110b
= 00b
f32
= 101b
= 01b
f8
= 100b
= 10b
f1
= 011b
= 11b
Count source
= 010b
IOA2 to IOA0
IOB2 to IOB0
IOC3 to IOC0
IOD3 to IOD0
= 001b
= 000b
f1
Sampling clock
DFj
C
TRDIOji input signal
D
C
Q
D
Latch
C
Q
D
Latch
1
C
Q
Latch
D
Q
Match
detection
circuit
Edge detection
circuit
Latch
0
Timer RD operation clock
f1, fOCO40M)
C
D
Q
Latch
Clock period selected by
bits TCK2 to TCK0 or
bits DFCK1 to DFCK0
Sampling clock
TRDIOji input signal
Recognition of the
signal change with
3-time match
Input signal through
digital filtering
Signal transmission delayed
up to 5-sampling clock
Transmission cannot be
performed without 3-time match
because the input signal is
assumed to be noise.
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
TCK0 to TCK2: Bits in TRDCRi register
DFCK0 to DFCK1 and DFj: Bits in TRDDF register
IOA0 to IOA2 and IOB0 to IOB2: Bits in TRDIORAi register
IOC0 to IOC3 and IOD0 to IOD3: Bits in TRDIORCi register
Figure 16.82
Block Diagram of Digital Filter
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 240 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.6
16. Timers
Output Compare Function
This function detects matches (compare match) between the content of the TRDGRji (j = either A, B, C, or D)
register and the content of the TRDi (i = 0 or 1) register. When the content matches, a user-set level is output
from the TRDIOji pin. Since this function is enabled with a combination of the TRDIOji pin and TRDGRji
register, the output compare function, or any other mode or function, can be selected for each individual pin.
Figure 16.83 shows a Block Diagram of Output Compare Function, Table 16.39 lists the Output Compare
Function Specifications. Figures 16.84 to 16.95 list the Registers Associated with Output Compare Function,
and Figure 16.96 shows an Operating Example of Output Compare Function.
Channel 0
TRD0
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOA0
IOC3 = 0 in
TRDIORC0 register
Comparator
TRDGRA0
Comparator
TRDGRC0
Comparator
TRDGRB0
Comparator
TRDGRD0
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOC0
IOC3 = 1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOB0
IOD3 = 0 in
TRDIORD0 register
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOD0
IOD3 = 1
Channel 1
TRD1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOA1
IOC3 = 0 in
TRDIORC1 register
Comparator
TRDGRA1
Comparator
TRDGRC1
Comparator
TRDGRB1
Comparator
TRDGRD1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOC1
IOC3 = 1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOB1
IOD3 = 0 in
TRDIORD1 register
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOD1
Figure 16.83
IOD3 = 1
Block Diagram of Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 241 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.39
16. Timers
Output Compare Function Specifications
Item
Specification
Count sources
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M
External signal input to the TRDCLK pin (valid edge selected by a program)
Count operations
Increment
Count period
• When bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 000b (free-running
operation)
1/fk × 65536 fk: Frequency of count source
• Bits CCLR1 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 01b or 10b (set the TRDi
register to 0000h at the compare match in the TRDGRji register).
Frequency of count source x (n+1)
n: Setting value in the TRDGRji register
Waveform output timing
Compare match
Count start condition
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register.
Count stop conditions
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register when the
CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1.
The output compare output pin holds output level before the count stops.
• When the CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 0, the count stops at the
compare match in the TRDGRAi register.
The output compare output pin holds level after output change by the compare
match.
Interrupt request generation
timing
• Compare match (content of the TRDi register matches content of the TRDGRji
register.)
• TRDi register overflows
TRDIOA0 pin function
Programmable I/O port, output-compare output, or TRDCLK (external clock) input
TRDIOB0, TRDIOC0,
TRDIOD0, TRDIOA1 to
TRDIOD1 pin functions
Programmable I/O port or output-compare output (Selectable by pin)
INT0 pin function
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or INT0 interrupt input
Read from timer
The count value can be read by reading the TRDi register.
Write to timer
• When the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 0 (channels 0 and 1 operate
independently).
Data can be written to the TRDi register.
• When the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (channels 0 and 1 operate
synchronously).
Data can be written to both the TRD0 and TRD1 registers by writing to the TRDi
register.
Select functions
• Output-compare output pin selected
Either 1 pin or multiple pins among TRDIOAi, TRDIOBi, TRDIOCi, or TRDIODi.
• Output level at the compare match selected
“L” output, “H” output, or output level inversed
• Initial output level selected
Set the level at period from the count start to the compare match.
• Timing to set the TRDi register to 0000h
Overflow or compare match in the TRDGRAi register
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Synchronous operation (Refer to 16.4.3 Synchronous Operation.)
• Output pin in registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi changed
The TRDGRCi register can be used as output control of the TRDIOAi pin and the
TRDGRDi register can be used as output control of the TRDIOBi pin.
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced
Cutoff.)
• Timer RD can be used as the internal timer without output.
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 242 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Start Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSTR
Bit Symbol
TSTART0
TSTART1
CSEL0
CSEL1
—
(b7-b4)
Address
0137h
Bit Name
TRD0 count start flag(4)
After Reset
11111100b
Function
RW
0 : Count stops (2)
1 : Count starts
RW
TRD1 count start flag(5)
0 : Count stops (3)
1 : Count starts
RW
TRD0 count operation
select bit
0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith the
TRDGRA0 register
1 : Count continues after the compare match
w ith the TRDGRA0 register
RW
TRD1 count operation
select bit
0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith the
TRDGRA1 register
1 : Count continues after the compare match
w ith the TRDGRA1 register
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
NOTES:
1. Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction (do not use the bit handling instruction). Refer to 16.4.12.1
TRDSTR Register of Notes on Tim er RD.
2. When the CSEL0 bit is
3. When the CSEL1 bit is
4. When the CSEL0 bit is
stops).
5. When the CSEL1 bit is
stops).
set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART0 bit.
set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART1 bit.
set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA0) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA1) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
Timer RD Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDMR
Bit Symbol
Address
0138h
Bit Name
Timer RD synchronous bit
SYNC
—
(b3-b1)
After Reset
00001110b
Function
0 : Registers TRD0 and TRD1
operate independently
1 : Registers TRD0 and TRD1
operate synchronously
—
BFC0
TRDGRC0 register function select 0 : General register
bit(1)
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA0 register
RW
BFD0
TRDGRD0 register function select 0 : General register
bit(1)
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB0 register
RW
BFC1
TRDGRC1 register function select 0 : General register
bit(1)
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA1 register
RW
BFD1
TRDGRD1 register function select 0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB1 register
bit(1)
RW
Registers TRDSTR and TRDMR in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTE:
1. When selecting 0 (change the TRDGRji register output pin) by the IOj3 (j = C or D) bit in the TRDIORCi (i = 0 or 1)
register, set the BFji bit in the TRDMR register to 0.
Figure 16.84
RW
Page 243 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD PWM Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0
0 0 0
Symbol
TRDPMR
Bit Symbol
PWMB0
PWMC0
PWMD0
—
(b3)
PWMB1
PWMC1
PWMD1
—
(b7)
Figure 16.85
Address
0139h
Bit Name
PWM mode of TRDIOB0 select bit
After Reset
10001000b
Function
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the output
compare function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOC0 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the output
compare function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOD0 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the output
compare function.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
PWM mode of TRDIOB1 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the output
compare function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOC1 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the output
compare function.
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOD1 select bit
Set to 0 (timer mode) in the output
compare function.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
TRDPMR Register in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 244 of 450
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Function Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
0 0
Symbol
TRDFCR
Bit Symbol
CMD0
Address
013Ah
Bit Name
Combination mode select bits (1)
After Reset
10000000b
Function
Set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or
PWM3 mode) in the output compare
function.
CMD1
RW
OLS0
RW
OLS1
Counter-phase output level select bit This bit is disabled in the output compare
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or function.
complementary PWM mode)
RW
ADTRG
A/D trigger enable bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in the output compare
function.
RW
ADEG
A/D trigger edge select bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in the output compare
function.
RW
External clock input select bit
0 : External clock input disabled
1 : External clock input enabled
RW
PWM3 mode select bit(2)
Set this bit to 1 (other than PWM3 mode) in
the output compare function.
RW
PWM3
NOTES:
1. Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits are set to 0 (count stops).
2. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or PWM3 mode), the setting of the PWM3 bit is
enabled.
TRDFCR Register in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Normal-phase output level select bit This bit is disabled in the output compare
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or function.
complementary PWM mode)
STCLK
Figure 16.86
RW
Page 245 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
Symbol
TRDOER1
Bit Symbol
Address
013Bh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output disable bit
EA0
TRDIOB0 output disable bit
EB0
TRDIOC0 output disable bit
EC0
TRDIOD0 output disable bit
ED0
TRDIOA1 output disable bit
EA1
TRDIOB1 output disable bit
EB1
TRDIOC1 output disable bit
EC1
TRDIOD1 output disable bit
ED1
After Reset
FFh
Function
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
013Ch
TRDOER2
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b6-b0)
When read, the content is 1.
After Reset
01111111b
Function
RW
—
_____
PTO
INT0 of pulse output forced
cutoff signal input enabled
bit(1)
0 : Pulse output forced cutoff input disabled
1 : Pulse output forced cutoff input enabled
(All bits in the TRDOER1 register
are set to 1 (disable output) w hen “L” is
_____
applied to the INT0 pin.)
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced Cutoff.
Figure 16.87
Registers TRDOER1 to TRDOER2 in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 246 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Control Register(1, 2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 1
Symbol
TRDOCR
Bit Symbol
TOA0
TOB0
TOC0
TOD0
TOA1
TOB1
TOC1
TOD1
Address
013Dh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output level select bit
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Initial output “L”
1 : Initial output “H”
RW
TRDIOB0 output level select bit
0 : Initial output “L”
1 : Initial output “H”
RW
TRDIOC0 initial output level select bit
0 : “L”
1 : “H”
RW
TRDIOD0 initial output level select bit
TRDIOA1 initial output level select bit
TRDIOB1 initial output level select bit
TRDIOC1 initial output level select bit
TRDIOD1 initial output level select bit
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to the TRDOCR register w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits in the TRDSTR register are set to 0 (count
stopped).
2. If the pin function is set for w aveform output (refer to Tables 16.26 to 16.33), the initial output level is output w hen
the TRDOCR register is set.
Figure 16.88
TRDOCR Register in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 247 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Control Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDCR0
TRDCR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0140h
0150h
Bit Name
Count source select bits
Function
TCK1
TCK2
External clock edge select
bits (2)
CKEG1
TRDi counter clear select
bits
CCLR0
CCLR1
CCLR2
RW
b2 b1 b0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
CKEG0
After Reset
00h
00h
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRDCLK input(1)
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
b4 b3
0
0
1
1
0 : Count at the rising edge
1 : Count at the falling edge
0 : Count at both edges
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
b7 b6 b5
0 0 0 : Disable clear (free-running operation)
0 0 1 : Clear by compare match w ith the
TRDGRAi register
0 1 0 : Clear by compare match w ith the
TRDGRBi register
0 1 1 : Synchronous clear (clear
simultaneously w ith other channel
counter)(3)
1 0 0 : Do not set.
1 0 1 : Clear by compare match w ith the
TRDGRCi register
1 1 0 : Clear by compare match w ith the
TRDGRDi register
1 1 1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. This setting is enabled w hen the STCLK bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
2. Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 are enabled w hen bits TCK2 to TCK0 are set to 101b (TRDCLK input) and the STCLK bit in the
TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
3. This setting is enabled w hen the SYNC bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRD0 and TRD1 operate
synchronously).
Figure 16.89
Registers TRDCR0 to TRDCR1 in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 248 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD I/O Control Register Ai (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
1 0
Symbol
TRDIORA0
TRDIORA1
Bit Symbol
Address
0141h
0151h
Bit Name
TRDGRA control bits
After Reset
10001000b
10001000b
Function
0 0 : Disable pin output by the compare match
(TRDIOAi pin functions as programmable
I/O port)
0 1 : “L” output at compare match w ith
the TRDGRAi register
1 0 : “H” output at compare match w ith
the TRDGRAi register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
w ith the TRDGRAi register
IOA0
IOA1
RW
b1 b0
RW
RW
IOA2
TRDGRA mode select bit(1) Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
RW
IOA3
Input capture input sw itch
bit
Set to 1.
RW
TRDGRB control bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Disable pin output by the compare match
(TRDIOBi pin functions as programmable
I/O port)
0 1 : “L” output at compare match
w ith the TRDGRBi register
1 0 : “H” output at compare match
w ith the TRDGRBi
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
w ith the TRDGRBi register
IOB0
IOB1
IOB2
—
(b7)
TRDGRB mode select bit(2)
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
RW
RW
—
NOTES:
1. To select 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRAi register) for this bit by the BFCi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOC2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
2. To select 1 (the TRDGRDi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRBi register) for this bit by the BFDi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOD2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
Figure 16.90
Registers TRDIORA0 to TRDIORA1 in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 249 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD I/O Control Register Ci (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0
Symbol
TRDIORC0
TRDIORC1
Bit Symbol
Address
0142h
0152h
Bit Name
TRDGRC control bits
IOC1
RW
RW
RW
TRDGRC mode select bit(1)
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
RW
TRDGRC register function
select bit
0 : TRDIOA output register
(Refer to 16.4.6.1 Changing Output Pins in
Registers TRDGRCi (i = 0 or 1) and
TRDGRDi.)
1 : General register or buffer register
RW
IOC3
TRDGRD control bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Disable pin output by compare match
0 1 : “L” output at compare match w ith
the TRDGRDi register
1 0 : “H” output at compare match w ith
the TRDGRDi register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
w ith the TRDGRDi register
IOD0
IOD1
IOD2
Function
b1 b0
0 0 : Disable pin output by compare match
0 1 : “L” output at compare match w ith
the TRDGRCi register
1 0 : “H” output at compare match w ith
the TRDGRCi register
1 1 : Toggle output by compare match
w ith the TRDGRCi register
IOC0
IOC2
After Reset
10001000b
10001000b
RW
RW
TRDGRD mode select bit(2)
Set to 0 (output compare) in the output compare
function.
RW
TRDGRD register function
select bit
0 : TRDIOB output register
(Refer to 16.4.6.1 Changing Output Pins in
Registers TRDGRCi (i = 0 or 1) and
TRDGRDi.)
1 : General register or buffer register
RW
IOD3
NOTES:
1. To select 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRAi register) for this bit by the BFCi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOC2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOA2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
2. To select 1 (the TRDGRDi register is used as a buffer register of the TRDGRBi register) for this bit by the BFDi bit in
the TRDMR register, set the IOD2 bit in the TRDIORCi register to the same value as the IOB2 bit in the TRDIORAi
register.
Figure 16.91
Registers TRDIORC0 to TRDIORC1 in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 250 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Status Register i (i=0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Bit Symbol
IMFA
Address
0143h
0153h
After Reset
11100000b
11000000b
Bit Name
Function
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag A
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRAi register.
IMFB
RW
IMFC
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag C
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRCi register (3).
RW
IMFD
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag D
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRDi register (3).
RW
OVF
UDF
—
(b7-b6)
Underflow flag(1)
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRDi register overflow s.
This bit is disabled in the output compare function.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. Nothing is assigned to b5 in the TRDSR0 register. When w riting to b5, w rite 0. When reading, the content is 1.
2. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit. (This bit remains
1 even if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0.)
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten to it.
3. Including w hen the BFji bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRDGRji is used as the buffer register).
Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag B
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRBi register.
Overflow flag
Figure 16.92
RW
Page 251 of 450
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDIER0
TRDIER1
Bit Symbol
IMIEA
IMIEB
IMIEC
IMIED
OVIE
—
(b7-b5)
Figure 16.93
Address
0144h
0154h
After Reset
11100000b
11100000b
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit A
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
RW
Overflow /underflow interrupt enable 0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the
bit
OVF bit
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF bit
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 252 of 450
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Counter i (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
0147h-0146h
0157h-0156h
TRD0
TRD1
Function
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRDSRi register is set to 1.
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access the TRDi register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.94
Registers TRD0 to TRD1 in Output Compare Function
Timer RD General Register Ai, Bi, Ci and Di (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
TRDGRA0
TRDGRB0
TRDGRC0
TRDGRD0
TRDGRA1
TRDGRB1
TRDGRC1
TRDGRD1
0149h-0148h
014Bh-014Ah
014Dh-014Ch
014Fh-014Eh
0159h-0158h
015Bh-015Ah
015Dh-015Ch
015Fh-015Eh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
Function
Refer to Table 16.40 TRDGRji Register Function in Output Com pare Function
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access registers TRDGRAi to TRDGRDi in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.95
Registers TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRCi, and TRDGRDi in Output Compare Function
The following registers are disabled in the output compare function: TRDDF0, TRDDF1, TRDPOCR0, and
TRDPOCR1.
Table 16.40
Register
TRDGRAi
TRDGRBi
TRDGRCi
TRDGRDi
TRDGRCi
TRDGRDi
TRDGRCi
TRDGRDi
TRDGRji Register Function in Output Compare Function
Setting
BFji
IOj3
−
−
0
1
1
1
0
0
Output-Compare
Output Pin
General register. Write the compare value.
TRDIOAi
TRDIOBi
General register. Write the compare value.
TRDIOCi
TRDIODi
Buffer register. Write the next compare value
TRDIOAi
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
TRDIOBi
TRDIOAi output control (Refer to 16.4.6.1 Changing TRDIOAi
Output Pins in Registers TRDGRCi (i = 0 or 1) and TRDIOBi
TRDGRDi.)
Register Function
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
BFji: Bit in TRDMR register
IOj3: Bit in TRDIORCi register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 253 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
Value in TRDi register
m
n
p
Count
restarts
Count
stops
TSTARTi bit in
TRDSTR register
1
0
m+1
m+1
Output level
held
TRDIOAi output
Output inverted by compare match
Initial output “L”
IMFA bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
n+1
TRDIOBi output
“H” output by compare match
Output level
held
n+1
Initial output “L”
IMFB bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
P+1
“L” output by compare match
Output level
held
TRDIOCi output
Initial output “H”
IMFC bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
i = 0 or 1
M: Value set in TRDGRAi register
n: Value set in TRDGRBi register
p: Value set in TRDGRCi register
The above applies under the following conditions:
The CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1 (the TRDi register is not stopped by compare match).
Bits BFCi and BFDi in the TRDMR register are set to 0 (registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi are not used as buffer registers).
Bits EAi, EBi, and ECi in the TRDOER1 register are set to 0 (enable the TRDIOAi, TRDIOBi and TRDIOCi pin outputs).
Bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 001b (set the TRDi register to 000h by compare match in the TRDGRAi register).
Bits TOAi and TOBi in the TRDOCR register is set to 0 (initial output “L” to compare match), the TOCi bit is set to 1 (initial output “H” to compare match).
Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 011b (TRDIOAi output inverted at TRDGRAi register compare match).
Bits IOB2 to IOB0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 010b (TRDIOBi “H” output at TRDGRBi register compare match).
Bits IOC3 to IOC0 in the TRDIORCi register are set to 1001b (TRDIOCi “L” output at TRDGRCi register compare match).
The IOD3 bit in the TRDIORCi register is set to 1 (TRDGRDi register does not control TRDIOBi pin output).
Figure 16.96
Operating Example of Output Compare Function
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 254 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.6.1
16. Timers
Changing Output Pins in Registers TRDGRCi (i = 0 or 1) and TRDGRDi
The TRDGRCi register can be used for output control of the TRDIOAi pin, and the TRDGRDi register can be
used for output control of the TRDIOBi pin. Therefore, each pin output can be controlled as follows:
• TRDIOAi output is controlled by the values in registers TRDGRAi and TRDGRCi.
• TRDIOBi output is controlled by the values in registers TRDGRBi and TRDGRDi.
Change output pins in registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi as follows:
• Select 0 (change TRDGRji register output pin) by the IOj3 (j = C or D) bit in the TRDIORCi register.
• Set the BFji bit in the TRDMR register to 0 (general register).
• Set different values in registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRAi. Also, set different values in registers
TRDGRDi and TRDGRBi.
Figure 16.98 shows an Operating Example When TRDGRCi Register is Used for Output Control of TRDIOAi
Pin and TRDGRDi Register is Used for Output Control of TRDIOBi Pin.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 255 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Channel 0
TRD0
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOA0
IOC3 = 0 in
TRDIORC0 register
Comparator
TRDGRA0
Comparator
TRDGRC0
Comparator
TRDGRB0
Comparator
TRDGRD0
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOC0
IOC3 = 1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOB0
IOD3 = 0 in
TRDIORD0 register
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOD0
IOD3 = 1
Channel 1
TRD1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOA1
IOC3 = 0 in
TRDIORC1 register
Comparator
TRDGRA1
Comparator
TRDGRC1
Comparator
TRDGRB1
Comparator
TRDGRD1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOC1
IOC3 = 1
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOB1
IOD3 = 0 in
TRDIORD1 register
Compare match signal
Output
control
TRDIOD1
Figure 16.97
IOD3 = 1
Changing Output Pins in Registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 256 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
Value in TRDi register
FFFFh
m
n
p
q
0000h
m+1
n+1
m-n
p+1
q+1
p-q
Initial output “L”
TRDIOAi output
Output inverted by compare match
IMFA bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
IMFC bit in
TRDSRi register
Set to 0 by a program
1
0
Initial output “L”
TRDIOBi output
Output inverted by compare match
IMFB bit in
TRDSRi register
1
IMFD bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
m: Value set in TRDGRAi register
n: Value set in TRDGRCi register
p: Value set in TRDGRBi register
q: Value set in TRDGRDi register
i = 0 or 1
The above applies under the following conditions:
The CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1 (the TRDi register is not stopped by compare match).
Bits BFCi and BFDi in the TRDMR register are set to 0 (registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi are not used as buffer register).
Bits EAi and EBi in the TRDOER1 register are set to 0 (enable TRDIOAi and TRDIOBi pin outputs).
Bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi register are set to 001b (set the TRDi register to 0000h by compare match in the TRDGRAi register).
Bits TOAi and TOBi in the TRDOCR register are set to 0 (initial output “L” to compare match).
Bits IOA2 to IOA0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 011b (TRDIOAi output inverted at TRDGRAi register compare match).
Bits IOB2 to IOB0 in the TRDIORAi register are set to 011b (TRDIOBi output inverted at TRDGRBi register compare match).
Bits IOC3 to IOC0 in the TRDIORCi register are set to 0011b (TRDIOAi output inverted at TRDGRCi register compare match).
Bits IOD3 to IOD0 in the TRDIORCi register are set to 0011b (TRDIOBi output inverted at TRDGRDi register compare match).
Figure 16.98
Operating Example When TRDGRCi Register is Used for Output Control of TRDIOAi
Pin and TRDGRDi Register is Used for Output Control of TRDIOBi Pin
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 257 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.7
16. Timers
PWM Mode
In PWM mode, a PWM waveform is output. Up to 3 PWM waveforms with the same period can be output by 1
channel. Also, up to 6 PWM waveforms with the same period can be output by synchronizing channels 0 and 1.
Since this mode functions by a combination of the TRDIOji (i = 0 or 1, j = B, C, or D) pin and TRDGRji
register, the PWM mode, or any other mode or function, can be selected for each individual pin. (However,
since the TRDGRAi register is used when using any pin for PWM mode, the TRDGRAi register cannot be used
for other modes.)
Figure 16.99 shows a Block Diagram of PWM Mode, and Table 16.41 lists the PWM Mode Specifications.
Figures 16.100 to 16.109 show the Registers Associated with PWM Mode, and Figures 16.110 and 16.111 show
Operating Examples of PWM Mode.
TRDi
Compare match signal
Comparator
TRDIOBi
TRDGRAi
Compare match signal
(Note 1)
TRDIOCi
Output
control
Comparator
TRDGRBi
Comparator
TRDGRCi
Compare match signal
TRDIODi
Compare match signal
(Note 2)
Comparator
TRDGRDi
i = 0 or 1
NOTES:
1. When the BFCi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRCi register is used as the
buffer register of the TRDGRAi register).
2. When the BFDi bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRDi register is used as the
buffer register of the TRDGRBi register).
Figure 16.99
Block Diagram of PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 258 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.41
16. Timers
PWM Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Count sources
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M
External signal input to the TRDCLK pin (valid edge selected by a
program)
Count operations
Increment
PWM waveform
PWM period: 1/fk x (m+1)
Active level width: 1/fk x (m-n)
Inactive level width: 1/fk x (n+1)
fk: Frequency of count source
m: Value set in the TRDGRAi (i = 0 or 1) register
n: Value set in the TRDGRji (j = B, C, or D) register
m+1
n+1
m-n
(When “L” is selected as the active level)
Count start condition
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register.
Count stop conditions
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register
when the CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1.
The PWM output pin holds output level before the count stops.
• When the CSELi bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 0, the count
stops at the compare match in the TRDGRAi register.
The PWM output pin holds level after output change by compare
match.
Interrupt request generation
timing
• Compare match (The content of the TRDi register matches content of
the TRDGRji register.)
• TRDi register overflows
TRDIOA0 pin function
Programmable I/O port or TRDCLK (external clock) input
TRDIOA1 pin function
Programmable I/O port
TRDIOB0, TRDIOC0, TRDIOD0, Programmable I/O port or pulse output (selectable by pin)
TRDIOB1, TRDIOC1, TRDIOD1
pin functions
INT0 pin function
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or INT0
interrupt input
Read from timer
The count value can be read by reading the TRDi register.
Write to timer
The value can be written to the TRDi register.
Select functions
• 1 to 3 PWM output pins selected per 1 channel
Either 1 pin or multiple pins of the TRDIOBi, TRDIOCi or TRDIODi
pin.
• The active level selected by pin.
• Initial output level selected by pin.
• Synchronous operation (Refer to 16.4.3 Synchronous Operation.)
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output
Forced Cutoff.)
i = 0 or 1
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 259 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Start Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSTR
Bit Symbol
TSTART0
TSTART1
Address
0137h
Bit Name
TRD0 count start flag(4)
TRD1 count start flag(5)
After Reset
11111100b
Function
RW
0 : Count stops (2)
1 : Count starts
RW
0 : Count stops (3)
1 : Count starts
RW
CSEL0
TRD0 count operation select bit 0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith
the TRDGRA0 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA0 register
RW
CSEL1
TRD1 count operation select bit 0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith
the TRDGRA1 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA1 register
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
NOTES:
1. Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction (do not use the bit handling instruction). Refer to 16.4.12.1
TRDSTR Register of Notes on Tim er RD.
2. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART0 bit.
3. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART1 bit.
4. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA0) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
5. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA1) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
Timer RD Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDMR
Bit Symbol
Address
0138h
Bit Name
Timer RD synchronous bit
SYNC
—
(b3-b1)
After Reset
00001110b
Function
0 : Registers TRD0 and TRD1 operate
independently
1 : Registers TRD0 and TRD1 operate
synchronously
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
BFC0
TRDGRC0 register function
select bit
0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA0 register
RW
BFD0
TRDGRD0 register function
select bit
0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB0 register
RW
BFC1
TRDGRC1 register function
select bit
0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA1 register
RW
BFD1
TRDGRD1 register function
select bit
0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB1 register
RW
Figure 16.100 Registers TRDSTR and TRDMR in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 260 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD PWM Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDPMR
Bit Symbol
PWMB0
PWMC0
PWMD0
—
(b3)
PWMB1
PWMC1
PWMD1
—
(b7)
Address
0139h
Bit Name
PWM mode of TRDIOB0 select bit
RW
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOC0 select bit
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOD0 select bit
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
PWM mode of TRDIOB1 select bit
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOC1 select bit
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
PWM mode of TRDIOD1 select bit
0 : Timer mode
1 : PWM mode
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
Figure 16.101 TRDPMR Register in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
After Reset
10001000b
Function
Page 261 of 450
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Function Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
0 0
Symbol
TRDFCR
Bit Symbol
CMD0
Address
013Ah
Bit Name
Combination mode select bits (1)
After Reset
10000000b
Function
Set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or
PWM3 mode) in PWM mode.
CMD1
RW
RW
OLS0
Normal-phase output level select Bit This bit is disabled in PWM mode.
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or
complementary PWM mode)
RW
OLS1
Counter-phase output level select bit This bit is disabled in PWM mode.
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or
complementary PWM mode)
RW
ADTRG
A/D trigger enable bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in PWM mode.
ADEG
A/D trigger edge select bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in PWM mode.
External clock input select bit
0 : External clock input disabled
1 : External clock input enabled
RW
PWM3 mode select bit(2)
Set this bit to 1 (other than PWM3 mode) in
PWM mode.
RW
STCLK
PWM3
NOTES:
1. Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits are set to 0 (count stops).
2. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or PWM3 mode), the setting of the PWM3 bit is
enabled.
Figure 16.102 TRDFCR Register in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 262 of 450
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
Symbol
TRDOER1
Bit Symbol
Address
013Bh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output disable bit
EA0
TRDIOB0 output disable bit
EB0
TRDIOC0 output disable bit
EC0
TRDIOD0 output disable bit
ED0
TRDIOA1 output disable bit
EA1
TRDIOB1 output disable bit
EB1
TRDIOC1 output disable bit
EC1
TRDIOD1 output disable bit
ED1
After Reset
FFh
Function
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
013Ch
TRDOER2
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b6-b0)
When read, the content is 1.
After Reset
01111111b
Function
RW
—
_____
PTO
INT0 of pulse output forced
0 : Pulse output forced cutoff input disabled
cutoff signal input enabled bit(1) 1 : Pulse output forced cutoff input enabled
(All bits in the TRDOER1 register
are set to 1 (disable output) w hen “L” is
_____
applied to the INT0 pin.)
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced Cutoff.
Figure 16.103 Registers TRDOER1 to TRDOER2 in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 263 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Control Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0
Symbol
TRDOCR
Bit Symbol
TOA0
TOB0
TOC0
TOD0
TOA1
TOB1
TOC1
TOD1
Address
013Dh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output level select bit
After Reset
00h
Function
Set this bit to 0 (enable output) in
PWM mode.
RW
TRDIOB0 output level select bit(2)
TRDIOC0 initial output level select bit(2)
TRDIOD0 initial output level select bit(2)
TRDIOA1 initial output level select bit
0 : Initial output is inactive
level
1 : Initial output is active level
RW
RW
RW
Set this bit to 0 (enable output) in
PWM mode.
RW
TRDIOB1 initial output level select bit(2)
TRDIOC1 initial output level select bit(2)
TRDIOD1 initial output level select bit(2)
0 : Inactive level
1 : Active level
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to the TRDOCR register w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits in the TRDSTR register are set to 0 (count
stops).
2. If the pin function is set for w aveform output (refer to Tables 16.27 to 16.29 and Tables 16.31 to 16.33), the initial
output level is output w hen the TRDOCR register is set.
Timer RD Control Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 1
Symbol
TRDCR0
TRDCR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0140h
0150h
Bit Name
Count source select bits
Function
TCK1
TCK2
External clock edge select bits (2)
CKEG1
TRDi counter clear select bits
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRDCLK input(1)
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
b4 b3
0
0
1
1
CKEG0
RW
b2 b1 b0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
CCLR0
CCLR1
CCLR2
After Reset
00h
00h
0 : Count at the rising edge
1 : Count at the falling edge
0 : Count at both edges
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
Set to 001b (the TRDi register cleared at
RW
compare match w ith TRDGRAi register) in PWM RW
mode.
RW
NOTES:
1. This setting is enabled w hen the STCLK bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
2. Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 are enabled w hen bits TCK2 to TCK0 are set to 101b (TRDCLK input) and the STCLK bit in the
TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
Figure 16.104 Registers TRDOCR and TRDCR0 to TRDCR1 in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 264 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Status Register i (i=0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Bit Symbol
IMFA
Address
0143h
0153h
After Reset
11100000b
11000000b
Bit Name
Function
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag A
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRAi register.
RW
IMFB
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag B
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRBi register.
RW
IMFC
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag C
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRCi register (3).
RW
IMFD
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag D
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRDi register (3).
RW
Overflow flag
OVF
UDF
—
(b7-b6)
Underflow flag(1)
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRDi register overflow s.
This bit is disabled in PWM mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. Nothing is assigned to b5 in the TRDSR0 register. When w riting to b5, w rite 0. When reading, the content is 1.
2. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit. (This bit remains
1 even if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0.)
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten.
3. Including w hen the BFji bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRDGRji is used as the buffer register).
Figure 16.105 Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 265 of 450
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDIER0
TRDIER1
Bit Symbol
IMIEA
IMIEB
IMIEC
IMIED
OVIE
—
(b7-b5)
Address
0144h
0154h
After Reset
11100000b
11100000b
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit A
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
RW
Overflow /underflow interrupt enable 0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the
bit
OVF bit
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF bit
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
Figure 16.106 Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 266 of 450
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD PWM Mode Output Level Control Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDPOCR0
TRDPOCR1
Bit Symbol
POLB
POLC
POLD
—
(b7-b3)
Address
0145h
0155h
After Reset
11111000b
11111000b
Bit Name
PWM mode output level control bit
B
Function
0 : “L” active TRDIOBi output level is
selected
1 : “H” active TRDIOBi output level is
selected
PWM mode output level control bit
C
0 : “L” active TRDIOCi output level is
selected
1 : “H” active TRDIOCi output level is
selected
RW
PWM mode output level control bit
D
0 : “L” active TRDIODi output level is
selected
1 : “H” active TRDIODi output level is
selected
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
RW
—
Figure 16.107 Registers TRDPOCR0 to TRDPOCR1 in PWM Mode
Timer RD Counter i (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRD0
TRD1
Address
0147h-0146h
0157h-0156h
Function
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRDSRi register is set to 1.
NOTE:
1. Access the TRDi register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.108 Registers TRD0 to TRD1 in PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 267 of 450
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD General Registers Ai, Bi, Ci, and Di (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
TRDGRA0
TRDGRB0
TRDGRC0
TRDGRD0
TRDGRA1
TRDGRB1
TRDGRC1
TRDGRD1
0149h-0148h
014Bh-014Ah
014Dh-014Ch
014Fh-014Eh
0159h-0158h
015Bh-015Ah
015Dh-015Ch
015Fh-015Eh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
Function
Refer to Table 16.42 TRDGRji Register Functions in PWM Mode.
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access registers TRDGRAi to TRDGRDi in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.109 Registers TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRCi, and TRDGRDi in PWM Mode
The following registers are disabled in the PWM mode: TRDDF0, TRDDF1, TRDIORA0, TRDIORC0,
TRDIORA1, and TRDIORC1.
Table 16.42
TRDGRji Register Functions in PWM Mode
Register
Setting
Register Function
PWM Output Pin
TRDGRAi
−
General register. Set the PWM period
TRDGRBi
−
General register. Set the changing point of PWM output TRDIOBi
TRDGRCi
BFCi = 0
General register. Set the changing point of PWM output TRDIOCi
TRDGRDi
BFDi = 0
TRDIODi
TRDGRCi
BFCi = 1
Buffer register. Set the next PWM period
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
TRDGRDi
BFDi = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of the next PWM TRDIOBi
output
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
i = 0 or 1
BFCi, BFDi: Bits in TRDMR register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 268 of 450
−
−
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
Value in TRDi register
m
n
p
q
m+1
n+1
m-n
Active level “H”
Initial output “L”
to compare match
TRDIOBi output
Inactive level “L”
p+1
TRDIOCi output
Initial output “H”
to compare match
m-p
Inactive level “H”
q+1
m-q
Active level “L”
TRDIODi output
Initial output “L”
to compare match
IMFA bit in
TRDSRi register
1
IMFB bit in
TRDSRi register
1
IMFC bit in
TRDSRi register
1
IMFD bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
m: Value set in TRDGRAi register
n: Value set in TRDGRBi register
p: Value set in TRDGRCi register
q: Value set in TRDGRDi register
i = 0 or 1
The above applies under the following conditions:
Bits BFCi and BFDi in the TRDMR register are set to 0 (registers TRDGRCi and TRDGRDi are not used as buffer registers).
Bits EBi, ECi and EDi in the TRDOER1 register are set to 0 (enable TRDIOBi, TRDIOCi and TRDIODi pin outputs).
Bits TOBi and TOCi in the TRDOCR register are set to 0 (inactive level), the TODi bit is set to 1 (active level).
The POLB bit in the TRDPOCRi register is set to 1 (active level “H”), bits POLC and POLD are set to 0 (active level “L”).
Figure 16.110 Operating Example of PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 269 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Value in TRDi register
p
m
q
n
0000h
TSTARTi bit in
TRDSTR register
1
Since no compare match in the TRDGRBi register is
generated, “L” is not applied to the TRDIOBi output
0
TRDIOBi output
Duty 0%
n
TRDGRBi register
p (p>m)
q
Rewrite by a program
IMFA bit in
TRDSRi register
1
IMFB bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
Value in TRDi register
m
p
n
0000h
TSTARTi bit in
TRDSTR register
1
When compare matches with registers TRDGRAi and TRDGRBi are generated
simultaneously, the compare match with the TRDGRBi register has priority.
“L” is applied to the TRDIOBi output without any change.
0
Duty 100%
TRDIOBi output
“L” is applied to TRDIOBi output at compare match
with the TRDGRBi register with no change.
TRDGRBi register
n
m
p
Rewrite by a program
IMFA bit in
TRDSRi register
1
IMFB bit in
TRDSRi register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
i = 0 or 1
m: Value set in TRDGRAi register
The above applies under the following conditions:
The EBi bit in the TRDOER1 register is set to 0 (enable TRDIOBi output).
The POLB bit in the TRDPOCRi register is set to 0 (active level “L”).
Figure 16.111 Operating Example of PWM Mode (Duty 0%, Duty 100%)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 270 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.8
16. Timers
Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
In this mode, 3 normal-phases and 3 counter-phases of the PWM waveform are output with the same period
(three-phase, sawtooth wave modulation, and no dead time).
Figure 16.112 shows a Block Diagram of Reset Synchronous PWM Mode, and Table 16.43 lists the Reset
Synchronous PWM Mode Specifications. Figures 16.113 to 16.120 show the Registers Associated with Reset
Synchronous PWM Mode and Figure 16.121 shows an Operating Example of Reset Synchronous PWM Mode.
Refer to Figure 16.111 Operating Example of PWM Mode (Duty 0%, Duty 100%) for an operating example
of PWM Mode with duty 0% and duty 100%.
Buffer(1)
Waveform control
TRDGRC0
register
TRDGRA0
register
TRDGRD0
register
TRDGRB0
register
Period
TRDIOC0
Normal-phase
TRDIOB0
PWM1
Counter-phase
TRDIOD0
Normal-phase
TRDGRC1
register
TRDGRA1
register
TRDIOA1
PWM2
Counter-phase
TRDIOC1
Normal-phase
TRDGRD1
register
TRDGRB1
register
TRDIOB1
PWM3
Counter-phase
TRDIOD1
NOTE:
1. When bits BFC0, BFD0, BFC1, and BFD1 in the TRDMR register are set to 1 (buffer register).
Figure 16.112 Block Diagram of Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 271 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.43
16. Timers
Reset Synchronous PWM Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M
External signal input to the TRDCLK pin (valid edge selected by a
program)
The TRD0 register is incremented (the TRD1 register is not used).
PWM period
: 1/fk × (m+1)
Active level width of normal-phase : 1/fk × (m-n)
Active level width of counter-phase: 1/fk × (n+1)
fk:Frequency of count source
m:Value set in the TRDGRA0 register
n: Value set in the TRDGRB0 register (PWM1 output),
Value set in the TRDGRA1 register (PWM2 output),
Value set in the TRDGRB1 register (PWM3 output)
Count sources
Count operations
PWM waveform
m+1
Normal-phase
m-n
Counter-phase
n+1
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request generation
timing
TRDIOA0 pin function
TRDIOB0 pin function
TRDIOD0 pin function
TRDIOA1 pin function
TRDIOC1 pin function
TRDIOB1 pin function
TRDIOD1 pin function
TRDIOC0 pin function
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART0 bit in the TRDSTR register.
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART0 bit in the TRDSTR register
when the CSEL0 bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1.
The PWM output pin holds output level before the count stops
• When the CSEL0 bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 0, the count
stops at the compare match in the TRDGRA0 register.
The PWM output pin holds level after output change at compare
match.
• Compare match (the content of the TRD0 register matches content
of registers TRDGRj0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1).
• The TRD0 register overflows
Programmable I/O port or TRDCLK (external clock) input
PWM1 output normal-phase output
PWM1 output counter-phase output
PWM2 output normal-phase output
PWM2 output counter-phase output
PWM3 output normal-phase output
PWM3 output counter-phase output
Output inverted every PWM period
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or
INT0 interrupt input
The count value can be read by reading the TRD0 register.
The value can be written to the TRD0 register.
• The active level of normal-phase and counter-phase and initial
output level selected individually.
• Buffer operation (Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse
Output Forced Cutoff.)
j = either A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
(When “L” is selected as the active level)
Page 272 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Start Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSTR
Bit Symbol
TSTART0
TSTART1
Address
0137h
Bit Name
TRD0 count start flag(4)
TRD1 count start flag(5)
After Reset
11111100b
Function
RW
0 : Count stops (2)
1 : Count starts
RW
0 : Count stops (3)
1 : Count starts
RW
CSEL0
TRD0 count operation select bit 0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith
the TRDGRA0 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA0 register
RW
CSEL1
TRD1 count operation select bit 0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith
the TRDGRA1 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA1 register
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
NOTES:
1. Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction (do not use the bit handling instruction). Refer to 16.4.12.1
TRDSTR Register of Notes on Tim er RD.
2. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART0 bit.
3. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART1 bit.
4. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA0) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
5. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA1) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
Timer RD Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
TRDMR
Bit Symbol
Address
0138h
Bit Name
Timer RD synchronous bit
SYNC
—
(b3-b1)
After Reset
00001110b
Function
Set this bit to 0 (registers TRD0 and TRD1
operate independently) in reset synchronous
PWM mode.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
BFC0
TRDGRC0 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA0 register
RW
BFD0
TRDGRD0 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB0 register
RW
BFC1
TRDGRC1 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA1 register
RW
BFD1
TRDGRD1 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB1 register
RW
Figure 16.113 Registers TRDSTR and TRDMR in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 273 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Function Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 1
Symbol
TRDFCR
Bit Symbol
CMD0
Address
013Ah
Bit Name
Combination mode select bits (1, 2)
After Reset
10000000b
Function
Set to 01b (reset synchronous PWM
mode) in reset synchronous PWM mode.
CMD1
OLS0
OLS1
RW
RW
Normal-phase output level select bit 0 : Initial output “H”
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or
Active level “L”
complementary PWM mode)
1 : Initial output “L”
Active level “H”
Counter-phase output level select bit 0 : Initial output “H”
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or
Active level “L”
complementary PWM mode)
1 : Initial output “L”
Active level “H”
RW
RW
ADTRG
A/D trigger enable bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in reset synchronous
PWM mode.
RW
ADEG
A/D trigger edge select bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in reset synchronous
PWM mode.
RW
External clock input select bit
0 : External clock input disabled
1 : External clock input enabled
RW
PWM3 mode select bit(3)
This bit is disabled in reset synchronous
PWM mode.
RW
STCLK
PWM3
NOTES:
1. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 01b, 10b, or 11b, the MCU enters reset synchronous PWM mode or
complementary PWM mode in spite of the setting of the TRDPMR register.
2. Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits are set to 0 (count stops).
3. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or PWM3 mode), the setting of the PWM3 bit is
enabled.
Figure 16.114 TRDFCR Register in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 274 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
Symbol
TRDOER1
Bit Symbol
Address
013Bh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output disable bit
EA0
TRDIOB0 output disable bit
EB0
TRDIOC0 output disable bit
EC0
TRDIOD0 output disable bit
ED0
TRDIOA1 output disable bit
EA1
TRDIOB1 output disable bit
EB1
TRDIOC1 output disable bit
EC1
TRDIOD1 output disable bit
ED1
After Reset
FFh
Function
Set this bit to 1 (the TRDIOA0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port) in reset
synchronous PWM mode.
RW
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
013Ch
TRDOER2
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b6-b0)
When read, the content is 1.
After Reset
01111111b
Function
RW
—
_____
PTO
INT0 of pulse output forced
0 : Pulse output forced cutoff input disabled
cutoff signal input enabled bit(1) 1 : Pulse output forced cutoff input enabled
(All bits in the TRDOER1 register
are set to 1 (disable output) w hen “L” is
_____
applied to the INT0 pin.)
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced Cutoff.
Figure 16.115 Registers TRDOER1 to TRDOER2 in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 275 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Control Register 0(3)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 1
Symbol
TRDCR0
Bit Symbol
Address
0140h
Bit Name
Count source select bits
TCK1
TCK2
External clock edge select bits (2)
CKEG1
TRD0 counter clear select bits
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRDCLK input(1)
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
b4 b3
0
0
1
1
CKEG0
RW
b2 b1b0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
CCLR0
CCLR1
CCLR2
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Count at the rising edge
1 : Count at the falling edge
0 : Count at both edges
1 : Do not set.
Set to 001b (TRD0 register cleared at compare
match w ith TRDGRA0 register) in reset
synchronous PWM mode.
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. This setting is enabled w hen the STCLK bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
2. Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 are enabled w hen bits TCK2 to TCK0 are set to 101b (TRDCLK input) and the STCLK bit in the
TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
3. The TRDCR1 register is not used in reset synchronous PWM mode.
Figure 16.116 TRDCR0 Register in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 276 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Status Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Bit Symbol
IMFA
Address
0143h
0153h
After Reset
11100000b
11000000b
Bit Name
Function
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag A
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRAi register.
RW
IMFB
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag B
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRBi register.
RW
IMFC
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag C
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRCi register (3).
RW
IMFD
Input capture/compare match [Source for setting this bit to 0]
flag D
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register matches w ith
the value in the TRDGRDi register (3).
RW
Overflow flag
OVF
UDF
—
(b7-b6)
Underflow flag(1)
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRDi register overflow s.
RW
This bit is disabled in reset synchronous PWM
mode.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
NOTES:
1. Nothing is assigned to b5 in the TRDSR0 register. When w riting to b5, w rite 0. When reading, the content is 1.
2. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit (this bit remains
1 even if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0).
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten to it.
3. Including w hen the BFji bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRDGRji is used as the buffer register).
Figure 16.117 Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 277 of 450
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDIER0
TRDIER1
Bit Symbol
IMIEA
IMIEB
IMIEC
IMIED
OVIE
—
(b7-b5)
Address
0144h
0154h
After Reset
11100000b
11100000b
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit A
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
RW
Overflow /underflow interrupt enable 0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the
bit
OVF bit
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF bit
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
RW
Figure 16.118 Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Timer RD Counter 0(1, 2)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRD0
Address
0147h-0146h
Function
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRDSR0 register is set to 1.
NOTES:
1. Access the TRD0 register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
2. The TRD1 register is not used in reset synchronous PWM mode.
Figure 16.119 TRD0 Registrar in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 278 of 450
After Reset
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD General Registers Ai, Bi, Ci, and Di (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
TRDGRA0
TRDGRB0
TRDGRC0
TRDGRD0
TRDGRA1
TRDGRB1
TRDGRC1
TRDGRD1
0149h-0148h
014Bh-014Ah
014Dh-014Ch
014Fh-014Eh
0159h-0158h
015Bh-015Ah
015Dh-015Ch
015Fh-015Eh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
Function
RW
Refer to Table 16.44 TRDGRji Register Function in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode.
RW
NOTE:
1. Access registers TRDGRAi to TRDGRDi in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.120 Registers TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRCi, and TRDGRDi in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
The following registers are disabled in the reset synchronous PWM mode: TRDPMR, TRDOCR, TRDDF0,
TRDDF1, TRDIORA0, TRDIORC0, TRDPOCR0, TRDIORA1, TRDIORC1, and TRDPOCR1.
Table 16.44
TRDGRji Register Functions in Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Register
Setting
Register Function
PWM Output Pin
TRDGRA0
−
General register. Set the PWM period.
(Output inverted every PWM
period and TRDIOC0 pin)
TRDGRB0
−
General register. Set the changing point of
PWM1 output.
TRDIOB0
TRDIOD0
TRDGRC0
BFC0 = 0
−
TRDGRD0
BFD0 = 0
(These registers are not used in reset
synchronous PWM mode.)
TRDGRA1
−
General register. Set the changing point of
PWM2 output.
TRDIOA1
TRDIOC1
TRDGRB1
−
General register. Set the changing point of
PWM3 output.
TRDIOB1
TRDIOD1
TRDGRC1
BFC1 = 0
−
TRDGRD1
BFD1 = 0
(These points are not used in reset
synchronous PWM mode.)
TRDGRC0
BFC0 = 1
Buffer register. Set the next PWM period.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
(Output inversed every PWM
period and TRDIOC0 pin)
TRDGRD0
BFD0 = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of
the next PWM1 output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
TRDIOB0
TRDIOD0
TRDGRC1
BFC1 = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of
the next PWM2 output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
TRDIOA1
TRDIOC1
TRDGRD1
BFD1 = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of
the next PWM3 output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
TRDIOB1
TRDIOD1
BFC0, BFD0, BFC1, BFD1: Bits in TRDMR register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 279 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
Value in TRD0 register
m
n
p
q
0000h
TSTARTi bit in
TRDSTR register
1
0
m+1
m-n
TRDIOB0 output
n+1
TRDIOD0 output
m-p
TRDIOA1 output
p+1
TRDIOC1 output
m-q
TRDIOB1 output
Initial output “H”
q+1
Active level “L”
TRDIOD1 output
Active level “L”
TRDIOC0 output
Initial output “H”
IMFA bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
IMFB bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
IMFA bit in
TRDSR1 register
1
IMFB bit in
TRDSR1 register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
0
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
Transfer from the buffer register to the
general register during buffer operation
Transfer from the buffer register to the
general register during buffer operation
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
n: Value set in TRDGRB0 register
p: Value set in TRDGRA1 register
q: Value set in TRDGRB1 register
i = 0 or 1
The above applies under the following conditions:
Bits OLS1 and OLS0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 0 (initial output level “H”, active level “L”).
Figure 16.121 Operating Example of Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 280 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.9
16. Timers
Complementary PWM Mode
In this mode, 3 normal-phases and 3 counter-phases of the PWM waveform are output with the same period
(three-phase, triangular wave modulation, and with dead time).
Figure 16.122 shows a Block Diagram of Complementary PWM Mode, and Table 16.45 lists the
Complementary PWM Mode Specifications. Figures 16.123 to 16.131 show the Registers Associated with
Complementary PWM Mode, Figure 16.132 shows the Output Model of Complementary PWM Mode, and
Figure 16.133 shows an Operating Example of Complementary PWM Mode.
Buffer
Waveform control
TRDGRA0
register
Period
TRDGRB0
register
PWM1
TRDIOC0
Normal-phase
TRDGRD0
register
Counter-phase
Normal-phase
TRDGRC1
register
TRDGRA1
register
PWM2
Counter-phase
Normal-phase
TRDGRD1
register
TRDGRB1
register
PWM3
Figure 16.122 Block Diagram of Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 281 of 450
Counter-phase
TRDIOB0
TRDIOD0
TRDIOA1
TRDIOC1
TRDIOB1
TRDIOD1
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.45
16. Timers
Complementary PWM Mode Specifications
Item
Count sources
Specification
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M
External signal input to the TRDCLK pin (valid edge selected by a program)
Set bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCR1 register to the same value (same count
source) as bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCR0 register.
Increment or decrement
Registers TRD0 and TRD1 are decremented with the compare match in registers
TRD0 and TRDGRA0 during increment operation. The TRD1 register value is
changed from 0000h to FFFFh during decrement operation, and registers TRD0 and
TRD1 are incremented.
Count operations
PWM operations
PWM period: 1/fk × (m+2-p) × 2(1)
Dead time: p
Active level width of normal-phase: 1/fk × (m-n-p+1) × 2
Active level width of counter-phase: 1/fk × (n+1-p) × 2
fk: Frequency of count source
m: Value set in the TRDGRA0 register
n: Value set in the TRDGRB0 register (PWM1 output)
Value set in the TRDGRA1 register (PWM2 output)
Value set in the TRDGRB1 register (PWM3 output)
p: Value set in the TRD0 register
m+2-p
n+1
Normal-phase
Counter-phase
n+1-p
Count start condition
Count stop conditions
Interrupt request generation
timing
p
m-p-n+1
(When “L” is selected as the active level)
1 (count starts) is written to bits TSTART0 and TSTART1 in the TRDSTR register.
0 (count stops) is written to bits TSTART0 and TSTART1 in the TRDSTR register
when the CSEL0 bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1.
(The PWM output pin holds output level before the count stops.)
• Compare match (The content of the TRDi register matches content of the TRDGRji
register.)
• The TRD1 register underflows
TRDIOA0 pin function
TRDIOB0 pin function
TRDIOD0 pin function
TRDIOA1 pin function
TRDIOC1 pin function
TRDIOB1 pin function
TRDIOD1 pin function
TRDIOC0 pin function
Programmable I/O port or TRDCLK (external clock) input
PWM1 output normal-phase output
PWM1 output counter-phase output
PWM2 output normal-phase output
PWM2 output counter-phase output
PWM3 output normal-phase output
PWM3 output counter-phase output
Output inverted every 1/2 period of PWM
INT0 pin function
Read from timer
Write to timer
Select functions
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input or INT0 interrupt input
The count value can be read by reading the TRDi register.
The value can be written to the TRDi register.
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced
Cutoff.)
• The active level of normal-phase and counter-phase and initial output level
selected individually
• Transfer timing from the buffer register selected
• A/D trigger generated
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
NOTE:
1. After a count starts, the PWM period is fixed.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 282 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Start Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSTR
Bit Symbol
TSTART0
TSTART1
Address
0137h
Bit Name
TRD0 count start flag(4)
TRD1 count start flag(5)
After Reset
11111100b
Function
RW
0 : Count stops (3)
1 : Count starts
RW
CSEL0
TRD0 count operation select bit 0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith
the TRDGRA0 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA0 register
RW
CSEL1
TRD1 count operation select bit 0 : Count stops at the compare match w ith
the TRDGRA1 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA1 register
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
NOTES:
1. Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction (do not use the bit handling instruction). Refer to 16.4.12.1
TRDSTR Register of Notes on Tim er RD.
2. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART0 bit.
3. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART1 bit.
4. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA0) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
5. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA1) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
Figure 16.123 TRDSTR Register in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
0 : Count stops (2)
1 : Count starts
Page 283 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
0
Symbol
TRDMR
Bit Symbol
Address
0138h
Bit Name
Timer RD synchronous bit
SYNC
—
(b3-b1)
After Reset
00001110b
Function
Set this bit to 0 (registers TRD0 and TRD1
operate independently) in complementary
PWM mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
RW
—
BFC0
TRDGRC0 register function select bit Set this bit to 0 (general register) in
complementary PWM mode.
RW
BFD0
TRDGRD0 register function select bit 0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB0 register
RW
BFC1
TRDGRC1 register function select bit 0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA1 register
RW
BFD1
TRDGRD1 register function select bit 0 : General register
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB1 register
RW
Figure 16.124 TRDMR Register in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 284 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Function Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDFCR
Bit Symbol
Address
013Ah
Bit Name
Combination mode select bits (1,2)
CMD1
OLS1
ADTRG
Normal-phase output level select bit 0 : Initial output “H”
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or
Active level “L”
complementary PWM mode)
1 : Initial output “L”
Active level “H”
Counter-phase output level select bit 0 : Initial output “H”
(in reset synchronous PWM mode or
Active level “L”
complementary PWM mode)
1 : Initial output “L”
Active level “H”
PWM3
RW
RW
RW
RW
A/D trigger enable bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
0 : Disable A/D trigger
1 : Enable A/D trigger (3)
A/D trigger edge select bit
(in complementary PWM mode)
0 : A/D trigger is generated at
compare match betw een registers
TRD0 and TRDGRA0
1 : A/D trigger is generated at underflow
in the TRD1 register
RW
External clock input select bit
0 : External clock input disabled
1 : External clock input enabled
RW
PWM3 mode select bit(4)
This bit is disabled in complementary PWM
mode.
RW
ADEG
STCLK
RW
b1 b0
1 0 : Complementary PWM mode
(transfer from the
buffer register to the general
register at the underflow in
the TRD1 register)
1 1 : Complementary PWM mode
(transfer from the
buffer register to the general
register at the compare match w ith
registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0.)
Other than above : Do not set.
CMD0
OLS0
After Reset
10000000b
Function
RW
NOTES:
1. When setting bits CMD1 to CMD0 to 10b or 11b, the MCU enters complementary PWM mode in spite of the setting of
the TRDPMR register.
2. Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits are set to 0 (count stops).
3. Set the ADCAP bit in the ADC0N0 register to 1 (starts by timer RD).
4. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or PWM3 mode), the setting of the PWM3 bit is
enabled.
Figure 16.125 TRDFCR Register in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 285 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
Symbol
TRDOER1
Bit Symbol
Address
013Bh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output disable bit
EA0
TRDIOB0 output disable bit
EB0
TRDIOC0 output disable bit
EC0
TRDIOD0 output disable bit
ED0
TRDIOA1 output disable bit
EA1
TRDIOB1 output disable bit
EB1
TRDIOC1 output disable bit
EC1
TRDIOD1 output disable bit
ED1
After Reset
FFh
Function
Set this bit to 1 (the TRDIOA0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port) in
complementary PWM mode.
RW
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOC1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOD1 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
RW
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
013Ch
TRDOER2
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b6-b0)
When read, the content is 1.
After Reset
01111111b
Function
RW
—
_____
PTO
INT0 of pulse output forced
0 : Pulse output forced cutoff input disabled
cutoff signal input enabled bit(1) 1 : Pulse output forced cutoff input enabled
(All bits in the TRDOER1 register
are set to 1 (disable output) w hen “L” is
_____
applied to the INT0 pin.)
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced Cutoff.
Figure 16.126 Registers TRDOER1 to TRDOER2 in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 286 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Control Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0
Symbol
TRDCR0
TRDCR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0140h
0150h
Bit Name
Count source select bits (2)
Function
TCK1
TCK2
External clock edge select bits (2,3)
CKEG1
TRDi counter clear select bits
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : TRDCLK input(1)
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
RW
RW
RW
b4 b3
0
0
1
1
CKEG0
RW
b2 b1 b0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
CCLR0
After Reset
00h
00h
0 : Count at the rising edge
1 : Count at the falling edge
0 : Count at both edges
1 : Do not set.
Set to 000b (disable clearing (free-running
operation)) in complementary PWM mode.
RW
RW
RW
CCLR1
RW
CCLR2
RW
NOTES:
1. This setting is enabled w hen the STCLK bit in the TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
2. Set bits TCK2 to TCK0 and bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 in registers TRDCR0 and TRDCR1 to the same values.
3. Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 are enabled w hen bits TCK2 to TCK0 are set to 101b (TRDCLK input) and the STCLK bit in the
TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
Figure 16.127 Registers TRDCR0 to TRDCR1 in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 287 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Status Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0143h
0153h
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match flag A
IMFA
Input capture/compare match flag B
IMFB
Input capture/compare match flag C
IMFC
Input capture/compare match flag D
IMFD
Overflow flag
OVF
Underflow flag(1)
UDF
—
(b7-b6)
After Reset
11100000b
11000000b
Function
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRAi
register.
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRCi
register (3).
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRDi
register (3).
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRDi register overflow s.
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRD1 register underflow s.
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
3. Including w hen the BFji bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRDGRji is used as the buffer register).
Figure 16.128 Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in Complementary PWM Mode
Page 288 of 450
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(2).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRBi
register.
NOTES:
1. Nothing is assigned to b5 in the TRDSR0 register. When w riting to b5, w rite 0. When reading, the content is 1.
2. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit (this bit remains
1 even if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0).
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten to it.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDIER0
TRDIER1
Bit Symbol
IMIEA
IMIEB
IMIEC
IMIED
OVIE
—
(b7-b5)
Address
0144h
0154h
After Reset
11100000b
11100000b
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit A
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
RW
Overflow /underflow interrupt enable 0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the
bit
OVF and UDF bits
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF and UDF bits
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
Figure 16.129 Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 289 of 450
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Counter 0(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRD0
Address
0147h-0146h
Function
Set the dead time.
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented or decremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRDSR0 register is set to 1.
After Reset
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access the TRD0 register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
Timer RD Counter 1(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRD1
Address
0157h-0156h
Function
Select 0000h.
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented or decremented.
When an underflow occurs, the UDF bit in the TRDSR1 register is set to 1.
After Reset
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access the TRD1 register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.130 Registers TRD0 to TRD1 in Complementary PWM Mode
Timer RD General Registers Ai, Bi, C1, and Di (i = 0 or 1)(1, 2)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRDGRA0
TRDGRB0
TRDGRD0
TRDGRA1
TRDGRB1
TRDGRC1
TRDGRD1
Address
0149h-0148h
014Bh-014Ah
014Fh-014Eh
0159h-0158h
015Bh-015Ah
015Dh-015Ch
015Fh-015Eh
After Reset
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
Function
Refer to Table 16.46 TRDGRji Register Functions in Com plem entary PWM Mode .
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Access registers TRDGRAi to TRDGRDi in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
2. The TRDGRC0 register is not used in complementary PWM mode.
Figure 16.131 Registers TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRC1, and TRDGRDi in Complementary PWM Mode
The following registers are disabled in the complementary PWM mode: TRDPMR, TRDOCR, TRDDF0,
TRDDF1, TRDIORA0, TRDIORC0, TRDPOCR0, TRDIORA1, TRDIORC1, and TRDPOCR1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 290 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.46
16. Timers
TRDGRji Register Functions in Complementary PWM Mode
Register
Setting
Register Function
PWM Output Pin
TRDGRA0
−
General register. Set the PWM period at initialization.
(Output inverted every half
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
period of TRDIOC0 pin)
FFFFh - TRD0 register setting value or below
Do not write to this register when the TSTART0 and TSTART1
bits in the TRDSTR register are set to 1 (count starts).
TRDGRB0
−
General register. Set the changing point of PWM1 output at
TRDIOB0
initialization.
TRDIOD0
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
TRDGRA0 register - TRD0 register setting
value or below
Do not write to this register when the TSTART0 and TSTART1
bits in the TRDSTR register are set to 1 (count starts).
TRDGRA1
−
General register. Set the changing point of PWM2 output at
TRDIOA1
initialization.
TRDIOC1
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
TRDGRA0 register - TRD0 register setting
value or below
Do not write to this register when the TSTART0 and TSTART1
bits in the TRDSTR register are set to 1 (count starts).
TRDGRB1
−
General register. Set the changing point of PWM3 output at
TRDIOB1
initialization.
TRDIOD1
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
TRDGRA0 register - TRD0 register setting
value or below
Do not write to this register when the TSTART0 and TSTART1
bits in the TRDSTR register are set to 1 (count starts).
TRDGRC0
−
This register is not used in complementary PWM mode.
−
TRDGRD0
BFD0 = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of next PWM1 output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
TRDGRA0 register - TRD0 register setting
value or below
Set this register to the same value as the TRDGRB0 register
for initialization.
TRDIOB0
TRDIOD0
TRDGRC1
BFC1 = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of next PWM2 output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
TRDGRA0 register - TRD0 register setting
value or below
Set this register to the same value as the TRDGRA1 register
for initialization.
TRDIOA1
TRDIOC1
TRDGRD1
BFD1 = 1
Buffer register. Set the changing point of next PWM3 output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Setting value or above in TRD0 register
TRDGRA0 register - TRD0 register setting
value or below
Set this register to the same value as the TRDGRB1 register
for initialization.
TRDIOB1
TRDIOD1
BFC0, BFD0, BFC1, BFD1: Bits in TRDMR register
Since values cannot be written to the TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, or TRDGRB1 register directly after count
operation starts (prohibited item), use the TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, or TRDGRD1 register as a buffer register.
However, to write data to the TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, or TRDGRD1 register, set bits BFD0, BFC1, and BFD1
to 0 (general register). After this, bits BFD0, BFC1, and BFD1 may be set to 1 (buffer register).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 291 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Value in TRDi register
Value in TRD0 register
Value in TRDGRA0
register
Value in TRD1 register
Value in TRDGRB0
register
Value in TRDGRA1
register
Value in TRDGRB1
register
0000h
TRDIOB0 output
TRDIOD0 output
TRDIOA1 output
TRDIOC1 output
TRDIOB1 output
TRDIOD1 output
TRDIOC0 output
i = 0 or 1
Figure 16.132 Output Model of Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 292 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
Value in TRDi register
m+1
m
Value in TRD0 register
n
Value in TRD1 register
p
0000h
Set to
FFFFh
Bits TSTART0 and TSTART1
in TRDSTR register
1
0
TRDIOB0 output
Initial output “H”
Active level “L”
TRDIOD0 output
TRDIOC0 output
Initial output “H”
m+2-p
m-p-n+1
n+1
n+1-p
p
p
(m-p-n+1) × 2
Width of normalphase active level
UDF bit in
TRDSR1 register
1
IMFA bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
Dead
time
n+1-p
(n+1-p) × 2
Width of counter-phase active level
0
Set to 0 by a program
0
TRDGRB0 register
n
n
Transfer (when bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 11b)
TRDGRD0 register
Transfer (when bits CMD1 to CMD0
are set to 10b)
n
Following data
Modify with a program
IMFB bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
Set to 0 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
CMD0, CMD1: Bits in TRDFCR register
i = 0 or 1
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
n: Value set in TRDGRB0 register
p: Value set in TRD0 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
Bits OLS1 and OLS0 in TRDFCR are set to 0 (initial output level “H”, active level “L” for normal-phase and counter-phase)
Figure 16.133 Operating Example of Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 293 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16.4.9.1
16. Timers
Transfer Timing from Buffer Register
• Transfer from the TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, or TRDGRD1 register to the TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, or
TRDGRB1 register.
When bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 10b, the content is transferred when the
TRD1 register underflows.
When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 11b, the content is transferred at compare match between registers
TRD0 and TRDGRA0.
16.4.9.2
A/D Trigger Generation
Compare match between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 and TRD1 underflow can be used as the conversion
start trigger of the A/D converter. The trigger is selected by bits ADEG and ADTRG in the TRDFCR register.
Also, set the ADCAP bit in the ADCON0 register to 1 (starts by timer RD).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 294 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
16.4.10 PWM3 Mode
In this mode, 2 PWM waveforms are output with the same period.
Figure 16.134 shows a Block Diagram of PWM3 Mode, and Table 16.47 lists the PWM3 Mode Specifications.
Figures 16.135 to 16.144 show the Registers Associated with PWM3 Mode, and Figure 16.145 shows an
Operating Example of PWM3 Mode.
Buffer
Compare match signal
TRD0
TRDIOA0
Output
control
Comparator
TRDGRA0
TRDGRC0
Comparator
TRDGRA1
TRDGRC1
Comparator
TRDGRB0
TRDGRD0
Comparator
TRDGRB1
TRDGRD1
Compare match signal
Compare match signal
TRDIOB0
Output
control
Compare match signal
Figure 16.134 Block Diagram of PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 295 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.47
16. Timers
PWM3 Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Count sources
f1, f2, f4, f8, f32, fOCO40M
Count operations
The TRD0 register is incremented (the TRD1 is not used).
PWM waveform
PWM period: 1/fk × (m+1)
Active level width of TRDIOA0 output: 1/fk × (m-n)
Active level width of TRDIOB0 output: 1/fk × (p-q)
fk: Frequency of count source
m: Value set in the TRDGRA0 register
n: Value set in the TRDGRA1 register
p: Value set in the TRDGRB0 register
q: Value set in the TRDGRB1 register
m+1
n+1
p+1
q+1
TRDIOA0 output
m-n
TRDIOB0 output
p-q
(When “H” is selected as the active level)
Count start condition
1 (count starts) is written to the TSTART0 bit in the TRDSTR register.
Count stop conditions
• 0 (count stops) is written to the TSTART0 bit in the TRDSTR register
when the CSEL0 bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 1.
The PWM output pin holds output level before the count stops
• When the CSEL0 bit in the TRDSTR register is set to 0, the count
stops at compare match with the TRDGRA0 register.
The PWM output pin holds level after output change by compare
match.
Interrupt request generation
timing
• Compare match (The content of the TRDi register matches content
of the TRDGRji register.)
• The TRD0 register overflows
TRDIOA0, TRDIOB0 pin
functions
PWM output
TRDIOC0, TRDIOD0, TRDIOA1
to TRDIOD1 pin functions
Programmable I/O port
INT0 pin function
Programmable I/O port, pulse output forced cutoff signal input, or
INT0 interrupt input
Read from timer
The count value can be read by reading the TRD0 register.
Write to timer
The value can be written to the TRD0 register.
Select functions
• Pulse output forced cutoff signal input (Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse
Output Forced Cutoff.)
• Buffer Operation (Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
• Active level selectable by pin
i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 296 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Start Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSTR
Bit Symbol
Address
0137h
Bit Name
TRD0 count start flag(4)
After Reset
11111100b
Function
RW
TRD1 count start flag(5)
0 : Count stops (3)
1 : Count starts
RW
TRD0 count operation select bit
CSEL0
0 : Count stops at the compare match
w ith the TRDGRA0 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA0 register
RW
CSEL1
TRD1 count operation select bit
0 : Count stops at the compare match
[this bit is not used in PWM3 mode]
w ith the TRDGRA1 register
1 : Count continues after the compare
match w ith the TRDGRA1 register
RW
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
TSTART0
TSTART1
NOTES:
1. Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction (do not use the bit handling instruction). Refer to 16.4.12.1
TRDSTR Register of Notes on Tim er RD.
2. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART0 bit.
3. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 1, w rite 0 to the TSTART1 bit.
4. When the CSEL0 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA0) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
5. When the CSEL1 bit is set to 0 and the compare match signal (TRDIOA1) is generated, this bit is set to 0 (count
stops).
Figure 16.135 TRDSTR Register in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
0 : Count stops (2)
1 : Count starts
Page 297 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Mode Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDMR
Bit Symbol
SYNC
Address
0138h
Bit Name
Timer RD synchronous bit
RW
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
BFC0
TRDGRC0 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA0 register
RW
BFD0
TRDGRD0 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB0 register
RW
BFC1
TRDGRC1 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRA1 register
RW
BFD1
TRDGRD1 register function select 0 : General register
bit
1 : Buffer register of TRDGRB1 register
RW
—
(b3-b1)
Figure 16.136 TRDMR Register in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
After Reset
00001110b
Function
Set this bit to 0 (TRD0 and TRD1 operate
independently) in PWM3 mode.
Page 298 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Function Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
0 0
Symbol
TRDFCR
Bit Symbol
CMD0
Address
013Ah
Bit Name
Combination mode select bits (1)
After Reset
10000000b
Function
Set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or
PWM3 mode) in PWM3 mode.
CMD1
RW
RW
This bit is disabled in PWM3 mode.
OLS0
Normal-phase output level select bit
(enabled in reset synchronous PWM
mode or complementary PWM mode)
This bit is disabled in PWM3 mode.
OLS1
Counter-phase output level select bit
(enabled in reset synchronous PWM
mode or complementary PWM mode)
RW
RW
ADTRG
A/D trigger enable bit
This bit is disabled in PWM3 mode.
(enabled in complementary PWM mode)
RW
ADEG
A/D trigger edge select bit
This bit is disabled in PWM3 mode.
(enabled in complementary PWM mode)
RW
STCLK
PWM3
External clock input select bit
Set this bit to 0 (external clock input
disabled) in PWM3 mode.
RW
PWM3 mode select bit(2)
Set this bit to 0 (PWM3 mode) in PWM3
mode.
RW
NOTES:
1. Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 w hen both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits are set to 0 (count stops).
2. When bits CMD1 to CMD0 are set to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, or PWM3 mode), the setting of the PWM3 bit is
enabled.
Figure 16.137 TRDFCR Register in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
Page 299 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1 1 1 1 1 1
Symbol
TRDOER1
Bit Symbol
Address
013Bh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output disable bit
EA0
TRDIOB0 output disable bit
EB0
EC0
ED0
EA1
EB1
EC1
ED1
TRDIOC0 output disable bit
TRDIOD0 output disable bit
TRDIOA1 output disable bit
TRDIOB1 output disable bit
TRDIOC1 output disable bit
TRDIOD1 output disable bit
After Reset
FFh
Function
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOA0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
0 : Enable output
1 : Disable output (The TRDIOB0 pin is
used as a programmable I/O port.)
Set these bits to 1 (programmable I/O port)
in PWM3 mode.
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
Timer RD Output Master Enable Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
Address
013Ch
TRDOER2
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
—
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
(b6-b0)
When read, the content is 1.
After Reset
01111111b
Function
RW
—
_____
PTO
INT0 of pulse output forced
cutoff signal input enabled
bit(1)
0 : Pulse output forced cutoff input disabled
1 : Pulse output forced cutoff input enabled
(All bits in the TRDOER1 register
are set to 1 (disable output) w hen “L” is
_____
applied to the INT0 pin.)
NOTE:
1. Refer to 16.4.4 Pulse Output Forced Cutoff.
Figure 16.138 Registers TRDOER1 to TRDOER2 in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 300 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Output Control Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDOCR
Bit Symbol
Address
013Dh
Bit Name
TRDIOA0 output level select
bit(2)
TOA0
TRDIOB0 output level select
bit(2)
TOB0
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Active level “H”,
initial output “L”,
output “H” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRA1register,
output “L” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRA0 register
1 : Active level “L”,
initial output “H”,
output “L” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRA1register,
output “H” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRA0 register
0 : Active level “H”,
initial output “L”,
output “H” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRB1register,
output “L” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRB0 register
1 : Active level “L”,
initial output “H”,
output “L” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRB1register,
output “H” at compare match w ith the
TRDGRB0 register
These bits are disabled in PWM3 mode.
RW
RW
RW
TOC0
TRDIOC0 initial output level
select bit
TOD0
TRDIOD0 initial output level
select bit
RW
TOA1
TRDIOA1 initial output level
select bit
RW
TOB1
TRDIOB1 initial output level
select bit
RW
TOC1
TRDIOC1 initial output level
select bit
RW
TOD1
TRDIOD1 initial output level
select bit
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to the TRDOCR register w hen both bits TSTART0 and TSTART1 in the TRDSTR register are set to 0 (count
stops).
2. If the pin function is set for w aveform output (refer to Tables 16.26 and 16.27), the initial output level is output w hen
the TRDOCR register is set.
Figure 16.139 TRDOCR Register in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 301 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Control Register 0(2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 1
Symbol
TRDCR0
Bit Symbol
Address
0140h
Bit Name
Count source select bits
TCK1
TCK2
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1
1 : f2
0 : f4
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : Do not set.
0 : fOCO40M
1 : Do not set.
External clock edge select bits (1) These bits are disabled in PWM3 mode.
TRD0 counter clear select bits
RW
b2 b1b0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
TCK0
CKEG0
CKEG1
CCLR0
CCLR1
CCLR2
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to 001b (the TRD0 register cleared at
compare match w ith TRDGRA0 register) in
PWM3 mode.
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Bits CKEG1 to CKEG0 are enabled w hen bits TCK2 to TCK0 are set to 101b (TRDCLK input) and the STCLK bit in the
TRDFCR register is set to 1 (external clock input enabled).
2. The TRDCR1 register is not used in PWM3 mode.
Figure 16.140 TRDCR0 Register in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 302 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Status Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDSR0
TRDSR1
Bit Symbol
Address
0143h
0153h
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match flag A
IMFA
Input capture/compare match flag B
IMFB
Input capture/compare match flag C
IMFC
Input capture/compare match flag D
IMFD
Overflow flag
OVF
UDF
—
(b7-b6)
Underflow flag(1)
After Reset
11100000b
11000000b
Function
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRAi
register.
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRCi
register (2).
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRDi
register (2).
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the TRDi register overflow s.
RW
This bit is disabled in PWM3 mode.
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
2. Including w hen the BFji (j = C or D) bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (TRDGRji is used as the buffer register).
Figure 16.141 Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in PWM3 Mode
Page 303 of 450
RW
[Source for setting this bit to 0]
Write 0 after read(1).
[Source for setting this bit to 1]
When the value in the TRDi register
matches w ith the value in the TRDGRBi
register.
NOTES:
1. The w riting results are as follow s:
• This bit is set to 0 w hen the read result is 1 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit.
• This bit remains unchanged even if the read result is 0 and 0 is w ritten to the same bit (this bit remains
1 even if it is set to 1 from 0 after reading, and w riting 0).
• This bit remains unchanged if 1 is w ritten to it.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
RW
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD Interrupt Enable Register i (i = 0 or 1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
TRDIER0
TRDIER1
Bit Symbol
IMIEA
IMIEB
IMIEC
IMIED
OVIE
—
(b7-b5)
Address
0144h
0154h
Bit Name
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit A
After Reset
11100000b
11100000b
Function
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIA) by the
IMFA bit
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit B
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIB) by the
IMFB bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit C
0 : Disable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMIC) by the
IMFC bit
RW
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable bit D
0 : Disable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
1 : Enable interrupt (IMID) by the
IMFD bit
RW
Overflow /underflow interrupt enable 0 : Disable interrupt (OVI) by the
bit
OVF bit
1 : Enable interrupt (OVI) by the
OVF bit
RW
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 1.
—
RW
RW
Figure 16.142 Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in PWM3 Mode
Timer RD Counter 0(1, 2)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRD0
Address
0147h-0146h
Function
Count a count source. Count operation is incremented.
When an overflow occurs, the OVF bit in the TRDSR0 register is set to 1.
NOTES:
1. Access the TRD0 register in 16-bit units. Do not access it in 8-bit units.
2. The TRD1 register is not used in PWM3 mode.
Figure 16.143 TRD0 Register in PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 304 of 450
After Reset
0000h
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Timer RD General Registers Ai, Bi, Ci, and Di (i = 0 or 1)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TRDGRA0
TRDGRB0
TRDGRC0
TRDGRD0
TRDGRA1
TRDGRB1
TRDGRC1
TRDGRD1
Address
After Reset
0149h-0148h
014Bh-014Ah
014Dh-014Ch
014Fh-014Eh
0159h-0158h
015Bh-015Ah
015Dh-015Ch
015Fh-015Eh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
FFFFh
Function
Refer to Table 16.48 TRDGRji Register Functions in PWM3 Mode.
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Access registers TRDGRAi to TRDGRDi in 16-bit units. Do not access them in 8-bit units.
Figure 16.144 Registers TRDGRAi, TRDGRBi, TRDGRCi, and TRDGRDi in PWM3 Mode
The following registers are disabled in the PWM3 mode function: TRDPMR, TRDDF0, TRDDF1,
TRDIORA0, TRDIORC0, TRDPOCR0, TRDIORA1, TRDIORC1, and TRDPOCR1.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 305 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 16.48
Register
16. Timers
TRDGRji Register Functions in PWM3 Mode
Setting
Register Function
TRDGRA0 −
General register. Set the PWM period.
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRA1 register or above
TRDGRA1
General register. Set the changing point (the active level
timing) of PWM output.
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRA0 register or below
TRDGRB0
General register. Set the changing point (the timing that
returns to initial output level) of PWM output.
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRB1 register or above
Value set in TRDGRA0 register or below
TRDGRB1
General register. Set the changing point (active level timing) of
PWM output.
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRB0 register or below
TRDGRC0 BFC0 = 0 (These registers is not used in PWM3 mode.)
PWM Output Pin
TRDIOA0
TRDIOB0
−
TRDGRC1 BFC1 = 0
TRDGRD0 BFD0 = 0
TRDGRD1 BFD1 = 0
TRDGRC0 BFC0 = 1 Buffer register. Set the next PWM period.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRC1 register or above
TRDIOA0
TRDGRC1 BFC1 = 1 Buffer register. Set the changing point of next PWM output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRC0 register or below
TRDGRD0 BFD0 = 1 Buffer register. Set the changing point of next PWM output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRD1 register or above,
setting value or below in TRDGRC0 register.
TRDIOB0
TRDGRD1 BFD1 = 1 Buffer register. Set the changing point of next PWM output.
(Refer to 16.4.2 Buffer Operation.)
Setting range: Value set in TRDGRD0 register or below
BFC0, BFD0, BFC1, BFD1: Bits in TRDMR register
Registers TRDGRC0, TRDGRC1, TRDGRD0, and TRDGRD1 are not used in PWM3 mode. To use them as
buffer registers, set bits BFC0, BFC1, BFD0, and BFD1 to 0 (general register) and write a value to the
TRDGRC0, TRDGRC1, TRDGRD0, or TRDGRD1 register. After this, bits BFC0, BFC1, BFD0, and BFD1
may be set to 1 (buffer register).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 306 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Count source
Value in TRD0 register
FFFFh
m
n
p
q
0000h
TSTART0 bit in
TRDSTR register
1
0
Count stop
CSEL0 bit in
TRDSTR register
Set to 0 by a program
1
0
m+1
n+1
m-n
p+1
q+1
p-q
Output “H” at compare
match with the
TRDGRA1 register
TRDIOA0 output
Output “L” at compare match
with the TRDGRA0 register
Initial output “L”
TRDIOB0 output
IMFA bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
IMFB bit in
TRDSR0 register
Set to 0 by a program
1
0
Set to 0 by a program
TRDGRA0 register
Set to 0 by a program
m
m
Transfer
TRDGRC0 register
m
Transfer
Following data
Transfer from buffer register to
general register
j = either A or B
Transfer from buffer register to
general register
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
n: Value set in TRDGRA1 register
p: Value set in TRDGRB0 register
q: Value set in TRDGRB1 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Both the TOA0 and TOB0 bits in the TRDOCR register are set to 0 (initial output level “L”, output “H” by compare match with the
TRDGRj1 register, output “L” at compare match with the TRDGRj0 register).
• The BFC0 bit in the TRDMR register is set to 1 (the TRDGRC0 register is used as the buffer register of the TRDGRA0 register).
Figure 16.145 Operating Example of PWM3 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 307 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
16.4.11 Timer RD Interrupt
Timer RD generates the timer RD interrupt request based on 6 sources for each channel. The timer RD interrupt
has 1 TRDiIC register (bits IR, and ILVL0 to ILVL2), and 1 vector for each channel. Table 16.49 lists the
Registers Associated with Timer RD Interrupt, and Figure 16.146 shows a Block Diagram of Timer RD
Interrupt.
Table 16.49
Registers Associated with Timer RD Interrupt
Timer RD
Status Register
Timer RD
Interrupt Enable Register
Timer RD
Interrupt Control Register
Channel 0
TRDSR0
TRDIER0
TRD0IC
Channel 1
TRDSR1
TRDIER1
TRD1IC
Channel i
IMFA bit
IMIEA bit
Timer RD interrupt request
(IR bit in TRDiIC register)
IMFB bit
IMIEB bit
IMFC bit
IMIEC bit
IMFD bit
IMIED bit
UDF bit
OVF bit
OVIE bit
i = 0 or 1
IMFA, IMFB, IMFC, IMFD, OVF, UDF: Bits in TRDSRi register
IMIEA, IMIEB, IMIEC, IMIED, OVIE: Bits in TRDIER register
Figure 16.146 Block Diagram of Timer RD Interrupt
As with other maskable interrupts, the timer RD interrupt is controlled by the combination of the I flag, IR bit,
bits ILVL0 to ILVL2, and IPL. However, since the interrupt source (timer RD interrupt) is generated by a
combination of multiple interrupt request sources, the following differences from other maskable interrupts
apply:
• When bits in the TRDSRi register corresponding to bits set to 1 in the TRDIERi register are set to 1 (enable
interrupt), the IR bit in the TRDiIC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested).
• When either bits in the TRDSRi register or bits in the TRDIERi register corresponding to bits in the
TRDSRi register, or both of them, are set to 0, the IR bit is set to 0 (interrupt not requested). Therefore,
even though the interrupt is not acknowledged after the IR bit is set to 1, the interrupt request will not be
maintained.
• When the conditions of other request sources are met, the IR bit remains 1.
• When multiple bits in the TRDIERi register are set to 1, which request source causes an interrupt is
determined by the TRDSRi register.
• Since each bit in the TRDSRi register is not automatically set to 0 even if the interrupt is acknowledged, set
each bit to 0 in the interrupt routine. For information on how to set these bits to 0, refer to the descriptions
of the registers used in the different modes (Figures 16.77, 16.92, 16.105, 16.117, 16.128, and 16.141).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 308 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
Refer to Registers TRDSR0 to TRDSR1 in each mode (Figures 16.77, 16.92, 16.105, 16.117, 16.128, and
16.141) for the TRDSRi register. Refer to Registers TRDIER0 to TRDIER1 in each mode (Figures 16.78,
16.93, 16.106, 16.118, 16.129, and 16.142) for the TRDIERi register.
Refer to 12.1.6 Interrupt Control for information on the TRDiIC register and 12.1.5.2 Relocatable Vector
Tables for the interrupt vectors.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 309 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
16.4.12 Notes on Timer RD
16.4.12.1 TRDSTR Register
• Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction.
• When the CSELi (i = 0 to 1) is set to 0 (the count stops at compare match of registers TRDi and
TRDGRAi), the count does not stop and the TSTARTi bit remains unchanged even if 0 (count stops) is
written to the TSTARTi bit.
• Therefore, set the TSTARTi bit to 0 to change other bits without changing the TSTARTi bit when the
CSELi bit is se to 0.
• To stop counting by a program, set the TSTARTi bit after setting the CSELi bit to 1. Although the CSELi
bit is set to 1 and the TSTARTi bit is set to 0 at the same time (with 1 instruction), the count cannot be
stopped.
• Table 16.50 lists the TRDIOji (j = A, B, C, or D) Pin Output Level when Count Stops to use the TRDIOji (j
= A, B, C, or D) pin with the timer RD output.
Table 16.50
TRDIOji (j = A, B, C, or D) Pin Output Level when Count Stops
Count Stop
When the CSELi bit is set to 1, set the TSTARTi bit to 0 and the count
stops.
When the CSELi bit is set to 0, the count stops at compare match of
registers TRDi and TRDGRAi.
TRDIOji Pin Output when Count Stops
Hold the output level immediately before the
count stops.
Hold the output level after output changes by
compare match.
16.4.12.2 TRDi Register (i = 0 or 1)
• When writing the value to the TRDi register by a program while the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register
is set to 1 (count starts), avoid overlapping with the timing for setting the TRDi register to 0000h, and then
write. If the timing for setting the TRDi register to 0000h overlaps with the timing for writing the value to
the TRDi register, the value is not written and the TRDi register is set to 0000h.
These precautions are applicable when selecting the following by bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi
register.
- 001b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRAi register.)
- 010b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRBi register.)
- 011b (Synchronous clear)
- 101b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRCi register.)
- 110b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRDi register.)
• When writing the value to the TRDi register and continuously reading the same register, the value before
writing may be read. In this case, execute the JMP.B instruction between the writing and reading.
Program example
MOV.W
#XXXXh, TRD0
;Writing
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B
L1:
MOV.W
TRD0,DATA
;Reading
16.4.12.3 TRDSRi Register (i = 0 or 1)
When writing the value to the TRDSRi register and continuously reading the same register, the value before
writing may be read. In this case, execute the JMP.B instruction between the writing and reading.
Program example
MOV.B
#XXh, TRDSR0
;Writing
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B
L1:
MOV.B
TRDSR0,DATA
;Reading
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 310 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
16.4.12.4 Count Source Switch
• Switch the count source after the count stops.
Change procedure
(1) Set the TSTARTi (i = 0 or 1) bit in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register.
• When changing the count source from fOCO40M to another source and stopping fOCO40M, wait 2 cycles
of f1 or more after setting the clock switch, and then stop fOCO40M.
Change procedure
(1) Set the TSTARTi (i = 0 or 1) bit in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register.
(3) Wait 2 or more cycles of f1.
(4) Set the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register to 0 (high-speed on-chip oscillator stops).
16.4.12.5 Input Capture Function
• Set the pulse width of the input capture signal to 3 or more cycles of the timer RD operation clock (refer to
Table 16.25 Timer RD Operation Clocks).
• The value in the TRDi register is transferred to the TRDGRji register 2 to 3 cycles of the timer RD
operation clock after the input capture signal is applied to the TRDIOji pin (i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or
D) (no digital filter).
16.4.12.6 Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
• When reset synchronous PWM mode is used for motor control, make sure OLS0 = OLS1.
• Set to reset synchronous PWM mode by the following procedure:
Change procedure
(1) Set the TSTART0 bit in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, and PWM3 mode).
(3) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 to 01b (reset synchronous PWM mode).
(4) Set the other registers associated with timer RD again.
16.4.12.7 Complementary PWM Mode
• When complementary PWM mode is used for motor control, make sure OLS0 = OLS1.
• Change bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register in the following procedure.
Change procedure: When setting to complementary PWM mode (including re-set), or changing the transfer
timing from the buffer register to the general register in complementary PWM mode.
(1) Set both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, and PWM3 mode).
(3) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 to 10b or 11b (complementary PWM mode).
(4) Set the registers associated with other timer RD again.
Change procedure: When stopping complementary PWM mode
(1) Set both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Set bits CMD1 to CMD to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, and PWM3 mode).
• Do not write to TRDGRA0, TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, or TRDGRB1 register during operation.
When changing the PWM waveform, transfer the values written to registers TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, and
TRDGRD1 to registers TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1 using the buffer operation.
However, to write data to the TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, or TRDGRD1 register, set bits BFD0, BFC1, and
BFD1 to 0 (general register). After this, bits BFD0, BFC1, and BFD1 may be set to 1 (buffer register).
The PWM period cannot be changed.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 311 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
• If the value in the TRDGRA0 register is assumed to be m, the TRD0 register counts m-1, m, m+1, m, m-1,
in that order, when changing from increment to decrement operation.
When changing from m to m+1, the IMFA bit is set to 1. Also, bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR
register are set to 11b (complementary PWM mode, buffer data transferred at compare match between
registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0), the content in the buffer registers (TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, and
TRDGRD1) is transferred to the general registers (TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1).
During m+1, m, and m-1 operation, the IMFA bit remains unchanged and data are not transferred to
registers such as the TRDGRA0 register.
Count value in TRD0
register
m+1
Setting value in
TRDGRA0
register m
Set to 0 by a program
IMFA bit in
TRDSR0 register
No change
1
0
Transferred from
buffer register
Not transferred from buffer register
When bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the
TRDFCR register are set to 11b
(transfer from the buffer register to the
general register at compare match of
between registers TRD0 and
TRDGRA0).
TRDGRB0 register
TRDGRA1 register
TRDGRB1 register
Figure 16.147 Operation at Compare Match between Registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 in
Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 312 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
• The TRD1 register counts 1, 0, FFFFh, 0, 1, in that order, when changing from decrement to increment
operation.
The UDF bit is set to 1 when changing between 1, 0, and FFFFh operation. Also, when bits CMD1 to
CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 10b (complementary PWM mode, buffer data transferred at
underflow in the TRD1 register), the content in the buffer registers (TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, and
TRDGRD1) is transferred to the general registers (TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1). During
FFFFh, 0, 1 operation, data are not transferred to registers such as the TRDGRB0 register. Also, at this
time, the OVF bit remains unchanged.
Count value in TRD0
register
1
0
FFFFh
Set to 0 by a program
UDF bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
OVF bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
0
No change
0
Transferred from
buffer register
TRDGRB0 register
TRDGRA1 register
TRDGRB1 register
Not transferred from buffer register
When bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the
TRDFCR register are set to 10b
(transfer from the buffer register to the
general register when the TRD1 register
underflows).
Figure 16.148 Operation when TRD1 Register Underflows in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 313 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
• Select with bits CMD1 to CMD0 the timing of data transfer from the buffer register to the general register.
However, transfer takes place with the following timing in spite of the value of bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the
following cases:
Value in buffer register ≥ value in TRDGRA0 register:
Transfer take place at underflow of the TRD1 register.
After this, when the buffer register is set to 0001h or above and a smaller value than the value of the
TRDGRA0 register, and the TRD1 register underflows for the first time after setting, the value is
transferred to the general register. After that, the value is transferred with the timing selected by bits CMD1
to CMD0.
n3
m+1
Count value in TRD0
register
n2
n1
Count value in TRD1
register
0000h
TRDGRD0 register
n2
n1
Transfer with timing set by
bits CMD1 to CMD0
n2
n1
Transfer
Transfer
Transfer
TRDGRB0 register
n2
n3
n3
Transfer at
underflow of TRD1
register because of
n3 > m
Transfer
n2
Transfer at
underflow of TRD1
register because
of first setting to
n2 < m
n1
Transfer with timing set by
bits CMD1 to CMD0
TRDIOB0 output
TRDIOD0 output
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 11b (data in the buffer register is transferred at compare match
between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 in complementary PWM mode).
• Both the OSL0 and OLS1 bits in the TRDFCR register are set to 1 (active ‘H” for normal-phase and counter-phase).
Figure 16.149 Operation when Value in Buffer Register ≥ Value in TRDGRA0 Register in
Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 314 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
16. Timers
When the value in the buffer register is set to 0000h:
Transfer takes place at compare match between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0.
After this, when the buffer register is set to 0001h or above and a smaller value than the value of the
TRDGRA0 register, and a compare match occurs between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 for the first time
after setting, the value is transferred to the general register. After that, the value is transferred with the
timing selected by bits CMD1 to CMD0.
m+1
Count value in TRD0 register
n2
n1
Count value in TRD1 register
0000h
0000h
n1
TRDGRD0 register
Transfer
Transfer
TRDGRB0 register
n2
n1
n1
Transfer with timing
set by bits CMD1 to
CMD0
Transfer
0000h
Transfer at compare
match between
registers TRD0 and
TRDGRA0 because
content in TRDGRD0
register is set to
0000h.
Transfer
n1
Transfer at compare
match between
registers TRD0 and
TRDGRA0 because
of first setting to
0001h ≤ n1 < m
Transfer with timing
set by bits CMD1 to
CMD0
TRDIOB0 output
TRDIOD0 output
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 10b (data in the buffer register is transferred at underflow of the TRD1 register in
PWM mode).
• Both the OLS0 and OLS1 bits in the TRDFCR register are set to 1 (active “H” for normal-phase and counter-phase).
Figure 16.150 Operation when Value in Buffer Register Is Set to 0000h in Complementary PWM
Mode
16.4.12.8 Count Source fOCO40M
• The count source fOCO40M can be used with supply voltage VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V. For supply voltage other
than that, do not set bits TCK2 to TCK0 in registers TRDCR0 and TRDCR to 110b (select fOCO40M as
the count source).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 315 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
17. Serial Interface
The serial interface consists of two channels (UART0 or UART2). Each UARTi (i = 0 or 2) has an exclusive timer to
generate the transfer clock and operates independently.
Figure 17.1 shows a UARTi (i = 0 or 2) Block Diagram. Figure 17.2 shows a UARTi Transmit/Receive Unit.
UARTi has two modes: clock synchronous serial I/O mode and clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART mode).
Figures 17.3 to 17.5 show the Registers Associated with UARTi, and Figure 17.6 shows the PINSR1 Register.
UARTi
TXDi
RXDi
CLK1 to CLK0 = 00b
f1
f8
f32
= 01b
= 10b
CKDIR = 0
Internal
1/16
Clock
synchronous type
U0BRG register
1/(n0+1)
UART reception
1/16
Reception control
circuit
UART transmission
Transmission
control circuit
Clock
synchronous type
External
CKDIR = 1
1/2
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when
external clock is selected)
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CLKi
Receive
clock
Transmit
clock
CKDIR = 0
CKDIR = 1
CLK
polarity
switch
circuit
i = 0 or 2
CKDIR: Bit in UiMR register
CLK0 to CLK1: Bits in UiC0 register
Figure 17.1
UARTi (i = 0 or 2) Block Diagram
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 316 of 450
Transmit/
receive
unit
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
1SP
RXDi
SP
SP
Clock
synchronous
type
PRYE = 0
Clock
PAR
disabled synchronous
type
UART (7 bits)
UART (8 bits)
UART (7 bits)
UARTi receive register
PAR
PAR
UART
enabled
PRYE = 1
2SP
UART (9 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
UART (8 bits)
UART (9 bits)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0 UiRB register
MSB/LSB conversion circuit
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
MSB/LSB conversion circuit
D8
PRYE = 1
PAR
enabled
2SP
SP
SP
UART (9 bits)
UART
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
TXDi
Clock
PAR
disabled synchronous
PRYE = 0 type
0
UARTi Transmit/Receive Unit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
D0 UiTB register
UART (8 bits)
UART (9 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
PAR
1SP
Figure 17.2
D7
Page 317 of 450
UART (7 bits)
UART (8 bits)
Clock
synchronous
type
UART (7 bits)
UARTi transmit register
i = 0 or 2
SP: Stop bit
PAR: Parity bit
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
UARTi Transmit/Receive Mode Register (i = 0 or 2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
U0MR
U2MR
Bit Symbol
Address
00A0h
0160h
Bit Name
Serial I/O mode select bits
SMD0
SMD2
STPS
Internal/external clock select bit 0 : Internal clock
1 : External clock
—
(b7)
RW
RW
RW
RW
Stop bit length select bit
0 : 1 stop bit
1 : 2 stop bits
RW
Odd/even parity select bit
Enable w hen PRYE = 1
0 : Odd parity
1 : Even parity
RW
Parity enable bit
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
PRY
PRYE
RW
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : Serial interface disabled
0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
1 0 0 : UART mode transfer data 7 bits long
1 0 1 : UART mode transfer data 8 bits long
1 1 0 : UART mode transfer data 9 bits long
Other than above : Do not set.
SMD1
CKDIR
After Reset
00h
00h
Function
RW
UARTi Bit Rate Register (i = 0 or 2)(1, 2, 3)
b7
b0
Symbol
U0BRG
U2BRG
Address
00A1h
0161h
Function
Assuming the set value is n, UiBRG divides the count source by n+1
NOTES:
1. Write to this register w hile the serial I/O is neither transmitting nor receiving.
2. Use the MOV instruction to w rite to this register.
3. After setting the CLK0 to CLK1 bits of the UiC0 register, w rite to the UiBRG register.
Figure 17.3
Registers U0MR, U2MR and U0BRG, U2BRG
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 318 of 450
After Reset
Undefined
Undefined
Setting Range
00h to FFh
RW
WO
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
UARTi Transmit Buffer Register (i = 0 or 2)(1, 2)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
U0TB
U2TB
Address
00A3h-00A2h
0163h-0162h
Function
—
(b8-b0)
Transmit data
—
(b15-b9)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
After Reset
Undefined
Undefined
RW
WO
—
NOTES:
1. When the transfer data length is 9 bits, w rite data to high byte first, then low byte.
2. Use the MOV instruction to w rite to this register.
UARTi Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 (i = 0 or 2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
U0C0
U2C0
Bit Symbol
CLK0
CLK1
—
(b2)
TXEPT
—
(b4)
NCH
Address
00A4h
0164h
Bit Name
BRG count source select b1 b0
0 0 : Selects f1
bits (1)
0 1 : Selects f8
1 0 : Selects f32
1 1 : Do not set.
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
Transmit register empty
flag
0 : Data in transmit register (during transmit)
1 : No data in transmit register (transmit completed)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
RW
RO
—
RW
CLK polarity select bit
0 : Transmit data is output at falling edge of transfer
clock and receive data is input at rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at rising edge of transfer
clock and receive data is input at falling edge
RW
Transfer format select bit 0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
Registers U0TB, U2TB and U0C0, U2C0
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
0 : TXDi pin is for CMOS output
1 : TXDi pin is for N-channel open-drain output
NOTE:
1. If the BRG count source is sw itched, set the UiBRG register again.
Figure 17.4
RW
Data output select bit
CKPOL
UFORM
After Reset
00001000b
00001000b
Function
Page 319 of 450
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
UARTi Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 (i = 0 or 2)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
U0C1
U2C1
Bit Symbol
Address
00A5h
0165h
Bit Name
Transmit enable bit
After Reset
00000010b
00000010b
Function
0 : Disables transmission
1 : Enables transmission
Transmit buffer empty flag
0 : Data in UiTB register
1 : No data in UiTB register
RO
Receive enable bit
0 : Disables reception
1 : Enables reception
RW
Receive complete flag(1)
0 : No data in UiRB register
1 : Data in UiRB register
RO
UiIRS
UARTi transmit interrupt cause
select bit
0 : Transmission buffer empty (TI=1)
1 : Transmission completed (TXEPT=1)
RW
UiRRM
UARTi continuous receive mode
enable bit(2)
0 : Disables continuous receive mode
1 : Enables continuous receive mode
RW
—
(b6)
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
—
(b7)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
TE
TI
RE
RI
RW
RW
RW
—
NOTES:
1. The RI bit is set to 0 w hen the higher byte of the UiRB register is read out.
2. Set the UiRRM bit to 0 (disables continuous receive mode) in UART mode.
UARTi Receive Buffer Register (i = 0 or 2)(1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
U0RB
U2RB
Bit Symbol
—
(b7-b0)
Address
00A7h-00A6h
0167h-0166h
Bit Name
—
—
(b8)
—
(b11-b9)
OER
FER
PER
SUM
—
After Reset
Undefined
Undefined
Function
Receive data (D7 to D0)
Receive data (D8)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is undefined.
RW
RO
RO
—
Overrun error flag(2)
0 : No overrun error
1 : Overrun error
RO
Framing error flag(2)
0 : No framing error
1 : Framing error
RO
Parity error flag(2)
0 : No parity error
1 : Parity error
RO
Error sum flag(2)
0 : No error
1 : Error
RO
NOTES:
1. Read out the UiRB register in 16-bit units.
2. Bits SUM, PER, FER, and OER are set to 0 (no error) w hen bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 000b
(serial interface disabled) or the RE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (receive disabled). The SUM bit is set to 0 (no
error) w hen bits PER, FER, and OER are set to 0 (no error). Bits PER and FER are set to 0 even w hen the higher byte
of the UiRB register is read out.
Also, bits PER and FER are set to 0 w hen reading the high-order byte of the UiRB register.
Figure 17.5
Registers U0C1, U2C1 and U0RB, U2RB
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 320 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
Pin Select Register 1
b7
b0
Symbol
PINSR1
Set to “70h” w hen using UART2.
Do not set values other than “70h”.
When read, its content is undefined.
Figure 17.6
PINSR1 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 321 of 450
Address
00F5h
Function
After Reset
Undefined
RW
WO
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17.1
17. Serial Interface
Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
In clock synchronous serial I/O mode, data is transmitted and received using a transfer clock.
Table 17.1 lists the Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Specifications. Table 17.2 lists the Registers Used and
Settings in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode.
Table 17.1
Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Specifications
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clocks
Specification
• Transfer data length: 8 bits
• CKDIR bit in UiMR register is set to 0 (internal clock): fi/(2(n+1))
fi = f1, f8, f32 n = value set in UiBRG register: 00h to FFh
• The CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock): input from CLKi pin
Transmit start conditions
• Before transmission starts, the following requirements must be met(1)
- The TE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (transmission enabled)
- The TI bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (data in the UiTB register)
Receive start conditions
• Before reception starts, the following requirements must be met(1)
- The RE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (reception enabled)
- The TE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (transmission enabled)
- The TI bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (data in the UiTB register)
• When transmitting, one of the following conditions can be selected
- The UiIRS bit is set to 0 (transmit buffer empty):
When transferring data from the UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
(when transmission starts).
- The UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transmission completes):
When completing data transmission from UARTi transmit register.
• When receiving
When data transfer from the UARTi receive register to the UiRB register
(when reception completes).
Interrupt request
generation timing
Error detection
Select functions
• Overrun error(2)
This error occurs if the serial interface starts receiving the next data item
before reading the UiRB register and receives the 7th bit of the next data.
• CLK polarity selection
Transfer data input/output can be selected to occur synchronously with the
rising or the falling edge of the transfer clock.
• LSB first, MSB first selection
Whether transmitting or receiving data begins with bit 0 or begins with bit 7
can be selected.
• Continuous receive mode selection
Receive is enabled immediately by reading the UiRB register.
i = 0 or 2
NOTES:
1. If an external clock is selected, ensure that the external clock is “H” when the CKPOL bit in the UiC0
register is set to 0 (transmit data output at falling edge and receive data input at rising edge of
transfer clock), and that the external clock is “L” when the CKPOL bit is set to 1 (transmit data output
at rising edge and receive data input at falling edge of transfer clock).
2. If an overrun error occurs, the receive data (b0 to b8) of the UiRB register will be undefined. The IR
bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 322 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 17.2
Register
UiTB
UiRB
UiBRG
UiMR
UiC0
UiC1
17. Serial Interface
Registers Used and Settings in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode(1)
Bit
0 to 7
0 to 7
OER
0 to 7
SMD2 to SMD0
CKDIR
CLK1 to CLK0
TXEPT
NCH
CKPOL
UFORM
TE
TI
RE
RI
UiIRS
UiRRM
Function
Set data transmission
Data reception can be read
Overrun error flag
Set bit rate
Set to 001b
Select the internal clock or external clock
Select the count source in the UiBRG register
Transmit register empty flag
Select TXDi pin output mode
Select the transfer clock polarity
Select the LSB first or MSB first
Set this bit to 1 to enable transmission/reception
Transmit buffer empty flag
Set this bit to 1 to enable reception
Reception complete flag
Select the UARTi transmit interrupt source
Set this bit to 1 to use continuous receive mode
i = 0 or 2
NOTE:
1. Set bits which are not in this table to 0 when writing to the above registers in clock synchronous
serial I/O mode.
Table 17.3 lists the I/O Pin Functions in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode. The TXDi pin outputs “H” level
between the operating mode selection of UARTi (i = 0 or 2) and transfer start. (If the NCH bit is set to 1 (N-channel
open-drain output), this pin is in a high-impedance state.)
Table 17.3
I/O Pin Functions in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
Pin Name
TXD0 (P1_4)
RXD0 (P1_5)
Function
Output serial data
Input serial data
CLK0 (P1_6)
Output transfer clock
Input transfer clock
TXD2 (P0_1)
RXD2 (P0_2)
Output serial data
Input serial data
CLK2 (P0_3)
Output transfer clock
Input transfer clock
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Selection Method
(Outputs dummy data when performing reception only)
PD1_5 bit in PD1 register = 0
(P1_5 can be used as an input port when performing
transmission only)
CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 0
CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 1
PD1_6 bit in PD1 register = 0
(Outputs dummy data when performing reception only)
PD0_2 bit in PD0 register = 0
(P0_2 can be used as an input port when performing
transmission only)
CKDIR bit in U2MR register = 0
CKDIR bit in U2MR register = 1
PD0_3 bit in PD0 register = 0
Page 323 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
• Example of transmit timing (when internal clock is selected)
TC
Transfer clock
TE bit in UiC1
register
1
0
TI bit in UiC1
register
1
0
Set data in UiTB register
Transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
TCLK
Stop pulsing because the TE bit is set to 0
CLKi
D0
TXDi
TXEPT bit in
UiC0 register
1
0
IR bit in SiTIC
register
1
0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program
TC=TCLK=2(n+1)/fi
fi: Frequency of UiBRG count source (f1, f8, f32)
The above applies under the following settings:
n: Setting value to UiBRG register
• CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 0 (internal clock)
• CKPOL bit in UiC0 register = 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
• UiIRS bit in UiC1 register = 0 (an interrupt request is generated when the transmit buffer is empty)
• Example of receive timing (when external clock is selected)
RE bit in UiC1
register
1
0
TE bit in UiC1
register
1
0
TI bit in UiC1
register
1
0
Write dummy data to UiTB register
Transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
1/fEXT
CLKi
Receive data is taken in
D0
RXDi
RI bit in UiC1
register
1
0
IR bit in SiRIC
register
1
0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D0
D1
Transfer from UARTi receive register to
UiRB register
D2
D3
D4
D5
Read out from UiRB register
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program
The above applies under the following settings:
• CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 1 (external clock)
• CKPOL bit in UiC0 register = 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
The following conditions are met when “H” is applied to the CLKi pin before receiving data:
• TE bit in UiC1 register = 1 (enables transmit)
• RE bit in UiC1 register = 1 (enables receive)
• Write dummy data to the UiTB register
fEXT: Frequency of external clock
i = 0 or 2
Figure 17.7
Transmit and Receive Timing Example in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 324 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17.1.1
17. Serial Interface
Polarity Select Function
Figure 17.8 shows the Transfer Clock Polarity. Use the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 (i = 0 or 2) register to select the
transfer clock polarity.
• When the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 0 (output transmit data at the falling
edge and input receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
CLKi(1)
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
• When the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 1 (output transmit data at the rising
edge and input receive data at the falling edge of the transfer clock)
CLKi(2)
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
NOTES:
1. When not transferring, the CLKi pin level is “H”.
2. When not transferring, the CLKi pin level is “L”.
i = 0 or 2
Figure 17.8
17.1.2
Transfer Clock Polarity
LSB First/MSB First Select Function
Figure 17.9 shows the Transfer Format. Use the UFORM bit in the UiC0 (i = 0 or 2) register to select the
transfer format.
• When UFORM bit in UiC0 register = 0 (LSB first)(1)
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
• When UFORM bit in UiC0 register = 1 (MSB first)(1)
CLKi
TXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
RXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
NOTE:
1. The above applies when the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register is
set to 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input receive
data at the rising edge of the transfer clock).
i = 0 or 2
Figure 17.9
Transfer Format
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 325 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17.1.3
17. Serial Interface
Continuous Receive Mode
Continuous receive mode is selected by setting the UiRRM (i = 0 or 2) bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (enables
continuous receive mode). In this mode, reading the UiRB register sets the TI bit in the UiC1 register to 0 (data
in the UiTB register). When the UiRRM bit is set to 1, do not write dummy data to the UiTB register by a
program.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 326 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17.2
17. Serial Interface
Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode
The UART mode allows data transmission and reception after setting the desired bit rate and transfer data format.
Table 17.4 lists the UART Mode Specifications. Table 17.5 lists the Registers Used and Settings for UART Mode.
Table 17.4
UART Mode Specifications
Item
Transfer data formats
Transfer clocks
Transmit start conditions
Receive start conditions
Interrupt request
generation timing
Error detection
Specification
• Character bit (transfer data): Selectable among 7, 8 or 9 bits
• Start bit: 1 bit
• Parity bit: Selectable among odd, even, or none
• Stop bit: Selectable among 1 or 2 bits
• CKDIR bit in UiMR register is set to 0 (internal clock): fj/(16(n+1))
fj = f1, f8, f32 n = value set in UiBRG register: 00h to FFh
• CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock): fEXT/(16(n+1))
fEXT: Input from CLKi pin, n = value set in UiBRG register: 00h to FFh
• Before transmission starts, the following are required
- TE bit in UiC1 register is set to 1 (transmission enabled)
- TI bit in UiC1 register is set to 0 (data in UiTB register)
• Before reception starts, the following are required
- RE bit in UiC1 register is set to 1 (reception enabled)
- Start bit detected
• When transmitting, one of the following conditions can be selected
- UiIRS bit is set to 0 (transmit buffer empty):
When transferring data from the UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
(when transmission starts).
- UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transfer ends):
When serial interfac.e completes transmitting data from the UARTi
transmit register
• When receiving
When transferring data from the UARTi receive register to UiRB register
(when reception ends).
• Overrun error(1)
This error occurs if the serial interface starts receiving the next data item
before reading the UiRB register and receive the bit preceding the final
stop bit of the next data item.
• Framing error
This error occurs when the set number of stop bits is not detected.
• Parity error
This error occurs when parity is enabled, and the number of 1’s in parity
and character bits do not match the number of 1’s set.
• Error sum flag
This flag is set is set to 1 when an overrun, framing, or parity error is
generated.
i = 0 or 2
NOTE:
1. If an overrun error occurs, the receive data (b0 to b8) of the UiRB register will be undefined. The IR
bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 327 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 17.5
17. Serial Interface
Registers Used and Settings for UART Mode
Register
UiTB
0 to 8
Set transmit data(1)
UiRB
0 to 8
UiBRG
UiMR
OER,FER,PER,SUM
0 to 7
SMD2 to SMD0
Receive data can be read(1, 2)
Error flag
Set a bit rate
Set to 100b when transfer data is 7 bits long
Set to 101b when transfer data is 8 bits long
Set to 110b when transfer data is 9 bits long
Select the internal clock or external clock
Select the stop bit
Select whether parity is included and whether odd or even
Select the count source for the UiBRG register
Transmit register empty flag
Select TXDi pin output mode
Set to 0
LSB first or MSB first can be selected when transfer data is 8 bits long.
Set to 0 when transfer data is 7 or 9 bits long.
Set to 1 to enable transmit
Transmit buffer empty flag
Set to 1 to enable receive
Receive complete flag
Select the source of UARTi transmit interrupt
Set to 0
UiC0
UiC1
Bit
CKDIR
STPS
PRY, PRYE
CLK0, CLK1
TXEPT
NCH
CKPOL
UFORM
TE
TI
RE
RI
UiIRS
UiRRM
Function
i = 0 or 2
NOTES:
1. The bits used for transmit/receive data are as follows: Bits 0 to 6 when transfer data is 7 bits long; bits 0 to 7
when transfer data is 8 bits long; bits 0 to 8 when transfer data is 9 bits long.
2. The following bits are undefined: Bits 7 and 8 when transfer data is 7 bits long; bit 8 when transfer data is 8 bits
long.
Table 17.6 lists the I/O Pin Functions in UART Mode. After the UARTi (i = 0 or 2) operating mode is selected, the
TXDi pin outputs “H” level. (If the NCH bit is set to 1 (N-channel open-drain output), this pin is in a highimpedance state) until transfer starts.)
Table 17.6
I/O Pin Functions in UART Mode
Pin name
Function
TXD0 (P1_4) Output serial data
RXD0 (P1_5) Input serial data
CLK0 (P1_6)
TXD2 (P0_1)
RXD2 (P0_2)
CLK2 (P0_3)
Selection Method
(Cannot be used as a port when performing reception only)
PD1_5 bit in PD1 register = 0
(P1_5 can be used as an input port when performing
transmission only)
Programmable I/O Port CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 0
Input transfer clock
CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 1
PD1_6 bit in PD1 register = 0
Output serial data
(Cannot be used as a port when performing reception only)
Input serial data
PD0_2 bit in PD0 register = 0
(P0_2 can be used as an input port when performing
transmission only)
Programmable I/O Port CKDIR bit in U2MR register = 0
Input transfer clock
CKDIR bit in U2MR register = 1
PD0_3 bit in PD0 register = 0
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 328 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
• Transmit timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity enabled, 1 stop bit)
TC
Transfer clock
TE bit in UiC1
register
1
0
TI bit in UiC1
register
1
0
Write data to UiTB register
Stop pulsing
because the TE bit is set to 0
Transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
Start
bit
TXDi
ST
TXEPT bit in
UiC0 register
1
0
IR bit SiTIC
register
1
0
Parity Stop
bit
bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST
D0
D1
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program
TC=16 (n + 1) / fj or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
The above timing diagram applies under the following conditions:
• PRYE bit in UiMR register = 1 (parity enabled)
fj: Frequency of UiBRG count source (f1, f8, f32)
• STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
fEXT: Frequency of UiBRG count source (external clock)
• UiIRS bit in UiC1 register = 1 (an interrupt request is generated when transmit completes)
n: Setting value to UiBRG register
i = 0 or 2
• Transmit timing when transfer data is 9 bits long (parity disabled, 2 stop bits)
TC
Transfer clock
TE bit in UiC1
register
1
0
TI bit in UiC1
register
1
0
Write data to UiTB register
Transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
Stop Stop
bit
bit
Start
bit
TXDi
ST
TXEPT bit in
UiC0 register
1
0
IR bit in SiTIC
register
1
0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
SP SP
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
SP SP
ST
D0
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program
The above timing diagram applies under the following conditions:
• PRYE bit in UiMR register = 0 (parity disabled)
• STPS bit in UiMR register = 1 (2 stop bits)
• UiIRS bit in UiC1 register = 0 (an interrupt request is generated when transmit buffer is empty)
Figure 17.10
Transmit Timing in UART Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 329 of 450
TC=16 (n + 1) / fj or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fj: Frequency of UiBRG count source (f1, f8, f32)
fEXT: Frequency of UiBRG count source (external clock)
n: Setting value to UiBRG register
i = 0 or 2
D1
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17. Serial Interface
• Example of receive timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity disabled, one stop bit)
UiBRG output
UiC1 register
RE bit
1
0
Stop bit
Start bit
RXDi
D0
D1
D7
Determined to be “L” Receive data taken in
Transfer clock
Reception triggered when transfer clock
is generated by falling edge of start bit
UiC1 register
RI bit
1
0
SiRIC register
IR bit
1
0
Transferred from UARTi receive
register to UiRB register
Set to 0 when interrupt request is accepted, or set by a program
The above timing diagram applies when the register bits are set as follows:
• UiMR register PRYE bit = 0 (parity disabled)
• UiMR register STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit)
i = 0 or 2
Figure 17.11
Receive Timing Example in UART Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 330 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17.2.1
17. Serial Interface
Bit Rate
In UART mode, the bit rate is the frequency divided by the UiBRG (i = 0 or 2) register.
Figure 17.12 shows the Calculation Formula of UiBRG (i = 0 or 2) Register Setting Value. Table 17.7 lists the
Bit Rate Setting Example in UART Mode (Internal Clock Selected).
UART mode
• Internal clock selected
UiBRG register setting value =
fj
Bit Rate × 16
-1
Fj: Count source frequency of the UiBRG register (f1, f8, or f32)
• External clock selected
UiBRG register setting value =
fEXT
Bit Rate × 16
-1
fEXT: Count source frequency of the UiBRG register (external clock)
i = 0 or 2
Figure 17.12
Calculation Formula of UiBRG (i = 0 or 2) Register Setting Value
Table 17.7
Bit Rate Setting Example in UART Mode (Internal Clock Selected)
System Clock = 20 MHz
System Clock = 18.432 MHz(1)
UiBRG
Setting UiBRG
Setting
Actual Time
Actual Time
Setting
Error
Setting
Error
(bps)
(bps)
Value
(%)
Value
(%)
Bit Rate
(bps)
UiBRG
Count
Source
1200
f8
129 (81h)
1201.92
2400
f8
64 (40h)
2403.85
4800
f8
32 (20h)
4734.85
0.16 119 (77h)
0.16
-1.36
1200.00
0.00
System Clock = 8 MHz
UiBRG
Actual Setting
Setting
Time
Error
Value
(bps)
(%)
51 (33h)
1201.92
0.16
59 (3Bh)
2400.00
0.00
25 (19h)
2403.85
0.16
29 (1Dh)
4800.00
0.00
12 (0Ch)
4807.69
0.16
0.16 119 (77h)
-0.22 79 (4Fh)
9600.00
0.00
51 (33h)
9615.38
14400.00
0.00
34 (22h) 14285.71
0.16
-0.79
9600
f1
129 (81h)
9615.38
14400
f1
86 (56h)
14367.82
19200
f1
64 (40h)
19230.77
0.16
59 (3Bh)
19200.00
0.00
25 (19h) 19230.77
0.16
28800
f1
42 (2Ah)
29069.77
39 (27h)
28800.00
0.00
16 (10h) 29411.76
2.12
38400
f1
32 (20h)
37878.79
0.94
-1.36
29 (1Dh)
38400.00
0.00
12 (0Ch) 38461.54
57600
f1
21 (15h)
56818.18
-1.36
19 (13h)
57600.00
0.00
0.16
-3.55
115200
f1
10 (0Ah)
113636.36
-1.36
9 (09h)
115200.00
0.00
8 (08h) 55555.56
−
−
−
i = 0 to 1
NOTES:
1. For the high-speed on-chip oscillator, the correction value in the FRA7 register should be written into the FRA1
register.
This applies when the high-speed on-chip oscillator is selected as the system clock and bits FRA22 to FRA20
in the FRA2 register are set to 000b (divide-by-2 mode). For the precision of the high-speed on-chip oscillator,
refer to 22. Electrical Characteristics.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 331 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
17.3
17. Serial Interface
Notes on Serial Interface
• When reading data from the UiRB (i = 0 or 2) register either in the clock synchronous serial I/O mode or in the
clock asynchronous serial I/O mode. Ensure the data is read in 16-bit units. When the high-order byte of the
UiRB register is read, bits PER and FER in the UiRB register and the RI bit in the UiC1 register are set to 0.
To check receive errors, read the UiRB register and then use the read data.
Example (when reading receive buffer register):
MOV.W
00A6H,R0
; Read the U0RB register
• When writing data to the UiTB register in the clock asynchronous serial I/O mode with 9-bit transfer data
length, write data to the high-order byte first then the low-order byte, in 8-bit units.
Example (when reading transmit buffer register):
MOV.B
#XXH,00A3H ; Write the high-order byte of U0TB register
MOV.B
#XXH,00A2H ; Write the low-order byte of U0TB register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 332 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
18. Hardware LIN
The hardware LIN performs LIN communication in cooperation with timer RA and UART0.
18.1
Features
The hardware LIN has the features listed below.
Figure 18.1 shows a Block Diagram of Hardware LIN.
Master mode
• Generates Synch Break
• Detects bus collision
Slave mode
• Detects Synch Break
• Measures Synch Field
• Controls Synch Break and Synch Field signal inputs to UART0
• Detects bus collision
NOTE:
1.The WakeUp function is detected by INT1.
Hardware LIN
Synch Field
control
circuit
RXD0 pin
Timer RA
TIOSEL = 0
RXD data
LSTART bit
SBE bit
LINE bit
RXD0 input
control
circuit
Timer RA
underflow signal
TIOSEL = 1
Bus collision
detection
circuit
Timer RA
interrupt
Interrupt
control
circuit
UART0
BCIE, SBIE,
and SFIE bits
UART0 transfer clock
UART0 TE bit
Timer RA output pulse
MST bit
UART0 TXD data
TXD0 pin
LINE, MST, SBE, LSTART, BCIE, SBIE, SFIE: Bits in LINCR register
TIOSEL: Bit in TRAIOC register
TE: Bit in U0C1 register
Figure 18.1
Block Diagram of Hardware LIN
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 333 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.2
18. Hardware LIN
Input/Output Pins
The pin configuration of the hardware LIN is listed in Table 18.1.
Table 18.1
Pin Configuration
Name
Abbreviation
Input/Output
Receive data input
RXD0
Input
Transmit data output
TXD0
Output
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 334 of 450
Function
Receive data input pin of the hardware LIN
Transmit data output pin of the hardware LIN
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.3
18. Hardware LIN
Register Configuration
The hardware LIN contains the registers listed below.
These registers are detailed in Figures 18.2 and 18.3.
• LIN Control Register 2 (LINCR2)
• LIN Control Register (LINCR)
• LIN Status Register (LINST)
LIN Control Register 2
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
LINCR2
Bit Symbol
Address
0105h
Bit Name
Bus collision during Sync Break
transmission detection enable bit
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Disables bus collision detection
1 : Enables bus collision detection
—
(b2-b1)
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
—
(b7-b3)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
—
Address
0106h
Bit Name
Synch Field measurementcompleted interrupt enable bit
RW
BCE
RW
RW
RW
LIN Control Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
LINCR
Bit Symbol
SFIE
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Disables Synch Field measurementcompleted interrupt
1 : Enables Synch Field measurementcompleted interrupt
RW
SBIE
Synch Break detection interrupt 0 : Disables Synch Break detection interrupt
enable bit
1 : Enables Synch Break detection interrupt
RW
BCIE
Bus collision detection interrupt 0 : Disables bus collision detection interrupt
enable bit
1 : Enables bus collision detection interrupt
RW
RXDSF
LSTART
SBE
RXD0 input status flag
0 : RXD0 input enabled
1 : RXD0 input disabled
RO
Synch Break detection start
bit(1)
When this bit is set to 1, timer RA input is
enabled and RXD0 input is disabled.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
RXD0 input unmasking timing
0 : Unmasked after Synch Break is detected
select bit (effective only in slave 1 : Unmasked after Synch Field measurement
mode)
is completed
LIN operation mode setting bit(2)
MST
LINE
LIN operation start bit
RW
0 : Slave mode
(Synch Break detection circuit actuated)
1 : Master mode
(timer RA output OR’ed w ith TXD0)
RW
0 : Causes LIN to stop
1 : Causes LIN to start operating(3)
RW
NOTES:
1. After setting the LSTART bit, confirm that the RXDSF flag is set to 1 before Synch Break input starts.
2. Before changing LIN operation modes, temporarily stop the LIN operation (LINE bit = 0).
3. Inputs to timer RA and UART0 are prohibited immediately after this bit is set to 1. (Refer to Figure 18.5 Exam ple of
Header Field Transm ission Flow chart (1) and Figure 18.9 Exam ple of Header Field Reception Flow chart
(2) .)
Figure 18.2
Registers LINCR2 and LINCR
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 335 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
LIN Status Register
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
LINST
Bit Symbol
SFDCT
SBDCT
BCDCT
Address
0107h
Bit Name
Synch Field measurementcompleted flag
After Reset
00h
Function
1 show s Synch Field measurement completed.
Synch Break detection flag
1 show s Synch Break detected or Synch
Break generation completed.
Bus collision detection flag
1 show s Bus collision detected
SFDCT bit clear bit
When this bit is set to 1, the SFDCT bit is set to
0.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
When this bit is set to 1, the SBDCT bit is set to
0.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
When this bit is set to 1, the BCDCT bit is set to
0.
When read, the content is 0.
RW
B0CLR
SBDCT bit clear bit
B1CLR
BCDCT bit clear bit
B2CLR
—
(b7-b6)
Figure 18.3
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
LINST Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 336 of 450
RW
RO
RO
RO
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.4
18. Hardware LIN
Functional Description
18.4.1
Master Mode
Figure 18.4 shows typical operation of the hardware LIN when transmitting a header field in master mode.
Figures 18.5 and 18.6 show an Example of Header Field Transmission Flowchart.
When transmitting a header field, the hardware LIN operates as described below.
(1) When the TSTART bit in the TRACR register for timer RA is set by writing 1 in software, the hardware
LIN outputs “L” level from the TXD0 pin for the period that is set in registers TRAPRE and TRA for timer
RA.
(2) When timer RA underflows upon reaching the terminal count, the hardware LIN reverses the output of the
TXD0 pin and sets the SBDCT flag in the LINST register to 1. Furthermore, if the SBIE bit in the LINCR
register is set to 1, it generates a timer RA interrupt.
(3) The hardware LIN transmits 55h via UART0.
(4) The hardware LIN transmits an ID field via UART0 after it finishes sending 55h.
(5) The hardware LIN performs communication for a response field after it finishes sending the ID field.
Synch Break
TXD0 pin
SBDCT flag in the
LINST register
IR bit in the TRAIC
register
Synch Field
1
0
Set by writing 1 to the
B1CLR bit in the LINST
register
1
0
Cleared to 0 upon
acceptance of interrupt
request or by a program
1
0
(1)
(2)
(3)
The above applies under the following conditions:
LINE = 1, MST = 1, SBIE = 1
Figure 18.4
IDENTIFIER
Typical Operation when Sending a Header Field
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 337 of 450
(4)
(5)
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
Timer RA Set to timer mode
Bits TMOD0 to TMOD2 in TRAMR register ← 000b
Timer RA Set the pulse output level from low to start
TEDGSEL bit in TRAIOC register ← 1
Timer RA Set the INT1/TRAIO pin to P1_5
TIOSEL bit in TRAIOC register ← 1
Timer RA Set the count source (f1, f2, f8, fOCO)
Bits TCK0 to TCK2 in TRAMR register
Timer RA Set the Synch Break width
TRAPRE register
TRA register
UART0
Set to transmit/receive mode
(Transfer data length: 8 bits, Internal clock, 1 stop bit,
Parity disabled)
U0MR register
UART0
Set the BRG count source (f1, f8, f32)
U0C0CLK0 to 1 bit
UART0
Set the bit rate
U0BRG register
For the hardware LIN
function, set the TIOSEL bit
in the TRAIOC register to 1.
Set the count source and
registers TRA and TRAPRE
as suitable for the Synch
Break period.
Set the BRG count source
and U0BRG register as
appropriate for the bit rate.
Hardware LIN Set the LIN operation to stop
LINCR register LINE bit ← 0
Hardware LIN Set to master mode
MST bit in LINCR register ← 1
Hardware LIN Set bus collision detection enabled
BCE bit in LINCR2 register ← 1
Hardware LIN Set the LIN operation to start
LINE bit in LINCR register ← 1
Hardware LIN Set the register to enable interrupts
(Bus collision detection, Synch Break detection,
Synch Field measurement)
Bits BCIE, SBIE, SFIE in LINCR register
Hardware LIN Clear the status flags
(Bus collision detection, Synch Break detection,
Synch Field measurement)
Bits B2CLR, B1CLR, B0CLR in LINST register ← 1
A
Figure 18.5
Example of Header Field Transmission Flowchart (1)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 338 of 450
During master mode, the
Synch Field measurementcompleted interrupt cannot be
used.
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
A
Timer RA Set the timer to start counting
TSTART bit in TRACR register ← 1
Timer RA Read the count status flag
TCSTF flag in TRACR register
TCSTF = 1 ?
NO
YES
Hardware LIN Read the Synch Break detection flag
SBDCT flag in LINST register
SBDCT = 1 ?
NO
YES
Timer RA Set the timer to stop counting
TSTART bit in TRACR register ← 0
Timer RA Read the count status flag
TCSTF flag in TRACR register
TCSTF = 0 ?
NO
YES
UART0 Communication via UART0
TE bit in U0C1 register ← 1
U0TB register ← 0055h
UART0 Communication via UART0
U0TB register ← ID field
Figure 18.6
Timer RA generates Synch Break.
If registers TRAPRE and TRA for
timer RA do not need to be read or
the register settings do not need to be
changed after writing 1 to the
TSTART bit, the procedure for reading
TCSTF flag = 1 can be omitted.
Zero to one cycle of the timer RA
count source is required after timer
RA starts counting before the TCSTF
flag is set to 1.
The timer RA interrupt may be used
to terminate generation of Synch
Break.
Three to five cycles of the CPU clock
are required after Synch Break
generation completes before the
SBDCT flag is set to 1.
After timer RA Synch Break is
generated, the timer should be made
to stop counting.
If registers TRAPRE and TRA for timer
RA do not need to be read or the
register settings do not need to be
changed after writing 0 to the TSTART
bit, the procedure for reading TCSTF
flag = 0 can be omitted.
Zero to one cycle of the timer RA count
source is required after timer RA stops
counting before the TCSTF flag is set
to 0.
Transmit the Synch Field.
Transmit the ID field.
Example of Header Field Transmission Flowchart (2)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 339 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.4.2
18. Hardware LIN
Slave Mode
Figure 18.7 shows typical operation of the hardware LIN when receiving a header field in slave mode. Figure
18.8 through Figure 18.10 show an Example of Header Field Reception Flowchart.
When receiving a header field, the hardware LIN operates as described below.
(1) Synch Break detection is enabled by writing 1 to the LSTART bit in the LINCR register of the hardware
LIN.
(2) When “L” level is input for a duration equal to or greater than the period set in timer RA, the hardware LIN
detects it as Synch Break. At this time, the SBDCT flag in the LINST register is set to 1. Furthermore, if
the SBIE bit in the LINCR register is set to 1, the hardware LIN generates a timer RA interrupt. Then it
goes to Synch Field measurement.
(3) The hardware LIN receives a Synch Field (55h). At this time, it measures the period of the start bit and bits
0 to 6 by using timer RA. In this case, it is possible to select whether to input the Synch Field signal to
RXD0 of UART0 by setting the SBE bit in the LINCR register accordingly.
(4) The hardware LIN sets the SFDCT flag in the LINST register to 1 when it finishes measuring the Synch
Field. Furthermore, if the SFIE bit in the LINCR register is set to 1, it generates a timer RA interrupt.
(5) After it finishes measuring the Synch Field, calculate a transfer rate from the count value of timer RA and
set to UART0 and registers TRAPRE and TRA of timer RA again.
(6) The hardware LIN performs communication for a response field after it finishes receiving the ID field.
Synch Break
RXD0 pin
1
0
RXD0 input for
UART0
1
0
RXDSF flag in the
LINCR register
SBDCT flag in the
LINST register
Synch Field
IDENTIFIER
Set by writing 1 to
the LSTART bit in
the LINCR register
1
0
Cleared to 0 when Synch
Field measurement
finishes
Set by writing 1 to
the B1CLR bit in
the LINST register
1
0
Measure this period
SFDCT flag in the
LINST register
1
0
IR bit in the TRAIC
register
1
0
Cleared to 0 upon
acceptance of
interrupt request or
by a program
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
The above applies under the following conditions:
LINE = 1, MST = 0, SBE = 1, SBIE = 1, SFIE = 1
Figure 18.7
Typical Operation when Receiving a Header Field
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Set by writing 1 to the
B0CLR bit in the LINST
register
Page 340 of 450
(5)
(6)
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
Timer RA Set to pulse width measurement mode
Bits TMOD0 to TMOD2 in the TRAMR register ← 011b
Timer RA Set the pulse width measurement level low
TEDGSEL bit in the TRAIOC register ← 0
Timer RA Set the INT1/TRAIO pin to P1_5
TIOSEL bit in the TRAIOC register ← 1
For the hardware LIN
function, set the TIOSEL bit
in the TRAIOC register to 1.
Timer RA Set the count source (f1, f2, f8, fOCO)
Bits TCK0 to TCK2 in the TRAMR register
Timer RA Set the Synch Break width
TRAPRE register
TRA register
Set the count source and registers
TRA and TRAPRE as appropriate
for the Synch Break period.
Hardware LIN Set the LIN operation to stop
LINE bit in the LINCR register ← 0
Hardware LIN Set to slave mode
MST bit in the LINCR register ← 0
Hardware LIN Set the LIN operation to start
LINE bit in the LINCR register ← 1
Hardware LIN Set the RXD0 input unmasking timing
(After Synch Break detection, or after Synch
Field measurement)
SBE bit in the LINCR register
Hardware LIN Set the register to enable interrupts
(Bus collision detection, Synch Break detection,
Synch Field measurement)
Bits BCIE, SBIE, SFIE in the LINCR register
A
Figure 18.8
Example of Header Field Reception Flowchart (1)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 341 of 450
Select the timing at which to
unmask the RXD0 input for UART0.
If the RXD0 input is chosen to be
unmasked after detection of Synch
Break, the Synch Field signal is
also input to UART0.
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
A
Hardware LIN Clear the status flags
(Bus collision detection, Synch Break
detection, Synch Field measurement)
Bits B2CLR, B1CLR, B0CLR in the LINST
register ← 1
Timer RA Set to start a pulse width measurement
TSTART bit in the TRACR register ← 1
Timer RA waits until the timer starts
counting.
Timer RA Read the count status flag
TCSTF flag in the TRACR register
TCSTF = 1 ?
NO
YES
Hardware LIN Set to start Synch Break detection
LSTART bit in the LINCR register ← 1
Hardware LIN Read the RXD0 input status flag
RXDSF flag in the LINCR register
RXDSF = 1 ?
NO
YES
Hardware LIN Read the Synch Break detection flag
SBDCT flag in the LINST register
SBDCT = 1 ?
NO
YES
B
Figure 18.9
Zero to one cycle of the timer RA count
source is required after timer RA starts
counting before the TCSTF flag is set to
1.
Hardware LIN waits until the RXD0
input for UART0 is masked.
Do not apply “L” level to the RXD pin
until the RXDSF flag reads 1 after
writing 1 to the LSTART bit. This is
because the signal applied during this
time is input directly to UART0.
Three to five cycles of the CPU clock
are required after the LSTART bit is set
to 1 before the RXDSF flag is set to 1.
After this, input to timer RA and UART0
is enabled.
Hardware LIN detects a Synch Break.
The interrupt of the timer RA may be
used.
When Synch Break is detected, timer
RA is reloaded with the initially set
count value.
Even if the duration of the input “L”
level is shorter than the set period,
timer RA is reloaded with the initially
set count value and waits until the
next “L” level is input.
Three to five cycles of the CPU clock
are required after Synch Break
detection before the SBDCT flag is
set to 1.
When the SBE bit in the LINCR
register is set to 0 (unmasked after
Synch Break is detected), timer RA
can be used in timer mode after the
SBDCT flag in the LINST register is
set to 1 and the RXDSF flag is set to
0.
Example of Header Field Reception Flowchart (2)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 342 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18. Hardware LIN
B
YES
Hardware LIN Read the Synch Field measurementcompleted flag
SFDCT flag in the LINST register
SFDCT = 1 ?
NO
YES
UART0 Set the UART0 communication rate
U0BRG register
Timer RA Set the Synch Break width again
TRAPRE register
TRA register
UART0 Communication via UART0
Clock asynchronous serial interface (UART) mode
Transmit ID field
Figure 18.10
Example of Header Field Reception Flowchart (3)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 343 of 450
Hardware LIN measures the Synch
Field.
The interrupt of timer RA may be
used (the SBDCT flag is set when
the timer RA counter underflows
upon reaching the terminal count).
When the SBE bit in the LINCR
register is set to 1 (unmasked after
Synch Field measurement is
completed), timer RA may be used
in timer mode after the SFDCT bit in
the LINST register is set to 1.
Set a communication rate based on
the Synch Field measurement
result.
Communication via UART0
(The SBDCT flag is set when the
timer RA counter underflows upon
reaching the terminal count.)
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.4.3
18. Hardware LIN
Bus Collision Detection Function
The bus collision detection function can be used when UART0 is enabled for transmission (TE bit in the U0C1
register = 1). To detect a bus collision during Synch Break transmission, set the BCE bit in the LINCR2 register
to 1 (bus collision detection enabled).
Figure 18.11 shows the Typical Operation when a Bus Collision is Detected.
TXD0 pin
1
0
RXD0 pin
1
0
Transfer clock
1
0
LINE bit in the
LINCR register
1
0
TE bit in the U0C1
register
1
0
Set to 1 by a program
Set to 1 by a program
BCDCT flag in the
LINST register
IR bit in the TRAIC
register
Figure 18.11
Set by writing 1 to
the B2CLR bit in the
LINST register
1
0
Cleared to 0 upon
acceptance of interrupt
request or by a program
1
0
Typical Operation when a Bus Collision is Detected
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 344 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.4.4
18. Hardware LIN
Hardware LIN End Processing
Figure 18.12 shows an Example of Hardware LIN Communication Completion Flowchart.
Use the following timing for hardware LIN end processing:
• If the hardware bus collision detection function is used
Perform hardware LIN end processing after checksum transmission completes.
• If the bus collision detection function is not used
Perform hardware LIN end processing after header field transmission and reception complete.
Timer RA
Timer RA
Set the timer to stop counting
TSTART bit in TRACR register ← 0
Read the count status flag
TCSTF flag in TRACR register
TCSTF = 0 ?
NO
YES
UART0 Complete transmission via UART0
Hardware LIN
Hardware LIN
Figure 18.12
Clear the status flags
(Bus collision detection, Synch Break
detection, Synch Field measurement)
Bits B2CLR, B1CLR, B0CLR in the LINST
register ← 1
Set the timer to stop counting.
Zero to one cycle of the timer RA
count source is required after
timer RA starts counting before
the TCSTF flag is set to 1.
When the bus collision
detection function is not used,
end processing for the UART0
transmission is not required.
After clearing hardware LIN
status flag, stop the hardware
LIN operation.
Set the LIN operation to stop
LINE bit in the LINCR register ← 0
Example of Hardware LIN Communication Completion Flowchart
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 345 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.5
18. Hardware LIN
Interrupt Requests
There are four interrupt requests that are generated by the hardware LIN: Synch Break detection, Synch Break
generation completed, Synch Field measurement completed, and bus collision detection. These interrupts are
shared with timer RA.
Table 18.2 lists the Interrupt Requests of Hardware LIN.
Table 18.2
Interrupt Requests of Hardware LIN
Interrupt Request
Synch Break detection
Status Flag
Cause of Interrupt
SBDCT
Generated when timer RA has underflowed after measuring
the “L” level duration of RXD0 input, or when a “L” level is
input for a duration longer than the Synch Break period
during communication.
Synch Break generation
completed
Generated when “L” level output to TXD0 for the duration set
by timer RA completes.
Synch Field
measurement completed
SFDCT
Generated when measurement for 6 bits of the Synch Field
by timer RA is completed.
Bus collision detection
BCDCT
Generated when the RXD0 input and TXD0 output values
differed at data latch timing while UART0 is enabled for
transmission.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 346 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
18.6
18. Hardware LIN
Notes on Hardware LIN
For the time-out processing of the header and response fields, use another timer to measure the duration of time
with a Synch Break detection interrupt as the starting point.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 347 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
19. A/D Converter
The A/D converter consists of one 10-bit successive approximation A/D converter circuit with a capacitive coupling
amplifier. The analog input shares pins P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5, and P1_0 to P1_3. Therefore, when using these pins,
ensure that the corresponding port direction bits are set to 0 (input mode).
When not using the A/D converter, set the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register to 0 (Vref unconnected) so that no
current will flow from the VREF pin into the resistor ladder. This helps to reduce the power consumption of the chip.
The result of A/D conversion is stored in the AD register.
Table 19.1 lists the Performance of A/D converter. Figure 19.1 shows a Block Diagram of A/D Converter.
Figures 19.2 and 19.3 show the A/D converter-related registers.
Table 19.1
Performance of A/D converter
Item
A/D conversion method
Performance
Successive approximation (with capacitive coupling amplifier)
0 V to AVCC
Analog input voltage(1)
4.2 V ≤ AVCC ≤ 5.5 V f1, f2, f4, fOCO-F
2.7 V ≤ AVCC < 4.2 V f2, f4, fOCO-F
8 bits or 10 bits selectable
AVCC = Vref = 5 V, φAD = 10 MHz
• 8-bit resolution ±2 LSB
• 10-bit resolution ±3 LSB
AVCC = Vref = 3.3 V, φAD = 10 MHz
• 8-bit resolution ±2 LSB
• 10-bit resolution ±5 LSB
Operating clock φAD(2)
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
Operating mode
Analog input pin
A/D conversion start condition
Conversion rate per pin
One-shot and repeat(3)
9 pins (AN2, AN4 to AN11)
• Software trigger
Set the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register to 1 (A/D conversion starts)
• Capture
Timer RD interrupt request is generated while the ADST bit is set to 1
• Without sample and hold function
8-bit resolution: 49φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 59φAD cycles
• With sample and hold function
8-bit resolution: 28φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 33φAD cycles
NOTES:
1. The analog input voltage does not depend on use of a sample and hold function.
When the analog input voltage is over the reference voltage, the A/D conversion result will be 3FFh
in 10-bit mode and FFh in 8-bit mode.
2. When 2.7 V ≤ AVCC ≤ 5.5 V, the frequency of φAD must be 10 MHz or below.
Without a sample and hold function, the φAD frequency should be 250 kHz or above.
With a sample and hold function, the φAD frequency should be 1 MHz or above.
3. In repeat mode, only 8-bit mode can be used.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 348 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
CKS0 = 1
fOCO-F
A/D conversion rate selection
CKS1 = 1
f1
CKS0 = 0
CKS0 = 1
φAD
f2
CKS1 = 0
f4
CKS0 = 0
VCUT = 0
AVSS
VREF
Resistor ladder
VCUT = 1
Successive conversion register
Software trigger
ADCAP = 0
ADCON0
Trigger
Timer RD
interrupt request
ADCAP = 1
Vcom
AD register
Decoder
Comparator
VIN
Data bus
P0_5/AN2
P0_3/AN4
P0_2/AN5
P0_1/AN6
P0_0/AN7
P1_0/AN8
P1_1/AN9
P1_2/AN10
P1_3/AN11
CH2 to CH0 = 010b
CH2 to CH0 = 100b
CH2 to CH0 = 101b
CH2 to CH0 = 110b
CH2 to CH0 = 111b
ADGSEL0 = 0
ADGSEL0 = 1
CH2 to CH0 = 100b
CH2 to CH0 = 101b
CH2 to CH0 = 110b
CH2 to CH0 = 111b
CH0 to CH2, ADGSEL0, ADCAP, CKS0: Bits in ADCON0 register
CKS1, VCUT: Bits in ADCON1 register
Figure 19.1
Block Diagram of A/D Converter
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 349 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit Symbol
CH0
Address
00D6h
Bit Name
Analog input pin select bits (Note 4)
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
CH2
RW
ADGSEL0
ADCAP
ADST
A/D operating mode select 0 : One-shot mode
1 : Repeat mode
bit(2)
RW
A/D input group select bit(4) 0 : Selects port P0 group (AN2, AN4 to AN7)
1 : Selects port P1 group (AN8 to AN11)
RW
A/D conversion automatic
start bit
0 : Starts at softw are trigger (ADST bit)
1 : Starts at timer RD
(complementary PWM mode)
RW
A/D conversion start flag
0 : Stops A/D conversion
1 : Starts A/D conversion
RW
Frequency select bit 0
[When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 0]
0 : Select f4
1 : Select f2
[When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 1]
0 : Select f1(3)
1 : Select fOCO-F
RW
CKS0
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
2. When changing A/D operation mode, set the analog input pin again.
3. Set øAD frequency to 10 MHz or below .
4. The analog input pin can be selected according to a combination of bits CH0 to CH2 and the ADGSEL0 bit.
Figure 19.2
ADGSEL0=0
—
Do not set.
AN2
Do not set.
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
ADGSEL0=1
Do not set.
AN8
AN9
AN10
AN11
ADCON0 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
CH1
MD
CH2 to CH0
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
RW
Page 350 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
00D7h
ADCON1
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Reserved bits
—
(b2-b0)
BITS
CKS1
VCUT
—
(b6-b7)
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
Set to 0.
RW
8/10-bit mode select bit(2)
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
Frequency select bit 1
Refer to the description of the CKS0 bit in the
ADCON0 register function.
RW
VREF connect bit(3)
0 : VREF not connected
1 : VREF connected
RW
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
RW
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
2. Set the BITS bit to 0 (8-bit mode) in repeat mode.
3. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 (connected) from 0 (not connected), w ait for 1 µs or more before starting
A/D conversion.
A/D Control Register 2(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0
Symbol
ADCON2
Bit Symbol
Address
00D4h
Bit Name
A/D conversion method select bit
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Without sample and hold
1 : With sample and hold
—
(b3-b1)
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
—
(b7-b4)
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
SMP
RW
RW
RW
—
NOTE:
1. If the ADCON2 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
A/D Register
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
AD
Address
00C1h-00C0h
After Reset
Undefined
Function
When BITS bit in ADCON1 register is
set to 1 (10-bit mode).
8 low -order bits in A/D conversion result
2 high-order bits in A/D conversion result
Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0.
When read, the content is 0.
Figure 19.3
Registers ADCON1, ADCON2, and AD
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 351 of 450
When BITS bit in ADCON1 register is
set to 0 (8-bit mode).
A/D conversion result
When read, the content is undefined.
RW
RO
RO
—
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19.1
19. A/D Converter
One-Shot Mode
In one-shot mode, the input voltage of one selected pin is A/D converted once.
Table 19.2 lists the Specification of One-Shot Mode. Figures 19.4 and 19.5 show Registers ADCON0 and
ADCON1 in One-Shot Mode.
Table 19.2
Specification of One-Shot Mode
Item
Specification
Function
The input voltage of one pin selected by bits CH2 to CH0 and ADGSEL0 is
A/D converted once
Start condition
• When the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software trigger):
Set the ADST bit to 1 (A/D conversion starts)
• When the ADCAP bit is set to 1 (starts in timer RD (complementary PWM
mode):
A compare match between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 or a TRD1
underflow is generated while the ADST bit is set to 1
Stop condition
• A/D conversion completes (when the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software
trigger), ADST bit is set to 0)
• Set the ADST bit to 0
Interrupt request generation A/D conversion completes
timing
Input pin
Select one of AN2, AN4 to AN11
Reading of A/D conversion Read AD register
result
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 352 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit Symbol
CH0
Address
00D6h
Bit Name
Analog input pin select bits (Note 4)
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
CH2
RW
ADGSEL0
ADCAP
ADST
A/D operating mode select 0 : One-shot mode
bit(2)
RW
A/D input group select bit(4) 0 : Selects port P0 group (AN2, AN4 to AN7)
1 : Selects port P1 group (AN8 to AN11)
RW
A/D conversion automatic
start bit
0 : Starts at softw are trigger (ADST bit)
1 : Starts at timer RD
(complementary PWM mode)
RW
A/D conversion start flag
0 : Stops A/D conversion
1 : Starts A/D conversion
RW
Frequency select bit 0
[When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 0]
0 : Select f4
1 : Select f2
[When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 1]
0 : Select f1(3)
1 : Select fOCO-F
RW
CKS0
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
2. After changing the A/D operating mode, select the analog input pin again.
3. Set øAD frequency to 10 MHz or below .
4. The analog input pin can be selected according to a combination of bits CH0 to CH2 and the ADGSEL0 bit.
Figure 19.4
ADGSEL0=0
—
Do not set.
AN2
Do not set.
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
ADGSEL0=1
Do not set.
AN8
AN9
AN10
AN11
ADCON0 Register in One-Shot Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
CH1
MD
CH2 to CH0
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
RW
Page 353 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 1
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
00D7h
ADCON1
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Reserved bits
—
(b2-b0)
BITS
CKS1
VCUT
—
(b6-b7)
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to 0.
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
Frequency select bit 1
Refer to the description of the CKS0 bit in the
ADCON0 register function.
RW
VREF connect bit(2)
1 : VREF connected
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
ADCON1 Register in One-Shot Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
8/10-bit mode select bit
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
2. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 (connected) from 0 (not connected), w ait for 1 µs or more before starting
A/D conversion.
Figure 19.5
RW
Page 354 of 450
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19.2
19. A/D Converter
Repeat Mode
In repeat mode, the input voltage of one selected pin is A/D converted repeatedly.
Table 19.3 lists the Repeat Mode Specifications. Figures 19.6 and 19.7 show Registers ADCON0 and ADCON1 in
Repeat Mode.
Table 19.3
Repeat Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The Input voltage of one pin selected by bits CH2 to CH0 and ADGSEL0 is
A/D converted repeatedly
Start conditions
• When the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software trigger):
Set the ADST bit to 1 (A/D conversion starts)
• When the ADCAP bit is set to 1 (starts in timer RD (complementary PWM
mode):
A compare match between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 or a TRD1
underflow is generated while the ADST bit is set to 1
Stop condition
Set the ADST bit to 0
Interrupt request generation Not generated
timing
Input pin
Select one of AN2, AN4 to AN11
Reading of result of A/D
Read AD register
converter
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 355 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
Symbol
ADCON0
Bit Symbol
CH0
Address
00D6h
Bit Name
Analog input pin select bits (Note 4)
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
CH2
RW
A/D operating mode select 1 : Repeat mode
bit(2)
(4)
ADGSEL0
ADCAP
ADST
0 : Selects port P0 group (AN2, AN4 to AN7)
1 : Selects port P1 group (AN8 to AN11)
RW
A/D conversion automatic
start bit
0 : Starts at softw are trigger (ADST bit)
1 : Starts at timer RD
(complementary PWM mode)
RW
A/D conversion start flag
0 : Stops A/D conversion
1 : Starts A/D conversion
RW
Frequency select bit 0
[When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 0]
0 : Select f4
1 : Select f2
[When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 1]
0 : Select f1(3)
1 : Do not set.
RW
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
2. After changing A/D operation mode, select the analog input pin again.
3. Set øAD frequency to 10 MHz or below .
4. The analog input pin can be selected according to a combination of bits CH0 to CH2 and the ADGSEL0 bit.
ADGSEL0=0
—
Do not set.
AN2
Do not set.
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
ADGSEL0=1
Do not set.
AN8
AN9
AN10
AN11
ADCON0 Register in Repeat Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
RW
A/D input group select bit
CKS0
Figure 19.6
RW
CH1
MD
CH2 to CH0
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
RW
Page 356 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 1(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 1
0 0 0 0
Symbol
Address
00D7h
ADCON1
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Reserved bits
—
(b2-b0)
BITS
CKS1
VCUT
—
(b6-b7)
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to 0.
8/10-bit mode select bit(2)
0 : 8-bit mode
Frequency select bit 1
Refer to the description of the CKS0 bit in the
ADCON0 register function.
VREF connect bit(3)
1 : VREF connected
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined.
2. Set the BITS bit to 0 (8-bit mode) in repeat mode.
3. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 (connected) from 0 (not connected), w ait for 1 µs or more before starting
A/D conversion.
Figure 19.7
ADCON1 Register in Repeat Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 357 of 450
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19.3
19. A/D Converter
Sample and Hold
When the SMP bit in the ADCON2 register is set to 1 (sample and hold function enabled), the A/D conversion rate
per pin increases. The sample and hold function is available in all operating modes. Start A/D conversion after
selecting whether the sample and hold circuit is to be used or not.
Figure 19.8 shows a Timing Diagram of A/D Conversion.
Sample and hold
disabled
Conversion time of 1st bit
2nd bit
Comparison Sampling time Comparison Sampling time Comparison
2.5ø AD cycles
2.5ø AD cycles
time
time
time
Sampling time
4ø AD cycles
* Repeat until conversion ends
Sample and hold
enabled
2nd bit
Conversion time of 1st bit
Comparison
time
Sampling time
4ø AD cycles
Comparison Comparison Comparison
time
time
time
* Repeat until conversion ends
Figure 19.8
19.4
Timing Diagram of A/D Conversion
A/D Conversion Cycles
Figure 19.9 shows the A/D Conversion Cycles.
Conversion time at the 1st bit
A/D Conversion Mode
Conversion time at the 2nd
bit and the follows
Conversion
Time
Sampling
Time
Comparison
Time
Sampling
Time
49φAD
4φAD
2.0φAD
2.5φAD
End process
Comparison
End process
Time
Without Sample & Hold
8 bits
Without Sample & Hold
10 bits
59φAD
4φAD
2.0φAD
2.5φAD
2.5φAD
8.0φAD
With Sample & Hold
8 bits
28φAD
4φAD
2.5φAD
0.0φAD
2.5φAD
4.0φAD
With Sample & Hold
10 bits
33φAD
4φAD
2.5φAD
0.0φAD
2.5φAD
4.0φAD
Figure 19.9
A/D Conversion Cycles
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 358 of 450
2.5φAD
8.0φAD
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19.5
19. A/D Converter
Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input
Figure 19.10 shows the Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input.
VCC
VCC VSS
AVCC
ON Resistor
Approx. 2kΩ Wiring Resistor
Approx. 0.2kΩ
Parasitic Diode
AN0
SW1
ON Resistor
Approx. 0.6kΩ
Analog Input
Voltage
SW2
Parasitic Diode
i Ladder-type
Switches
i=9
AMP
VIN
ON Resistor
Approx. 5kΩ
Sampling
Control Signal
VSS
C = Approx.1.5pF
SW3
SW4
i Ladder-type
Wiring Resistors
AVSS
ON Resistor
Approx. 2kΩ Wiring Resistor
Approx. 0.2kΩ
Chopper-type
Amplifier
AN11
SW1
b4 b2 b1 b0
A/D Control Register 0
Reference
Control Signal
A/D Successive
Conversion Register
Vref
VREF
Resistor
ladder
SW5
Comparison
voltage
ON Resistor
Approx. 0.6k f
A/D Conversion
Interrupt Request
AVSS
Comparison reference voltage
(Vref) generator
Sampling Comparison
SW1 conducts only on the ports selected for analog input.
Connect to
Control signal
for SW2
Connect to
Connect to
Control signal
for SW3
SW2 and SW3 are open when A/D conversion is not in progress;
their status varies as shown by the waveforms in the diagrams on the left.
SW4 conducts only when A/D conversion is not in progress.
Connect to
SW5 conducts when compare operation is in progress.
NOTE:
1. Use only as a standard for designing this data.
Mass production may cause some changes in device characteristics.
Figure 19.10
Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 359 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19.6
19. A/D Converter
Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion
To carry out A/D conversion properly, charging the internal capacitor C shown in Figure 19.11 has to be completed
within a specified period of time. T (sampling time) as the specified time. Let output impedance of sensor
equivalent circuit be R0, internal resistance of microcomputer be R, precision (error) of the A/D converter be X,
and the resolution of A/D converter be Y (Y is 1024 in the 10-bit mode, and 256 in the 8-bit mode).
VC is generally
And when t = T,
1
– -------------------------C ( R0 + R )

VC = VIN  1 – e

t



X
X
VC = VIN – ---- VIN = VIN  1 – ----

Y
Y
1
– --------------------------T
C
(
R0
+ R) = X
e
---Y
1
– -------------------------T = ln X
---C ( R0 + R )
Y
Hence,
T
R0 = – ------------------- – R
X
C • ln ---Y
Figure 19.11 shows the Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit. When the difference between
VIN and VC becomes 0.1LSB, we find impedance R0 when voltage between pins VC changes from 0 to VIN-(0.1/
1024) VIN in time T. (0.1/1024) means that A/D precision drop due to insufficient capacitor charge is held to
0.1LSB at time of A/D conversion in the 10-bit mode. Actual error however is the value of absolute precision
added to 0.1LSB.
When f(XIN) = 10 MHz, T = 0.25 µs in the A/D conversion mode without sample and hold. Output impedance R0
for sufficiently charging capacitor C within time T is determined as follows.
T = 0.25 µs, R = 2.8 kΩ, C = 6.0 pF, X = 0.1, and Y = 1024. Hence,
3
3
0.25 × 10 – 6
- – 2.8 ×10 ≈ 1.7 ×10
R0 = – -------------------------------------------------0.1 6.0 × 10 – 12 • ln ----------1024
Thus, the allowable output impedance of the sensor equivalent circuit, making the precision (error) 0.1LSB or less,
is approximately 1.7 kΩ. maximum.
MCU
Sensor equivalent
circuit
R0
R (2.8 kΩ)
VIN
C (6.0 pF)
VC
NOTE:
1. The capacity of the terminal is assumed to be 4.5 pF.
Figure 19.11
Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 360 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
19.7
19. A/D Converter
Notes on A/D Converter
• Write to each bit (other than bit 6) in the ADCON0 register, each bit in the ADCON1 register, or the SMP bit
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
in the ADCON2 register when A/D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs).
When the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register is changed from 0 (VREF not connected) to 1 (VREF
connected), wait for at least 1 µs before starting the A/D conversion.
After changing the A/D operating mode, select an analog input pin again.
When using the one-shot mode, ensure that A/D conversion is completed before reading the AD register. The
IR bit in the ADIC register or the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register can be used to determine whether A/D
conversion is completed.
When using the repeat mode, select the frequency of the A/D converter operating clock φAD or more for the
CPU clock during A/D conversion.
If the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register is set to 0 (A/D conversion stops) by a program and A/D conversion
is forcibly terminated during an A/D conversion operation, the conversion result of the A/D converter will be
undefined. If the ADST bit is set to 0 by a program, do not use the value of the AD register.
Connect 0.1 µF capacitor between the P4_2/VREF pin and AVSS pin.
Do not enter stop mode during A/D conversion.
Do not enter wait mode when the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in
wait mode) during A/D conversion.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 361 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
20. Flash Memory
20.1
Overview
Rewrite operations to the flash memory can be performed in three modes: CPU rewrite, standard serial I/O, and
parallel I/O.
Table 20.1 lists the Flash Memory Version Performance (refer to Tables 1.1 and 1.4 Specifications for items not
listed in Table 20.1).
Table 20.1
Flash Memory Version Performance
Item
Flash memory operating modes
Division of erase block
Programming method
Erase method
Programming and erasure control method
Suspend functions
Protection method
Number of commands
Programming and
Blocks 0 and 1
erasure endurance(1) (program ROM)
Blocks A and B
(data flash)(2)
Programming and erasure voltage
ID code check function
ROM code protect
Specification
3 modes (CPU rewrite, standard serial I/O, and parallel I/O)
Refer to Figures 20.1 and 20.2.
Byte unit
Block erase
Programming and erasure control by software command
Program-suspend and erase-suspend
Program ROM protection by FMR0 register
5 commands
R8C/2K Group: 100 times; R8C/2L Group: 1,000 times
10,000 times
VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V
Standard serial I/O mode supported
Parallel I/O mode supported
NOTES:
1. Definition of programming and erasure endurance.
The programming and erasure endurance is defined on a per-block basis.
2. Blocks A and B (data flash) are included in the R8C/2L Group.
Table 20.2
Flash Memory Rewrite Modes
Flash Memory
Rewrite Mode
Function
CPU Rewrite Mode
User ROM area is rewritten
by executing software
commands from the CPU.
Rewritable areas User ROM area
Rewrite programs User program
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 362 of 450
Standard Serial I/O Mode
Parallel I/O Mode
User ROM area is rewritten
by a dedicated serial
programmer.
User ROM area
Standard boot program
User ROM area is rewritten
by a dedicated parallel
programmer.
User ROM area
–
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.2
20. Flash Memory
Memory Map
The flash memory contains a user ROM area and a boot ROM area (reserved area).
Figure 20.1 shows the Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/2K Group and Figure 20.2 shows the Flash Memory
Block Diagram for R8C/2L Group.
The user ROM area contains program ROM. In addition, the R8C/2L Group has on-chip data flash.
The user ROM area is divided into several blocks. The user ROM area can be rewritten in CPU rewrite mode, and
standard serial I/O mode, and parallel I/O mode.
The rewrite control program (standard boot program) for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area
before shipment. The boot ROM area and the user ROM area share the same address, but have separate memory
areas.
16 Kbytes ROM product
0C000h
Block 1: 8 Kbytes(1)
0DFFFh
0E000h
Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1)
8 Kbytes ROM product
Program ROM
0E000h
Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1)
0E000h
8 Kbytes
0FFFFh
0FFFFh
0FFFFh
User ROM area
User ROM area
Boot ROM area
(reserved area)(2)
NOTES:
1. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 0 (rewrite
enabled), block 0 is rewritable. When the FMR16 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1 is rewritable (only for CPU rewrite mode).
2. This area is for storing the boot program provided by Renesas Technology.
Figure 20.1
Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/2K Group
16 Kbytes ROM product
02400h
Block A: 1 Kbyte
8 Kbytes ROM product
02400h
Block A: 1 Kbyte
Data flash
02BFFh
0C000h
0DFFFh
0E000h
0FFFFh
Block B: 1 Kbyte
02BFFh
Block B: 1 Kbyte
Block 1: 8 Kbytes(1)
Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1)
0E000h
Program ROM
Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1)
User ROM area
User ROM area
0E000h
8 Kbytes
0FFFFh
0FFFFh
Boot ROM area
(reserved area)(2)
NOTES:
1. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 0 (rewrite
enabled), block 0 is rewritable. When the FMR16 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1 is rewritable (only for CPU rewrite mode).
2. This area is for storing the boot program provided by Renesas Technology.
Figure 20.2
Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/2L Group
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 363 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.3
20. Flash Memory
Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory
Standard serial I/O mode has an ID code check function, and parallel I/O mode has a ROM code protect function to
prevent the flash memory from being read, rewritten, or erased.
20.3.1
ID Code Check Function
The ID code check function is used in standard serial I/O mode. Unless 3 bytes (addresses from 0FFFCh to
0FFFEh) of the reset vector are set to FFFFFFh, the ID codes sent from the serial programmer or the on-chip
debugging emulator and the 7-byte ID codes written in the flash memory are checked to see if they match. If the
ID codes do not match, the commands sent from the serial programmer or the on-chip debugging emulator are
not acknowledged. For details of the ID code check function, refer to 13. ID Code Areas.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 364 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.3.2
20. Flash Memory
ROM Code Protect Function
The ROM protect function prevents the contents of the flash memory from being read, rewritten, or erased by
means of the OFS register when parallel I/O mode is used.
Figure 20.3 shows the OFS Register. Refer to 14. Option Function Select Area for details of the OFS register.
The ROM code protect function is enabled by writing 0 to the ROMCP1 bit and 1 to the ROMCR bit. It disables
reading or changing the contents of the on-chip flash memory.
Once ROM code protect is enabled, the content in the internal flash memory cannot be rewritten in parallel I/O
mode. To disable ROM code protect, erase the block including the OFS register with CPU rewrite mode or
standard serial I/O mode.
Option Function Select Register(1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
1
1
Symbol
OFS
Bit Symbol
WDTON
—
(b1)
ROMCR
ROMCP1
—
(b4)
LVD0ON
—
(b6)
Address
0FFFFh
Bit Name
Watchdog timer start
select bit
When Shipping
FFh(3)
Function
0 : Starts w atchdog timer automatically after reset
1 : Watchdog timer is inactive after reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
ROM code protect
disabled bit
0 : ROM code protect disabled
1 : ROMCP1 enabled
RW
ROM code protect bit
0 : ROM code protect enabled
1 : ROM code protect disabled
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Voltage detection 0
circuit start bit(2)
0 : Voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are
reset
1 : Voltage monitor 0 reset disabled after hardw are
reset
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
Count source protect
CSPROINI mode after reset select
bit
0 : Count source protect mode enabled after reset
1 : Count source protect mode disabled after reset
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. The OFS register is on the flash memory. Write to the OFS register w ith a program. After w riting is completed, do not
w rite additions to the OFS register.
2. Setting the LVD0ON bit is only valid after a hardw are reset. To use the pow er-on reset, set the LVD0ON bit to 0
(voltage monitor 0 reset enabled after hardw are reset).
3. If the block including the OFS register is erased, FFh is set to the OFS register.
Figure 20.3
OFS Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 365 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4
20. Flash Memory
CPU Rewrite Mode
In CPU rewrite mode, the user ROM area can be rewritten by executing software commands from the CPU.
Therefore, the user ROM area can be rewritten directly while the MCU is mounted on a board without using a
ROM programmer. Execute the software command only to blocks in the user ROM area.
The flash module has an erase-suspend function when an interrupt request is generated during an erase operation in
CPU rewrite mode. It performs an interrupt process after the erase operation is halted temporarily. During erasesuspend, the user ROM area can be read by a program.
In case an interrupt request is generated during an auto-program operation in CPU rewrite mode, the flash module
has a program-suspend function which performs the interrupt process after the auto-program operation is
suspended. During program-suspend, the user ROM area can be read by a program.
CPU rewrite mode has an erase write 0 mode (EW0 mode) and an erase write 1 mode (EW1 mode). Table 20.3 lists
the Differences between EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode.
Table 20.3
Differences between EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode
Item
Operating mode
Areas in which a rewrite
control program can be
executed
Rewritable areas
EW0 Mode
Single-chip mode
RAM (Rewrite control program is
executed after being transferred)
EW1 Mode
Single-chip mode
User ROM or RAM
User ROM
Software command
restrictions
None
Modes after program or
erase
Modes after read status
register
CPU status during autowrite and auto-erase
Flash memory status
detection
Read status register mode
User ROM
However, blocks which contain a rewrite
control program are excluded
• Program and block erase commands
Cannot be run on any block which
contains a rewrite control program
• Read status register command
Cannot be executed
Read array mode
Read status register mode
Do not execute this command
Operating
Conditions for transition to
erase-suspend
Conditions for transitions to
program-suspend
CPU clock
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Hold state (I/O ports hold state before the
command is executed)
• Read bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 Read bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in
in the FMR0 register by a program
the FMR0 register by a program
• Execute the read status register
command and read bits SR7, SR5, and
SR4 in the status register.
Set bits FMR40 and FMR41 in the FMR4 The FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set
register to 1 by a program.
to 1 and the interrupt request of the
enabled maskable interrupt is generated
Set bits FMR40 and FMR42 in the FMR4 The FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set
register to 1 by a program.
to 1 and the interrupt request of the
enabled maskable interrupt is generated
5 MHz or below
No restriction (on clock frequency to be
used)
Page 366 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.1
20. Flash Memory
Register Description
The registers used in CPU rewrite mode are described.
20.4.1.1
FMR0 Register (FMR0)
Figure 20.4 shows the FMR0 Register.
Flash Memory Control Register 0
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0
Symbol
FMR0
Bit Symbol
FMR00
FMR01
FMR02
Address
01B7h
____
Bit Name
RY/BY status flag
FMR06
FMR07
Function
0 : Busy (w riting or erasing in progress)
1 : Ready
RW
RO
CPU rew rite mode select bit(1)
0 : CPU rew rite mode disabled
1 : CPU rew rite mode enabled
RW
Blocks 0 and 1 rew rite enable
bit(2, 6)
0 : Rew rite disabled
1 : Rew rite enabled
RW
Flash memory stop bit(3, 5)
0 : Flash memory operates
1 : Flash memory stops
(low -pow er consumption state
and flash memory initialization)
RW
FMSTP
—
(b5-b4)
After Reset
00000001b
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
Program status flag(4)
0 : Completed successfully
1 : Terminated in error
RO
Erase status flag(4)
0 : Completed successfully
1 : Terminated in error
RO
RW
NOTES:
1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0. Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit
to 0 and setting it to 1. Enter read array mode and set this bit to 0.
2. Set this bit to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0 w hile the FMR01 bit is set to 1.
Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit to 0 and setting it to 1.
3. Set this bit by a program located in a space other than the flash memory.
4. This bit is set to 0 by executing the clear status command.
5. This bit is enabled w hen the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rew rite mode). When the FMR01 bit is set to 0, w riting 1 to the
FMSTP bit causes the FMSTP bit to be set to 1. The flash memory does not enter low -pow er consumption state nor is
it initialized.
6. When setting the FMR01 bit to 0 (CPU rew rite mode disabled), the FMR02 bit is set to 0 (rew rite disabled).
Figure 20.4
FMR0 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 367 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• FMR00 Bit
This bit indicates the operating status of the flash memory. The bits value is 0 during programming, erasure
(including suspend periods), or erase-suspend mode; otherwise, it is 1.
• FMR01 Bit
The MCU is made ready to accept commands by setting the FMR01 bit to 1 (CPU rewrite mode).
• FMR02 Bit
Rewriting of blocks 0 and 1 does not accept program or block erase commands if the FMR02 bit is set to 0
(rewrite disabled).
Rewriting of blocks 0 and 1 is controlled by bits FMR15 and FMR16 if the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite
enabled).
• FMSTP Bit
This bit is used to initialize the flash memory control circuits, and also to reduce the amount of current
consumed by the flash memory. Access to the flash memory is disabled by setting the FMSTP bit to 1.
Therefore, the FMSTP bit must be written to by a program transferred to the RAM.
In the following cases, set the FMSTP bit to 1:
- When flash memory access resulted in an error while erasing or programming in EW0 mode (FMR00 bit not
initialized to 1 (ready))
- To provide lower consumption in low-speed on-chip oscillator mode and low-speed clock mode.
Note that when going to stop or wait mode while the CPU rewrite mode is disabled, the FMR0 register does
not need to be set because the power for the flash memory is automatically turned off and is turned back on
again after returning from stop or wait mode.
• FMR06 Bit
This is a read-only bit indicating the status of an auto-program operation. The bit is set to 1 when a program
error occurs; otherwise, it is set to 0. For details, refer to the description in Table 20.4 Errors and FMR0
Register Status.
• FMR07 Bit
This is a read-only bit indicating the status of an auto-erase operation. The bit is set to 1 when an erase error
occurs; otherwise, it is set to 0. Refer to Table 20.4 Errors and FMR0 Register Status for details.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 368 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 20.4
20. Flash Memory
Errors and FMR0 Register Status
FRM0 Register (Status
Register) Status
Error
FMR07 (SR5) FMR06 (SR4)
1
1
Command sequence
error
1
0
0
1
0
0
Error Occurrence Condition
• When a command is not written correctly.
• When D0h or FFh is not written in the 2nd byte
of the block erase command.(1)
• When the program command or block erase
command is executed while rewriting is
disabled by the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register,
or the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register.
• When an address not allocated in flash memory
is input during erase command input
• When attempting to erase the block for which
rewriting is disabled during erase command
input.
• When an address not allocated in flash memory
is input during write command input.
• When attempting to write to a block for which
rewriting is disabled during write command
input.
Erase error
• When the block erase command is executed
but auto-erasure does not complete correctly
Program error
• When the program command is executed but
not auto-programming does not complete.
Completed successfully –
NOTE:
1. When FFh is written in the 2nd byte of the block erase command, the MCU enters read array mode,
and the command code written in the 1st byte is disabled.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 369 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.1.2
20. Flash Memory
FMR1 Register (FMR1)
Figure 20.5 shows the FMR1 Register.
Flash Memory Control Register 1
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
01B5h
FMR1
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Reserved bit
—
(b0)
FMR11
—
(b4-b2)
FMR15
FMR16
—
(b7)
After Reset
1000000Xb
Function
When read, the content is undefined.
RW
RO
EW1 mode select bit(1, 2)
0 : EW0 mode
1 : EW1 mode
Reserved bits
Set to 0.
Block 0 rew rite disable bit(2,3)
0 : Rew rite enabled
1 : Rew rite disabled
RW
Block 1 rew rite disable bit(2,3)
0 : Rew rite enabled
1 : Rew rite disabled
RW
Reserved bit
Set to 1.
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0 w hile the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rew rite mode
enabled). Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit to 0 and setting it to 1.
2. This bit is set to 0 by setting the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rew rite mode disabled).
3. While the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rew rite mode enabled), bits FMR15 and FMR 16 can be w ritten to.
To set this bit to 0, set it to 0 immediately after setting it first to 1.
To set this bit to 1, set it to 1.
Figure 20.5
FMR1 Register
• FMR11 Bit
Setting this bit to 1 (EW1 mode) places the MCU in EW1 mode.
• FMR15 Bit
When the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 0
accepts program and block erase commands.
• FMR16 Bit
When the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR16 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1
accepts program and block erase commands.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 370 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.1.3
20. Flash Memory
FMR4 Register (FMR4)
Figure 20.6 shows the FMR4 Register.
Flash Memory Control Register 4
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
0
Symbol
FMR4
Bit Symbol
FMR40
FMR41
FMR42
FMR43
FMR44
—
(b5)
FMR46
FMR47
Address
01B3h
Bit Name
Erase-suspend function
enable bit(1)
Erase-suspend request bit(2)
After Reset
01000000b
Function
RW
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
RW
0 : Erasure restarts
1 : Erase-suspend request
RW
Program-suspend request bit(3) 0 : Programming restarts
1 : Program-suspend request
RW
Erase command flag
0 : Erase not executed
1 : Erase execution in progress
RO
Program command flag
0 : Program not executed
1 : Program execution in progress
RO
Reserved bit
Set to 0.
Read status flag
0 : Reading disabled
1 : Reading enabled
RO
Low -current-consumption
read mode enable bit (1, 4, 5)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
RW
RO
NOTES:
1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0. Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit
to 0 and setting it to 1.
2. This bit is enabled w hen the FMR40 bit is set to 1 (enabled) and it can be w ritten to during the period betw een
issuing an erase command and completing the erase. (This bit is set to 0 during periods other than the above.)
In EW0 mode, it can be set to 0 or 1 by a program.
In EW1 mode, it is automatically set to 1 if a maskable interrupt is generated during an erase
operation w hile the FMR40 bit is set to 1. Do not set this bit to 1 by a program (0 can be w ritten).
3. The FMR42 bit is enabled only w hen the FMR40 bit is set to 1 (enabled) and programming to the FMR42 bit is enabled
until auto-programming ends after a program command is generated. (This bit is set to 0 during periods other than the
above.)
In EW0 mode, 0 or 1 can be programmed to the FMR42 bit by a program.
In EW1 mode, the FMR42 bit is automatically set to 1 by generating a maskable interrupt during auto-programming
w hen the FMR40 bit is set to 1. 1 cannot be w ritten to the FMR42 bit by a program.
4. In high-speed clock mode and high-speed on-chip oscillator mode, set the FMR47 bit to 0 (disabled).
5. Set the FMR01 bit to 0 (CPU rew rite mode disabled) in low -current-consumption read mode.
Figure 20.6
FMR4 Register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 371 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• FMR40 Bit
The suspend function is enabled by setting the FMR40 bit to 1 (enabled).
• FMR41 Bit
In EW0 mode, the MCU enters erase-suspend mode when the FMR41 bit is set to 1 by a program. The FMR41
bit is automatically set to 1 (erase-suspend request) when an interrupt request of an enabled interrupt is
generated in EW1 mode, and then the MCU enters erase-suspend mode.
Set the FMR41 bit to 0 (erasure restarts) when the auto-erase operation restarts.
• FMR42 Bit
In EW0 mode, the MCU enters program-suspend mode when the FMR42 bit is set to 1 by a program. The
FMR42 bit is automatically set to 1 (program-suspend request) when an interrupt request of an enabled
interrupt is generated in EW1 mode, and then the MCU enters program-suspend mode.
Set the FMR42 bit to 0 (programming restarts) when the auto-program operation restarts.
• FMR43 Bit
When the auto-erase operation starts, the FMR43 bit is set to 1 (erase execution in progress). The FMR43 bit
remains set to 1 (erase execution in progress) during erase-suspend operation.
When the auto-erase operation ends, the FMR43 bit is set to 0 (erase not executed).
• FMR44 Bit
When the auto-program operation starts, the FMR44 bit is set to 1 (program execution in progress). The
FMR44 bit remains set to 1 (program execution in progress) during program-suspend operation.
When the auto-program operation ends, the FMR44 bit is set to 0 (program not executed).
• FMR46 Bit
The FMR46 bit is set to 0 (reading disabled) during auto-program or auto-erase execution and set to 1 (reading
enabled) in suspend mode. Do not access the flash memory while this bit is set to 0.
• FMR47 Bit
Current consumption when reading the flash memory can be reduced by setting the FMR47 bit to 1 (enabled)
in low-speed clock mode and low-speed on-chip oscillator mode.
Refer to 21.2.10 Low-Current-Consumption Read Mode for details of the handling procedure.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 372 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.2
20. Flash Memory
Status Check Procedure
When an error occurs, bits FMR06 to FMR07 in the FMR0 register are set to 1, indicating the occurrence of an
error. Therefore, checking these status bits (full status check) can be used to determine the execution result.
Figure 20.7 shows the Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Individual Errors.
Command sequence error
Full status check
Execute the clear status register command
(set these status flags to 0)
FMR06 = 1
and
FMR07 = 1?
Yes
Command sequence error
Check if the command is properly input
No
Re-execute the command
FMR07 = 1?
Yes
Erase error
Erase error
No
Execute the clear status register command
(set these status flags to 0)
Erase command
re-execution times ≤ 3 times?
FMR06 = 1?
Yes
Program error
No
Yes
Re-execute the block erase command
No
Program error
Execute the clear status register command
(set these status flags to 0)
Full status check completed
Specify an address other than
the write address where the error occurs
as the program address(1)
NOTE:
1. To rewrite to the address where the program error occurs, check if the full
status check is complete normally and write to the address after the block
erase command is executed.
Figure 20.7
Re-execute the program command
Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Individual Errors
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 373 of 450
Block targeting for erasure
cannot be used
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.3
20. Flash Memory
EW0 Mode
The MCU enters CPU rewrite mode and software commands can be acknowledged by setting the FMR01 bit in
the FMR0 register to 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled). In this case, since the FMR11 bit in the FMR1 register is
set to 0, EW0 mode is selected.
Use software commands to control program and erase operations. The FMR0 register or the status register can
be used to determine when program and erase operations complete.
Figure 20.8 shows the How to Set and Exit EW0 Mode.
EW0 Mode Operating Procedure
Rewrite control program
Write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1
(CPU rewrite mode enabled)(2)
Set registers(1) CM0 and CM1
Execute software commands
Transfer a rewrite control program which uses CPU
rewrite mode to the RAM.
Jump to the rewrite control program which has been
transferred to the RAM.
(The subsequent process is executed by the rewrite
control program in the RAM.)
Execute the read array command(3)
Write 0 to the FMR01 bit
(CPU rewrite mode disabled)
Jump to a specified address in the flash memory
NOTES:
1. Select 5 MHz or below for the CPU clock by the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register.
2. To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1.
Write to the FMR01 bit in the RAM.
3. Disable the CPU rewrite mode after executing the read array command.
Figure 20.8
How to Set and Exit EW0 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 374 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.3.1
20. Flash Memory
Software Commands
There are five types of software commands:
• Read array
• Read status register
• Clear status register
• Program
• Block erase
Figure 20.9 shows the Software Command Status Transition Diagram in EW0 Mode.
Read array mode
Reset
CPU rewrite disabled
(FMR46 = 1 Reading enabled)
No command required
Reading only available
Write 1 to the FMR01 bit immediately after writing 0.
CPU rewrite mode (EW0 mode)
FMR01 = 0
Program
suspend
40h
(Program command)
70h
FMR42 = 0
(Read status
register
command)
(Restart)
FFh
(Programming starts)
FMR41 = 0
(Restart)
(Read array
command)
Program
Read status
register mode
20h
(Block erase
command)
Clear ends
Clear status
register
Block erase
Non-D0h
and
non-FFh
D0h
(Block erasure starts)
FMR42 = 1
(Suspend request)
FMR41 = 1
(Suspend request)
Auto-erase
Auto-program
(FMR46 = 0 Reading disabled)
Auto-programming completed
Figure 20.9
(FMR46 = 0
Reading disabled)
Auto-erasure completed
Software Command Status Transition Diagram in EW0 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 375 of 450
50h
(Clear status
register command)
FFh
(Read array
command)
Write data
Erase
suspend
Read array mode
(FMR46 = 1 Reading enabled)
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• Read Array Command
The read array command reads the flash memory.
When FFh is written to an address in the user ROM area, the MCU enters read array mode. In this mode, the
contents of the specified address can be read.
Read array mode continues until other commands are written. The MCU enters this mode after a reset is
deasserted.
• Read Status Register Command
The read status register command is used to read the status register. Figure 20.10 shows the Status Register.
The status register indicates the operating status of the flash memory and whether an erase or program
operation has completed normally or in error (refer to Table 20.4 Errors and FMR0 Register Status). When
70h is written to an address in the user ROM area, the MCU enters read status register mode. When the
address in the user ROM area is read subsequently, the status register can be read.
The MCU remains in read status register mode until the next read array command is written.
The status of the status register can be determined by reading bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in the FMR0
register.
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
SR7 SR6 SR5 SR4 SR3 SR2 SR1 SR0
Status register
FMR0 register
FMR06 bit
FMR07 bit
FMR00 bit
D0 to D7: These indicate the read data buses when the read status command is executed.
Figure 20.10
Status Register
• Clear Status Register Command
The clear status register command sets the status register to 0.
When 50h is written to an address in the user ROM area, bits FMR07 and FMR06 in the FMR0 register and
bits SR5 and SR4 in the status register are set to 00b.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 376 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• Program Command
The program command writes data to the flash memory in 1-byte units.
When 40h is written and then data is written to the write address, an auto-program operation (data program
and verify) starts.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether auto-programming has completed.
When suspend function disabled, the FMR00 bit is set to 0 during auto-programming and set to 1 when autoprogramming completes. When suspend function enabled, the FMR44 bit is set to 1 during auto-programming
and set to 0 when auto-programming completes.
The FMR06 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine the result of auto-programming after it has been
finished (refer to 20.4.2 Status Check Procedure).
Do not write additions to the already programmed addresses.
Also, when the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 0 (rewrite disabled), or the FMR02 bit is set to 1
(rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 1 (rewrite disabled), program commands
targeting block 0 are not acknowledged.
Figure 20.11 shows the Program Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled). Figure 20.12
shows the Program Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled).
In EW0 mode, the MCU enters read status register mode at the same time auto-programming starts and the
status register can be read. In this case, the MCU remains in read status register mode until the next read array
command is written.
Start
Write the command code 40h to
the write address
Write data to the write address
FMR00 = 1?
No
Yes
Full status check
Program completed
Figure 20.11
Program Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 377 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
Maskable interrupt(1)
Start
FMR40 = 1
FMR44 = 1 ?
Write the command code 40h
No
Yes
FMR42 = 1(3)
I = 1 (enable interrupt)(2)
FMR46 = 1 ?
No
Write data to the write address
Access flash memory
Yes
FMR44 = 0 ?
No
Yes
Access flash memory
FMR42 = 0
Full status check
REIT
Program completed
NOTES:
1. In EW0 mode, the interrupt vector table and interrupt routine for interrupts to be used should be allocated to the RAM area.
2. When no interrupt is used, the instruction to enable interrupts is not needed.
3. td(SR-SUS) is needed until program is suspended after the FMR42 bit in the FMR4 register is set to 1.
Figure 20.12
Program Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 378 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• Block Erase
When 20h is first written and then D0h is written to a given block address, an auto-erase operation (erase and
verify) of the specified block starts.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether auto-erasure has completed.
The FMR00 bit is set to 0 during auto-erasure and set to 1 when auto-erasure completes.
The FMR07 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine the result of auto-erasure after auto-erasure has
completed (refer to 20.4.2 Status Check Procedure).
Also, when the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 0 (rewrite disabled), or the FMR02 bit is set to 1
(rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 1 (rewrite disabled), block erase commands
targeting block 0 are not acknowledged.
Do not use the block erase command during program-suspend.
In EW0 mode, the MCU enters read status register mode at the same time auto-erasure starts and the status
register can be read. In this case, the MCU remains in read status register mode until the next read array
command is written.
Figure 20.13 shows the Block Erase Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled). Figure
20.14 shows the Block Erase Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled).
If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100, 1,000, or 10,000), each block can be erased n times.
For example, if 1,024 1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1-Kbyte block, and then the block is erased,
the erase count stands at one. When performing 100 or more rewrites, the actual erase count can be reduced by
executing programming operations in such a way that all blank areas are used before performing an erase
operation. Avoid rewriting only particular blocks and try to average out the programming and erasure
endurance of the blocks. It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the
number of erase operations to a certain number.
Start
Write the command code 20h
Write D0h to any block
address
FMR00 = 1?
No
Yes
Full status check
Block erase completed
Figure 20.13
Block Erase Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 379 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
Maskable interrupt(1)
Start
FMR40 = 1
FMR43 = 1 ?
No
Yes
Write the command code 20h
FMR41 = 1(3)
I = 1 (enable interrupt)(2)
FMR46 = 1 ?
Write D0h to any block
address
No
Access flash memory
Yes
Access flash memory
FMR00 = 1 ?
No
FMR41 = 0
Yes
Full status check
REIT
Block erase completed
NOTES:
1. In EW0 mode, the interrupt vector table and interrupt routine for interrupts to be used should be allocated to
the RAM area.
2. When no interrupt is used, the instruction to enable interrupts is not needed.
3. td(SR-SUS) is needed until erase is suspended after the FMR41 bit in the FMR4 register is set to 1.
Figure 20.14
Block Erase Command in EW0 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 380 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.3.2
20. Flash Memory
Suspend Function
The suspend function halts auto-erasure and auto-programming temporarily while these operations are in
progress. This function is used for interrupt handling as the user ROM area can be read after the above
operations have been suspended.
When using erase-suspend or program-suspend in EW0 mode, first check the status of the flash memory in the
interrupt routine and then enter erase-suspend or program-suspend. Figure 20.15 shows the Timing of Suspend
Operation in EW0 Mode.
The procedure for entering erase-suspend during auto-erase operation is as follows:
(1) Set the FMR40 bit to 1 (suspend enabled)
(2) Set the FMR41 bit to 1 (erase-suspend request).
(3) Wait for td (SR-SUS).
(4) Confirm that the FMR46 bit is set to 1 (reading enabled)
(5) Access the user ROM area.
(6) When the FMR41 bit is set to 0 (erasure restarts), auto-erase operation restarts.
The procedure for entering program-suspend during auto-programming operation is as follows:
(1) Set the FMR40 bit to 1 (suspend enabled)
(2) Set the FMR42 bit to 1 (program-suspend request).
(3) Wait for td (SR-SUS).
(4) Confirm that the FMR46 bit is set to 1 (reading enabled)
(5) Access the user ROM area.
(6) When the FMR42 bit is set to 0 (programming restarts), auto-programming operation restarts.
Erasure
starts
Erasure
suspends
Programming Programming Programming Programming Erasure
starts
suspends
restarts(1)
ends
restarts
During erasure
FMR00 bit in
FMR0 register
1
FMR46 bit in
FMR4 register
1
FMR44 bit in
FMR4 register
1
FMR43 bit in
FMR4 register
1
FMR41 bit in
FMR4 register
1
FMR42 bit in
FMR4 register
1
During programming
During programming
Erasure
ends
During erasure
Remains 0 during suspend
0
0
0
Remains 1 during suspend
0
Set to 1 by
a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
Set to 1 by a program
Set to 0 by a program
0
Check that the
FMR43 bit is set to 1
(during erase
execution), and that
the erase-operation
has not ended.
Check that the
FMR44 bit is set to 1
(during program
execution), and that
the program has not
ended.
Check the status,
and that the
programming ends
normally.
Check the status,
and that the
erasure ends
normally.
The above figure shows an example of the use of program-suspend during programming following erase-suspend.
NOTE:
1. If program-suspend is entered during erase-suspend, restart programming first.
Figure 20.15
Timing of Suspend Operation in EW0 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 381 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
Figure 20.16 shows the Program Flowchart during Erase-Suspend in EW0 Mode.
(EW0 Mode)
Maskable interrupt 1(1)
Start
FMR40 = 1
FMR43 = 1 ?
No
Yes
Write the command code 20h
FMR41 = 1(3)
I = 1 (enable interrupt)(2)
FMR46 = 1 ?
No
Write D0h to any block
address
Yes
FMR00 = 1 ?
No
Yes
Write the command code 40h to
the write address
Write the command code 40h to
the write address
I = 1 (enable interrupt)(2)
I = 1 (enable interrupt)(2)
Write data to the write address
Write data to the write address
Full status check
Block erase completed
FMR44 = 0 ?
No
Yes
FMR44 = 0 ?
No
Yes
Maskable interrupt 2(1)
Full status check
FMR44 = 1 ?
No
Yes
Full status check
FMR41 = 0
REIT
FMR42 = 1(3)
FMR46 = 1 ?
No
Access flash memory
Yes
Access flash memory
FMR42 = 0
REIT
NOTES:
1. In EW0 mode, the interrupt vector table and interrupt routine for interrupts to be used should be allocated to the RAM area.
2. When no interrupt is used, the instruction to enable interrupts is not needed.
3. td(SR-SUS) is needed until erase or program is suspended after the FMR41 bit or the FMR42 bit in the FMR4 register is set to 1.
Maskable interrupt 1: interrupt in erase-suspend, maskable interrupt 2: interrupt in program-suspend
Figure 20.16
Program Flowchart during Erase-Suspend in EW0 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 382 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.3.3
20. Flash Memory
EW0 Mode Interrupts
In EW0 mode, maskable interrupts can be used by allocating a vector in RAM. Table 20.5 lists the EW0 Mode
Interrupts. Refer to 20.7.1.3 Non-Maskable Interrupts for details of the non-maskable interrupt.
Table 20.5
EW0 Mode Interrupts
Status
During auto-erasure
Auto-programming
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
When Maskable Interrupt Request is Acknowledged
Interrupt handling is executed.
Page 383 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.4
20. Flash Memory
EW1 Mode
The MCU is switched to EW1 mode by setting the FMR11 bit to 1 (EW1 mode) after setting the FMR01 bit to
1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled).
The FMR0 register can be used to determine when program and erase operations complete. Figure 20.17 shows
the How to Set and Exit EW1 Mode.
EW1 Mode Operating Procedure
Program in ROM
Write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1
(CPU rewrite mode enabled)(1)
Write 0 to the FMR11 bit before writing 1
(EW1 mode)
Execute software commands
Write 0 to the FMR01 bit
(CPU rewrite mode disabled)
NOTE:
1. To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1.
Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1.
Figure 20.17
How to Set and Exit EW1 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 384 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.4.1
20. Flash Memory
Software Commands
There are four types of software commands:
• Read array
• Clear status register
• Program
• Block erase
Do not execute read status register command in EW1 mode.
Figure 20.18 shows the Software Command Status Transition Diagram in EW1 Mode.
Read array mode
Reset
CPU rewrite disabled
(FMR46 = 1
Write 1 to the FMR01 bit immediately after writing 0, and
write 1 to the FMR11 bit immediately after writing 0.
Reading enabled)
No command required
Reading only available
CPU rewrite mode (EW1 mode)
FMR01 = 0
Program
suspend
Erase
suspend
Read array mode
(FMR46 = 1 Reading enabled)
40h
FMR42 = 0
20h
FMR41 = 0
(Program command)
(Restart)
(Block erase
command)
(Restart)
FFh
(Read array
command)
50h
(Clear status
register
command)
Clear ends
Program
Clear status
register
Block erase
Write data
(Programming starts)
D0h
(Block erasure starts)
Interrupt
(FMR42 = 1)
Interrupt
(FMR41 = 1)
Auto-program
Auto-erase
(FMR46 = 0 Reading disabled)
(FMR46 = 0 Reading disabled)
Auto-programming
completed
Figure 20.18
CPU stops
Auto-erasure
completed
Software Command Status Transition Diagram in EW1 Mode
• Read Array Command
The read array command reads the flash memory.
When FFh is written to an address in the user ROM area, the MCU enters read array mode. In this mode, the
contents of the specified address can be read.
Read array mode continues until other commands are written. The MCU enters this mode after a reset is
deasserted.
• Clear Status Register Command
The clear status register command sets the status register to 0.
When 50h is written to an address in the user ROM area, bits FMR07 and FMR06 in the FMR0 register and
bits SR5 and SR4 in the status register are set to 00b.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 385 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• Program Command
The program command writes data to the flash memory in 1-byte units.
When 40h is written and then data is written to the write address, an auto-program operation (data program
and verify) starts.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether auto-programming has completed.
When suspend function disabled, the FMR00 bit is set to 0 during auto-programming and set to 1 when autoprogramming completes. When suspend function enabled, the FMR44 bit is set to 1 during auto-programming
and set to 0 when auto-programming completes.
The FMR06 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine the result of auto-programming after it has been
finished (refer to 20.4.2 Status Check Procedure).
Do not write additions to the already programmed addresses.
Also, when the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 0 (rewrite disabled), or the FMR02 bit is set to 1
(rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 1 (rewrite disabled), program commands
targeting block 0 are not acknowledged.
In EW1 mode, do not execute this command for any address which a rewrite control program is allocated.
Figure 20.19 shows the Program Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled). Figure 20.20
shows the Program Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled).
Start
Write the command code 40h to
the write address
Write data to the write address
FMR00 = 1?
No
Yes
Full status check
Program completed
Figure 20.19
Program Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 386 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
Start
Maskable interrupt(1)
FMR40 = 1
Access flash memory
Write the command code 40h
REIT
I = 1 (enable interrupt)
Write data to the write address
FMR42 = 0
FMR44 = 0 ?
No
Yes
Full status check
Program completed
NOTE:
1. td(SR-SUS) is needed until the interrupt request is acknowledged after it is generated. The interrupt to enter suspend
should be in interrupt enabled status.
Figure 20.20
Program Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 387 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
• Block Erase
When 20h is first written and then D0h is written to a given block address, an auto-erase operation (erase and
verify) of the specified block starts.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether auto-erasure has completed.
The FMR00 bit is set to 0 during auto-erasure and set to 1 when auto-erasure completes.
The FMR07 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine the result of auto-erasure after auto-erasure has
completed (refer to 20.4.2 Status Check Procedure).
Also, when the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 0 (rewrite disabled), or the FMR02 bit is set to 1
(rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 1 (rewrite disabled), block erase commands
targeting block 0 are not acknowledged.
Do not use the block erase command during program-suspend.
Do not execute this command for any address to which a rewrite control program is allocated.
Figure 20.21 shows the Block Erase Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled). Figure
20.22 shows the Block Erase Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled).
If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100, 1000, or 10,000), each block can be erased n times.
For example, if 1,024 1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1-Kbyte block, and then the block is erased,
the erase count stands at one. When performing 100 or more rewrites, the actual erase count can be reduced by
executing programming operations in such a way that all blank areas are used before performing an erase
operation. Avoid rewriting only particular blocks and try to average out the programming and erasure
endurance of the blocks.
It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the number of erase operations to a
certain number.
Start
Write the command code 20h
Write D0h to any block
address
FMR00 = 1?
No
Yes
Full status check
Block erase completed
Figure 20.21
Block Erase Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Disabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 388 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
Start
Maskable interrupt(1)
FMR40 = 1
Access flash memory
Write the command code 20h
REIT
I = 1 (enable interrupt)
Write D0h to any block
address
FMR41 = 0
FMR00 = 1 ?
No
Yes
Full status check
Block erase completed
NOTE:
1. td(SR-SUS) is needed until the interrupt request is acknowledged after it is generated.
The interrupt to enter suspend should be in interrupt enabled status.
Figure 20.22
Block Erase Command in EW1 Mode (When Suspend Function Enabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 389 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.4.4.2
20. Flash Memory
Suspend Function
The suspend function halts auto-erasure and auto-programming temporarily while these operations are in
progress. This function is used for interrupt handling as the user ROM area can be read after the above
operations have been suspended.
When the suspend function is used in EW1 mode, the MCU enters erase-suspend or program-suspend after an
interrupt request is acknowledged.
To enable the suspend function, set the FMR40 bit to 1 (suspend enabled). The interrupt to enter suspend should
also be set to enable beforehand. When td (SR-SUS) has elapsed after the interrupt request is generated, the
request is acknowledged.
When an interrupt request is generated during an erase operation, the FMR41 bit is automatically set to 1 (erasesuspend request) and the auto-erase operation suspends. If an auto-erase operation does not complete (FMR00
bit is 0) after an interrupt process completes, the auto-erase operation restarts by setting the FMR41 bit to 0
(erasure restarts).
When an interrupt request is generated during an auto-program operation, the FMR42 bit is automatically set to
1 (program-suspend request) and the auto-program operation suspends. When the auto-program operation does
not complete (FMR00 bit is 0) after the interrupt process completes, the auto-program operation can be
restarted by setting the FMR42 bit to 0 (programming restarts).
Figure 20.23 shows the Timing of Suspend Operation in EW1 Mode. Figure 20.24 shows the Program
Flowchart during Erase-Suspend in EW1 Mode.
Erasure
starts
Erasure
suspends
Programming Programming Programming Programming Erasure
starts
suspends
restarts(1)
ends
restarts
During erasure
FMR00 bit in
FMR0 register
1
FMR46 bit in
FMR4 register
1
FMR44 bit in
FMR4 register
1
FMR43 bit in
FMR4 register
1
During programming
During programming
Erasure
ends
During erasure
Remains 0 during suspend
0
0
0
0
Remains 1 during suspend
Check that the
FMR43 bit is set to 1
(during erase
execution), and that
the erase-operation
has not ended.
Check that the
FMR44 bit is set to 1
(during program
execution), and that
the program has not
ended.
Check the status,
and that the
programming ends
normally.
Check the status,
and that the
erasure ends
normally.
Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program.
IR bit in interrupt
control register
1
0
The above figure shows an example of the use of program-suspend during programming following erase-suspend.
NOTE:
1. If program-suspend is entered during erase-suspend, restart programming first.
Figure 20.23
Timing of Suspend Operation in EW1 Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 390 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20. Flash Memory
(EW1 Mode)
Start
Maskable interrupt 1(1)
Maskable interrupt 2(1)
FMR40 = 1
Write the command code 40h
to the write address
Access flash memory
Write the command code 20h
REIT
I = 1 (enable interrupt)
I = 1 (enable interrupt)
Write data to the write address
Write D0h to any block
address
FMR42 = 0
FMR41 = 0
FMR44 = 0 ?
No
FMR00 = 1 ?
No
Yes
Full status check
Yes
Full status check
REIT
Block erase completed
NOTE:
1.td(SR-SUS) is needed until the interrupt request is acknowledged after it is generated. The interrupt to enter
suspend should be in interrupt enabled status.
Maskable interrupt 1: interrupt in erase-suspend, maskable interrupt 2: interrupt in program-suspend
Figure 20.24
20.4.4.3
Program Flowchart during Erase-Suspend in EW1 Mode
EW1 Mode Interrupts
In EW1 mode, maskable interrupts can be used.
Table 20.6 lists the EW1 Mode Interrupts. Refer to 20.7.1.3 Non-Maskable Interrupts for details of the nonmaskable interrupt.
Table 20.6
EW1 Mode Interrupts
Status
During auto-erasure (erasesuspend function enabled)
During auto-erasure (erasesuspend function disabled)
During auto-programming
(program suspend function
enabled)
During auto- programming
(program suspend function
disabled)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
When Maskable Interrupt Request is Acknowledged
Auto-erasure is suspended after td(SR-SUS) and interrupt handling is executed.
Auto-erasure can be restarted by setting the FMR41 bit in theFMR4 register to 0
(erasure restarts) after interrupt handling completes.
Auto-erasure has priority and the interrupt request acknowledgement is put on
standby. Interrupt handling is executed after auto-erasure completes.
Auto-programming is suspended after td(SR-SUS) and interrupt
handling is executed. Auto-programming can be restarted by setting the FMR42 bit
in the FMR4 register to 0 (programming restarts) after interrupt handling completes.
Auto-programming has priority and the interrupt request acknowledgement is put on
standby. Interrupt handling is executed after auto-programming completes.
Page 391 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.5
20. Flash Memory
Standard Serial I/O Mode
In standard serial I/O mode, the user ROM area can be rewritten while the MCU is mounted on-board by using a
serial programmer which is suitable for the MCU.
There are three types of standard serial I/O modes:
• Standard serial I/O mode 1 ..................Clock synchronous serial I/O used to connect with a serial programmer
• Standard serial I/O mode 2 ..................Clock asynchronous serial I/O used to connect with a serial programmer
• Standard serial I/O mode 3 ..................Special clock asynchronous serial I/O used to connect with a serial
programmer
This MCU uses standard serial I/O mode 2 and standard serial I/O mode 3.
Refer to Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging Emulator.
Contact the manufacturer of your serial programmer for details. Refer to the user’s manual of your serial
programmer for instructions on how to use it.
Table 20.7 lists the Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 2) and Figure 20.25 shows an Example
of Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2. Table 20.8 lists the Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial
I/O Mode 3) and Figure 20.26 shows an Example of Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 3.
After processing the pins shown in Table 20.8 and rewriting the flash memory using the programmer, apply “H” to
the MODE pin and reset the hardware to run a program in the flash memory in single-chip mode.
20.5.1
ID Code Check Function
The ID code check function determines whether the ID codes sent from the serial programmer and those written
in the flash memory match.
Refer to 13. ID Code Areas for details of the ID code check.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 392 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 20.7
20. Flash Memory
Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 2)
Pin
VCC, VSS
Name
Power input
I/O
RESET
P4_6/XIN
P4_7/XOUT
P0_1 to P0_3, P0_5
P1_0 to P1_7
P2_0 to P2_7
P3_3 to P3_5
P4_2/VREF
MODE
P0_0
P4_5
Reset input
I
P4_6 input/clock input
P4_7 input/clock output
Input port P0
Input port P1
Input port P2
Input port P3
Input port P4
MODE
TXD output
RXD input
I
I/O
I
I
I
I
I
I/O
O
I
Description
Apply the voltage guaranteed for programming and
erasure to the VCC pin and 0 V to the VSS pin.
Reset input pin.
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator
between the XIN and XOUT pins.
Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open.
Input “L”.
Serial data output pin.
Serial data input pin.
MCU
Data output
VCC
TXD
AVCC
Data input
RXD
MODE
User reset signal
RESET
VSS
AVSS
XIN
XOUT
Connect an oscillation circuit(2)
NOTES:
1. In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O mode
by controlling the MODE input with a switch.
2. An oscillator must be connected. Set the main clock frequency to 1 MHz to 20 MHz.
Refer to Appendix Figure 2.1 Connection Example with M16C Flash Starter (M3A-0806).
Figure 20.25
Example of Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 393 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 20.8
20. Flash Memory
Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 3)
Pin
VCC, VSS
Name
Power input
I/O
Description
Apply the voltage guaranteed for programming and
erasure to the VCC pin and 0 V to the VSS pin.
Reset input pin.
RESET
P4_6/XIN
Reset input
I
P4_6 input/clock input
I
Input port P0
Input port P1
Input port P2
Input port P3
Input port P4
MODE
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open.
I
I
I
I
I/O Serial data I/O pin. Connect to the flash
programmer.
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator
between the XIN and XOUT pins when connecting
P4_7 input/clock output I/O external oscillator. Apply “H” and “L” or leave the pin
open when using as input port.
P4_7/XOUT
P0_0 to P0_3, P0_5
P1_0 to P1_7
P2_0 to P2_7
P3_3 to P3_5
P4_2/VREF, P4_5
MODE
MCU
MODE I/O
MODE
VCC
AVCC
Reset input
RESET
User reset signal
VSS
AVSS
NOTES:
1. Controlled pins and external circuits vary depending on the programmer.
Refer to the programmer manual for details.
2. In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O mode
by connecting a programmer.
3. When operating with the on-chip oscillator clock, it is not necessary to connect an oscillating circuit.
Figure 20.26
Example of Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 3
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 394 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.6
20. Flash Memory
Parallel I/O Mode
Parallel I/O mode is used to input and output software commands, addresses and data necessary to control (read,
program, and erase) the on-chip flash memory. Use a parallel programmer which supports this MCU. Contact the
manufacturer of the parallel programmer for more information, and refer to the user’s manual of the parallel
programmer for details on how to use it.
ROM areas shown in Figures 20.1 and 20.2 can be rewritten in parallel I/O mode.
20.6.1
ROM Code Protect Function
The ROM code protect function disables the reading and rewriting of the flash memory. (Refer to the 20.3.2
ROM Code Protect Function.)
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 395 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.7
20. Flash Memory
Notes on Flash Memory
20.7.1
CPU Rewrite Mode
20.7.1.1
Operating Speed
Before entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0 mode), select 5 MHz or below for the CPU clock using the CM06 bit
in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register. This does not apply to EW1 mode.
20.7.1.2
Prohibited Instructions
The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because they reference data in the flash memory:
UND, INTO, and BRK.
20.7.1.3
Non-Maskable Interrupts
• EW0 Mode
Once a watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor1, or voltage monitor 2 interrupt request
is acknowledged, auto-erasure or auto-programming is forcibly stopped immediately and the flash memory
is reset. Interrupt handling starts after a fixed period and the flash memory restarts.
As the block during auto-erasure or the address during auto-programming is forcibly stopped, the normal
value may not be readable. Execute auto-erasure again and ensure it completes normally.
The watchdog timer does not stop during command operation, so that interrupt requests may be generated.
Initialize the watchdog timer regularly.
Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is being executed because the vector of the
address match interrupt is allocated in ROM.
Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is
allocated in block 0.
• EW1 Mode
Once a watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor1, or voltage monitor 2 interrupt request
is acknowledged, auto-erasure or auto-programming is forcibly stopped immediately and the flash memory
is reset. Interrupt handling starts after a fixed period and the flash memory restarts.
As the block during auto-erasure or the address during auto-programming is forcibly stopped, the normal
value may not be readable. Execute auto-erasure again and ensure it completes normally.
The watchdog timer does not stop even during command operation, so that interrupt requests may be
generated. Initialize the watchdog timer by using the erase-suspend function.
Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is being executed because the vector of the
address match interrupt is allocated in ROM.
Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is
allocated in block 0.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 396 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
20.7.1.4
20. Flash Memory
How to Access
Write 0 before writing 1 when setting Bits FMR01, FMR02 in the FMR0 register, or FMR11 bit in the FMR1
register to 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1.
20.7.1.5
Rewriting User ROM Area
In EW0 Mode, if the supply voltage drops while rewriting any block in which a rewrite control program is
stored, it may not be possible to rewrite the flash memory because the rewrite control program cannot be
rewritten correctly. In this case, use standard serial I/O mode.
20.7.1.6
Program
Do not write additions to the already programmed address.
20.7.1.7
Suspend
Do not use the block erase command during program-suspend.
20.7.1.8
Entering Stop Mode or Wait Mode
Do not enter stop mode or wait mode during erase-suspend.
20.7.1.9
Program and Erase Voltage for Flash Memory
To perform programming and erasure, use VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V as the supply voltage. Do not perform
programming and erasure at less than 2.7 V.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 397 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
21. Reducing Power Consumption
21. Reducing Power Consumption
21.1
Overview
This chapter describes key points and processing methods for reducing power consumption.
21.2
Key Points and Processing Methods for Reducing Power Consumption
Key points for reducing power consumption are shown below. They should be referred to when designing a system
or creating a program.
21.2.1
Voltage Detection Circuit
When voltage monitor 1 is not used, set the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register to 0 (voltage detection 1 circuit
disabled). When voltage monitor 2 is not used, set the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register to 0 (voltage detection 2
circuit disabled).
If the power-on reset and voltage monitor 0 reset are not used, set the VCA25 bit in the VCA2 register to 0
(voltage detection 0 circuit disabled).
21.2.2
Ports
Even after the MCU enters wait mode or stop mode, the states of the I/O ports are retained. Current flows into
the output ports in the active state, and shoot-through current flows into the input ports in the high-impedance
state. Unnecessary ports should be set to input and fixed to a stable electric potential before the MCU enters
wait mode or stop mode.
21.2.3
Clocks
Power consumption generally depends on the number of the operating clocks and their frequencies. The fewer
the number of operating clocks or the lower their frequencies, the more power consumption decreases.
Unnecessary clocks should be stopped accordingly.
Stopping XIN clock: CM05 bit in CM0 register
Stopping low-speed on-chip oscillator oscillation: CM14 bit in CM1 register
Stopping high-speed on-chip oscillator oscillation: HRA00 bit in HRA0 register
21.2.4
Wait Mode, Stop Mode
Power consumption can be reduced in wait mode and stop mode. Refer to 10.4 Power Control for details.
21.2.5
Stopping Peripheral Function Clocks
If the peripheral function f1, f2, f4, f8, and f32 clocks are not necessary in wait mode, set the CM02 bit in the
CM0 register to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait mode). This will stop the f1, f2, f4, f8, and f32 clocks
in wait mode.
21.2.6
Timers
If timer RA is not used, set the TCKCUT bit in the TRAMR register to 1 (count source cutoff).
If timer RB is not used, set the TCKCUT bit in the TRBMR register to 1 (count source cutoff).
21.2.7
A/D Converter
When A/D conversion is not performed, set the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register to 0 (VREF unconnected).
To perform A/D conversion, wait for at least 1 µs after setting the VCUT bit to 1 (VREF connected) before
starting the A/D conversion.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 398 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
21.2.8
21. Reducing Power Consumption
Reducing Internal Power Consumption
When the MCU enters wait mode using low-speed on-chip oscillator mode, internal power consumption can be
reduced by using the VCA20 bit in the VCA2 register. Figure 21.1 shows the Handling Procedure of Internal
Power Low Consumption Using VCA20 Bit. To enable internal power low consumption by the VCA20 bit,
follow Figure 21.1 Handling Procedure of Internal Power Low Consumption Using VCA20 Bit.
Exit wait mode by interrupt
Handling procedure of internal power
low consumption enabled by VCA20 bit
(Note 1)
In interrupt routine
Step (1)
Enter low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (5)
VCA20 ← 0 (internal power low consumption
disabled)(2)
Step (2)
Stop XIN clock and high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (6)
Start XIN clock or high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (3)
VCA20 ← 1 (internal power low consumption
enabled)(2, 3)
Step (7)
(Wait until XIN clock oscillation stabilizes)
Step (4)
Enter wait mode(4)
Step (8)
Enter high-speed clock mode or
high-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (5)
VCA20 ← 0 (internal power low consumption
disabled)(2)
Step (6)
Start XIN clock or high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (7)
(Wait until XIN clock oscillation stabilizes)
Step (8)
Enter high-speed clock mode or
high-speed on-chip oscillator mode
If it is necessary to start
the high-speed clock or
the high-speed on-chip
oscillator in the interrupt
routine, execute steps (5)
to (7) in the interrupt
routine.
Interrupt handling
Step (1)
Enter low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (2)
Stop XIN clock and high-speed on-chip
oscillator clock
Step (3)
VCA20 ← 1 (internal power low consumption
enabled)(2, 3)
If the high-speed clock or
high-speed on-chip
oscillator is started in the
interrupt routine, execute
steps (1) to (3) at the last of
the interrupt routine.
Interrupt handling completed
NOTES:
1. Execute this routine to handle all interrupts generated in wait mode.
However, this does not apply if it is not necessary to start the high-speed clock or high-speed on-chip oscillator during the interrupt routine.
2. Do not set the VCA20 bit to 0 with the instruction immediately after setting the VCA20 bit to 1. Also, do not do the opposite.
3. When the VCA20 bit is set to 1, do not set the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode).
4. When entering wait mode, follow 10.6.2 Wait Mode.
VCA20: Bit in VCA2 register
Figure 21.1
Handling Procedure of Internal Power Low Consumption Using VCA20 Bit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 399 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
21.2.9
21. Reducing Power Consumption
Stopping Flash Memory
In low-speed on-chip oscillator mode, power consumption can be further reduced by stopping the flash memory
using the FMSTP bit in the FMR0 register.
Access to the flash memory is disabled by setting the FMSTP bit to 1 (flash memory stops). The FMSTP bit
must be written to by a program transferred to RAM.
When the MUC enters stop mode or wait mode while CPU rewrite mode is disabled, the power for the flash
memory is automatically turned off. It is turned back on again after the MCU exit stop mode or wait mode. This
eliminates the need to set the FMR0 register.
Figure 21.2 shows the Handling Procedure Example of Low Power Consumption Using FMSTP Bit.
FMSTP bit setting program
Transfer FMSTP bit setting program to RAM
After writing 0 to FMR01 bit, write 1 (CPU
rewrite mode enabled)
Write 1 to FMSTP bit (flash memory stops. low
power consumption state)(1)
Jump to FMSTP bit setting program
(The subsequent processing is executed by
the program in the RAM)
Enter low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Stop high-speed on-chip oscillator
Process in low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Switch clock source for CPU clock(2)
Write 0 to FMSTP bit (flash memory operates)
Write 0 to FMR01 bit (CPU rewrite mode
disabled)
NOTES:
1. After setting the FMR01 bit to 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled),
set the FMSTP bit to 1 (flash memory stops).
2. Before switching the CPU clock source, make sure the designated
clock is stable.
3. Insert a 30 µs wait time by a program.
Do not access to the flash memory during this wait time.
Wait until flash memory circuit stabilizes
(30 µs)(3)
Jump to specified address in flash memory
FMR01, FMSTP: Bits in FMR0 register
Figure 21.2
Handling Procedure Example of Low Power Consumption Using FMSTP Bit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 400 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
21. Reducing Power Consumption
21.2.10 Low-Current-Consumption Read Mode
In low-speed on-chip oscillator mode, the current consumption when reading the flash memory can be reduced
by setting the FMR47 bit in the FMR4 register to 1 (enabled).
Figure 21.3 shows the Handling Procedure Example of Low-Current-Consumption Read Mode.
Handling procedure of
low-current-consumption read mode
enabled by FMR47 bit
Step (1)
low-speed on-chip oscillator mode
Step (2)
Stop high-speed on-chip oscillator clock
Step (3)
FMR47 ← 1 (low-current-consumption read
mode enabled)(1)
Step (4)
Enter low-current-consumption read mode(2)
Step (5)
FMR47 ← 0 (low-current-consumption read
mode disabled)
Step (6)
Start high-speed on-chip oscillator clock
Step (7)
(Wait until high-speed on-chip oscillator clock
oscillation stabilizes)
Step (8)
Enter high-speed on-chip oscillator mode
NOTES:
1. To set the FMR47 bit to 1, first write 0 and then write 1 immediately.
After writing 0, do not generate an interrupt before writing 1.
2. In low-current-consumption read mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled).
FMR47: Bit in FMR4 register
Figure 21.3
Handling Procedure Example of Low-Current-Consumption Read Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 401 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
22. Electrical Characteristics
22. Electrical Characteristics
The electrical characteristics of N version (Topr = –20°C to 85°C) and D version (Topr = –40°C to 85°C) are
listed below.
Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the electrical characteristics in the Y version (Topr =
–20°C to 105°C).
Table 22.1
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Symbol
VCC/AVCC
VI
VO
Pd
Topr
Parameter
Supply voltage
Input voltage
Output voltage
Power dissipation
Operating ambient temperature
Tstg
Storage temperature
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 402 of 450
Condition
Topr = 25°C
Rated Value
−0.3 to 6.5
−0.3 to VCC + 0.3
−0.3 to VCC + 0.3
500
−20 to 85 (N version) /
−40 to 85 (D version)
−65 to 150
Unit
V
V
V
mW
°C
°C
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.2
Recommended Operating Conditions
Symbol
VCC
AVCC
VSS/AVSS
VIH
VIL
IOH(sum)
22. Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
f(XIN)
Supply voltage
Supply voltage
Supply voltage
Input “H” voltage
Input “L” voltage
Peak sum output Sum of all pins IOH(peak)
“H” current
Average sum
Sum of all pins IOH(avg)
output “H” current
Peak output “H”
Except P2_0 to P2_7
current
P2_0 to P2_7
Average output
Except P2_0 to P2_7
“H” current
P2_0 to P2_7
Peak sum output Sum of all pins IOL(peak)
“L” currents
Average sum
Sum of all pins IOL(avg)
output “L”
currents
Peak output “L”
Except P2_0 to P2_7
currents
P2_0 to P2_7
Average output
Except P2_0 to P2_7
“L” current
P2_0 to P2_7
XIN clock input oscillation frequency
−
System clock
IOH(sum)
IOH(peak)
IOH(avg)
IOL(sum)
IOL(sum)
IOL(peak)
IOL(avg)
OCD2 = 0
XlN clock selected
OCD2 = 1
On-chip oscillator clock
selected
Conditions
3.0 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V
2.7 V ≤ VCC < 3.0 V
2.2 V ≤ VCC < 2.7 V
3.0 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V
2.7 V ≤ VCC < 3.0 V
2.2 V ≤ VCC < 2.7 V
FRA01 = 0
Low-speed on-chip
oscillator clock selected
FRA01 = 1
High-speed on-chip
oscillator clock selected
3.0 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V
FRA01 = 1
High-speed on-chip
oscillator clock selected
2.7 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V
FRA01 = 1
High-speed on-chip
oscillator clock selected
2.2 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V
Min.
2.2
2.7
−
0.8 VCC
0
−
Standard
Typ.
−
−
0
−
−
−
Max.
5.5
5.5
−
VCC
0.2 VCC
−160
−
−
−80
mA
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−10
−40
−5
−20
160
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
−
−
80
mA
−
−
−
−
0
0
0
0
0
0
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
125
10
40
5
20
20
10
5
20
10
5
−
mA
mA
mA
mA
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
−
−
20
MHz
−
−
10
MHz
−
−
5
MHz
NOTES:
1. VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V at Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.
2. The average output current indicates the average value of current measured during 100 ms.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 403 of 450
Unit
V
V
V
V
mA
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.3
A/D Converter Characteristics
Symbol
−
−
Rladder
tconv
Vref
VIA
−
22. Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
Resolution
Absolute
accuracy
Conditions
Vref = AVCC
φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = AVCC = 5.0 V
φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = AVCC = 5.0 V
φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = AVCC = 3.3 V
φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = AVCC = 3.3 V
Vref = AVCC
φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = AVCC = 5.0 V
φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = AVCC = 5.0 V
10-bit mode
8-bit mode
10-bit mode
8-bit mode
Resistor ladder
Conversion time 10-bit mode
8-bit mode
Reference voltage
Analog input voltage(2)
A/D operating
Without sample and hold
clock frequency With sample and hold
Vref = AVCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V
Vref = AVCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V
Min.
−
−
−
−
−
10
3.3
2.8
2.2
0
0.25
1
Standard
Typ.
Max.
−
10
−
±3
−
±2
−
±5
−
±2
−
40
−
−
−
−
−
AVCC
−
AVCC
−
−
10
10
Unit
Bits
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
kΩ
µs
µs
V
V
MHz
MHz
NOTES:
1. AVCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.
2. When the analog input voltage is over the reference voltage, the A/D conversion result will be 3FFh in 10-bit mode and FFh in
8-bit mode.
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
Figure 22.1
Ports P0 to P4 Timing Measurement Circuit
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 404 of 450
30pF
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.4
Flash Memory (Program ROM) Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
−
−
Parameter
Program/erase endurance(2)
−
Byte program time
Block erase time
Time delay from suspend request until
suspend
Interval from erase start/restart until
following suspend request
Interval from program start/restart until
following suspend request
Time from suspend until program/erase
restart
Program, erase voltage
Read voltage
Program, erase temperature
−
Data hold time(7)
−
td(SR-SUS)
−
−
−
−
−
22. Electrical Characteristics
Conditions
Min.
Standard
Typ.
−
Unit
Max.
−
times
R8C/2K Group
100(3)
R8C/2L Group
1,000(3)
−
−
−
−
−
times
50
0.4
−
µs
650
−
400
9
97+CPU clock
× 6 cycles
−
µs
0
−
−
ns
−
−
µs
2.7
2.2
0
20
−
3+CPU clock
× 4 cycles
5.5
5.5
60
−
Ambient temperature = 55°C
−
−
−
s
µs
V
V
°C
year
NOTES:
1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = 0 to 60°C, unless otherwise specified.
2. Definition of programming/erasure endurance
The programming and erasure endurance is defined on a per-block basis.
If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100 or 10,000), each block can be erased n times. For example, if 1,024
1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1 Kbyte block, and then the block is erased, the programming/erasure endurance
still stands at one.
However, the same address must not be programmed more than once per erase operation (overwriting prohibited).
3. Endurance to guarantee all electrical characteristics after program and erase. (1 to Min. value can be guaranteed).
4. In a system that executes multiple programming operations, the actual erasure count can be reduced by writing to sequential
addresses in turn so that as much of the block as possible is used up before performing an erase operation. For example,
when programming groups of 16 bytes, the effective number of rewrites can be minimized by programming up to 128 groups
before erasing them all in one operation. It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the
number of erase operations to a certain number.
5. If an error occurs during block erase, attempt to execute the clear status register command, then execute the block erase
command at least three times until the erase error does not occur.
6. Customers desiring program/erase failure rate information should contact their Renesas technical support representative.
7. The data hold time includes time that the power supply is off or the clock is not supplied.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 405 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.5
Flash Memory (Data flash Block A, Block B) Electrical Characteristics(4)
Symbol
−
Parameter
−
Program/erase endurance(2)
Byte program time
(program/erase endurance ≤ 1,000 times)
Byte program time
(program/erase endurance > 1,000 times)
Block erase time
(program/erase endurance ≤ 1,000 times)
Block erase time
(program/erase endurance > 1,000 times)
Time delay from suspend request until
suspend
Interval from erase start/restart until
following suspend request
Interval from program start/restart until
following suspend request
Time from suspend until program/erase
restart
Program, erase voltage
Read voltage
Program, erase temperature
−
Data hold time(9)
−
−
−
−
td(SR-SUS)
−
−
−
−
−
22. Electrical Characteristics
Conditions
Min.
Unit
Max.
−
times
50
400
µs
−
65
−
µs
−
0.2
9
s
−
0.3
−
s
−
−
µs
650
−
97+CPU clock
× 6 cycles
−
µs
0
−
−
ns
−
−
µs
2.7
2.2
−
−20(8)
−
3+CPU clock
× 4 cycles
5.5
5.5
85
20
−
−
year
10,000(3)
−
Ambient temperature = 55 °C
Standard
Typ.
−
−
V
V
°C
NOTES:
1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.
2. Definition of programming/erasure endurance
The programming and erasure endurance is defined on a per-block basis.
If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100 or 10,000), each block can be erased n times. For example, if 1,024
1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1 Kbyte block, and then the block is erased, the programming/erasure endurance
still stands at one.
However, the same address must not be programmed more than once per erase operation (overwriting prohibited).
3. Endurance to guarantee all electrical characteristics after program and erase. (1 to Min. value can be guaranteed).
4. Standard of block A and block B when program and erase endurance exceeds 1,000 times. Byte program time to 1,000 times
is the same as that in program ROM.
5. In a system that executes multiple programming operations, the actual erasure count can be reduced by writing to sequential
addresses in turn so that as much of the block as possible is used up before performing an erase operation. For example,
when programming groups of 16 bytes, the effective number of rewrites can be minimized by programming up to 128 groups
before erasing them all in one operation. It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the
number of erase operations to a certain number.
6. If an error occurs during block erase, attempt to execute the clear status register command, then execute the block erase
command at least three times until the erase error does not occur.
7. Customers desiring program/erase failure rate information should contact their Renesas technical support representative.
8. −40°C for D version.
9. The data hold time includes time that the power supply is off or the clock is not supplied.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 406 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
22. Electrical Characteristics
Suspend request
(maskable interrupt request)
FMR46
Clock-dependent
time
Fixed time
Access restart
td(SR-SUS)
Figure 22.2
Table 22.6
Time delay until Suspend
Voltage Detection 0 Circuit Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
Vdet0
−
td(E-A)
Vccmin
Parameter
Voltage detection level
Voltage detection circuit self power consumption
Waiting time until voltage detection circuit operation
starts(2)
MCU operating voltage minimum value
Condition
VCA25 = 1, VCC = 5.0 V
Min.
2.2
−
−
2.2
Standard
Typ.
Max.
2.3
2.4
0.9
−
−
300
−
−
Unit
V
µA
µs
V
NOTES:
1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V and Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version).
2. Necessary time until the voltage detection circuit operates when setting to 1 again after setting the VCA25 bit in the VCA2
register to 0.
Table 22.7
Voltage Detection 1 Circuit Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Vdet1
Voltage detection level(4)
−
Voltage monitor 1 interrupt request generation time(2)
Voltage detection circuit self power consumption
Waiting time until voltage detection circuit operation
starts(3)
−
td(E-A)
Condition
VCA26 = 1, VCC = 5.0 V
Min.
2.70
Standard
Typ.
Max.
2.85
3.00
Unit
V
−
40
−
µs
−
0.6
−
−
100
µA
−
µs
NOTES:
1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V and Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version).
2. Time until the voltage monitor 1 interrupt request is generated after the voltage passes Vdet1.
3. Necessary time until the voltage detection circuit operates when setting to 1 again after setting the VCA26 bit in the VCA2
register to 0.
4. This parameter shows the voltage detection level when the power supply drops.
The voltage detection level when the power supply rises is higher than the voltage detection level when the power supply
drops by approximately 0.1 V.
Table 22.8
Voltage Detection 2 Circuit Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Vdet2
Voltage detection level
−
Voltage monitor 2 interrupt request generation time(2)
Voltage detection circuit self power consumption
Waiting time until voltage detection circuit operation
starts(3)
−
td(E-A)
Condition
VCA27 = 1, VCC = 5.0 V
Min.
3.3
−
−
−
Standard
Typ.
Max.
3.6
3.9
40
−
0.6
−
−
100
Unit
V
µs
µA
µs
NOTES:
1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V and Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version).
2. Time until the voltage monitor 2 interrupt request is generated after the voltage passes Vdet2.
3. Necessary time until the voltage detection circuit operates after setting to 1 again after setting the VCA27 bit in the VCA2
register to 0.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 407 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.9
Power-on Reset Circuit, Voltage Monitor 0 Reset Electrical Characteristics(3)
Symbol
Vpor1
22. Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
Condition
Vpor2
Power-on reset valid voltage(4)
Power-on reset or voltage monitor 0 reset valid
voltage
trth
External power VCC rise gradient(2)
Min.
−
Standard
Typ.
−
Max.
0.1
0
−
Vdet0
V
20
−
−
mV/msec
Unit
V
NOTES:
1. The measurement condition is Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.
2. This condition (external power VCC rise gradient) does not apply if VCC ≥ 1.0 V.
3. To use the power-on reset function, enable voltage monitor 0 reset by setting the LVD0ON bit in the OFS register to 0, the
VW0C0 and VW0C6 bits in the VW0C register to 1 respectively, and the VCA25 bit in the VCA2 register to 1.
4. tw(por1) indicates the duration the external power VCC must be held below the effective voltage (Vpor1) to enable a power on
reset. When turning on the power for the first time, maintain tw(por1) for 30 s or more if −20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C, maintain tw(por1) for
3,000 s or more if −40°C ≤ Topr < −20°C.
Vdet0(3)
Vdet0(3)
2.2V
trth
trth
External
Power VCC
Vpor2
Vpor1
Sampling time(1, 2)
tw(por1)
Internal
reset signal
(“L” valid)
1
× 32
fOCO-S
1
× 32
fOCO-S
NOTES:
1. When using the voltage monitor 0 digital filter, ensure that the voltage is within the MCU operation voltage
range (2.2 V or above) during the sampling time.
2. The sampling clock can be selected. Refer to 6. Voltage Detection Circuit for details.
3. Vdet0 indicates the voltage detection level of the voltage detection 0 circuit. Refer to 6. Voltage Detection
Circuit for details.
Figure 22.3
Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 408 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.10
22. Electrical Characteristics
High-speed On-Chip Oscillator Circuit Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
fOCO40M
High-speed on-chip oscillator frequency
temperature • supply voltage dependence
High-speed on-chip oscillator frequency when
correction value in FRA7 register is written to
FRA1 register(4)
−
Value in FRA1 register after reset
−
Oscillation frequency adjustment unit of highspeed on-chip oscillator
−
−
Condition
Standard
Unit
Min.
Typ.
Max.
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V
−20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C(2)
39.2
40
40.8
MHz
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V
−40°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C(2)
39.0
40
41.0
MHz
VCC = 2.2 V to 5.5 V
−20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C(3)
35.2
40
44.8
MHz
VCC = 2.2 V to 5.5 V
−40°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C(3)
34.0
40
46.0
MHz
−
36.864
−
MHz
−3%
−
3%
%
VCC = 5.0 V, Topr = 25°C
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V
−20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C
08h
−
F7h
−
Adjust FRA1 register
(value after reset) to -1
−
+0.3
−
MHz
Oscillation stability time
VCC = 5.0 V, Topr = 25°C
−
10
100
µs
Self power consumption at oscillation
VCC = 5.0 V, Topr = 25°C
−
550
−
µA
NOTES:
1. VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V, Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.
2. These standard values show when the FRA1 register value after reset is assumed.
3. These standard values show when the corrected value of the FRA6 register is written to the FRA1 register.
4. This enables the setting errors of bit rates such as 9600 bps and 38400 bps to be 0% when the serial interface is used in
UART mode.
Table 22.11
Low-speed On-Chip Oscillator Circuit Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Standard
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
fOCO-S
Low-speed on-chip oscillator frequency
30
125
250
−
Oscillation stability time
−
10
100
µs
−
Self power consumption at oscillation
−
15
−
µA
VCC = 5.0 V, Topr = 25°C
kHz
NOTE:
1. VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V, Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.
Table 22.12
Power Supply Circuit Timing Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Standard
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
td(P-R)
Time for internal power supply stabilization during
power-on(2)
1
−
2000
µs
td(R-S)
STOP exit time(3)
−
−
150
µs
NOTES:
1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.2 to 5.5 V and Topr = 25°C.
2. Waiting time until the internal power supply generation circuit stabilizes during power-on.
3. Time until system clock supply starts after the interrupt is acknowledged to exit stop mode.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 409 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.13
Electrical Characteristics (1) [VCC = 5 V]
Symbol
VOH
Parameter
Output “H”
voltage
Except P2_0 to P2_7,
XOUT
P2_0 to P2_7
XOUT
VOL
Output “L” voltage Except P2_0 to P2_7,
XOUT
P2_0 to P2_7
XOUT
VT+-VT-
IIH
IIL
RPULLUP
RfXIN
VRAM
22. Electrical Characteristics
Hysteresis
Condition
IOH = −5 mA
IOH = −200 µA
Drive capacity HIGH
Drive capacity LOW
Drive capacity HIGH
Drive capacity LOW
IOL = 5 mA
IOL = 200 µA
Drive capacity HIGH
Drive capacity LOW
Drive capacity HIGH
Drive capacity LOW
INT0, INT1, INT3,
KI0, KI1, KI2, KI3,
TRAIO, RXD0, RXD2,
CLK0, CLK2
RESET
Input “H” current
Input “L” current
Pull-up resistance
Feedback
XIN
resistance
RAM hold voltage
VI = 5 V, VCC = 5 V
VI = 0 V, VCC = 5 V
VI = 0 V, VCC = 5 V
During stop mode
IOH = −20 mA
IOH = −5 mA
IOH = −1 mA
IOH = −500 µA
IOL = 20 mA
IOL = 5 mA
IOL = 1 mA
IOL = 500 µA
Standard
Min.
Typ.
VCC − 2.0
−
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC − 2.0
−
VCC − 2.0
−
VCC − 2.0
−
VCC − 2.0
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
0.1
0.5
Max.
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
2.0
0.45
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
−
Unit
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
0.1
1.0
−
V
−
−
µA
−
30
−
−
50
1.0
5.0
−5.0
167
−
µA
kΩ
MΩ
1.8
−
−
V
NOTE:
1. VCC = 4.2 to 5.5 V at Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), f(XIN) = 20 MHz, unless otherwise specified.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 410 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.14
Symbol
ICC
22. Electrical Characteristics
Electrical Characteristics (2) [Vcc = 5 V]
(Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.)
Parameter
Condition
Power supply
High-speed
current
clock mode
(VCC = 3.3 to 5.5 V)
Single-chip mode,
output pins are
open, other pins
are VSS
High-speed
on-chip
oscillator mode
Low-speed
on-chip
oscillator mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
XIN = 20 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
Min.
−
Standard
Typ.
Max.
10
17
Unit
mA
XIN = 16 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
−
9
15
mA
XIN = 10 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
−
6
−
mA
XIN = 20 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
−
5
−
mA
XIN = 16 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
−
4
−
mA
XIN = 10 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
−
2.5
−
mA
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 20 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
−
10
15
mA
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 20 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
−
4
−
mA
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 10 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
−
5.5
10
mA
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 10 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
−
2.5
−
mA
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8, FMR47 = 1
−
130
300
µA
Page 411 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.15
Symbol
ICC
22. Electrical Characteristics
Electrical Characteristics (3) [Vcc = 5 V]
(Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.)
Parameter
Condition
Power supply
Wait mode
current
(VCC = 3.3 to 5.5 V)
Single-chip mode,
output pins are
open, other pins
are VSS
Stop mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
While a WAIT instruction is executed
Peripheral clock operation
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
VCA20 = 1
Min.
−
Standard
Typ.
Max.
25
75
Unit
µA
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
While a WAIT instruction is executed
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
VCA20 = 1
−
23
60
µA
XIN clock off, Topr = 25°C
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator off
CM10 = 1
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
−
0.8
3.0
µA
XIN clock off, Topr = 85°C
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator off
CM10 = 1
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
−
1.2
−
µA
Page 412 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
22. Electrical Characteristics
Timing Requirements
(Unless Otherwise Specified: VCC = 5 V, VSS = 0 V at Topr = 25°C) [VCC = 5 V]
Table 22.16
XIN Input
Symbol
tc(XIN)
tWH(XIN)
tWL(XIN)
Standard
Min.
Max.
50
−
25
−
25
−
Parameter
XIN input cycle time
XIN input “H” width
XIN input “L” width
tC(XIN)
Unit
ns
ns
ns
VCC = 5 V
tWH(XIN)
XIN input
tWL(XIN)
Figure 22.4
Table 22.17
XIN Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V
TRAIO Input
Symbol
tc(TRAIO)
tWH(TRAIO)
tWL(TRAIO)
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
−
40
−
40
−
Parameter
TRAIO input cycle time
TRAIO input “H” width
TRAIO input “L” width
tC(TRAIO)
tWH(TRAIO)
TRAIO input
tWL(TRAIO)
Figure 22.5
TRAIO Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 413 of 450
Unit
ns
ns
ns
VCC = 5 V
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.18
22. Electrical Characteristics
Serial Interface
Symbol
tc(CK)
tW(CKH)
tW(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
−
100
−
100
−
−
50
0
−
50
−
90
−
Parameter
CLKi input cycle time
CLKi input “H” width
CLKi input “L” width
TXDi output delay time
TXDi hold time
RXDi input setup time
RXDi input hold time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
i = 0, 2
VCC = 5 V
tC(CK)
tW(CKH)
CLKi
tW(CKL)
th(C-Q)
TXDi
td(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
RXDi
i = 0, 2
Figure 22.6
Table 22.19
Serial Interface Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V
External Interrupt INTi (i = 0, 1, 3) Input
tW(INH)
INTi input “H” width
Standard
Min.
Max.
(1)
−
250
tW(INL)
INTi input “L” width
250(2)
Symbol
Parameter
−
Unit
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. When selecting the digital filter by the INTi input filter select bit, use an INTi input HIGH width of either (1/digital filter clock
frequency × 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater.
2. When selecting the digital filter by the INTi input filter select bit, use an INTi input LOW width of either (1/digital filter clock
frequency × 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater.
VCC = 5 V
tW(INL)
INTi input
tW(INH)
i = 0, 1, 3
Figure 22.7
External Interrupt INTi Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 414 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.20
Electrical Characteristics (1) [VCC = 3 V]
Symbol
VOH
22. Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
Output “H” voltage
Except P2_0 to P2_7,
XOUT
P2_0 to P2_7
XOUT
VOL
Output “L” voltage
Except P2_0 to P2_7,
XOUT
P2_0 to P2_7
XOUT
VT+-VT-
Hysteresis
IIH
IIL
RPULLUP
RfXIN
VRAM
Input “H” current
Input “L” current
Pull-up resistance
Feedback resistance
RAM hold voltage
Condition
IOH = −1 mA
Standard
Min.
Typ.
VCC − 0.5
−
Max.
VCC
Unit
V
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
IOL = 1 mA
IOH = −5 mA
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
IOH = −1 mA
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
IOH = −0.1 mA VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
IOH = −50 µA
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
−
−
0.5
V
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
IOL = 5 mA
−
−
0.5
V
IOL = 1 mA
−
−
0.5
V
IOL = 0.1 mA
−
−
0.5
V
IOL = 50 µA
−
−
0.5
V
0.1
0.3
−
V
0.1
0.4
−
V
−
−
µA
−
66
−
1.8
−
160
3.0
−
4.0
−4.0
500
−
−
INT0, INT1, INT3,
KI0, KI1, KI2, KI3,
TRAIO, RXD0, RXD2,
CLK0, CLK2
RESET
VI = 3 V, VCC = 3 V
VI = 0 V, VCC = 3 V
VI = 0 V, VCC = 3 V
XIN
During stop mode
µA
kΩ
MΩ
V
NOTE:
1. VCC =2.7 to 3.3 V at Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), f(XIN) = 10 MHz, unless otherwise specified.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 415 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.21
Symbol
ICC
22. Electrical Characteristics
Electrical Characteristics (2) [Vcc = 3 V]
(Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.)
Parameter
Condition
Power supply current High-speed
(VCC = 2.7 to 3.3 V)
clock mode
Single-chip mode,
output pins are open,
other pins are VSS
High-speed
on-chip
oscillator
mode
Low-speed
on-chip
oscillator
mode
Wait mode
Stop mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
XIN = 10 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
XIN = 10 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 10 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 10 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8, FMR47 = 1
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
While a WAIT instruction is executed
Peripheral clock operation
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
VCA20 = 1
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
While a WAIT instruction is executed
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
VCA20 = 1
XIN clock off, Topr = 25°C
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator off
CM10 = 1
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
XIN clock off, Topr = 85°C
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator off
CM10 = 1
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
Page 416 of 450
Min.
−
Standard
Typ.
Max.
6
−
Unit
mA
−
2
−
mA
−
5
9
mA
−
2
−
mA
−
130
300
µA
−
25
70
µA
−
23
55
µA
−
0.7
3.0
µA
−
1.1
−
µA
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
22. Electrical Characteristics
Timing requirements
(Unless Otherwise Specified: VCC = 3 V, VSS = 0 V at Topr = 25°C) [VCC = 3 V]
Table 22.22
XIN Input
Symbol
tc(XIN)
tWH(XIN)
tWL(XIN)
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
−
40
−
40
−
Parameter
XIN input cycle time
XIN input “H” width
XIN input “L” width
tC(XIN)
Unit
ns
ns
ns
VCC = 3 V
tWH(XIN)
XIN input
tWL(XIN)
Figure 22.8
XIN Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V
Table 22.23
TRAIO Input
Symbol
tc(TRAIO)
tWH(TRAIO)
tWL(TRAIO)
Standard
Min.
Max.
300
−
120
−
120
−
Parameter
TRAIO input cycle time
TRAIO input “H” width
TRAIO input “L” width
tC(TRAIO)
tWH(TRAIO)
TRAIO input
tWL(TRAIO)
Figure 22.9
TRAIO Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 417 of 450
Unit
ns
ns
ns
VCC = 3 V
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.24
22. Electrical Characteristics
Serial Interface
Symbol
tc(CK)
tW(CKH)
tW(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
Standard
Min.
Max.
300
−
150
−
150
−
−
80
0
−
70
−
90
−
Parameter
CLKi input cycle time
CLKi input “H” width
CLKi Input “L” width
TXDi output delay time
TXDi hold time
RXDi input setup time
RXDi input hold time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
i = 0, 2
VCC = 3 V
tC(CK)
tW(CKH)
CLKi
tW(CKL)
th(C-Q)
TXDi
td(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
RXDi
i = 0, 2
Figure 22.10
Table 22.25
Serial Interface Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V
External Interrupt INTi (i = 0, 1, 3) Input
tW(INH)
INTi input “H” width
Standard
Min.
Max.
(1)
−
380
tW(INL)
INTi input “L” width
380(2)
Symbol
Parameter
Unit
−
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. When selecting the digital filter by the INTi input filter select bit, use an INTi input HIGH width of either (1/digital filter clock
frequency × 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater.
2. When selecting the digital filter by the INTi input filter select bit, use an INTi input LOW width of either (1/digital filter clock
frequency × 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater.
VCC = 3 V
tW(INL)
INTi input
tW(INH)
i = 0, 1, 3
Figure 22.11
External Interrupt INTi Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 418 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.26
Electrical Characteristics (1) [VCC = 2.2 V]
Symbol
VOH
22. Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
Output “H” voltage
Except P2_0 to P2_7,
XOUT
P2_0 to P2_7
XOUT
VOL
Output “L” voltage
Except P2_0 to P2_7,
XOUT
P2_0 to P2_7
XOUT
VT+-VT-
Hysteresis
IIH
IIL
RPULLUP
RfXIN
VRAM
Input “H” current
Input “L” current
Pull-up resistance
Feedback resistance
RAM hold voltage
Condition
IOH = −1 mA
Standard
Min.
Typ.
VCC − 0.5
−
Max.
VCC
IOH = −2 mA
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
IOH = −1 mA
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
IOH = −0.1 mA VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
IOH = −50 µA
VCC − 0.5
−
VCC
V
−
−
0.5
V
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
IOL = 2 mA
−
−
0.5
V
IOL = 1 mA
−
−
0.5
V
IOL = 0.1 mA
−
−
0.5
V
IOL = 50 µA
−
−
0.5
V
0.05
0.3
−
V
0.05
0.15
−
V
−
−
µA
−
100
−
1.8
−
200
5
−
4.0
−4.0
600
−
−
INT0, INT1, INT3,
KI0, KI1, KI2, KI3,
TRAIO, RXD0, RXD2,
CLK0, CLK2
VI = 2.2 V
VI = 0 V
VI = 0 V
XIN
During stop mode
NOTE:
1. VCC = 2.2 V at Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), f(XIN) = 5 MHz, unless otherwise specified.
Page 419 of 450
V
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
Drive capacity
HIGH
Drive capacity
LOW
IOL = 1 mA
RESET
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Unit
µA
kΩ
MΩ
V
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.27
Symbol
ICC
22. Electrical Characteristics
Electrical Characteristics (2) [Vcc = 2.2 V]
(Topr = −20 to 85°C (N version) / −40 to 85°C (D version), unless otherwise specified.)
Parameter
Condition
Power supply current High-speed
(VCC = 2.2 to 2.7 V)
clock mode
Single-chip mode,
output pins are open,
other pins are VSS
High-speed
on-chip
oscillator
mode
Low-speed
on-chip
oscillator
mode
Wait mode
Stop mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
XIN = 5 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
XIN = 5 MHz (square wave)
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 5 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
No division
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator on fOCO = 5 MHz
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
Divide-by-8, FMR47 = 1
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
While a WAIT instruction is executed
Peripheral clock operation
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
VCA20 = 1
XIN clock off
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz
While a WAIT instruction is executed
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
VCA20 = 1
XIN clock off, Topr = 25°C
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator off
CM10 = 1
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
XIN clock off, Topr = 85°C
High-speed on-chip oscillator off
Low-speed on-chip oscillator off
CM10 = 1
Peripheral clock off
VCA27 = VCA26 = VCA25 = 0
Page 420 of 450
Min.
−
Standard
Typ.
Max.
3.5
−
Unit
mA
−
1.5
−
mA
−
3.5
−
mA
−
1.5
−
mA
−
100
230
µA
−
22
60
µA
−
20
55
µA
−
0.7
3.0
µA
−
1.1
−
µA
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
22. Electrical Characteristics
Timing requirements
(Unless Otherwise Specified: VCC = 2.2 V, VSS = 0 V at Topr = 25°C) [VCC = 2.2 V]
Table 22.28
XIN Input
Symbol
tc(XIN)
tWH(XIN)
tWL(XIN)
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
−
90
−
90
−
Parameter
XIN input cycle time
XIN input “H” width
XIN input “L” width
tC(XIN)
Unit
ns
ns
ns
VCC = 2.2 V
tWH(XIN)
XIN input
tWL(XIN)
Figure 22.12
XIN Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 2.2 V
Table 22.29
TRAIO Input
Symbol
tc(TRAIO)
tWH(TRAIO)
tWL(TRAIO)
Standard
Min.
Max.
500
−
200
−
200
−
Parameter
TRAIO input cycle time
TRAIO input “H” width
TRAIO input “L” width
tC(TRAIO)
tWH(TRAIO)
TRAIO input
tWL(TRAIO)
Figure 22.13
TRAIO Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 2.2 V
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 421 of 450
Unit
ns
ns
ns
VCC = 2.2 V
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Table 22.30
22. Electrical Characteristics
Serial Interface
Symbol
tc(CK)
tW(CKH)
tW(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
Standard
Min.
Max.
800
−
400
−
400
−
−
200
0
−
150
−
90
−
Parameter
CLKi input cycle time
CLKi input “H” width
CLKi input “L” width
TXDi output delay time
TXDi hold time
RXDi input setup time
RXDi input hold time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
i = 0, 2
VCC = 2.2 V
tC(CK)
tW(CKH)
CLKi
tW(CKL)
th(C-Q)
TXDi
td(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
RXDi
i = 0, 2
Figure 22.14
Table 22.31
Serial Interface Timing Diagram when VCC = 2.2 V
External Interrupt INTi (i = 0, 1, 3) Input
INTi input “H” width
Standard
Min.
Max.
−
1000(1)
INTi input “L” width
1000(2)
Symbol
tW(INH)
tW(INL)
Parameter
−
Unit
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. When selecting the digital filter by the INTi input filter select bit, use an INTi input HIGH width of either (1/digital filter clock
frequency × 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater.
2. When selecting the digital filter by the INTi input filter select bit, use an INTi input LOW width of either (1/digital filter clock
frequency × 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater.
VCC = 2.2 V
tW(INL)
INTi input
tW(INH)
i = 0, 1, 3
Figure 22.15
External Interrupt INTi Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 2.2 V
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 422 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23. Usage Notes
23. Usage Notes
23.1
Notes on Clock Generation Circuit
23.1.1
Stop Mode
When entering stop mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and the
CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (stop mode). An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the instruction
which sets the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode) and the program stops.
Insert at least 4 NOP instructions following the JMP.B instruction after the instruction which sets the CM10 bit
to 1.
• Program example to enter stop mode
BCLR
BSET
FSET
BSET
JMP.B
LABEL_001 :
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
23.1.2
1,FMR0
0,PRCR
I
0,CM1
LABEL_001
; CPU rewrite mode disabled
; Protect disabled
; Enable interrupt
; Stop mode
Wait Mode
When entering wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and
execute the WAIT instruction. An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the WAIT instruction and the
program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions after the WAIT instruction.
• Program example to execute the WAIT instruction
BCLR
1,FMR0
FSET
I
WAIT
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
23.1.3
; CPU rewrite mode disabled
; Enable interrupt
; Wait mode
Oscillation Stop Detection Function
Since the oscillation stop detection function cannot be used if the XIN clock frequency is 2 MHz or below, set
bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b.
23.1.4
Oscillation Circuit Constants
Ask the manufacturer of the oscillator to specify the best oscillation circuit constants for your system.
To use this MCU with supply voltage below VCC = 2.7 V, it is recommended to set the CM11 bit in the CM1
register to 1 (on-chip feedback resistor disabled), the CM15 bit to 1 (high drive capacity), and connect the
feedback resistor to the chip externally.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 423 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.2
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Interrupts
23.2.1
Reading Address 00000h
Do not read address 00000h by a program. When a maskable interrupt request is acknowledged, the CPU reads
interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) from 00000h in the interrupt sequence. At
this time, the acknowledged interrupt IR bit is set to 0.
If address 00000h is read by a program, the IR bit for the interrupt which has the highest priority among the
enabled interrupts is set to 0. This may cause the interrupt to be canceled, or an unexpected interrupt to be
generated.
23.2.2
SP Setting
Set any value in the SP before an interrupt is acknowledged. The SP is set to 0000h after reset. Therefore, if an
interrupt is acknowledged before setting a value in the SP, the program may run out of control.
23.2.3
External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt
Either “L” level or an “H” level of width shown in the Electrical Characteristics is necessary for the signal input
to pins INT0, INT1, INT3 and pins KI0 to KI3, regardless of the CPU clock.
For details, refer to Table 22.19 (VCC = 5V), Table 22.25 (VCC = 3V), Table 22.31 (VCC = 2.2V) External
Interrupt INTi (i = 0, 1, 3) Input.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 424 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.2.4
23. Usage Notes
Changing Interrupt Sources
The IR bit in the interrupt control register may be set to 1 (interrupt requested) when the interrupt source
changes. When using an interrupt, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after changing the interrupt source.
In addition, changes of interrupt sources include all factors that change the interrupt sources assigned to
individual software interrupt numbers, polarities, and timing. Therefore, if a mode change of a peripheral
function involves interrupt sources, edge polarities, and timing, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after
the change. Refer to the individual peripheral function for its related interrupts.
Figure 23.1 shows an Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources.
Interrupt source change
Disable interrupts(2, 3)
Change interrupt source (including mode
of peripheral function)
Set the IR bit to 0 (interrupt not requested)
using the MOV instruction(3)
Enable interrupts (2, 3)
Change completed
IR bit:
The interrupt control register bit of an
interrupt whose source is changed.
NOTES:
1. Execute the above settings individually. Do not execute two
or more settings at once (by one instruction).
2. To prevent interrupt requests from being generated disable
the peripheral function before changing the interrupt
source. In this case, use the I flag if all maskable interrupts
can be disabled. If all maskable interrupts cannot be
disabled, use bits ILVL0 to ILVL2 of the interrupt whose
source is changed.
3. Refer to 12.6.5 Changing Interrupt Control Register
Contents for the instructions to be used and usage notes.
Figure 23.1
Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 425 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.2.5
23. Usage Notes
Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents
(a) The contents of an interrupt control register can only be changed while no interrupt requests corresponding
to that register are generated. If interrupt requests may be generated, disable interrupts before changing the
interrupt control register contents.
(b) When changing the contents of an interrupt control register after disabling interrupts, be careful to choose
appropriate instructions.
Changing any bit other than IR bit
If an interrupt request corresponding to a register is generated while executing the instruction, the IR bit
may not be set to 1 (interrupt requested), and the interrupt request may be ignored. If this causes a problem,
use the following instructions to change the register: AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
Changing IR bit
If the IR bit is set to 0 (interrupt not requested), it may not be set to 0 depending on the instruction used.
Therefore, use the MOV instruction to set the IR bit to 0.
(c) When disabling interrupts using the I flag, set the I flag as shown in the sample programs below. Refer to
(b) regarding changing the contents of interrupt control registers by the sample programs.
Sample programs 1 to 3 are for preventing the I flag from being set to 1 (interrupts enabled) before the interrupt
control register is changed for reasons of the internal bus or the instruction queue buffer.
Example 1:
Use NOP instructions to prevent I flag from being set to 1 before interrupt control register
is changed
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupts
AND.B #00H,0056H
; Set TRAIC register to 00h
NOP
;
NOP
FSET
I
; Enable interrupts
Example 2: Use dummy read to delay FSET instruction
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupts
AND.B #00H,0056H
; Set TRAIC register to 00h
MOV.W MEM,R0
; Dummy read
FSET
I
; Enable interrupts
Example 3: Use POPC instruction to change I flag
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupts
AND.B #00H,0056H
; Set TRAIC register to 00h
POPC
FLG
; Enable interrupts
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 426 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Timers
23.3.1
Notes on Timer RA
• Timer RA stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer RA and timer RA prescalers before the count
starts.
• Even if the prescaler and timer RA are read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the
MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being
read.
• In pulse period measurement mode, bits TEDGF and TUNDF in the TRACR register can be set to 0 by
writing 0 to these bits by a program. However, these bits remain unchanged if 1 is written. When using the
READ-MODIFY-WRITE instruction for the TRACR register, the TEDGF or TUNDF bit may be set to 0
although these bits are set to 1 while the instruction is being executed. In this case, write 1 to the TEDGF or
TUNDF bit which is not supposed to be set to 0 with the MOV instruction.
• When changing to pulse period measurement mode from another mode, the contents of bits TEDGF and
TUNDF are undefined. Write 0 to bits TEDGF and TUNDF before the count starts.
• The TEDGF bit may be set to 1 by the first timer RA prescaler underflow generated after the count starts.
• When using the pulse period measurement mode, leave two or more periods of the timer RA prescaler
immediately after the count starts, then set the TEDGF bit to 0.
• The TCSTF bit retains 0 (count stops) for 0 to 1 cycle of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 1
(count starts) while the count is stopped.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RA(1) other than the TCSTF bit. Timer RA
starts counting at the first valid edge of the count source after The TCSTF bit is set to 1 (during count).
The TCSTF bit remains 1 for 0 to 1 cycle of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 0 (count stops)
while the count is in progress. Timer RA counting is stopped when the TCSTF bit is set to 0.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RA(1) other than the TCSTF bit.
NOTE:
1.Registers associated with timer RA: TRACR, TRAIOC, TRAMR, TRAPRE, and TRA.
• When the TRAPRE register is continuously written during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow three
or more cycles of the count source clock for each write interval.
• When the TRA register is continuously written during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow three or
more cycles of the prescaler underflow for each write interval.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 427 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3.2
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Timer RB
• Timer RB stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer RB and timer RB prescalers before the count
starts.
• Even if the prescaler and timer RB is read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the
MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being
read.
• In programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, when setting
the TSTART bit in the TRBCR register to 0, 0 (stops counting) or setting the TOSSP bit in the TRBOCR
register to 1 (stops one-shot), the timer reloads the value of reload register and stops. Therefore, in
programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, read the timer
count value before the timer stops.
• The TCSTF bit remains 0 (count stops) for 1 to 2 cycles of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 1
(count starts) while the count is stopped.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RB(1) other than the TCSTF bit. Timer RB
starts counting at the first valid edge of the count source after the TCSTF bit is set to 1 (during count).
The TCSTF bit remains 1 for 1 to 2 cycles of the count source after setting the TSTART bit to 0 (count stops)
while the count is in progress. Timer RB counting is stopped when the TCSTF bit is set to 0.
During this time, do not access registers associated with timer RB(1) other than the TCSTF bit.
NOTE:
1.Registers associated with timer RB: TRBCR, TRBOCR, TRBIOC, TRBMR, TRBPRE, TRBSC, and
TRBPR.
• If the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register is set to 1 during timer operation, timer RB stops immediately.
• If 1 is written to the TOSST or TOSSP bit in the TRBOCR register, the value of the TOSSTF bit changes after
one or two cycles of the count source have elapsed. If the TOSSP bit is written to 1 during the period between
when the TOSST bit is written to 1 and when the TOSSTF bit is set to 1, the TOSSTF bit may be set to either
0 or 1 depending on the content state. Likewise, if the TOSST bit is written to 1 during the period between
when the TOSSP bit is written to 1 and when the TOSSTF bit is set to 0, the TOSSTF bit may be set to either
0 or 1.
23.3.2.1
Timer mode
The following workaround should be performed in timer mode.
To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the following
points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the count source for each
write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow for
each write interval.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 428 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3.2.2
23. Usage Notes
Programmable waveform generation mode
The following three workarounds should be performed in programmable waveform generation mode.
(1) To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the
following points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the count source for each
write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow for
each write interval.
(2) To change registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), synchronize the
TRBO output cycle using a timer RB interrupt, etc. This operation should be preformed only once in the
same output cycle. Also, make sure that writing to the TRBPR register does not occur during period A
shown in Figures 23.2 and 23.3.
The following shows the detailed workaround examples.
• Workaround example (a):
As shown in Figure 23.2, write to registers TRBSC and TRBPR in the timer RB interrupt routine. These write
operations must be completed by the beginning of period A.
Period A
Count source/
prescaler
underflow signal
TRBO pin output
IR bit in
TRBIC register
Primary period
(a)
Interrupt request is
acknowledged
Secondary period
Ensure sufficient time
(b)
Interrupt request
is generated
Interrupt
Instruction in
sequence interrupt routine
Set the secondary and then
the primary register immediately
(a) Period between interrupt request generation and the completion of execution of an instruction. The length of time
varies depending on the instruction being executed.
The DIVX instruction requires the longest time, 30 cycles (assuming no wait states and that a register is set as
the divisor).
(b) 20 cycles. 21 cycles for address match and single-step interrupts.
Figure 23.2
Workaround Example (a) When Timer RB interrupt is Used
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 429 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23. Usage Notes
• Workaround example (b):
As shown in Figure 23.3 detect the start of the primary period by the TRBO pin output level and write to
registers TRBSC and TRBPR. These write operations must be completed by the beginning of period A.
If the port register’s bit value is read after the port direction register’s bit corresponding to the TRBO pin is set
to 0 (input mode), the read value indicates the TRBO pin output value.
Period A
Count source/
prescaler
underflow signal
TRBO pin output
Read value of the port register’s
bit corresponding to the TRBO pin
(when the bit in the port direction
register is set to 0)
Primary period
Secondary period
(i) (ii) (iii)
Ensure sufficient time
The TRBO output inversion
is detected at the end of the
secondary period.
Figure 23.3
Upon detecting (i), set the secondary and
then the primary register immediately.
Workaround Example (b) When TRBO Pin Output Value is Read
(3) To stop the timer counting in the primary period, use the TSTOP bit in the TRBCR register. In this case,
registers TRBPRE and TRBPR are initialized and their values are set to the values after reset.
23.3.2.3
Programmable one-shot generation mode
The following two workarounds should be performed in programmable one-shot generation mode.
(1) To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the
following points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow three
or more cycles of the count source for each write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), allow three
or more cycles of the prescaler underflow for each write interval.
(2) Do not set both the TRBPRE and TRBPR registers to 00h.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 430 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3.2.4
23. Usage Notes
Programmable wait one-shot generation mode
The following three workarounds should be performed in programmable wait one-shot generation mode.
(1) To write to registers TRBPRE and TRBPR during count operation (TCSTF bit is set to 1), note the
following points:
• When the TRBPRE register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the count source for each
write interval.
• When the TRBPR register is written continuously, allow three or more cycles of the prescaler underflow for
each write interval.
(2) Do not set both the TRBPRE and TRBPR registers to 00h.
(3) Set registers TRBSC and TRBPR using the following procedure.
(a) To use “INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled” as the count start condition
Set the TRBSC register and then the TRBPR register. At this time, after writing to the TRBPR
register, allow an interval of 0.5 or more cycles of the count source before trigger input from the
INT0 pin.
(b) To use “writing 1 to TOSST bit” as the start condition
Set the TRBSC register, the TRBPR register, and then TOSST bit. At this time, after writing to the
TRBPR register, allow an interval of 0.5 or more cycles of the count source before writing to the
TOSST bit.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 431 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3.3
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Timer RC
23.3.3.1
TRC Register
• The following note applies when the CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1 (clear TRC register at
compare match with TRCGRA register).
When using a program to write a value to the TRC register while the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register is set
to 1 (count starts), ensure that the write does not overlap with the timing with which the TRC register is set to
0000h.
If the timing of the write to the TRC register and the setting of the TRC register to 0000h coincide, the write
value will not be written to the TRC register and the TRC register will be set to 0000h.
• Reading from the TRC register immediately after writing to it can result in the value previous to the write
being read out. To prevent this, execute the JMP.B instruction between the read and the write instructions.
Program Example
MOV.W
#XXXXh, TRC
;Write
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B instruction
L1:
MOV.W
TRC,DATA
;Read
23.3.3.2
TRCSR Register
Reading from the TRCSR register immediately after writing to it can result in the value previous to the write
being read out. To prevent this, execute the JMP.B instruction between the read and the write instructions.
Program Example
MOV.B
#XXh, TRCSR
;Write
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B instruction
L1:
MOV.B
TRCSR,DATA
;Read
23.3.3.3
Count Source Switching
• Stop the count before switching the count source.
Switching procedure
(1) Set the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change the settings of bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRCCR1 register.
• After switching the count source from fOCO40M to another clock, allow a minimum of two cycles of f1 to
elapse after changing the clock setting before stopping fOCO40M.
Switching procedure
(1) Set the TSTART bit in the TRCMR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change the settings of bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRCCR1 register.
(3) Wait for a minimum of two cycles of f1.
(4) Set the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register to 0 (high-speed on-chip oscillator off).
23.3.3.4
Input Capture Function
• The pulse width of the input capture signal should be three cycles or more of the timer RC operation clock
(refer to Table 16.11 Timer RC Operation Clock).
• The value of the TRC register is transferred to the TRCGRj register one or two cycles of the timer RC
operation clock after the input capture signal is input to the TRCIOj (j = A, B, C, or D) pin (when the digital
filter function is not used).
23.3.3.5
TRCMR Register in PWM2 Mode
When the CSEL bit in the TRCCR2 register is set to 1 (count stops at compare match with the TRCGRA
register), do not set the TRCMR register at compare match timing of registers TRC and TRCGRA.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 432 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3.4
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Timer RD
23.3.4.1
TRDSTR Register
• Set the TRDSTR register using the MOV instruction.
• When the CSELi (i = 0 to 1) is set to 0 (the count stops at compare match of registers TRDi and TRDGRAi),
the count does not stop and the TSTARTi bit remains unchanged even if 0 (count stops) is written to the
TSTARTi bit.
• Therefore, set the TSTARTi bit to 0 to change other bits without changing the TSTARTi bit when the CSELi
bit is se to 0.
• To stop counting by a program, set the TSTARTi bit after setting the CSELi bit to 1. Although the CSELi bit is
set to 1 and the TSTARTi bit is set to 0 at the same time (with 1 instruction), the count cannot be stopped.
• Table 23.1 lists the TRDIOji (j = A, B, C, or D) Pin Output Level when Count Stops to use the TRDIOji (j =
A, B, C, or D) pin with the timer RD output.
Table 23.1
TRDIOji (j = A, B, C, or D) Pin Output Level when Count Stops
Count Stop
When the CSELi bit is set to 1, set the TSTARTi bit to 0 and the count
stops.
When the CSELi bit is set to 0, the count stops at compare match of
registers TRDi and TRDGRAi.
23.3.4.2
TRDIOji Pin Output when Count Stops
Hold the output level immediately before the
count stops.
Hold the output level after output changes by
compare match.
TRDi Register (i = 0 or 1)
• When writing the value to the TRDi register by a program while the TSTARTi bit in the TRDSTR register is
set to 1 (count starts), avoid overlapping with the timing for setting the TRDi register to 0000h, and then write.
If the timing for setting the TRDi register to 0000h overlaps with the timing for writing the value to the TRDi
register, the value is not written and the TRDi register is set to 0000h.
These precautions are applicable when selecting the following by bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TRDCRi
register.
- 001b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRAi register.)
- 010b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRBi register.)
- 011b (Synchronous clear)
- 101b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRCi register.)
- 110b (Clear by the TRDi register at compare match with the TRDGRDi register.)
• When writing the value to the TRDi register and continuously reading the same register, the value before
writing may be read. In this case, execute the JMP.B instruction between the writing and reading.
Program example
MOV.W
#XXXXh, TRD0
;Writing
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B
L1:
MOV.W
TRD0,DATA
;Reading
23.3.4.3
TRDSRi Register (i = 0 or 1)
When writing the value to the TRDSRi register and continuously reading the same register, the value before
writing may be read. In this case, execute the JMP.B instruction between the writing and reading.
Program example
MOV.B
#XXh, TRDSR0
;Writing
JMP.B
L1
;JMP.B
L1:
MOV.B
TRDSR0,DATA
;Reading
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 433 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.3.4.4
23. Usage Notes
Count Source Switch
• Switch the count source after the count stops.
Change procedure
(1) Set the TSTARTi (i = 0 or 1) bit in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register.
• When changing the count source from fOCO40M to another source and stopping fOCO40M, wait 2 cycles of
f1 or more after setting the clock switch, and then stop fOCO40M.
Change procedure
(1) Set the TSTARTi (i = 0 or 1) bit in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Change bits TCK2 to TCK0 in the TRDCRi register.
(3) Wait 2 or more cycles of f1.
(4) Set the FRA00 bit in the FRA0 register to 0 (high-speed on-chip oscillator stops).
23.3.4.5
Input Capture Function
• Set the pulse width of the input capture signal to 3 or more cycles of the timer RD operation clock (refer to
Table 16.25 Timer RD Operation Clocks).
• The value in the TRDi register is transferred to the TRDGRji register 2 to 3 cycles of the timer RD operation
clock after the input capture signal is applied to the TRDIOji pin (i = 0 or 1, j = either A, B, C, or D) (no digital
filter).
23.3.4.6
Reset Synchronous PWM Mode
• When reset synchronous PWM mode is used for motor control, make sure OLS0 = OLS1.
• Set to reset synchronous PWM mode by the following procedure:
Change procedure
(1) Set the TSTART0 bit in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, and PWM3 mode).
(3) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 to 01b (reset synchronous PWM mode).
(4) Set the other registers associated with timer RD again.
23.3.4.7
Complementary PWM Mode
• When complementary PWM mode is used for motor control, make sure OLS0 = OLS1.
• Change bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register in the following procedure.
Change procedure: When setting to complementary PWM mode (including re-set), or changing the transfer
timing from the buffer register to the general register in complementary PWM mode.
(1) Set both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, and PWM3 mode).
(3) Set bits CMD1 to CMD0 to 10b or 11b (complementary PWM mode).
(4) Set the registers associated with other timer RD again.
Change procedure: When stopping complementary PWM mode
(1) Set both the TSTART0 and TSTART1 bits in the TRDSTR register to 0 (count stops).
(2) Set bits CMD1 to CMD to 00b (timer mode, PWM mode, and PWM3 mode).
• Do not write to TRDGRA0, TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, or TRDGRB1 register during operation.
When changing the PWM waveform, transfer the values written to registers TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, and
TRDGRD1 to registers TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1 using the buffer operation.
However, to write data to the TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, or TRDGRD1 register, set bits BFD0, BFC1, and
BFD1 to 0 (general register). After this, bits BFD0, BFC1, and BFD1 may be set to 1 (buffer register).
The PWM period cannot be changed.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 434 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23. Usage Notes
• If the value in the TRDGRA0 register is assumed to be m, the TRD0 register counts m-1, m, m+1, m, m-1, in
that order, when changing from increment to decrement operation.
When changing from m to m+1, the IMFA bit is set to 1. Also, bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register
are set to 11b (complementary PWM mode, buffer data transferred at compare match between registers TRD0
and TRDGRA0), the content in the buffer registers (TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, and TRDGRD1) is transferred to
the general registers (TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1).
During m+1, m, and m-1 operation, the IMFA bit remains unchanged and data are not transferred to registers
such as the TRDGRA0 register.
Count value in TRD0
register
m+1
Setting value in
TRDGRA0
register m
Set to 0 by a program
IMFA bit in
TRDSR0 register
No change
1
0
Transferred from
buffer register
When bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the
TRDFCR register are set to 11b
(transfer from the buffer register to the
general register at compare match of
between registers TRD0 and
TRDGRA0).
TRDGRB0 register
TRDGRA1 register
TRDGRB1 register
Figure 23.4
Not transferred from buffer register
Operation at Compare Match between Registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 in
Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 435 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23. Usage Notes
• The TRD1 register counts 1, 0, FFFFh, 0, 1, in that order, when changing from decrement to increment
operation.
The UDF bit is set to 1 when changing between 1, 0, and FFFFh operation. Also, when bits CMD1 to CMD0
in the TRDFCR register are set to 10b (complementary PWM mode, buffer data transferred at underflow in
the TRD1 register), the content in the buffer registers (TRDGRD0, TRDGRC1, and TRDGRD1) is transferred
to the general registers (TRDGRB0, TRDGRA1, and TRDGRB1). During FFFFh, 0, 1 operation, data are not
transferred to registers such as the TRDGRB0 register. Also, at this time, the OVF bit remains unchanged.
Count value in TRD0
register
1
0
FFFFh
Set to 0 by a program
UDF bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
OVF bit in
TRDSR0 register
1
0
No change
0
Transferred from
buffer register
TRDGRB0 register
TRDGRA1 register
TRDGRB1 register
Figure 23.5
Not transferred from buffer register
When bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the
TRDFCR register are set to 10b
(transfer from the buffer register to the
general register when the TRD1 register
underflows).
Operation when TRD1 Register Underflows in Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 436 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23. Usage Notes
• Select with bits CMD1 to CMD0 the timing of data transfer from the buffer register to the general register.
However, transfer takes place with the following timing in spite of the value of bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the
following cases:
Value in buffer register ≥ value in TRDGRA0 register:
Transfer take place at underflow of the TRD1 register.
After this, when the buffer register is set to 0001h or above and a smaller value than the value of the
TRDGRA0 register, and the TRD1 register underflows for the first time after setting, the value is transferred
to the general register. After that, the value is transferred with the timing selected by bits CMD1 to CMD0.
n3
m+1
Count value in TRD0
register
n2
n1
Count value in TRD1
register
0000h
TRDGRD0 register
n2
n1
Transfer with timing set by
bits CMD1 to CMD0
n2
n1
Transfer
Transfer
Transfer
TRDGRB0 register
n2
n3
n3
Transfer at
underflow of TRD1
register because of
n3 > m
Transfer
n2
Transfer at
underflow of TRD1
register because
of first setting to
n2 < m
n1
Transfer with timing set by
bits CMD1 to CMD0
TRDIOB0 output
TRDIOD0 output
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 11b (data in the buffer register is transferred at compare match
between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 in complementary PWM mode).
• Both the OSL0 and OLS1 bits in the TRDFCR register are set to 1 (active ‘H” for normal-phase and counter-phase).
Figure 23.6
Operation when Value in Buffer Register ≥ Value in TRDGRA0 Register in
Complementary PWM Mode
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 437 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23. Usage Notes
When the value in the buffer register is set to 0000h:
Transfer takes place at compare match between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0.
After this, when the buffer register is set to 0001h or above and a smaller value than the value of the
TRDGRA0 register, and a compare match occurs between registers TRD0 and TRDGRA0 for the first time
after setting, the value is transferred to the general register. After that, the value is transferred with the timing
selected by bits CMD1 to CMD0.
m+1
Count value in TRD0 register
n2
n1
Count value in TRD1 register
0000h
TRDGRD0 register
0000h
n1
Transfer
Transfer
TRDGRB0 register
n2
n1
n1
Transfer with timing
set by bits CMD1 to
CMD0
Transfer
0000h
Transfer at compare
match between
registers TRD0 and
TRDGRA0 because
content in TRDGRD0
register is set to
0000h.
Transfer
n1
Transfer at compare
match between
registers TRD0 and
TRDGRA0 because
of first setting to
0001h ≤ n1 < m
Transfer with timing
set by bits CMD1 to
CMD0
TRDIOB0 output
TRDIOD0 output
m: Value set in TRDGRA0 register
The above applies under the following conditions:
• Bits CMD1 to CMD0 in the TRDFCR register are set to 10b (data in the buffer register is transferred at underflow of the TRD1 register in
PWM mode).
• Both the OLS0 and OLS1 bits in the TRDFCR register are set to 1 (active “H” for normal-phase and counter-phase).
Figure 23.7
23.3.4.8
Operation when Value in Buffer Register Is Set to 0000h in Complementary PWM
Mode
Count Source fOCO40M
• The count source fOCO40M can be used with supply voltage VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V. For supply voltage other
than that, do not set bits TCK2 to TCK0 in registers TRDCR0 and TRDCR to 110b (select fOCO40M as the
count source).
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 438 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.4
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Serial Interface
• When reading data from the UiRB (i = 0 or 2) register either in the clock synchronous serial I/O mode or in the
clock asynchronous serial I/O mode. Ensure the data is read in 16-bit units. When the high-order byte of the UiRB
register is read, bits PER and FER in the UiRB register and the RI bit in the UiC1 register are set to 0.
To check receive errors, read the UiRB register and then use the read data.
Example (when reading receive buffer register):
MOV.W
00A6H,R0
; Read the U0RB register
• When writing data to the UiTB register in the clock asynchronous serial I/O mode with 9-bit transfer data length,
write data to the high-order byte first then the low-order byte, in 8-bit units.
Example (when reading transmit buffer register):
MOV.B
#XXH,00A3H ; Write the high-order byte of U0TB register
MOV.B
#XXH,00A2H ; Write the low-order byte of U0TB register
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 439 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.5
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Hardware LIN
For the time-out processing of the header and response fields, use another timer to measure the duration of time
with a Synch Break detection interrupt as the starting point.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 440 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.6
23. Usage Notes
Notes on A/D Converter
• Write to each bit (other than bit 6) in the ADCON0 register, each bit in the ADCON1 register, or the SMP bit in
the ADCON2 register when A/D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs).
When the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register is changed from 0 (VREF not connected) to 1 (VREF connected),
wait for at least 1 µs before starting the A/D conversion.
• After changing the A/D operating mode, select an analog input pin again.
• When using the one-shot mode, ensure that A/D conversion is completed before reading the AD register. The IR
bit in the ADIC register or the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register can be used to determine whether A/D
conversion is completed.
• When using the repeat mode, select the frequency of the A/D converter operating clock φAD or more for the CPU
clock during A/D conversion.
• If the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register is set to 0 (A/D conversion stops) by a program and A/D conversion is
forcibly terminated during an A/D conversion operation, the conversion result of the A/D converter will be
undefined. If the ADST bit is set to 0 by a program, do not use the value of the AD register.
• Connect 0.1 µF capacitor between the P4_2/VREF pin and AVSS pin.
• Do not enter stop mode during A/D conversion.
• Do not enter wait mode when the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait
mode) during A/D conversion.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 441 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.7
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Flash Memory
23.7.1
CPU Rewrite Mode
23.7.1.1
Operating Speed
Before entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0 mode), select 5 MHz or below for the CPU clock using the CM06 bit
in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register. This does not apply to EW1 mode.
23.7.1.2
Prohibited Instructions
The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because they reference data in the flash memory:
UND, INTO, and BRK.
23.7.1.3
Non-Maskable Interrupts
• EW0 Mode
Once a watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor1, or voltage monitor 2 interrupt request is
acknowledged, auto-erasure or auto-programming is forcibly stopped immediately and the flash memory is
reset. Interrupt handling starts after a fixed period and the flash memory restarts.
As the block during auto-erasure or the address during auto-programming is forcibly stopped, the normal
value may not be readable. Execute auto-erasure again and ensure it completes normally.
The watchdog timer does not stop during command operation, so that interrupt requests may be generated.
Initialize the watchdog timer regularly.
Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is being executed because the vector of the address
match interrupt is allocated in ROM.
Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is
allocated in block 0.
• EW1 Mode
Once a watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor1, or voltage monitor 2 interrupt request is
acknowledged, auto-erasure or auto-programming is forcibly stopped immediately and the flash memory is
reset. Interrupt handling starts after a fixed period and the flash memory restarts.
As the block during auto-erasure or the address during auto-programming is forcibly stopped, the normal
value may not be readable. Execute auto-erasure again and ensure it completes normally.
The watchdog timer does not stop even during command operation, so that interrupt requests may be
generated. Initialize the watchdog timer by using the erase-suspend function.
Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is being executed because the vector of the address
match interrupt is allocated in ROM.
Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is
allocated in block 0.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 442 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.7.1.4
23. Usage Notes
How to Access
Write 0 before writing 1 when setting Bits FMR01, FMR02 in the FMR0 register, or FMR11 bit in the FMR1
register to 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1.
23.7.1.5
Rewriting User ROM Area
In EW0 Mode, if the supply voltage drops while rewriting any block in which a rewrite control program is
stored, it may not be possible to rewrite the flash memory because the rewrite control program cannot be
rewritten correctly. In this case, use standard serial I/O mode.
23.7.1.6
Program
Do not write additions to the already programmed address.
23.7.1.7
Suspend
Do not use the block erase command during program-suspend.
23.7.1.8
Entering Stop Mode or Wait Mode
Do not enter stop mode or wait mode during erase-suspend.
23.7.1.9
Program and Erase Voltage for Flash Memory
To perform programming and erasure, use VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V as the supply voltage. Do not perform
programming and erasure at less than 2.7 V.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 443 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
23.8
23. Usage Notes
Notes on Noise
23.8.1
Inserting a Bypass Capacitor between VCC and VSS Pins as a Countermeasure
against Noise and Latch-up
Connect a bypass capacitor (at least 0.1 µF) using the shortest and thickest write possible.
23.8.2
Countermeasures against Noise Error of Port Control Registers
During rigorous noise testing or the like, external noise (mainly power supply system noise) can exceed the
capacity of the MCU's internal noise control circuitry. In such cases the contents of the port related registers
may be changed.
As a firmware countermeasure, it is recommended that the port registers, port direction registers, and pull-up
control registers be reset periodically. However, examine the control processing fully before introducing the
reset routine as conflicts may be created between the reset routine and interrupt routines.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 444 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
24. Notes for On-Chip Debugger
24. Notes for On-Chip Debugger
When using the on-chip debugger to develop and debug programs for the R8C/2K Group and R8C/2L Group take note
of the following.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Some of the user flash memory and RAM areas are used by the on-ship debugger. These areas cannot be accessed
by the user.
Refer to the on-chip debugger manual for which areas are used.
Do not set the address match interrupt (registers AIER, RMAD0, and RMAD1 and fixed vector tables) in a user
system.
Do not use the BRK instruction in a user system.
Debugging is available under the condition of supply voltage VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V. Debugging with the on-chip
debugger under less than 2.7 V is not allowed.
Connecting and using the on-chip debugger has some special restrictions. Refer to the on-chip debugger manual for
details.
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 445 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions
Diagrams showing the latest package dimensions and mounting information are available in the “Packages” section of
the Renesas Technology website.
JEITA Package Code
P-LQFP32-7x7-0.80
RENESAS Code
PLQP0032GB-A
Previous Code
32P6U-A
MASS[Typ.]
0.2g
HD
*1
D
24
17
NOTE)
1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2"
DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH.
2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT
INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET.
16
25
bp
c
c1
HE
*2
E
b1
Reference Dimension in Millimeters
Symbol
32
9
1
ZE
Terminal cross section
8
ZD
c
A
A1
F
A2
Index mark
L
D
E
A2
HD
HE
A
A1
bp
b1
c
c1
L1
y
e
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
*3
Detail F
bp
x
Page 446 of 450
e
x
y
ZD
ZE
L
L1
Min Nom Max
6.9 7.0 7.1
6.9 7.0 7.1
1.4
8.8 9.0 9.2
8.8 9.0 9.2
1.7
0.1 0.2
0
0.32 0.37 0.42
0.35
0.09 0.145 0.20
0.125
0°
8°
0.8
0.20
0.10
0.7
0.7
0.3 0.5 0.7
1.0
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging
Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip
Debugging Emulator
Appendix Figure 2.1 shows a Connection Example with M16C Flash Starter (M3A-0806) and Appendix Figure 2.2
shows a Connection Example with E8 Emulator (R0E000080KCE00).
VCC
25
27
VSS
Connect
oscillation
circuit(1)
26
24
2
23
R8C/2K Group,
R8C/2L Group
RESET
28
1
(2)
TXD
29
30
32
31
MODE
3
4
5
6
7
22
21
20
19
18
17
8
16
15
14
13
12
11
9
10
10
TXD
7 VSS
RXD 4
1 VCC
M16C Flash Starter
(M3A-0806)
(2)
RXD
NOTES:
1. An oscillation circuit must be connected, even when operating with the on-chip oscillator clock.
2. For development tools only.
Appendix Figure 2.1
Connection Example with M16C Flash Starter (M3A-0806)
VCC
Open collector buffer
12
RESET
23
3
4
5
22
21
20
19
18
17
8
15
16
14
13
11
12
9
10
8
VCC
7
MODE
10
25
13
26
14
27
24
2
6
4.7kΩ ±10%
28
1
R8C/2K Group,
R8C/2L Group
VSS
30
Connect
oscillation
circuit(1)
29
32
4.7kΩ or more
31
User logic
7 MODE
6
4
2
VSS
E8 emulator
(R0E000080KCE00)
Appendix Figure 2.2
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
NOTE:
1. It is not necessary to connect an oscillation circuit when
operating with the on-chip oscillator clock.
Connection Example with E8 Emulator (R0E000080KCE00)
Page 447 of 450
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Appendix 3. Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit
Appendix 3. Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit
Appendix Figure 3.1 shows an Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit.
VCC
25
26
27
28
24
2
23
R8C/2K Group,
R8C/2L Group
3
4
VSS
29
30
Connect
oscillation
circuit
31
32
RESET
1
5
6
7
22
21
20
19
18
8
17
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit
Page 448 of 450
16
Appendix Figure 3.1
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
NOTE:
1. After reset, the XIN clock stops.
Write a program to oscillate the XIN clock.
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Index
Index
[A]
AD ....................................................................................... 351
ADCON0 ............................................................................. 350
ADCON1 ............................................................................. 351
ADCON2 ............................................................................. 351
ADIC .................................................................................... 102
AIER .................................................................................... 117
[C]
CM0 ....................................................................................... 74
CM1 ....................................................................................... 75
CSPR .................................................................................. 131
[F]
FMR0 .................................................................................. 367
FMR1 .................................................................................. 370
FMR4 .................................................................................. 371
FRA0 ..................................................................................... 77
FRA1 ..................................................................................... 77
FRA2 ..................................................................................... 78
FRA6 ..................................................................................... 78
FRA7 ..................................................................................... 78
[I]
INT0IC ................................................................................. 104
INT1IC ................................................................................. 104
INT3IC ................................................................................. 104
INTEN ................................................................................. 111
INTF .................................................................................... 112
[K]
KIEN .................................................................................... 115
KUPIC ................................................................................. 102
[L]
LINCR ................................................................................. 335
LINCR2 ............................................................................... 335
LINST .................................................................................. 336
[O]
OCD ...................................................................................... 76
OFS ............................................................... 26, 126, 131, 365
[P]
P2DRR .................................................................................. 55
PDi (i = 0 to 4) ....................................................................... 54
Pi (i = 0 to 4) .......................................................................... 55
PINSR1 ......................................................................... 56, 321
PINSR2 ......................................................................... 56, 153
PINSR3 ......................................................................... 56, 177
PM0 ....................................................................................... 69
PM1 ....................................................................................... 69
PMR .............................................................................. 56, 111
PRCR .................................................................................... 96
PUR0 ..................................................................................... 57
PUR1 ..................................................................................... 57
[R]
RMAD0 ................................................................................ 117
RMAD1 ................................................................................ 117
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 449 of 450
[S]
S0RIC
S0TIC
S2RIC
S2TIC
.................................................................................. 102
.................................................................................. 102
.................................................................................. 102
.................................................................................. 102
[T]
TRA ..................................................................................... 138
TRACR ................................................................................ 137
TRAIC .................................................................................. 102
TRAIOC ....................................... 137, 139, 142, 144, 146, 149
TRAMR ................................................................................ 138
TRAPRE .............................................................................. 138
TRBCR ................................................................................ 154
TRBIC .................................................................................. 102
TRBIOC ............................................... 155, 157, 161, 164, 168
TRBMR ................................................................................ 155
TRBOCR ............................................................................. 154
TRBPR ................................................................................ 156
TRBPRE .............................................................................. 156
TRBSC ................................................................................ 156
TRC ..................................................................................... 181
TRCCR1 ...................................................... 178, 201, 205, 210
TRCCR2 .............................................................................. 182
TRCDF ................................................................................ 183
TRCGRA ............................................................................. 181
TRCGRB ............................................................................. 181
TRCGRC ............................................................................. 181
TRCGRD ............................................................................. 181
TRCIC .................................................................................. 103
TRCIER ............................................................................... 179
TRCIOR0 ............................................................. 185, 194, 199
TRCIOR1 ............................................................. 185, 195, 200
TRCMR ................................................................................ 177
TRCOER ............................................................................. 184
TRCSR ................................................................................ 180
TRD0 ........................................... 237, 253, 267, 278, 290, 304
TRD0IC ................................................................................ 103
TRD1 ........................................................... 237, 253, 267, 290
TRD1IC ................................................................................ 103
TRDCR0 ...................................... 233, 248, 264, 276, 287, 302
TRDCR1 ...................................................... 233, 248, 264, 287
TRDDF0 .............................................................................. 232
TRDDF1 .............................................................................. 232
TRDFCR ...................................... 231, 245, 262, 274, 285, 299
TRDGRAi (i = 0 to 1) ................... 238, 253, 268, 279, 290, 305
TRDGRBi (i = 0 to 1) ................... 238, 253, 268, 279, 290, 305
TRDGRCi (i = 0 to 1) ................... 238, 253, 268, 279, 290, 305
TRDGRDi (i = 0 to 1) ................... 238, 253, 268, 279, 290, 305
TRDIER0 ..................................... 237, 252, 266, 278, 289, 304
TRDIER1 ..................................... 237, 252, 266, 278, 289, 304
TRDIORA0 .................................................................. 234, 249
TRDIORA1 .................................................................. 234, 249
TRDIORC0 .................................................................. 235, 250
TRDIORC1 .................................................................. 235, 250
TRDMR ........................................ 229, 243, 260, 273, 284, 298
TRDOCR ............................................................. 247, 264, 301
TRDOER1 ........................................... 246, 263, 275, 286, 300
TRDOER2 ........................................... 246, 263, 275, 286, 300
TRDPMR ............................................................. 230, 244, 261
TRDPOCR0 ......................................................................... 267
TRDPOCR1 ......................................................................... 267
TRDSR0 ...................................... 236, 251, 265, 277, 288, 303
TRDSR1 ...................................... 236, 251, 265, 277, 288, 303
TRDSTR ...................................... 229, 243, 260, 273, 283, 297
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
[U]
U0BRG ................................................................................ 318
U0C0 ................................................................................... 319
U0C1 ................................................................................... 320
U0MR .................................................................................. 318
U0RB ................................................................................... 320
U0TB ................................................................................... 319
U2BRG ................................................................................ 318
U2C0 ................................................................................... 319
U2C1 ................................................................................... 320
U2MR .................................................................................. 318
U2RB ................................................................................... 320
U2TB ................................................................................... 319
[V]
VCA1 ..................................................................................... 35
VCA2 ............................................................................... 35, 79
VW0C .................................................................................... 36
VW1C .................................................................................... 37
VW2C .................................................................................... 38
[W]
WDC .................................................................................... 130
WDTR ................................................................................. 130
WDTS .................................................................................. 130
Rev.1.10 Dec 21, 2007
REJ09B0406-0110
Page 450 of 450
Index
REVISION HISTORY
REVISION HISTORY
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group Hardware Manual
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group Hardware Manual
Description
Rev.
Date
0.10
Jul 20, 2007
−
0.20
Aug 31, 2007
108
Figure 12.11 “UART1 receive”, “UART1 transmit” deleted
199
Figure 16.50
“• The CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 0 .... compare match).”
→ “• The CCLR bit in the TRCCR1 register is set to 1 .... compare
match).”
200
Table 16.20 “j = A, B, C, or D” → “ j = B, C, or D”
254
Figure 16.96 revised
338
Figure 18.9
“When the SBE bit .... timer RA may be used in timer mode after the
SBDCT flag in the LINST register is set to 1.” → “When the SBE bit ....
timer RA can be used in timer mode after the SBDCT flag in the LINST
register is set to 1 and the RXDSF flag is set to 0.”
355
Figure 19.10
“SW5 conducts when compare operation is in progress.” added
442
Appendix Figure 2.1 revised
1.00
Nov 7, 2007
Page
Summary
First Edition issued
All pages “Preliminary” deleted
3, 5
Table 1.2, Table 1.4;
Current consumption: “TBD” → “Typ. 10 mA” “Typ. 6 mA” “Typ. 2.0 µA”
“Typ. 0.7 µA” revised
6, 7
Table 1.5, Table 1.6 revised
Figure 1.1, Figure 1.2; ROM number “XXX” added, NOTE1 added
20
Table 4.4 “005Fh” “006Fh” “007Fh” “008Fh” added
45, 56
Figure 7.11 added
58 to 60 Table 7.5 NOTE3 added
Table 7.6, Table 7.7, Table 7.10, Table 7.12, Table 7.14 NOTE2 added
65
Table 7.28 NOTE2 and NOTE3 added
Table 7.29, Table 7.31 NOTE2 added
111
Figure 12.12 added
136
Figure 16.1 “TSTART” → “TCSTF” revised
153
Figure 16.13 added
176
Table 16.13 “00F7h” added
177
Figure 16.28 added
307
Figure 16.145 “TSTP0” → “CSEL0” revised
321
Figure 17.6 added
402
Table 22.2 NOTE2 revised
410, 411 Table 22.14, Table 22.15 revised
415, 419 Table 22.21, Table 22.27 revised
447
Appendix Figure 3.1 revised
C-1
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
1.10
Dec 21, 2007
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
3, 5
Table 1.2, Table 1.4: revised, NOTE2 added
6, 7
Figure 1.1, Figure 1.2: “Y: Operating ambient ....”, NOTE1 added
15, 16
Figure 3.1, Figure 3.2: “Expanded area” deleted
17
Table 4.1 “002Ch” added, “003Bh” “003Ch” “003Dh” deleted
20
Table 4.4 “00D4h” “00D6h” revised
22
Table 4.6 “0143h” revised
35
Figure 6.5 “VCA Register” NOTE7 deleted
59
Table 7.11 revised
73
Figure 10.2 revised
78
Figure 10.7 “FRA7 Register” added
79
Figure 10.8 NOTE7 deleted
82
10.2.2 revised
83
10.3.8 revised
185
Figure 16.38 TRCIOR0: b3 revised, NOTE4 added
192
16.3.4, Table 16.16: revised
193
Figure 16.44 revised
194
Figure 14.45 b3 revised, NOTE3 added
199
Figure 14.49 b3 revised
203
Table 16.20 Interrupt request generation timing: Specification “... and
TRCGRj match)” → “... and TRCGRh match)”
“h = A, B, C, or D” added
209
Table 16.22 “ j = A, B, C, or D” → “ j = A, B, or C”
297
Figure 16.135 b1 revised
331
Table 17.7 revised
402
22. “The electrical characteristics ....” added
408
Table 21.10 Symbol “fOCO40M”: Parameter added, NOTE4 added
C-2
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group Hardware Manual
Publication Date:
Published by:
Rev.0.10
Rev.1.10
Jul 20, 2007
Dec 21, 2007
Sales Strategic Planning Div.
Renesas Technology Corp.
© 2007. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan
R8C/2K Group, R8C/2L Group
Hardware Manual
2-6-2, Ote-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0004, Japan